blob: cd048456d3b704668ac20b95617d7b4eae7d2d06 [file] [log] [blame]
Bram Moolenaar75ab5902022-04-18 15:36:40 +01001*options.txt* For Vim version 8.2. Last change: 2022 Apr 13
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002
3
4 VIM REFERENCE MANUAL by Bram Moolenaar
5
6
7Options *options*
8
91. Setting options |set-option|
102. Automatically setting options |auto-setting|
113. Options summary |option-summary|
12
Bram Moolenaar2ec618c2016-10-01 14:47:05 +020013For an overview of options see quickref.txt |option-list|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +000014
15Vim has a number of internal variables and switches which can be set to
16achieve special effects. These options come in three forms:
17 boolean can only be on or off *boolean* *toggle*
18 number has a numeric value
19 string has a string value
20
21==============================================================================
Bram Moolenaarf75a9632005-09-13 21:20:47 +0000221. Setting options *set-option* *E764*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +000023
24 *:se* *:set*
Bram Moolenaar6b915c02020-01-18 15:53:19 +010025:se[t][!] Show all options that differ from their default value.
26 When [!] is present every option is on a separate
27 line.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +000028
Bram Moolenaar6b915c02020-01-18 15:53:19 +010029:se[t][!] all Show all but terminal options.
30 When [!] is present every option is on a separate
31 line.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +000032
33:se[t] termcap Show all terminal options. Note that in the GUI the
34 key codes are not shown, because they are generated
35 internally and can't be changed. Changing the terminal
36 codes in the GUI is not useful either...
37
Bram Moolenaar47003982021-12-05 21:54:04 +000038:se[t]! termcap Idem, but don't use multiple columns.
39
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +000040 *E518* *E519*
41:se[t] {option}? Show value of {option}.
42
43:se[t] {option} Toggle option: set, switch it on.
44 Number option: show value.
45 String option: show value.
46
47:se[t] no{option} Toggle option: Reset, switch it off.
48
Bram Moolenaar00a927d2010-05-14 23:24:24 +020049 *:set-!* *:set-inv*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +000050:se[t] {option}! or
Bram Moolenaar6c60f472019-04-28 16:00:35 +020051:se[t] inv{option} Toggle option: Invert value.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +000052
53 *:set-default* *:set-&* *:set-&vi* *:set-&vim*
54:se[t] {option}& Reset option to its default value. May depend on the
Bram Moolenaar6c60f472019-04-28 16:00:35 +020055 current value of 'compatible'.
56:se[t] {option}&vi Reset option to its Vi default value.
57:se[t] {option}&vim Reset option to its Vim default value.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +000058
Bram Moolenaar22f1d0e2018-02-27 14:53:30 +010059:se[t] all& Set all options to their default value. The values of
Bram Moolenaar88774fd2015-08-25 19:52:04 +020060 these options are not changed:
61 all terminal options, starting with t_
62 'columns'
63 'cryptmethod'
64 'encoding'
65 'key'
66 'lines'
67 'term'
68 'ttymouse'
69 'ttytype'
70 Warning: This may have a lot of side effects.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +000071
72 *:set-args* *E487* *E521*
73:se[t] {option}={value} or
74:se[t] {option}:{value}
75 Set string or number option to {value}.
76 For numeric options the value can be given in decimal,
Bram Moolenaar3848e002016-03-19 18:42:29 +010077 hex (preceded with 0x) or octal (preceded with '0').
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +000078 The old value can be inserted by typing 'wildchar' (by
79 default this is a <Tab> or CTRL-E if 'compatible' is
80 set). See |cmdline-completion|.
81 White space between {option} and '=' is allowed and
82 will be ignored. White space between '=' and {value}
83 is not allowed.
84 See |option-backslash| for using white space and
85 backslashes in {value}.
86
87:se[t] {option}+={value} *:set+=*
88 Add the {value} to a number option, or append the
89 {value} to a string option. When the option is a
Bram Moolenaarcbaff5e2022-04-08 17:45:08 +010090 comma-separated list, a comma is added, unless the
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +000091 value was empty.
92 If the option is a list of flags, superfluous flags
Bram Moolenaara5792f52005-11-23 21:25:05 +000093 are removed. When adding a flag that was already
94 present the option value doesn't change.
Bram Moolenaar899dddf2006-03-26 21:06:50 +000095 Also see |:set-args| above.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +000096
97:se[t] {option}^={value} *:set^=*
98 Multiply the {value} to a number option, or prepend
99 the {value} to a string option. When the option is a
Bram Moolenaarcbaff5e2022-04-08 17:45:08 +0100100 comma-separated list, a comma is added, unless the
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000101 value was empty.
102 Also see |:set-args| above.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000103
104:se[t] {option}-={value} *:set-=*
105 Subtract the {value} from a number option, or remove
106 the {value} from a string option, if it is there.
107 If the {value} is not found in a string option, there
108 is no error or warning. When the option is a comma
109 separated list, a comma is deleted, unless the option
110 becomes empty.
111 When the option is a list of flags, {value} must be
112 exactly as they appear in the option. Remove flags
113 one by one to avoid problems.
114 Also see |:set-args| above.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000115
116The {option} arguments to ":set" may be repeated. For example: >
117 :set ai nosi sw=3 ts=3
118If you make an error in one of the arguments, an error message will be given
119and the following arguments will be ignored.
120
121 *:set-verbose*
122When 'verbose' is non-zero, displaying an option value will also tell where it
123was last set. Example: >
124 :verbose set shiftwidth cindent?
Bram Moolenaar95bafa22018-10-02 13:26:25 +0200125< shiftwidth=4 ~
126 Last set from modeline line 1 ~
127 cindent ~
128 Last set from /usr/local/share/vim/vim60/ftplugin/c.vim line 30 ~
Bram Moolenaar446cb832008-06-24 21:56:24 +0000129This is only done when specific option values are requested, not for ":verbose
130set all" or ":verbose set" without an argument.
131When the option was set by hand there is no "Last set" message.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000132When the option was set while executing a function, user command or
133autocommand, the script in which it was defined is reported.
134Note that an option may also have been set as a side effect of setting
135'compatible'.
Bram Moolenaar446cb832008-06-24 21:56:24 +0000136A few special texts:
Bram Moolenaar95bafa22018-10-02 13:26:25 +0200137 Last set from modeline line 1 ~
Bram Moolenaar446cb832008-06-24 21:56:24 +0000138 Option was set in a |modeline|.
139 Last set from --cmd argument ~
140 Option was set with command line argument |--cmd| or +.
141 Last set from -c argument ~
142 Option was set with command line argument |-c|, +, |-S| or
143 |-q|.
144 Last set from environment variable ~
145 Option was set from an environment variable, $VIMINIT,
146 $GVIMINIT or $EXINIT.
147 Last set from error handler ~
148 Option was cleared when evaluating it resulted in an error.
149
Bram Moolenaardb84e452010-08-15 13:50:43 +0200150{not available when compiled without the |+eval| feature}
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000151
152 *:set-termcap* *E522*
Bram Moolenaar1d2ba7f2006-02-14 22:29:30 +0000153For {option} the form "t_xx" may be used to set a terminal option. This will
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000154override the value from the termcap. You can then use it in a mapping. If
155the "xx" part contains special characters, use the <t_xx> form: >
156 :set <t_#4>=^[Ot
157This can also be used to translate a special code for a normal key. For
158example, if Alt-b produces <Esc>b, use this: >
159 :set <M-b>=^[b
160(the ^[ is a real <Esc> here, use CTRL-V <Esc> to enter it)
161The advantage over a mapping is that it works in all situations.
162
Bram Moolenaar0b2f94d2011-03-22 14:35:05 +0100163You can define any key codes, e.g.: >
164 :set t_xy=^[foo;
165There is no warning for using a name that isn't recognized. You can map these
166codes as you like: >
167 :map <t_xy> something
168< *E846*
169When a key code is not set, it's like it does not exist. Trying to get its
170value will result in an error: >
171 :set t_kb=
172 :set t_kb
Bram Moolenaar6f4754b2022-01-23 12:07:04 +0000173< E846: Key code not set: t_kb ~
Bram Moolenaar0b2f94d2011-03-22 14:35:05 +0100174
Bram Moolenaar293ee4d2004-12-09 21:34:53 +0000175The t_xx options cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
176security reasons.
177
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000178The listing from ":set" looks different from Vi. Long string options are put
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +0000179at the end of the list. The number of options is quite large. The output of
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000180"set all" probably does not fit on the screen, causing Vim to give the
181|more-prompt|.
182
183 *option-backslash*
184To include white space in a string option value it has to be preceded with a
185backslash. To include a backslash you have to use two. Effectively this
186means that the number of backslashes in an option value is halved (rounded
187down).
188A few examples: >
189 :set tags=tags\ /usr/tags results in "tags /usr/tags"
190 :set tags=tags\\,file results in "tags\,file"
191 :set tags=tags\\\ file results in "tags\ file"
192
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +0000193The "|" character separates a ":set" command from a following command. To
194include the "|" in the option value, use "\|" instead. This example sets the
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000195'titlestring' option to "hi|there": >
196 :set titlestring=hi\|there
197This sets the 'titlestring' option to "hi" and 'iconstring' to "there": >
198 :set titlestring=hi|set iconstring=there
199
Bram Moolenaar89a9c152021-08-29 21:55:35 +0200200Similarly, in legacy script the double quote character starts a comment. To
201include the '"' in the option value, use '\"' instead. This example sets the
202'titlestring' option to 'hi "there"': >
Bram Moolenaar7df351e2006-01-23 22:30:28 +0000203 :set titlestring=hi\ \"there\"
204
Bram Moolenaar89a9c152021-08-29 21:55:35 +0200205In |Vim9| script it's simpler, comments start with a '#' character, and only
206when preceded by white space. A backslash is needed less often: >
207 vim9script
208 set titlestring=hi\ "there"
209 set titlestring=hi#there#
210 set titlestring=hi\ \#there#
211
Bram Moolenaar5666fcd2019-12-26 14:35:26 +0100212For Win32 backslashes in file names are mostly not removed. More precise: For
213options that expect a file name (those where environment variables are
214expanded) a backslash before a normal file name character is not removed. But
215a backslash before a special character (space, backslash, comma, etc.) is used
216like explained above.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000217There is one special situation, when the value starts with "\\": >
218 :set dir=\\machine\path results in "\\machine\path"
219 :set dir=\\\\machine\\path results in "\\machine\path"
220 :set dir=\\path\\file results in "\\path\file" (wrong!)
221For the first one the start is kept, but for the second one the backslashes
222are halved. This makes sure it works both when you expect backslashes to be
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +0000223halved and when you expect the backslashes to be kept. The third gives a
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000224result which is probably not what you want. Avoid it.
225
226 *add-option-flags* *remove-option-flags*
227 *E539* *E550* *E551* *E552*
228Some options are a list of flags. When you want to add a flag to such an
229option, without changing the existing ones, you can do it like this: >
230 :set guioptions+=a
231Remove a flag from an option like this: >
232 :set guioptions-=a
233This removes the 'a' flag from 'guioptions'.
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +0000234Note that you should add or remove one flag at a time. If 'guioptions' has
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000235the value "ab", using "set guioptions-=ba" won't work, because the string "ba"
236doesn't appear.
237
238 *:set_env* *expand-env* *expand-environment-var*
Bram Moolenaard4755bb2004-09-02 19:12:26 +0000239Environment variables in specific string options will be expanded. If the
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000240environment variable exists the '$' and the following environment variable
241name is replaced with its value. If it does not exist the '$' and the name
242are not modified. Any non-id character (not a letter, digit or '_') may
243follow the environment variable name. That character and what follows is
244appended to the value of the environment variable. Examples: >
245 :set term=$TERM.new
246 :set path=/usr/$INCLUDE,$HOME/include,.
247When adding or removing a string from an option with ":set opt-=val" or ":set
248opt+=val" the expansion is done before the adding or removing.
249
250
251Handling of local options *local-options*
252
253Some of the options only apply to a window or buffer. Each window or buffer
Bram Moolenaar51628222016-12-01 23:03:28 +0100254has its own copy of this option, thus each can have its own value. This
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000255allows you to set 'list' in one window but not in another. And set
256'shiftwidth' to 3 in one buffer and 4 in another.
257
258The following explains what happens to these local options in specific
259situations. You don't really need to know all of this, since Vim mostly uses
260the option values you would expect. Unfortunately, doing what the user
261expects is a bit complicated...
262
263When splitting a window, the local options are copied to the new window. Thus
264right after the split the contents of the two windows look the same.
265
266When editing a new buffer, its local option values must be initialized. Since
267the local options of the current buffer might be specifically for that buffer,
268these are not used. Instead, for each buffer-local option there also is a
269global value, which is used for new buffers. With ":set" both the local and
270global value is changed. With "setlocal" only the local value is changed,
271thus this value is not used when editing a new buffer.
272
Bram Moolenaar95ec9d62016-08-12 18:29:59 +0200273When editing a buffer that has been edited before, the options from the window
274that was last closed are used again. If this buffer has been edited in this
275window, the values from back then are used. Otherwise the values from the
276last closed window where the buffer was edited last are used.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000277
278It's possible to set a local window option specifically for a type of buffer.
279When you edit another buffer in the same window, you don't want to keep
280using these local window options. Therefore Vim keeps a global value of the
281local window options, which is used when editing another buffer. Each window
282has its own copy of these values. Thus these are local to the window, but
283global to all buffers in the window. With this you can do: >
284 :e one
285 :set list
286 :e two
287Now the 'list' option will also be set in "two", since with the ":set list"
288command you have also set the global value. >
289 :set nolist
290 :e one
291 :setlocal list
292 :e two
293Now the 'list' option is not set, because ":set nolist" resets the global
294value, ":setlocal list" only changes the local value and ":e two" gets the
295global value. Note that if you do this next: >
296 :e one
Bram Moolenaar531da592013-05-06 05:58:55 +0200297You will get back the 'list' value as it was the last time you edited "one".
298The options local to a window are remembered for each buffer. This also
299happens when the buffer is not loaded, but they are lost when the buffer is
300wiped out |:bwipe|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000301
302 *:setl* *:setlocal*
Bram Moolenaar6b915c02020-01-18 15:53:19 +0100303:setl[ocal][!] ... Like ":set" but set only the value local to the
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000304 current buffer or window. Not all options have a
305 local value. If the option does not have a local
306 value the global value is set.
Bram Moolenaarc3301872010-07-25 20:53:06 +0200307 With the "all" argument: display local values for all
308 local options.
309 Without argument: Display local values for all local
310 options which are different from the default.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000311 When displaying a specific local option, show the
Bram Moolenaar446cb832008-06-24 21:56:24 +0000312 local value. For a global/local boolean option, when
313 the global value is being used, "--" is displayed
314 before the option name.
315 For a global option the global value is
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000316 shown (but that might change in the future).
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000317
Bram Moolenaar899dddf2006-03-26 21:06:50 +0000318:setl[ocal] {option}< Set the local value of {option} to its global value by
319 copying the value.
Bram Moolenaar899dddf2006-03-26 21:06:50 +0000320
Bram Moolenaar6be7f872012-01-20 21:08:56 +0100321:se[t] {option}< For |global-local| options: Remove the local value of
322 {option}, so that the global value will be used.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000323
324 *:setg* *:setglobal*
Bram Moolenaar6b915c02020-01-18 15:53:19 +0100325:setg[lobal][!] ... Like ":set" but set only the global value for a local
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000326 option without changing the local value.
327 When displaying an option, the global value is shown.
Bram Moolenaarc3301872010-07-25 20:53:06 +0200328 With the "all" argument: display global values for all
329 local options.
330 Without argument: display global values for all local
331 options which are different from the default.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000332
333For buffer-local and window-local options:
334 Command global value local value ~
335 :set option=value set set
336 :setlocal option=value - set
337:setglobal option=value set -
338 :set option? - display
339 :setlocal option? - display
340:setglobal option? display -
341
342
343Global options with a local value *global-local*
344
Bram Moolenaarb5bf5b82004-12-24 14:35:23 +0000345Options are global when you mostly use one value for all buffers and windows.
346For some global options it's useful to sometimes have a different local value.
347You can set the local value with ":setlocal". That buffer or window will then
348use the local value, while other buffers and windows continue using the global
349value.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000350
351For example, you have two windows, both on C source code. They use the global
352'makeprg' option. If you do this in one of the two windows: >
353 :set makeprg=gmake
354then the other window will switch to the same value. There is no need to set
355the 'makeprg' option in the other C source window too.
356However, if you start editing a Perl file in a new window, you want to use
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +0000357another 'makeprg' for it, without changing the value used for the C source
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +0000358files. You use this command: >
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000359 :setlocal makeprg=perlmake
360You can switch back to using the global value by making the local value empty: >
361 :setlocal makeprg=
Bram Moolenaar314dd792019-02-03 15:27:20 +0100362This only works for a string option. For a number or boolean option you need
363to use the "<" flag, like this: >
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000364 :setlocal autoread<
Bram Moolenaar314dd792019-02-03 15:27:20 +0100365Note that for non-boolean and non-number options using "<" copies the global
366value to the local value, it doesn't switch back to using the global value
367(that matters when the global value changes later). You can also use: >
Bram Moolenaar899dddf2006-03-26 21:06:50 +0000368 :set path<
369This will make the local value of 'path' empty, so that the global value is
370used. Thus it does the same as: >
371 :setlocal path=
Bram Moolenaar2f0936c2022-01-08 21:51:59 +0000372Note: In the future more global options can be made |global-local|. Using
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000373":setlocal" on a global option might work differently then.
374
375
Yegappan Lakshmanan777175b2021-11-18 22:08:57 +0000376 *option-value-function*
377Some options ('completefunc', 'imactivatefunc', 'imstatusfunc', 'omnifunc',
Yegappan Lakshmanan8658c752021-12-03 11:09:29 +0000378'operatorfunc', 'quickfixtextfunc', 'tagfunc' and 'thesaurusfunc') are set to
Yegappan Lakshmanan64095532021-12-06 11:03:55 +0000379a function name or a function reference or a lambda function. When using a
380lambda it will be converted to the name, e.g. "<lambda>123". Examples:
Yegappan Lakshmanan777175b2021-11-18 22:08:57 +0000381>
382 set opfunc=MyOpFunc
Yegappan Lakshmanan19916a82021-11-24 16:32:55 +0000383 set opfunc=function('MyOpFunc')
384 set opfunc=funcref('MyOpFunc')
Yegappan Lakshmanan05e59e32021-12-01 10:30:07 +0000385 set opfunc={a\ ->\ MyOpFunc(a)}
Bram Moolenaar1fca5f32022-02-18 17:50:47 +0000386
387Set to a script-local function: >
388 set opfunc=s:MyLocalFunc
389 set opfunc=<SID>MyLocalFunc
390In |Vim9| script the "s:" and "<SID>" can be omitted if the function exists in
391the script: >
392 set opfunc=MyLocalFunc
393
394Set using a funcref variable: >
Yegappan Lakshmanan05e59e32021-12-01 10:30:07 +0000395 let Fn = function('MyTagFunc')
Bram Moolenaarfa3b7232021-12-24 13:18:38 +0000396 let &tagfunc = Fn
Bram Moolenaar1fca5f32022-02-18 17:50:47 +0000397
398Set using a lambda expression: >
Yegappan Lakshmanan64095532021-12-06 11:03:55 +0000399 let &tagfunc = {t -> MyTagFunc(t)}
Bram Moolenaar1fca5f32022-02-18 17:50:47 +0000400
401Set using a variable with lambda expression: >
Yegappan Lakshmanan05e59e32021-12-01 10:30:07 +0000402 let L = {a, b, c -> MyTagFunc(a, b , c)}
Yegappan Lakshmanan64095532021-12-06 11:03:55 +0000403 let &tagfunc = L
Bram Moolenaar7b1463b2021-12-11 17:24:39 +0000404
405In Vim9 script, in a compiled function, you can use a lambda, but a
406closured does not work, because the function will be called without the
407context of where it was defined.
408
Yegappan Lakshmanan777175b2021-11-18 22:08:57 +0000409
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000410Setting the filetype
411
Bram Moolenaar6aa8cea2017-06-05 14:44:35 +0200412:setf[iletype] [FALLBACK] {filetype} *:setf* *:setfiletype*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000413 Set the 'filetype' option to {filetype}, but only if
414 not done yet in a sequence of (nested) autocommands.
415 This is short for: >
416 :if !did_filetype()
417 : setlocal filetype={filetype}
418 :endif
419< This command is used in a filetype.vim file to avoid
420 setting the 'filetype' option twice, causing different
421 settings and syntax files to be loaded.
Bram Moolenaar6aa8cea2017-06-05 14:44:35 +0200422
423 When the optional FALLBACK argument is present, a
424 later :setfiletype command will override the
Bram Moolenaar26967612019-03-17 17:13:16 +0100425 'filetype'. This is to be used for filetype
426 detections that are just a guess. |did_filetype()|
427 will return false after this command.
Bram Moolenaar6aa8cea2017-06-05 14:44:35 +0200428
Bram Moolenaard58e9292011-02-09 17:07:58 +0100429 *option-window* *optwin*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000430:bro[wse] se[t] *:set-browse* *:browse-set* *:opt* *:options*
431:opt[ions] Open a window for viewing and setting all options.
432 Options are grouped by function.
433 Offers short help for each option. Hit <CR> on the
434 short help to open a help window with more help for
435 the option.
436 Modify the value of the option and hit <CR> on the
437 "set" line to set the new value. For window and
438 buffer specific options, the last accessed window is
439 used to set the option value in, unless this is a help
440 window, in which case the window below help window is
441 used (skipping the option-window).
Bram Moolenaarb5b75622018-03-09 22:22:21 +0100442 {not available when compiled without the |+eval|
443 feature}
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000444
445 *$HOME*
446Using "~" is like using "$HOME", but it is only recognized at the start of an
447option and after a space or comma.
448
449On Unix systems "~user" can be used too. It is replaced by the home directory
450of user "user". Example: >
451 :set path=~mool/include,/usr/include,.
452
453On Unix systems the form "${HOME}" can be used too. The name between {} can
454contain non-id characters then. Note that if you want to use this for the
455"gf" command, you need to add the '{' and '}' characters to 'isfname'.
456
457NOTE: expanding environment variables and "~/" is only done with the ":set"
458command, not when assigning a value to an option with ":let".
459
Bram Moolenaarc572da52017-08-27 16:52:01 +0200460 *$HOME-windows*
461On MS-Windows, if $HOME is not defined as an environment variable, then
462at runtime Vim will set it to the expansion of $HOMEDRIVE$HOMEPATH.
Bram Moolenaar37c64c72017-09-19 22:06:03 +0200463If $HOMEDRIVE is not set then $USERPROFILE is used.
464
465This expanded value is not exported to the environment, this matters when
466running an external command: >
467 :echo system('set | findstr ^HOME=')
468and >
469 :echo luaeval('os.getenv("HOME")')
470should echo nothing (an empty string) despite exists('$HOME') being true.
471When setting $HOME to a non-empty string it will be exported to the
472subprocesses.
Bram Moolenaarc572da52017-08-27 16:52:01 +0200473
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000474
475Note the maximum length of an expanded option is limited. How much depends on
476the system, mostly it is something like 256 or 1024 characters.
477
478 *:fix* *:fixdel*
479:fix[del] Set the value of 't_kD':
480 't_kb' is 't_kD' becomes ~
481 CTRL-? CTRL-H
482 not CTRL-? CTRL-?
483
Bram Moolenaar82be4842021-01-11 19:40:15 +0100484 (CTRL-? is 0o177 octal, 0x7f hex)
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000485
486 If your delete key terminal code is wrong, but the
487 code for backspace is alright, you can put this in
488 your .vimrc: >
489 :fixdel
490< This works no matter what the actual code for
491 backspace is.
492
493 If the backspace key terminal code is wrong you can
494 use this: >
495 :if &term == "termname"
496 : set t_kb=^V<BS>
497 : fixdel
498 :endif
499< Where "^V" is CTRL-V and "<BS>" is the backspace key
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +0000500 (don't type four characters!). Replace "termname"
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000501 with your terminal name.
502
503 If your <Delete> key sends a strange key sequence (not
504 CTRL-? or CTRL-H) you cannot use ":fixdel". Then use: >
505 :if &term == "termname"
506 : set t_kD=^V<Delete>
507 :endif
508< Where "^V" is CTRL-V and "<Delete>" is the delete key
509 (don't type eight characters!). Replace "termname"
510 with your terminal name.
511
512 *Linux-backspace*
513 Note about Linux: By default the backspace key
514 produces CTRL-?, which is wrong. You can fix it by
515 putting this line in your rc.local: >
516 echo "keycode 14 = BackSpace" | loadkeys
517<
518 *NetBSD-backspace*
519 Note about NetBSD: If your backspace doesn't produce
520 the right code, try this: >
521 xmodmap -e "keycode 22 = BackSpace"
522< If this works, add this in your .Xmodmap file: >
523 keysym 22 = BackSpace
524< You need to restart for this to take effect.
525
526==============================================================================
5272. Automatically setting options *auto-setting*
528
529Besides changing options with the ":set" command, there are three alternatives
530to set options automatically for one or more files:
531
5321. When starting Vim initializations are read from various places. See
533 |initialization|. Most of them are performed for all editing sessions,
534 and some of them depend on the directory where Vim is started.
535 You can create an initialization file with |:mkvimrc|, |:mkview| and
536 |:mksession|.
5372. If you start editing a new file, the automatic commands are executed.
538 This can be used to set options for files matching a particular pattern and
539 many other things. See |autocommand|.
5403. If you start editing a new file, and the 'modeline' option is on, a
541 number of lines at the beginning and end of the file are checked for
542 modelines. This is explained here.
543
544 *modeline* *vim:* *vi:* *ex:* *E520*
545There are two forms of modelines. The first form:
Bram Moolenaar664f3cf2019-12-07 16:03:51 +0100546 [text{white}]{vi:|vim:|ex:}[white]{options}
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000547
Bram Moolenaar664f3cf2019-12-07 16:03:51 +0100548[text{white}] empty or any text followed by at least one blank
549 character (<Space> or <Tab>); "ex:" always requires at
550 least one blank character
Bram Moolenaar14b69452013-06-29 23:05:20 +0200551{vi:|vim:|ex:} the string "vi:", "vim:" or "ex:"
Bram Moolenaar22dbc772013-06-28 18:44:48 +0200552[white] optional white space
553{options} a list of option settings, separated with white space
554 or ':', where each part between ':' is the argument
555 for a ":set" command (can be empty)
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000556
Bram Moolenaar14b69452013-06-29 23:05:20 +0200557Examples:
Bram Moolenaar97b2ad32006-03-18 21:40:56 +0000558 vi:noai:sw=3 ts=6 ~
Bram Moolenaar14b69452013-06-29 23:05:20 +0200559 vim: tw=77 ~
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000560
561The second form (this is compatible with some versions of Vi):
562
Bram Moolenaarade0d392020-01-21 22:33:58 +0100563 [text{white}]{vi:|vim:|Vim:|ex:}[white]se[t] {options}:[text]
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000564
Bram Moolenaarade0d392020-01-21 22:33:58 +0100565[text{white}] empty or any text followed by at least one blank
566 character (<Space> or <Tab>); "ex:" always requires at
567 least one blank character
Bram Moolenaar22dbc772013-06-28 18:44:48 +0200568{vi:|vim:|Vim:|ex:} the string "vi:", "vim:", "Vim:" or "ex:"
569[white] optional white space
Bram Moolenaar14b69452013-06-29 23:05:20 +0200570se[t] the string "set " or "se " (note the space); When
571 "Vim" is used it must be "set".
Bram Moolenaar22dbc772013-06-28 18:44:48 +0200572{options} a list of options, separated with white space, which
573 is the argument for a ":set" command
574: a colon
575[text] any text or empty
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000576
Bram Moolenaar14b69452013-06-29 23:05:20 +0200577Examples:
Bram Moolenaar97b2ad32006-03-18 21:40:56 +0000578 /* vim: set ai tw=75: */ ~
Bram Moolenaar14b69452013-06-29 23:05:20 +0200579 /* Vim: set ai tw=75: */ ~
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000580
Bram Moolenaar22dbc772013-06-28 18:44:48 +0200581The white space before {vi:|vim:|Vim:|ex:} is required. This minimizes the
582chance that a normal word like "lex:" is caught. There is one exception:
583"vi:" and "vim:" can also be at the start of the line (for compatibility with
584version 3.0). Using "ex:" at the start of the line will be ignored (this
585could be short for "example:").
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000586
Hu Jialun9dcd3492021-08-28 20:42:50 +0200587If the modeline is disabled within a modeline, subsequent modelines will be
588ignored. This is to allow turning off modeline on a per-file basis. This is
589useful when a line looks like a modeline but isn't. For example, it would be
590good to start a YAML file containing strings like "vim:" with
591 # vim: nomodeline ~
592so as to avoid modeline misdetection. Following options on the same line
593after modeline deactivation, if any, are still evaluated (but you would
594normally not have any).
595
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000596 *modeline-local*
597The options are set like with ":setlocal": The new value only applies to the
Bram Moolenaar843ee412004-06-30 16:16:41 +0000598buffer and window that contain the file. Although it's possible to set global
599options from a modeline, this is unusual. If you have two windows open and
600the files in it set the same global option to a different value, the result
601depends on which one was opened last.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000602
Bram Moolenaar15d0a8c2004-09-06 17:44:46 +0000603When editing a file that was already loaded, only the window-local options
604from the modeline are used. Thus if you manually changed a buffer-local
605option after opening the file, it won't be changed if you edit the same buffer
606in another window. But window-local options will be set.
607
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000608 *modeline-version*
609If the modeline is only to be used for some versions of Vim, the version
Bram Moolenaar22dbc772013-06-28 18:44:48 +0200610number can be specified where "vim:" or "Vim:" is used:
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000611 vim{vers}: version {vers} or later
612 vim<{vers}: version before {vers}
613 vim={vers}: version {vers}
614 vim>{vers}: version after {vers}
Bram Moolenaar2b8388b2015-02-28 13:11:45 +0100615{vers} is 700 for Vim 7.0 (hundred times the major version plus minor).
616For example, to use a modeline only for Vim 7.0:
617 /* vim700: set foldmethod=marker */ ~
618To use a modeline for Vim after version 7.2:
619 /* vim>702: set cole=2: */ ~
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000620There can be no blanks between "vim" and the ":".
621
622
623The number of lines that are checked can be set with the 'modelines' option.
624If 'modeline' is off or 'modelines' is 0 no lines are checked.
625
626Note that for the first form all of the rest of the line is used, thus a line
Bram Moolenaar97b2ad32006-03-18 21:40:56 +0000627like:
628 /* vi:ts=4: */ ~
629will give an error message for the trailing "*/". This line is OK:
630 /* vi:set ts=4: */ ~
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000631
632If an error is detected the rest of the line is skipped.
633
634If you want to include a ':' in a set command precede it with a '\'. The
Bram Moolenaar97b2ad32006-03-18 21:40:56 +0000635backslash in front of the ':' will be removed. Example:
Bram Moolenaar95a9dd12019-12-19 22:12:03 +0100636 /* vi:set fillchars=stl\:^,vert\:\|: */ ~
637This sets the 'fillchars' option to "stl:^,vert:\|". Only a single backslash
638before the ':' is removed. Thus to include "\:" you have to specify "\\:".
Bram Moolenaar110289e2019-05-23 15:38:06 +0200639 *E992*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000640No other commands than "set" are supported, for security reasons (somebody
Bram Moolenaar8243a792007-05-01 17:05:03 +0000641might create a Trojan horse text file with modelines). And not all options
Bram Moolenaar110289e2019-05-23 15:38:06 +0200642can be set. For some options a flag is set, so that when the value is used
643the |sandbox| is effective. Some options can only be set from the modeline
644when 'modelineexpr' is set (the default is off).
645
646Still, there is always a small risk that a modeline causes trouble. E.g.,
647when some joker sets 'textwidth' to 5 all your lines are wrapped unexpectedly.
648So disable modelines before editing untrusted text. The mail ftplugin does
649this, for example.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000650
651Hint: If you would like to do something else than setting an option, you could
652define an autocommand that checks the file for a specific string. For
653example: >
654 au BufReadPost * if getline(1) =~ "VAR" | call SetVar() | endif
655And define a function SetVar() that does something with the line containing
656"VAR".
657
658==============================================================================
6593. Options summary *option-summary*
660
661In the list below all the options are mentioned with their full name and with
662an abbreviation if there is one. Both forms may be used.
663
664In this document when a boolean option is "set" that means that ":set option"
665is entered. When an option is "reset", ":set nooption" is used.
666
667For some options there are two default values: The "Vim default", which is
668used when 'compatible' is not set, and the "Vi default", which is used when
669'compatible' is set.
670
671Most options are the same in all windows and buffers. There are a few that
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +0000672are specific to how the text is presented in a window. These can be set to a
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000673different value in each window. For example the 'list' option can be set in
674one window and reset in another for the same text, giving both types of view
675at the same time. There are a few options that are specific to a certain
676file. These can have a different value for each file or buffer. For example
677the 'textwidth' option can be 78 for a normal text file and 0 for a C
678program.
679
680 global one option for all buffers and windows
681 local to window each window has its own copy of this option
682 local to buffer each buffer has its own copy of this option
683
684When creating a new window the option values from the currently active window
685are used as a default value for the window-specific options. For the
686buffer-specific options this depends on the 's' and 'S' flags in the
687'cpoptions' option. If 's' is included (which is the default) the values for
688buffer options are copied from the currently active buffer when a buffer is
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +0000689first entered. If 'S' is present the options are copied each time the buffer
690is entered, this is almost like having global options. If 's' and 'S' are not
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000691present, the options are copied from the currently active buffer when the
692buffer is created.
693
Bram Moolenaar578b49e2005-09-10 19:22:57 +0000694Hidden options *hidden-options*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000695
Bram Moolenaar578b49e2005-09-10 19:22:57 +0000696Not all options are supported in all versions. This depends on the supported
697features and sometimes on the system. A remark about this is in curly braces
698below. When an option is not supported it may still be set without getting an
699error, this is called a hidden option. You can't get the value of a hidden
700option though, it is not stored.
701
702To test if option "foo" can be used with ":set" use something like this: >
703 if exists('&foo')
704This also returns true for a hidden option. To test if option "foo" is really
705supported use something like this: >
706 if exists('+foo')
707<
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000708 *E355*
709A jump table for the options with a short description can be found at |Q_op|.
710
711 *'aleph'* *'al'* *aleph* *Aleph*
Bram Moolenaar5666fcd2019-12-26 14:35:26 +0100712'aleph' 'al' number (default 128 for MS-Windows, 224 otherwise)
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000713 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000714 {only available when compiled with the |+rightleft|
715 feature}
716 The ASCII code for the first letter of the Hebrew alphabet. The
717 routine that maps the keyboard in Hebrew mode, both in Insert mode
718 (when hkmap is set) and on the command-line (when hitting CTRL-_)
719 outputs the Hebrew characters in the range [aleph..aleph+26].
720 aleph=128 applies to PC code, and aleph=224 applies to ISO 8859-8.
721 See |rileft.txt|.
722
723 *'allowrevins'* *'ari'* *'noallowrevins'* *'noari'*
724'allowrevins' 'ari' boolean (default off)
725 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000726 {only available when compiled with the |+rightleft|
727 feature}
728 Allow CTRL-_ in Insert and Command-line mode. This is default off, to
729 avoid that users that accidentally type CTRL-_ instead of SHIFT-_ get
730 into reverse Insert mode, and don't know how to get out. See
731 'revins'.
732 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
733
734 *'altkeymap'* *'akm'* *'noaltkeymap'* *'noakm'*
735'altkeymap' 'akm' boolean (default off)
736 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000737 {only available when compiled with the |+farsi|
738 feature}
Bram Moolenaar14184a32019-02-16 15:10:30 +0100739 This option was for using Farsi, which has been removed. See
740 |farsi.txt|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000741
742 *'ambiwidth'* *'ambw'*
743'ambiwidth' 'ambw' string (default: "single")
744 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000745 Only effective when 'encoding' is "utf-8" or another Unicode encoding.
746 Tells Vim what to do with characters with East Asian Width Class
747 Ambiguous (such as Euro, Registered Sign, Copyright Sign, Greek
748 letters, Cyrillic letters).
749
750 There are currently two possible values:
Bram Moolenaar582fd852005-03-28 20:58:01 +0000751 "single": Use the same width as characters in US-ASCII. This is
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000752 expected by most users.
753 "double": Use twice the width of ASCII characters.
Bram Moolenaar5c3bd0a2010-08-04 20:55:44 +0200754 *E834* *E835*
755 The value "double" cannot be used if 'listchars' or 'fillchars'
Bram Moolenaar079ba762021-10-23 12:08:41 +0100756 contains a character that would be double width. These errors may
757 also be given when calling setcellwidths().
Bram Moolenaar08aac3c2020-08-28 21:04:24 +0200758
759 The values are overruled for characters specified with
760 |setcellwidths()|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000761
762 There are a number of CJK fonts for which the width of glyphs for
763 those characters are solely based on how many octets they take in
764 legacy/traditional CJK encodings. In those encodings, Euro,
765 Registered sign, Greek/Cyrillic letters are represented by two octets,
Bram Moolenaar582fd852005-03-28 20:58:01 +0000766 therefore those fonts have "wide" glyphs for them. This is also
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000767 true of some line drawing characters used to make tables in text
Bram Moolenaar582fd852005-03-28 20:58:01 +0000768 file. Therefore, when a CJK font is used for GUI Vim or
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000769 Vim is running inside a terminal (emulators) that uses a CJK font
770 (or Vim is run inside an xterm invoked with "-cjkwidth" option.),
771 this option should be set to "double" to match the width perceived
772 by Vim with the width of glyphs in the font. Perhaps it also has
Bram Moolenaar8024f932020-01-14 19:29:13 +0100773 to be set to "double" under CJK MS-Windows when the system locale is
774 set to one of CJK locales. See Unicode Standard Annex #11
775 (http://www.unicode.org/reports/tr11).
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000776
Bram Moolenaarac7bd632013-03-19 11:35:58 +0100777 Vim may set this option automatically at startup time when Vim is
778 compiled with the |+termresponse| feature and if |t_u7| is set to the
Bram Moolenaar37c64c72017-09-19 22:06:03 +0200779 escape sequence to request cursor position report. The response can
780 be found in |v:termu7resp|.
Bram Moolenaarac7bd632013-03-19 11:35:58 +0100781
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000782 *'antialias'* *'anti'* *'noantialias'* *'noanti'*
783'antialias' 'anti' boolean (default: off)
784 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000785 {only available when compiled with GUI enabled
Bram Moolenaar3d1cde82020-08-15 18:55:18 +0200786 on macOS}
787 This option only has an effect in the GUI version of Vim on macOS
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000788 v10.2 or later. When on, Vim will use smooth ("antialiased") fonts,
789 which can be easier to read at certain sizes on certain displays.
790 Setting this option can sometimes cause problems if 'guifont' is set
791 to its default (empty string).
Bram Moolenaar036986f2017-03-16 17:41:02 +0100792 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000793
794 *'autochdir'* *'acd'* *'noautochdir'* *'noacd'*
795'autochdir' 'acd' boolean (default off)
796 global
Bram Moolenaar00a927d2010-05-14 23:24:24 +0200797 {only available when compiled with it, use
798 exists("+autochdir") to check}
Bram Moolenaard8c00872005-07-22 21:52:15 +0000799 When on, Vim will change the current working directory whenever you
800 open a file, switch buffers, delete a buffer or open/close a window.
801 It will change to the directory containing the file which was opened
802 or selected.
Bram Moolenaar910f66f2006-04-05 20:41:53 +0000803 Note: When this option is on some plugins may not work.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000804
Bram Moolenaar8b9abfd2021-03-29 20:49:05 +0200805 *'autoshelldir'* *'asd'* *'noautoshelldir'* *'noasd'*
806'autoshelldir' 'asd' boolean (default off)
807 global
808 When on, Vim will change the current working directory whenever you
809 change the directory of the shell running in a terminal window. You
810 need proper setting-up, so whenever the shell's pwd changes an OSC 7
811 escape sequence will be emitted. For example, on Linux, you can source
812 /etc/profile.d/vte.sh in your shell profile if you use bash or zsh.
Bram Moolenaara2baa732022-02-04 16:09:54 +0000813 When the parsing of the OSC sequence fails you get *E1179* .
Bram Moolenaar8b9abfd2021-03-29 20:49:05 +0200814
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000815 *'arabic'* *'arab'* *'noarabic'* *'noarab'*
816'arabic' 'arab' boolean (default off)
817 local to window
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000818 {only available when compiled with the |+arabic|
819 feature}
820 This option can be set to start editing Arabic text.
821 Setting this option will:
822 - Set the 'rightleft' option, unless 'termbidi' is set.
823 - Set the 'arabicshape' option, unless 'termbidi' is set.
824 - Set the 'keymap' option to "arabic"; in Insert mode CTRL-^ toggles
825 between typing English and Arabic key mapping.
826 - Set the 'delcombine' option
827 Note that 'encoding' must be "utf-8" for working with Arabic text.
828
829 Resetting this option will:
830 - Reset the 'rightleft' option.
831 - Disable the use of 'keymap' (without changing its value).
832 Note that 'arabicshape' and 'delcombine' are not reset (it is a global
Bram Moolenaarc8734422012-06-01 22:38:45 +0200833 option).
Bram Moolenaar036986f2017-03-16 17:41:02 +0100834 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000835 Also see |arabic.txt|.
836
837 *'arabicshape'* *'arshape'*
838 *'noarabicshape'* *'noarshape'*
839'arabicshape' 'arshape' boolean (default on)
840 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000841 {only available when compiled with the |+arabic|
842 feature}
843 When on and 'termbidi' is off, the required visual character
844 corrections that need to take place for displaying the Arabic language
Bram Moolenaar3a0d8092012-10-21 03:02:54 +0200845 take effect. Shaping, in essence, gets enabled; the term is a broad
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000846 one which encompasses:
847 a) the changing/morphing of characters based on their location
848 within a word (initial, medial, final and stand-alone).
849 b) the enabling of the ability to compose characters
850 c) the enabling of the required combining of some characters
Bram Moolenaar8f3f58f2010-01-06 20:52:26 +0100851 When disabled the display shows each character's true stand-alone
852 form.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000853 Arabic is a complex language which requires other settings, for
854 further details see |arabic.txt|.
Bram Moolenaar036986f2017-03-16 17:41:02 +0100855 NOTE: This option is set when 'compatible' is set.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000856
857 *'autoindent'* *'ai'* *'noautoindent'* *'noai'*
858'autoindent' 'ai' boolean (default off)
859 local to buffer
860 Copy indent from current line when starting a new line (typing <CR>
861 in Insert mode or when using the "o" or "O" command). If you do not
862 type anything on the new line except <BS> or CTRL-D and then type
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +0000863 <Esc>, CTRL-O or <CR>, the indent is deleted again. Moving the cursor
864 to another line has the same effect, unless the 'I' flag is included
865 in 'cpoptions'.
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +0000866 When autoindent is on, formatting (with the "gq" command or when you
867 reach 'textwidth' in Insert mode) uses the indentation of the first
868 line.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000869 When 'smartindent' or 'cindent' is on the indent is changed in
870 a different way.
Bram Moolenaarca635012015-09-25 20:34:21 +0200871 The 'autoindent' option is reset when the 'paste' option is set and
872 restored when 'paste' is reset.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000873
874 *'autoread'* *'ar'* *'noautoread'* *'noar'*
875'autoread' 'ar' boolean (default off)
876 global or local to buffer |global-local|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000877 When a file has been detected to have been changed outside of Vim and
878 it has not been changed inside of Vim, automatically read it again.
Bram Moolenaarfd358112018-07-07 23:21:31 +0200879 When the file has been deleted this is not done, so you have the text
880 from before it was deleted. When it appears again then it is read.
881 |timestamp|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000882 If this option has a local value, use this command to switch back to
883 using the global value: >
884 :set autoread<
885<
886 *'autowrite'* *'aw'* *'noautowrite'* *'noaw'*
887'autowrite' 'aw' boolean (default off)
888 global
889 Write the contents of the file, if it has been modified, on each
Bram Moolenaar47003982021-12-05 21:54:04 +0000890 `:next`, `:rewind`, `:last`, `:first`, `:previous`, `:stop`,
Bram Moolenaar2f0936c2022-01-08 21:51:59 +0000891 `:suspend`, `:tag`, `:!`, `:make`, CTRL-] and CTRL-^ command; and when
892 a `:buffer`, CTRL-O, CTRL-I, '{A-Z0-9}, or `{A-Z0-9} command takes one
Bram Moolenaar47003982021-12-05 21:54:04 +0000893 to another file.
894 A buffer is not written if it becomes hidden, e.g. when 'bufhidden' is
Bram Moolenaar2f0936c2022-01-08 21:51:59 +0000895 set to "hide" and `:next` is used.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000896 Note that for some commands the 'autowrite' option is not used, see
897 'autowriteall' for that.
Bram Moolenaar93a1df22018-09-10 11:51:50 +0200898 Some buffers will not be written, specifically when 'buftype' is
Bram Moolenaar20aac6c2018-09-02 21:07:30 +0200899 "nowrite", "nofile", "terminal" or "prompt".
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000900
901 *'autowriteall'* *'awa'* *'noautowriteall'* *'noawa'*
902'autowriteall' 'awa' boolean (default off)
903 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000904 Like 'autowrite', but also used for commands ":edit", ":enew", ":quit",
905 ":qall", ":exit", ":xit", ":recover" and closing the Vim window.
906 Setting this option also implies that Vim behaves like 'autowrite' has
907 been set.
908
909 *'background'* *'bg'*
Bram Moolenaar446beb42011-05-10 17:18:44 +0200910'background' 'bg' string (default "dark" or "light", see below)
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000911 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000912 When set to "dark", Vim will try to use colors that look good on a
913 dark background. When set to "light", Vim will try to use colors that
914 look good on a light background. Any other value is illegal.
915 Vim tries to set the default value according to the terminal used.
916 This will not always be correct.
917 Setting this option does not change the background color, it tells Vim
918 what the background color looks like. For changing the background
919 color, see |:hi-normal|.
920
921 When 'background' is set Vim will adjust the default color groups for
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +0000922 the new value. But the colors used for syntax highlighting will not
Bram Moolenaar446cb832008-06-24 21:56:24 +0000923 change. *g:colors_name*
Bram Moolenaar8f3f58f2010-01-06 20:52:26 +0100924 When a color scheme is loaded (the "g:colors_name" variable is set)
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000925 setting 'background' will cause the color scheme to be reloaded. If
926 the color scheme adjusts to the value of 'background' this will work.
927 However, if the color scheme sets 'background' itself the effect may
Bram Moolenaar8f3f58f2010-01-06 20:52:26 +0100928 be undone. First delete the "g:colors_name" variable when needed.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000929
930 When setting 'background' to the default value with: >
931 :set background&
932< Vim will guess the value. In the GUI this should work correctly,
933 in other cases Vim might not be able to guess the right value.
Bram Moolenaar2e693a82019-10-16 22:35:02 +0200934 If the GUI supports a dark theme, you can use the "d" flag in
Bram Moolenaar50bf7ce2019-09-15 13:17:00 +0200935 'guioptions', see 'go-d'.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000936
Bram Moolenaar37c64c72017-09-19 22:06:03 +0200937 When the |t_RB| option is set, Vim will use it to request the background
Bram Moolenaarb4d6c3e2017-05-27 16:45:17 +0200938 color from the terminal. If the returned RGB value is dark/light and
939 'background' is not dark/light, 'background' will be set and the
940 screen is redrawn. This may have side effects, make t_BG empty in
Bram Moolenaar37c64c72017-09-19 22:06:03 +0200941 your .vimrc if you suspect this problem. The response to |t_RB| can
Bram Moolenaar01164a62017-11-02 22:58:42 +0100942 be found in |v:termrbgresp|.
Bram Moolenaarb4d6c3e2017-05-27 16:45:17 +0200943
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000944 When starting the GUI, the default value for 'background' will be
945 "light". When the value is not set in the .gvimrc, and Vim detects
946 that the background is actually quite dark, 'background' is set to
947 "dark". But this happens only AFTER the .gvimrc file has been read
948 (because the window needs to be opened to find the actual background
949 color). To get around this, force the GUI window to be opened by
950 putting a ":gui" command in the .gvimrc file, before where the value
951 of 'background' is used (e.g., before ":syntax on").
Bram Moolenaar446beb42011-05-10 17:18:44 +0200952
Bram Moolenaar6f345a12019-12-17 21:27:18 +0100953 For MS-Windows the default is "dark".
Bram Moolenaar446beb42011-05-10 17:18:44 +0200954 For other systems "dark" is used when 'term' is "linux",
955 "screen.linux", "cygwin" or "putty", or $COLORFGBG suggests a dark
956 background. Otherwise the default is "light".
957
Bram Moolenaarc572da52017-08-27 16:52:01 +0200958 The |:terminal| command and the |term_start()| function use the
959 'background' value to decide whether the terminal window will start
960 with a white or black background.
961
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000962 Normally this option would be set in the .vimrc file. Possibly
963 depending on the terminal name. Example: >
964 :if &term == "pcterm"
965 : set background=dark
966 :endif
967< When this option is set, the default settings for the highlight groups
968 will change. To use other settings, place ":highlight" commands AFTER
969 the setting of the 'background' option.
970 This option is also used in the "$VIMRUNTIME/syntax/syntax.vim" file
971 to select the colors for syntax highlighting. After changing this
972 option, you must load syntax.vim again to see the result. This can be
973 done with ":syntax on".
974
975 *'backspace'* *'bs'*
Bram Moolenaar8c08b5b2016-07-28 22:24:15 +0200976'backspace' 'bs' string (default "", set to "indent,eol,start"
977 in |defaults.vim|)
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000978 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000979 Influences the working of <BS>, <Del>, CTRL-W and CTRL-U in Insert
980 mode. This is a list of items, separated by commas. Each item allows
981 a way to backspace over something:
982 value effect ~
983 indent allow backspacing over autoindent
984 eol allow backspacing over line breaks (join lines)
985 start allow backspacing over the start of insert; CTRL-W and CTRL-U
986 stop once at the start of insert.
Bram Moolenaaraa0489e2020-04-17 19:41:21 +0200987 nostop like start, except CTRL-W and CTRL-U do not stop at the start of
988 insert.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000989
Bram Moolenaar46eea442022-03-30 10:51:39 +0100990 When the value is empty, Vi compatible backspacing is used, none of
991 the ways mentioned for the items above are possible.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000992
993 For backwards compatibility with version 5.4 and earlier:
994 value effect ~
995 0 same as ":set backspace=" (Vi compatible)
996 1 same as ":set backspace=indent,eol"
997 2 same as ":set backspace=indent,eol,start"
Bram Moolenaaraa0489e2020-04-17 19:41:21 +0200998 3 same as ":set backspace=indent,eol,nostop"
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000999
1000 See |:fixdel| if your <BS> or <Del> key does not do what you want.
1001 NOTE: This option is set to "" when 'compatible' is set.
1002
1003 *'backup'* *'bk'* *'nobackup'* *'nobk'*
1004'backup' 'bk' boolean (default off)
1005 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001006 Make a backup before overwriting a file. Leave it around after the
1007 file has been successfully written. If you do not want to keep the
1008 backup file, but you do want a backup while the file is being
1009 written, reset this option and set the 'writebackup' option (this is
1010 the default). If you do not want a backup file at all reset both
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00001011 options (use this if your file system is almost full). See the
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001012 |backup-table| for more explanations.
1013 When the 'backupskip' pattern matches, a backup is not made anyway.
1014 When 'patchmode' is set, the backup may be renamed to become the
1015 oldest version of a file.
1016 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
1017
1018 *'backupcopy'* *'bkc'*
1019'backupcopy' 'bkc' string (Vi default for Unix: "yes", otherwise: "auto")
Bram Moolenaarb8ee25a2014-09-23 15:45:08 +02001020 global or local to buffer |global-local|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001021 When writing a file and a backup is made, this option tells how it's
Bram Moolenaarcbaff5e2022-04-08 17:45:08 +01001022 done. This is a comma-separated list of words.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001023
1024 The main values are:
1025 "yes" make a copy of the file and overwrite the original one
1026 "no" rename the file and write a new one
1027 "auto" one of the previous, what works best
1028
1029 Extra values that can be combined with the ones above are:
1030 "breaksymlink" always break symlinks when writing
1031 "breakhardlink" always break hardlinks when writing
1032
1033 Making a copy and overwriting the original file:
1034 - Takes extra time to copy the file.
1035 + When the file has special attributes, is a (hard/symbolic) link or
1036 has a resource fork, all this is preserved.
1037 - When the file is a link the backup will have the name of the link,
1038 not of the real file.
1039
1040 Renaming the file and writing a new one:
1041 + It's fast.
1042 - Sometimes not all attributes of the file can be copied to the new
1043 file.
1044 - When the file is a link the new file will not be a link.
1045
Bram Moolenaarcbaff5e2022-04-08 17:45:08 +01001046 The "auto" value is the middle way: When Vim sees that renaming the
1047 file is possible without side effects (the attributes can be passed on
1048 and the file is not a link) that is used. When problems are expected,
1049 a copy will be made.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001050
1051 The "breaksymlink" and "breakhardlink" values can be used in
1052 combination with any of "yes", "no" and "auto". When included, they
1053 force Vim to always break either symbolic or hard links by doing
1054 exactly what the "no" option does, renaming the original file to
1055 become the backup and writing a new file in its place. This can be
1056 useful for example in source trees where all the files are symbolic or
1057 hard links and any changes should stay in the local source tree, not
1058 be propagated back to the original source.
1059 *crontab*
1060 One situation where "no" and "auto" will cause problems: A program
1061 that opens a file, invokes Vim to edit that file, and then tests if
1062 the open file was changed (through the file descriptor) will check the
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00001063 backup file instead of the newly created file. "crontab -e" is an
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001064 example.
1065
1066 When a copy is made, the original file is truncated and then filled
1067 with the new text. This means that protection bits, owner and
Bram Moolenaarcbaff5e2022-04-08 17:45:08 +01001068 symbolic links of the original file are unmodified. The backup file,
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00001069 however, is a new file, owned by the user who edited the file. The
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001070 group of the backup is set to the group of the original file. If this
1071 fails, the protection bits for the group are made the same as for
1072 others.
1073
Bram Moolenaarcbaff5e2022-04-08 17:45:08 +01001074 When the file is renamed, this is the other way around: The backup has
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001075 the same attributes of the original file, and the newly written file
1076 is owned by the current user. When the file was a (hard/symbolic)
1077 link, the new file will not! That's why the "auto" value doesn't
1078 rename when the file is a link. The owner and group of the newly
1079 written file will be set to the same ones as the original file, but
1080 the system may refuse to do this. In that case the "auto" value will
1081 again not rename the file.
1082
Bram Moolenaar036986f2017-03-16 17:41:02 +01001083 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
1084 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
1085
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001086 *'backupdir'* *'bdir'*
1087'backupdir' 'bdir' string (default for Amiga: ".,t:",
Bram Moolenaar5666fcd2019-12-26 14:35:26 +01001088 for Win32: ".,$TEMP,c:/tmp,c:/temp"
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001089 for Unix: ".,~/tmp,~/")
1090 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001091 List of directories for the backup file, separated with commas.
1092 - The backup file will be created in the first directory in the list
Bram Moolenaar8f3f58f2010-01-06 20:52:26 +01001093 where this is possible. The directory must exist, Vim will not
1094 create it for you.
Bram Moolenaar3848e002016-03-19 18:42:29 +01001095 - Empty means that no backup file will be created ('patchmode' is
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001096 impossible!). Writing may fail because of this.
1097 - A directory "." means to put the backup file in the same directory
1098 as the edited file.
Bram Moolenaar8024f932020-01-14 19:29:13 +01001099 - A directory starting with "./" (or ".\" for MS-Windows) means to put
1100 the backup file relative to where the edited file is. The leading
1101 "." is replaced with the path name of the edited file.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001102 ("." inside a directory name has no special meaning).
1103 - Spaces after the comma are ignored, other spaces are considered part
1104 of the directory name. To have a space at the start of a directory
1105 name, precede it with a backslash.
1106 - To include a comma in a directory name precede it with a backslash.
1107 - A directory name may end in an '/'.
Bram Moolenaarb782ba42018-08-07 21:39:28 +02001108 - For Unix and Win32, if a directory ends in two path separators "//",
Bram Moolenaarf0d58ef2018-11-16 16:13:44 +01001109 the backup file name will be built from the complete path to the
1110 file with all path separators changed to percent '%' signs. This
1111 will ensure file name uniqueness in the backup directory.
Bram Moolenaarb782ba42018-08-07 21:39:28 +02001112 On Win32, it is also possible to end with "\\". However, When a
1113 separating comma is following, you must use "//", since "\\" will
1114 include the comma in the file name. Therefore it is recommended to
1115 use '//', instead of '\\'.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001116 - Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|.
1117 - Careful with '\' characters, type one before a space, type two to
1118 get one in the option (see |option-backslash|), for example: >
1119 :set bdir=c:\\tmp,\ dir\\,with\\,commas,\\\ dir\ with\ spaces
1120< - For backwards compatibility with Vim version 3.0 a '>' at the start
1121 of the option is removed.
1122 See also 'backup' and 'writebackup' options.
1123 If you want to hide your backup files on Unix, consider this value: >
1124 :set backupdir=./.backup,~/.backup,.,/tmp
1125< You must create a ".backup" directory in each directory and in your
1126 home directory for this to work properly.
1127 The use of |:set+=| and |:set-=| is preferred when adding or removing
1128 directories from the list. This avoids problems when a future version
1129 uses another default.
1130 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
1131 security reasons.
1132
1133 *'backupext'* *'bex'* *E589*
1134'backupext' 'bex' string (default "~", for VMS: "_")
1135 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001136 String which is appended to a file name to make the name of the
1137 backup file. The default is quite unusual, because this avoids
1138 accidentally overwriting existing files with a backup file. You might
1139 prefer using ".bak", but make sure that you don't have files with
1140 ".bak" that you want to keep.
Bram Moolenaarcbaff5e2022-04-08 17:45:08 +01001141 Only normal file name characters can be used; "/\*?[|<>" are illegal.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001142
Bram Moolenaar3fdfa4a2004-10-07 21:02:47 +00001143 If you like to keep a lot of backups, you could use a BufWritePre
1144 autocommand to change 'backupext' just before writing the file to
1145 include a timestamp. >
Bram Moolenaarc51cf032022-02-26 12:25:45 +00001146 :au BufWritePre * let &bex = '-' .. strftime("%Y%b%d%X") .. '~'
Bram Moolenaar3fdfa4a2004-10-07 21:02:47 +00001147< Use 'backupdir' to put the backup in a different directory.
1148
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001149 *'backupskip'* *'bsk'*
Bram Moolenaarb8e22a02018-04-12 21:37:34 +02001150'backupskip' 'bsk' string (default: "$TMPDIR/*,$TMP/*,$TEMP/*"
1151 Unix: "/tmp/*,$TMPDIR/*,$TMP/*,$TEMP/*"
1152 Mac: "/private/tmp/*,$TMPDIR/*,$TMP/*,$TEMP/*")
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001153 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001154 {not available when compiled without the |+wildignore|
1155 feature}
1156 A list of file patterns. When one of the patterns matches with the
1157 name of the file which is written, no backup file is created. Both
1158 the specified file name and the full path name of the file are used.
1159 The pattern is used like with |:autocmd|, see |autocmd-patterns|.
1160 Watch out for special characters, see |option-backslash|.
1161 When $TMPDIR, $TMP or $TEMP is not defined, it is not used for the
Bram Moolenaar582fd852005-03-28 20:58:01 +00001162 default value. "/tmp/*" is only used for Unix.
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00001163
Bram Moolenaar1aeaf8c2012-05-18 13:46:39 +02001164 WARNING: Not having a backup file means that when Vim fails to write
1165 your buffer correctly and then, for whatever reason, Vim exits, you
1166 lose both the original file and what you were writing. Only disable
1167 backups if you don't care about losing the file.
1168
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00001169 Note that environment variables are not expanded. If you want to use
1170 $HOME you must expand it explicitly, e.g.: >
Bram Moolenaarc51cf032022-02-26 12:25:45 +00001171 :let &backupskip = escape(expand('$HOME'), '\') .. '/tmp/*'
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00001172
1173< Note that the default also makes sure that "crontab -e" works (when a
Bram Moolenaara5792f52005-11-23 21:25:05 +00001174 backup would be made by renaming the original file crontab won't see
1175 the newly created file). Also see 'backupcopy' and |crontab|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001176
1177 *'balloondelay'* *'bdlay'*
1178'balloondelay' 'bdlay' number (default: 600)
1179 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001180 {only available when compiled with the |+balloon_eval|
1181 feature}
1182 Delay in milliseconds before a balloon may pop up. See |balloon-eval|.
1183
1184 *'ballooneval'* *'beval'* *'noballooneval'* *'nobeval'*
1185'ballooneval' 'beval' boolean (default off)
1186 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001187 {only available when compiled with the |+balloon_eval|
Bram Moolenaare4efc3b2005-03-07 23:16:51 +00001188 feature}
Bram Moolenaar51b0f372017-11-18 18:52:04 +01001189 Switch on the |balloon-eval| functionality for the GUI.
1190
1191 *'balloonevalterm'* *'bevalterm'* *'noballoonevalterm'*
1192 *'nobevalterm'*
1193'balloonevalterm' 'bevalterm' boolean (default off)
1194 global
Bram Moolenaar51b0f372017-11-18 18:52:04 +01001195 {only available when compiled with the
1196 |+balloon_eval_term| feature}
1197 Switch on the |balloon-eval| functionality for the terminal.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001198
Bram Moolenaare4efc3b2005-03-07 23:16:51 +00001199 *'balloonexpr'* *'bexpr'*
1200'balloonexpr' 'bexpr' string (default "")
Bram Moolenaar9b2200a2006-03-20 21:55:45 +00001201 global or local to buffer |global-local|
Bram Moolenaare4efc3b2005-03-07 23:16:51 +00001202 {only available when compiled with the |+balloon_eval|
1203 feature}
Bram Moolenaar97b2ad32006-03-18 21:40:56 +00001204 Expression for text to show in evaluation balloon. It is only used
Bram Moolenaara6c27c42019-05-09 19:16:22 +02001205 when 'ballooneval' or 'balloonevalterm' is on. These variables can be
1206 used:
Bram Moolenaare4efc3b2005-03-07 23:16:51 +00001207
1208 v:beval_bufnr number of the buffer in which balloon is going to show
1209 v:beval_winnr number of the window
Bram Moolenaar82af8712016-06-04 20:20:29 +02001210 v:beval_winid ID of the window
Bram Moolenaare4efc3b2005-03-07 23:16:51 +00001211 v:beval_lnum line number
1212 v:beval_col column number (byte index)
1213 v:beval_text word under or after the mouse pointer
1214
Bram Moolenaar54775062019-07-31 21:07:14 +02001215 Instead of showing a balloon, which is limited to plain text, consider
1216 using a popup window, see |popup_beval_example|. A popup window can
1217 use highlighting and show a border.
1218
Bram Moolenaare4efc3b2005-03-07 23:16:51 +00001219 The evaluation of the expression must not have side effects!
1220 Example: >
Bram Moolenaara6c27c42019-05-09 19:16:22 +02001221 function MyBalloonExpr()
Bram Moolenaarc51cf032022-02-26 12:25:45 +00001222 return 'Cursor is at line ' .. v:beval_lnum ..
1223 \ ', column ' .. v:beval_col ..
1224 \ ' of file ' .. bufname(v:beval_bufnr) ..
1225 \ ' on word "' .. v:beval_text .. '"'
Bram Moolenaare4efc3b2005-03-07 23:16:51 +00001226 endfunction
1227 set bexpr=MyBalloonExpr()
1228 set ballooneval
1229<
Bram Moolenaar396e8292019-07-13 23:04:31 +02001230 Also see |balloon_show()|, it can be used if the content of the balloon
1231 is to be fetched asynchronously. In that case evaluating
1232 'balloonexpr' should result in an empty string. If you get a balloon
1233 with only "0" you probably didn't return anything from your function.
Bram Moolenaar214641f2017-03-05 17:04:09 +01001234
Bram Moolenaare4efc3b2005-03-07 23:16:51 +00001235 NOTE: The balloon is displayed only if the cursor is on a text
1236 character. If the result of evaluating 'balloonexpr' is not empty,
1237 Vim does not try to send a message to an external debugger (Netbeans
1238 or Sun Workshop).
1239
Yegappan Lakshmanan8bb65f22021-12-26 10:51:39 +00001240 If the expression starts with s: or |<SID>|, then it is replaced with
1241 the script ID (|local-function|). Example: >
1242 set bexpr=s:MyBalloonExpr()
1243 set bexpr=<SID>SomeBalloonExpr()
Bram Moolenaar6f4754b2022-01-23 12:07:04 +00001244< Otherwise, the expression is evaluated in the context of the script
1245 where the option was set, thus script-local items are available.
1246
Bram Moolenaar30b65812012-07-12 22:01:11 +02001247 The expression will be evaluated in the |sandbox| when set from a
1248 modeline, see |sandbox-option|.
Bram Moolenaar110289e2019-05-23 15:38:06 +02001249 This option cannot be set in a modeline when 'modelineexpr' is off.
Bram Moolenaarb71eaae2006-01-20 23:10:18 +00001250
1251 It is not allowed to change text or jump to another window while
Bram Moolenaar396e8292019-07-13 23:04:31 +02001252 evaluating 'balloonexpr', see |textlock|.
Bram Moolenaarb71eaae2006-01-20 23:10:18 +00001253
Bram Moolenaar87e25fd2005-07-27 21:13:01 +00001254 To check whether line breaks in the balloon text work use this check: >
Bram Moolenaar45360022005-07-21 21:08:21 +00001255 if has("balloon_multiline")
Bram Moolenaar362e1a32006-03-06 23:29:24 +00001256< When they are supported "\n" characters will start a new line. If the
1257 expression evaluates to a |List| this is equal to using each List item
1258 as a string and putting "\n" in between them.
Bram Moolenaar036986f2017-03-16 17:41:02 +01001259 NOTE: This option is set to "" when 'compatible' is set.
Bram Moolenaar362e1a32006-03-06 23:29:24 +00001260
Bram Moolenaar165bc692015-07-21 17:53:25 +02001261 *'belloff'* *'bo'*
1262'belloff' 'bo' string (default "")
1263 global
Bram Moolenaar165bc692015-07-21 17:53:25 +02001264 Specifies for which events the bell will not be rung. It is a comma
1265 separated list of items. For each item that is present, the bell
1266 will be silenced. This is most useful to specify specific events in
1267 insert mode to be silenced.
LemonBoy77771d32022-04-13 11:47:25 +01001268 You can also make it flash by using 'visualbell'.
Bram Moolenaar165bc692015-07-21 17:53:25 +02001269
1270 item meaning when present ~
1271 all All events.
1272 backspace When hitting <BS> or <Del> and deleting results in an
1273 error.
1274 cursor Fail to move around using the cursor keys or
1275 <PageUp>/<PageDown> in |Insert-mode|.
1276 complete Error occurred when using |i_CTRL-X_CTRL-K| or
1277 |i_CTRL-X_CTRL-T|.
1278 copy Cannot copy char from insert mode using |i_CTRL-Y| or
1279 |i_CTRL-E|.
1280 ctrlg Unknown Char after <C-G> in Insert mode.
1281 error Other Error occurred (e.g. try to join last line)
1282 (mostly used in |Normal-mode| or |Cmdline-mode|).
1283 esc hitting <Esc> in |Normal-mode|.
1284 ex In |Visual-mode|, hitting |Q| results in an error.
Bram Moolenaar0c0734d2019-11-26 21:44:46 +01001285 hangul Ignored.
Bram Moolenaar165bc692015-07-21 17:53:25 +02001286 insertmode Pressing <Esc> in 'insertmode'.
1287 lang Calling the beep module for Lua/Mzscheme/TCL.
1288 mess No output available for |g<|.
1289 showmatch Error occurred for 'showmatch' function.
1290 operator Empty region error |cpo-E|.
1291 register Unknown register after <C-R> in |Insert-mode|.
1292 shell Bell from shell output |:!|.
1293 spell Error happened on spell suggest.
LemonBoy77771d32022-04-13 11:47:25 +01001294 term Bell from |:terminal| output.
Bram Moolenaar165bc692015-07-21 17:53:25 +02001295 wildmode More matches in |cmdline-completion| available
1296 (depends on the 'wildmode' setting).
1297
Bram Moolenaar036986f2017-03-16 17:41:02 +01001298 This is most useful to fine tune when in Insert mode the bell should
1299 be rung. For Normal mode and Ex commands, the bell is often rung to
Bram Moolenaar165bc692015-07-21 17:53:25 +02001300 indicate that an error occurred. It can be silenced by adding the
1301 "error" keyword.
1302
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001303 *'binary'* *'bin'* *'nobinary'* *'nobin'*
1304'binary' 'bin' boolean (default off)
1305 local to buffer
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001306 This option should be set before editing a binary file. You can also
1307 use the |-b| Vim argument. When this option is switched on a few
1308 options will be changed (also when it already was on):
1309 'textwidth' will be set to 0
1310 'wrapmargin' will be set to 0
1311 'modeline' will be off
1312 'expandtab' will be off
1313 Also, 'fileformat' and 'fileformats' options will not be used, the
1314 file is read and written like 'fileformat' was "unix" (a single <NL>
1315 separates lines).
1316 The 'fileencoding' and 'fileencodings' options will not be used, the
1317 file is read without conversion.
1318 NOTE: When you start editing a(nother) file while the 'bin' option is
1319 on, settings from autocommands may change the settings again (e.g.,
1320 'textwidth'), causing trouble when editing. You might want to set
1321 'bin' again when the file has been loaded.
1322 The previous values of these options are remembered and restored when
1323 'bin' is switched from on to off. Each buffer has its own set of
1324 saved option values.
1325 To edit a file with 'binary' set you can use the |++bin| argument.
1326 This avoids you have to do ":set bin", which would have effect for all
1327 files you edit.
1328 When writing a file the <EOL> for the last line is only written if
1329 there was one in the original file (normally Vim appends an <EOL> to
1330 the last line if there is none; this would make the file longer). See
1331 the 'endofline' option.
1332
1333 *'bioskey'* *'biosk'* *'nobioskey'* *'nobiosk'*
1334'bioskey' 'biosk' boolean (default on)
1335 global
Bram Moolenaar6c60f472019-04-28 16:00:35 +02001336 {only for MS-DOS}
Bram Moolenaarf3913272016-02-25 00:00:01 +01001337 This was for MS-DOS and is no longer supported.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001338
1339 *'bomb'* *'nobomb'*
1340'bomb' boolean (default off)
1341 local to buffer
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001342 When writing a file and the following conditions are met, a BOM (Byte
1343 Order Mark) is prepended to the file:
1344 - this option is on
1345 - the 'binary' option is off
1346 - 'fileencoding' is "utf-8", "ucs-2", "ucs-4" or one of the little/big
1347 endian variants.
1348 Some applications use the BOM to recognize the encoding of the file.
1349 Often used for UCS-2 files on MS-Windows. For other applications it
1350 causes trouble, for example: "cat file1 file2" makes the BOM of file2
Bram Moolenaar8f3f58f2010-01-06 20:52:26 +01001351 appear halfway the resulting file. Gcc doesn't accept a BOM.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001352 When Vim reads a file and 'fileencodings' starts with "ucs-bom", a
1353 check for the presence of the BOM is done and 'bomb' set accordingly.
1354 Unless 'binary' is set, it is removed from the first line, so that you
1355 don't see it when editing. When you don't change the options, the BOM
1356 will be restored when writing the file.
1357
1358 *'breakat'* *'brk'*
1359'breakat' 'brk' string (default " ^I!@*-+;:,./?")
1360 global
Bram Moolenaardb84e452010-08-15 13:50:43 +02001361 {not available when compiled without the |+linebreak|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001362 feature}
1363 This option lets you choose which characters might cause a line
Bram Moolenaarac6e65f2005-08-29 22:25:38 +00001364 break if 'linebreak' is on. Only works for ASCII and also for 8-bit
1365 characters when 'encoding' is an 8-bit encoding.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001366
Bram Moolenaar7c1c6db2016-04-03 22:08:05 +02001367 *'breakindent'* *'bri'* *'nobreakindent'* *'nobri'*
Bram Moolenaar946e27a2014-06-25 18:50:27 +02001368'breakindent' 'bri' boolean (default off)
1369 local to window
Bram Moolenaar946e27a2014-06-25 18:50:27 +02001370 {not available when compiled without the |+linebreak|
1371 feature}
1372 Every wrapped line will continue visually indented (same amount of
1373 space as the beginning of that line), thus preserving horizontal blocks
1374 of text.
Bram Moolenaar036986f2017-03-16 17:41:02 +01001375 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
Bram Moolenaar946e27a2014-06-25 18:50:27 +02001376
1377 *'breakindentopt'* *'briopt'*
1378'breakindentopt' 'briopt' string (default empty)
1379 local to window
Bram Moolenaar946e27a2014-06-25 18:50:27 +02001380 {not available when compiled without the |+linebreak|
1381 feature}
1382 Settings for 'breakindent'. It can consist of the following optional
Bram Moolenaar86b17e92014-07-02 20:00:47 +02001383 items and must be separated by a comma:
Bram Moolenaar946e27a2014-06-25 18:50:27 +02001384 min:{n} Minimum text width that will be kept after
1385 applying 'breakindent', even if the resulting
1386 text should normally be narrower. This prevents
1387 text indented almost to the right window border
1388 occupying lot of vertical space when broken.
Christian Brabandtc53b4672022-01-15 10:01:05 +00001389 (default: 20)
Bram Moolenaar86b17e92014-07-02 20:00:47 +02001390 shift:{n} After applying 'breakindent', the wrapped line's
1391 beginning will be shifted by the given number of
1392 characters. It permits dynamic French paragraph
Bram Moolenaar946e27a2014-06-25 18:50:27 +02001393 indentation (negative) or emphasizing the line
1394 continuation (positive).
Bram Moolenaar22f1d0e2018-02-27 14:53:30 +01001395 sbr Display the 'showbreak' value before applying the
Bram Moolenaar946e27a2014-06-25 18:50:27 +02001396 additional indent.
Maxim Kimf674b352021-07-22 11:46:59 +02001397 list:{n} Adds an additional indent for lines that match a
Christian Brabandt4a0b85a2021-07-14 20:00:27 +02001398 numbered or bulleted list (using the
1399 'formatlistpat' setting).
Maxim Kimf674b352021-07-22 11:46:59 +02001400 list:-1 Uses the length of a match with 'formatlistpat'
1401 for indentation.
Christian Brabandt4a0b85a2021-07-14 20:00:27 +02001402 The default value for min is 20, shift and list is 0.
Bram Moolenaar946e27a2014-06-25 18:50:27 +02001403
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001404 *'browsedir'* *'bsdir'*
Bram Moolenaar7b0294c2004-10-11 10:16:09 +00001405'browsedir' 'bsdir' string (default: "last")
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001406 global
Bram Moolenaarcbaff5e2022-04-08 17:45:08 +01001407 {only for Motif, GTK, Mac and Win32 GUI}
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001408 Which directory to use for the file browser:
Bram Moolenaar446cb832008-06-24 21:56:24 +00001409 last Use same directory as with last file browser, where a
Bram Moolenaar0bc380a2010-07-10 13:52:13 +02001410 file was opened or saved.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001411 buffer Use the directory of the related buffer.
1412 current Use the current directory.
1413 {path} Use the specified directory
1414
1415 *'bufhidden'* *'bh'*
1416'bufhidden' 'bh' string (default: "")
1417 local to buffer
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001418 This option specifies what happens when a buffer is no longer
1419 displayed in a window:
1420 <empty> follow the global 'hidden' option
Bram Moolenaarcbaff5e2022-04-08 17:45:08 +01001421 hide hide the buffer (don't unload it), even if 'hidden' is
1422 not set
1423 unload unload the buffer, even if 'hidden' is set; the
1424 |:hide| command will also unlod the buffer
1425 delete delete the buffer from the buffer list, even if
1426 'hidden' is set; the |:hide| command will also delete
1427 the buffer, making it behave like |:bdelete|
1428 wipe wipe the buffer from the buffer list, even if
1429 'hidden' is set; the |:hide| command will also wipe
1430 out the buffer, making it behave like |:bwipeout|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001431
Bram Moolenaara14de3d2005-01-07 21:48:26 +00001432 CAREFUL: when "unload", "delete" or "wipe" is used changes in a buffer
Bram Moolenaarf1568ec2011-12-14 21:17:39 +01001433 are lost without a warning. Also, these values may break autocommands
1434 that switch between buffers temporarily.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001435 This option is used together with 'buftype' and 'swapfile' to specify
1436 special kinds of buffers. See |special-buffers|.
1437
1438 *'buflisted'* *'bl'* *'nobuflisted'* *'nobl'* *E85*
1439'buflisted' 'bl' boolean (default: on)
1440 local to buffer
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001441 When this option is set, the buffer shows up in the buffer list. If
1442 it is reset it is not used for ":bnext", "ls", the Buffers menu, etc.
1443 This option is reset by Vim for buffers that are only used to remember
1444 a file name or marks. Vim sets it when starting to edit a buffer.
1445 But not when moving to a buffer with ":buffer".
1446
1447 *'buftype'* *'bt'* *E382*
1448'buftype' 'bt' string (default: "")
1449 local to buffer
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001450 The value of this option specifies the type of a buffer:
1451 <empty> normal buffer
1452 nofile buffer which is not related to a file and will not be
1453 written
1454 nowrite buffer which will not be written
Bram Moolenaar21cf8232004-07-16 20:18:37 +00001455 acwrite buffer which will always be written with BufWriteCmd
Bram Moolenaarb5b75622018-03-09 22:22:21 +01001456 autocommands.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001457 quickfix quickfix buffer, contains list of errors |:cwindow|
Bram Moolenaar280f1262006-01-30 00:14:18 +00001458 or list of locations |:lwindow|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001459 help help buffer (you are not supposed to set this
1460 manually)
Bram Moolenaar1f2903c2017-07-23 19:51:01 +02001461 terminal buffer for a |terminal| (you are not supposed to set
1462 this manually)
Bram Moolenaarf2732452018-06-03 14:47:35 +02001463 prompt buffer where only the last line can be edited, meant
1464 to be used by a plugin, see |prompt-buffer|
1465 {only when compiled with the |+channel| feature}
Bram Moolenaar4d784b22019-05-25 19:51:39 +02001466 popup buffer used in a popup window, see |popup|.
1467 {only when compiled with the |+textprop| feature}
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001468
1469 This option is used together with 'bufhidden' and 'swapfile' to
1470 specify special kinds of buffers. See |special-buffers|.
Bram Moolenaarebdf3c92020-02-15 21:41:42 +01001471 Also see |win_gettype()|, which returns the type of the window.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001472
1473 Be careful with changing this option, it can have many side effects!
Bram Moolenaar113cb512021-11-07 20:27:04 +00001474 One such effect is that Vim will not check the timestamp of the file,
1475 if the file is changed by another program this will not be noticed.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001476
Bram Moolenaar280f1262006-01-30 00:14:18 +00001477 A "quickfix" buffer is only used for the error list and the location
1478 list. This value is set by the |:cwindow| and |:lwindow| commands and
1479 you are not supposed to change it.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001480
1481 "nofile" and "nowrite" buffers are similar:
1482 both: The buffer is not to be written to disk, ":w" doesn't
1483 work (":w filename" does work though).
1484 both: The buffer is never considered to be |'modified'|.
1485 There is no warning when the changes will be lost, for
1486 example when you quit Vim.
1487 both: A swap file is only created when using too much memory
1488 (when 'swapfile' has been reset there is never a swap
1489 file).
1490 nofile only: The buffer name is fixed, it is not handled like a
1491 file name. It is not modified in response to a |:cd|
1492 command.
Bram Moolenaar2b8388b2015-02-28 13:11:45 +01001493 both: When using ":e bufname" and already editing "bufname"
1494 the buffer is made empty and autocommands are
1495 triggered as usual for |:edit|.
Bram Moolenaar21cf8232004-07-16 20:18:37 +00001496 *E676*
1497 "acwrite" implies that the buffer name is not related to a file, like
1498 "nofile", but it will be written. Thus, in contrast to "nofile" and
1499 "nowrite", ":w" does work and a modified buffer can't be abandoned
1500 without saving. For writing there must be matching |BufWriteCmd|,
1501 |FileWriteCmd| or |FileAppendCmd| autocommands.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001502
1503 *'casemap'* *'cmp'*
1504'casemap' 'cmp' string (default: "internal,keepascii")
1505 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001506 Specifies details about changing the case of letters. It may contain
1507 these words, separated by a comma:
1508 internal Use internal case mapping functions, the current
1509 locale does not change the case mapping. This only
Bram Moolenaar6f16eb82005-08-23 21:02:42 +00001510 matters when 'encoding' is a Unicode encoding,
1511 "latin1" or "iso-8859-15". When "internal" is
1512 omitted, the towupper() and towlower() system library
1513 functions are used when available.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001514 keepascii For the ASCII characters (0x00 to 0x7f) use the US
1515 case mapping, the current locale is not effective.
1516 This probably only matters for Turkish.
1517
Bram Moolenaar7b1463b2021-12-11 17:24:39 +00001518 *'cdhome'* *'cdh'*
1519'cdhome' 'cdh' boolean (default: off)
1520 global
1521 When on, |:cd|, |:tcd| and |:lcd| without an argument changes the
1522 current working directory to the |$HOME| directory like in Unix.
1523 When off, those commands just print the current directory name.
1524 On Unix this option has no effect.
1525 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
1526
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001527 *'cdpath'* *'cd'* *E344* *E346*
1528'cdpath' 'cd' string (default: equivalent to $CDPATH or ",,")
1529 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001530 {not available when compiled without the
1531 |+file_in_path| feature}
1532 This is a list of directories which will be searched when using the
Bram Moolenaar00aa0692019-04-27 20:37:57 +02001533 |:cd|, |:tcd| and |:lcd| commands, provided that the directory being
1534 searched for has a relative path, not an absolute part starting with
1535 "/", "./" or "../", the 'cdpath' option is not used then.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001536 The 'cdpath' option's value has the same form and semantics as
1537 |'path'|. Also see |file-searching|.
1538 The default value is taken from $CDPATH, with a "," prepended to look
1539 in the current directory first.
1540 If the default value taken from $CDPATH is not what you want, include
1541 a modified version of the following command in your vimrc file to
1542 override it: >
Bram Moolenaarc51cf032022-02-26 12:25:45 +00001543 :let &cdpath = ',' .. substitute(substitute($CDPATH, '[, ]', '\\\0', 'g'), ':', ',', 'g')
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001544< This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
1545 security reasons.
1546 (parts of 'cdpath' can be passed to the shell to expand file names).
1547
1548 *'cedit'*
1549'cedit' string (Vi default: "", Vim default: CTRL-F)
1550 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001551 The key used in Command-line Mode to open the command-line window.
1552 The default is CTRL-F when 'compatible' is off.
1553 Only non-printable keys are allowed.
1554 The key can be specified as a single character, but it is difficult to
1555 type. The preferred way is to use the <> notation. Examples: >
Bram Moolenaare18dbe82016-07-02 21:42:23 +02001556 :exe "set cedit=\<C-Y>"
1557 :exe "set cedit=\<Esc>"
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001558< |Nvi| also has this option, but it only uses the first character.
1559 See |cmdwin|.
Bram Moolenaar036986f2017-03-16 17:41:02 +01001560 NOTE: This option is set to the Vim default value when 'compatible'
1561 is reset.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001562
1563 *'charconvert'* *'ccv'* *E202* *E214* *E513*
1564'charconvert' 'ccv' string (default "")
1565 global
Bram Moolenaar4c92e752019-02-17 21:18:32 +01001566 {only available when compiled with the |+eval| feature}
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001567 An expression that is used for character encoding conversion. It is
1568 evaluated when a file that is to be read or has been written has a
1569 different encoding from what is desired.
1570 'charconvert' is not used when the internal iconv() function is
1571 supported and is able to do the conversion. Using iconv() is
1572 preferred, because it is much faster.
1573 'charconvert' is not used when reading stdin |--|, because there is no
1574 file to convert from. You will have to save the text in a file first.
Bram Moolenaarf10911e2022-01-29 22:20:48 +00001575 The expression must return zero, false or an empty string for success,
1576 non-zero or true for failure.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001577 The possible encoding names encountered are in 'encoding'.
1578 Additionally, names given in 'fileencodings' and 'fileencoding' are
1579 used.
1580 Conversion between "latin1", "unicode", "ucs-2", "ucs-4" and "utf-8"
1581 is done internally by Vim, 'charconvert' is not used for this.
1582 'charconvert' is also used to convert the viminfo file, if the 'c'
1583 flag is present in 'viminfo'. Also used for Unicode conversion.
1584 Example: >
1585 set charconvert=CharConvert()
1586 fun CharConvert()
1587 system("recode "
Bram Moolenaarc51cf032022-02-26 12:25:45 +00001588 \ .. v:charconvert_from .. ".." .. v:charconvert_to
1589 \ .. " <" .. v:fname_in .. " >" .. v:fname_out)
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001590 return v:shell_error
1591 endfun
1592< The related Vim variables are:
1593 v:charconvert_from name of the current encoding
1594 v:charconvert_to name of the desired encoding
1595 v:fname_in name of the input file
1596 v:fname_out name of the output file
1597 Note that v:fname_in and v:fname_out will never be the same.
1598 Note that v:charconvert_from and v:charconvert_to may be different
1599 from 'encoding'. Vim internally uses UTF-8 instead of UCS-2 or UCS-4.
Bram Moolenaarf10911e2022-01-29 22:20:48 +00001600
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001601 Encryption is not done by Vim when using 'charconvert'. If you want
1602 to encrypt the file after conversion, 'charconvert' should take care
1603 of this.
Bram Moolenaarf10911e2022-01-29 22:20:48 +00001604
1605 If the 'charconvert' expression starts with s: or |<SID>|, then it is
1606 replaced with the script ID (|local-function|). Example: >
1607 set charconvert=s:MyConvert()
1608 set charconvert=<SID>SomeConvert()
1609< Otherwise the expression is evaluated in the context of the script
1610 where the option was set, thus script-local items are available.
1611
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001612 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
1613 security reasons.
1614
1615 *'cindent'* *'cin'* *'nocindent'* *'nocin'*
1616'cindent' 'cin' boolean (default off)
1617 local to buffer
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001618 {not available when compiled without the |+cindent|
1619 feature}
Bram Moolenaar446cb832008-06-24 21:56:24 +00001620 Enables automatic C program indenting. See 'cinkeys' to set the keys
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001621 that trigger reindenting in insert mode and 'cinoptions' to set your
1622 preferred indent style.
1623 If 'indentexpr' is not empty, it overrules 'cindent'.
1624 If 'lisp' is not on and both 'indentexpr' and 'equalprg' are empty,
1625 the "=" operator indents using this algorithm rather than calling an
1626 external program.
1627 See |C-indenting|.
1628 When you don't like the way 'cindent' works, try the 'smartindent'
1629 option or 'indentexpr'.
1630 This option is not used when 'paste' is set.
1631 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
1632
1633 *'cinkeys'* *'cink'*
Bram Moolenaarce655742019-01-31 14:12:57 +01001634'cinkeys' 'cink' string (default "0{,0},0),0],:,0#,!^F,o,O,e")
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001635 local to buffer
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001636 {not available when compiled without the |+cindent|
1637 feature}
1638 A list of keys that, when typed in Insert mode, cause reindenting of
1639 the current line. Only used if 'cindent' is on and 'indentexpr' is
1640 empty.
1641 For the format of this option see |cinkeys-format|.
1642 See |C-indenting|.
1643
1644 *'cinoptions'* *'cino'*
1645'cinoptions' 'cino' string (default "")
1646 local to buffer
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001647 {not available when compiled without the |+cindent|
1648 feature}
1649 The 'cinoptions' affect the way 'cindent' reindents lines in a C
1650 program. See |cinoptions-values| for the values of this option, and
1651 |C-indenting| for info on C indenting in general.
1652
1653
1654 *'cinwords'* *'cinw'*
1655'cinwords' 'cinw' string (default "if,else,while,do,for,switch")
1656 local to buffer
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001657 {not available when compiled without both the
1658 |+cindent| and the |+smartindent| features}
1659 These keywords start an extra indent in the next line when
1660 'smartindent' or 'cindent' is set. For 'cindent' this is only done at
1661 an appropriate place (inside {}).
1662 Note that 'ignorecase' isn't used for 'cinwords'. If case doesn't
1663 matter, include the keyword both the uppercase and lowercase:
1664 "if,If,IF".
1665
Tom Praschan3506cf32022-04-07 12:39:08 +01001666 *'cinscopedecls'* *'cinsd'*
1667'cinscopedecls' 'cinsd' string (default "public,protected,private")
1668 local to buffer
1669 {not available when compiled without the |+cindent|
1670 feature}
1671 Keywords that are interpreted as a C++ scope declaration by |cino-g|.
1672 Useful e.g. for working with the Qt framework that defines additional
1673 scope declarations "signals", "public slots" and "private slots": >
1674 set cinscopedecls+=signals,public\ slots,private\ slots
1675
1676< *'clipboard'* *'cb'*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001677'clipboard' 'cb' string (default "autoselect,exclude:cons\|linux"
1678 for X-windows, "" otherwise)
1679 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001680 {only in GUI versions or when the |+xterm_clipboard|
1681 feature is included}
Tom Praschan3506cf32022-04-07 12:39:08 +01001682 This option is a list of comma-separated names.
Bram Moolenaar942db232021-02-13 18:14:48 +01001683 Note: if one of the items is "exclude:", then you can't add an item
1684 after that. Therefore do append an item with += but use ^= to
1685 prepend, e.g.: >
1686 set clipboard^=unnamed
1687< These names are recognized:
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001688
Bram Moolenaarc0885aa2012-07-10 16:49:23 +02001689 *clipboard-unnamed*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001690 unnamed When included, Vim will use the clipboard register '*'
1691 for all yank, delete, change and put operations which
1692 would normally go to the unnamed register. When a
1693 register is explicitly specified, it will always be
1694 used regardless of whether "unnamed" is in 'clipboard'
1695 or not. The clipboard register can always be
1696 explicitly accessed using the "* notation. Also see
1697 |gui-clipboard|.
1698
Bram Moolenaar30b65812012-07-12 22:01:11 +02001699 *clipboard-unnamedplus*
Bram Moolenaar00154502013-02-13 16:15:55 +01001700 unnamedplus A variant of the "unnamed" flag which uses the
1701 clipboard register '+' (|quoteplus|) instead of
1702 register '*' for all yank, delete, change and put
1703 operations which would normally go to the unnamed
1704 register. When "unnamed" is also included to the
1705 option, yank operations (but not delete, change or
1706 put) will additionally copy the text into register
1707 '*'.
Bram Moolenaar81af9252010-12-10 20:35:50 +01001708 Only available with the |+X11| feature.
Bram Moolenaarbf9680e2010-12-02 21:43:16 +01001709 Availability can be checked with: >
1710 if has('unnamedplus')
1711<
Bram Moolenaar30b65812012-07-12 22:01:11 +02001712 *clipboard-autoselect*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001713 autoselect Works like the 'a' flag in 'guioptions': If present,
1714 then whenever Visual mode is started, or the Visual
1715 area extended, Vim tries to become the owner of the
1716 windowing system's global selection or put the
1717 selected text on the clipboard used by the selection
Bram Moolenaarba3ff532018-11-04 14:45:49 +01001718 register "*. See |'go-a'| and |quotestar| for details.
1719 When the GUI is active, the 'a' flag in 'guioptions'
1720 is used, when the GUI is not active, this "autoselect"
1721 flag is used.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001722 Also applies to the modeless selection.
1723
Bram Moolenaarc0885aa2012-07-10 16:49:23 +02001724 *clipboard-autoselectplus*
1725 autoselectplus Like "autoselect" but using the + register instead of
1726 the * register. Compare to the 'P' flag in
1727 'guioptions'.
1728
1729 *clipboard-autoselectml*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001730 autoselectml Like "autoselect", but for the modeless selection
1731 only. Compare to the 'A' flag in 'guioptions'.
1732
Bram Moolenaarc0885aa2012-07-10 16:49:23 +02001733 *clipboard-html*
Bram Moolenaar3a6eaa52009-06-16 13:23:06 +00001734 html When the clipboard contains HTML, use this when
1735 pasting. When putting text on the clipboard, mark it
1736 as HTML. This works to copy rendered HTML from
1737 Firefox, paste it as raw HTML in Vim, select the HTML
1738 in Vim and paste it in a rich edit box in Firefox.
Bram Moolenaar20a825a2010-05-31 21:27:30 +02001739 You probably want to add this only temporarily,
1740 possibly use BufEnter autocommands.
Bram Moolenaar3a6eaa52009-06-16 13:23:06 +00001741 Only supported for GTK version 2 and later.
Bram Moolenaar3a6eaa52009-06-16 13:23:06 +00001742
Bram Moolenaarc0885aa2012-07-10 16:49:23 +02001743 *clipboard-exclude*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001744 exclude:{pattern}
1745 Defines a pattern that is matched against the name of
1746 the terminal 'term'. If there is a match, no
1747 connection will be made to the X server. This is
1748 useful in this situation:
1749 - Running Vim in a console.
1750 - $DISPLAY is set to start applications on another
1751 display.
1752 - You do not want to connect to the X server in the
1753 console, but do want this in a terminal emulator.
1754 To never connect to the X server use: >
1755 exclude:.*
1756< This has the same effect as using the |-X| argument.
1757 Note that when there is no connection to the X server
1758 the window title won't be restored and the clipboard
1759 cannot be accessed.
1760 The value of 'magic' is ignored, {pattern} is
1761 interpreted as if 'magic' was on.
1762 The rest of the option value will be used for
1763 {pattern}, this must be the last entry.
1764
1765 *'cmdheight'* *'ch'*
1766'cmdheight' 'ch' number (default 1)
1767 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001768 Number of screen lines to use for the command-line. Helps avoiding
1769 |hit-enter| prompts.
Bram Moolenaarc6fe9192006-04-09 21:54:49 +00001770 The value of this option is stored with the tab page, so that each tab
1771 page can have a different value.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001772
1773 *'cmdwinheight'* *'cwh'*
1774'cmdwinheight' 'cwh' number (default 7)
1775 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001776 Number of screen lines to use for the command-line window. |cmdwin|
1777
Bram Moolenaar483c5d82010-10-20 18:45:33 +02001778 *'colorcolumn'* *'cc'*
1779'colorcolumn' 'cc' string (default "")
1780 local to window
Bram Moolenaar483c5d82010-10-20 18:45:33 +02001781 {not available when compiled without the |+syntax|
1782 feature}
Bram Moolenaarcbaff5e2022-04-08 17:45:08 +01001783 'colorcolumn' is a comma-separated list of screen columns that are
Bram Moolenaar483c5d82010-10-20 18:45:33 +02001784 highlighted with ColorColumn |hl-ColorColumn|. Useful to align
1785 text. Will make screen redrawing slower.
1786 The screen column can be an absolute number, or a number preceded with
1787 '+' or '-', which is added to or subtracted from 'textwidth'. >
1788
1789 :set cc=+1 " highlight column after 'textwidth'
1790 :set cc=+1,+2,+3 " highlight three columns after 'textwidth'
1791 :hi ColorColumn ctermbg=lightgrey guibg=lightgrey
1792<
1793 When 'textwidth' is zero then the items with '-' and '+' are not used.
1794 A maximum of 256 columns are highlighted.
1795
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001796 *'columns'* *'co'* *E594*
1797'columns' 'co' number (default 80 or terminal width)
1798 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001799 Number of columns of the screen. Normally this is set by the terminal
Bram Moolenaar7c626922005-02-07 22:01:03 +00001800 initialization and does not have to be set by hand. Also see
1801 |posix-screen-size|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001802 When Vim is running in the GUI or in a resizable window, setting this
1803 option will cause the window size to be changed. When you only want
1804 to use the size for the GUI, put the command in your |gvimrc| file.
1805 When you set this option and Vim is unable to change the physical
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00001806 number of columns of the display, the display may be messed up. For
1807 the GUI it is always possible and Vim limits the number of columns to
1808 what fits on the screen. You can use this command to get the widest
1809 window possible: >
1810 :set columns=9999
1811< Minimum value is 12, maximum value is 10000.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001812
1813 *'comments'* *'com'* *E524* *E525*
1814'comments' 'com' string (default
1815 "s1:/*,mb:*,ex:*/,://,b:#,:%,:XCOMM,n:>,fb:-")
1816 local to buffer
Bram Moolenaarcbaff5e2022-04-08 17:45:08 +01001817 A comma-separated list of strings that can start a comment line. See
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001818 |format-comments|. See |option-backslash| about using backslashes to
1819 insert a space.
1820
1821 *'commentstring'* *'cms'* *E537*
1822'commentstring' 'cms' string (default "/*%s*/")
1823 local to buffer
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001824 {not available when compiled without the |+folding|
1825 feature}
1826 A template for a comment. The "%s" in the value is replaced with the
1827 comment text. Currently only used to add markers for folding, see
1828 |fold-marker|.
1829
1830 *'compatible'* *'cp'* *'nocompatible'* *'nocp'*
Bram Moolenaar910f66f2006-04-05 20:41:53 +00001831'compatible' 'cp' boolean (default on, off when a |vimrc| or |gvimrc|
Bram Moolenaar8c08b5b2016-07-28 22:24:15 +02001832 file is found, reset in |defaults.vim|)
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001833 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001834 This option has the effect of making Vim either more Vi-compatible, or
1835 make Vim behave in a more useful way.
Bram Moolenaar214641f2017-03-05 17:04:09 +01001836
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001837 This is a special kind of option, because when it's set or reset,
Bram Moolenaar214641f2017-03-05 17:04:09 +01001838 other options are also changed as a side effect.
1839 NOTE: Setting or resetting this option can have a lot of unexpected
1840 effects: Mappings are interpreted in another way, undo behaves
1841 differently, etc. If you set this option in your vimrc file, you
1842 should probably put it at the very start.
1843
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001844 By default this option is on and the Vi defaults are used for the
1845 options. This default was chosen for those people who want to use Vim
1846 just like Vi, and don't even (want to) know about the 'compatible'
1847 option.
Bram Moolenaar910f66f2006-04-05 20:41:53 +00001848 When a |vimrc| or |gvimrc| file is found while Vim is starting up,
Bram Moolenaard042c562005-06-30 22:04:15 +00001849 this option is switched off, and all options that have not been
1850 modified will be set to the Vim defaults. Effectively, this means
Bram Moolenaar910f66f2006-04-05 20:41:53 +00001851 that when a |vimrc| or |gvimrc| file exists, Vim will use the Vim
Bram Moolenaard042c562005-06-30 22:04:15 +00001852 defaults, otherwise it will use the Vi defaults. (Note: This doesn't
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00001853 happen for the system-wide vimrc or gvimrc file, nor for a file given
1854 with the |-u| argument). Also see |compatible-default| and
1855 |posix-compliance|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001856 You can also set this option with the "-C" argument, and reset it with
1857 "-N". See |-C| and |-N|.
Bram Moolenaar214641f2017-03-05 17:04:09 +01001858 See 'cpoptions' for more fine tuning of Vi compatibility.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001859
Bram Moolenaar214641f2017-03-05 17:04:09 +01001860 When this option is set, numerous other options are set to make Vim as
1861 Vi-compatible as possible. When this option is unset, various options
1862 are set to make Vim more useful. The table below lists all the
1863 options affected.
1864 The {?} column indicates when the options are affected:
1865 + Means that the option is set to the value given in {set value} when
1866 'compatible' is set.
1867 & Means that the option is set to the value given in {set value} when
1868 'compatible' is set AND is set to its Vim default value when
1869 'compatible' is unset.
1870 - Means the option is NOT changed when setting 'compatible' but IS
1871 set to its Vim default when 'compatible' is unset.
1872 The {effect} column summarises the change when 'compatible' is set.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001873
Bram Moolenaar036986f2017-03-16 17:41:02 +01001874 option ? set value effect ~
Bram Moolenaar214641f2017-03-05 17:04:09 +01001875
1876 'allowrevins' + off no CTRL-_ command
1877 'antialias' + off don't use antialiased fonts
1878 'arabic' + off reset arabic-related options
1879 'arabicshape' + on correct character shapes
1880 'backspace' + "" normal backspace
1881 'backup' + off no backup file
1882 'backupcopy' & Unix: "yes" backup file is a copy
1883 else: "auto" copy or rename backup file
1884 'balloonexpr' + "" text to show in evaluation balloon
1885 'breakindent' + off don't indent when wrapping lines
1886 'cedit' - {unchanged} {set vim default only on resetting 'cp'}
Bram Moolenaar7b1463b2021-12-11 17:24:39 +00001887 'cdhome' + off ":cd" don't chdir to home on non-Unix
Bram Moolenaar214641f2017-03-05 17:04:09 +01001888 'cindent' + off no C code indentation
1889 'compatible' - {unchanged} {set vim default only on resetting 'cp'}
1890 'copyindent' + off don't copy indent structure
1891 'cpoptions' & (all flags) Vi-compatible flags
1892 'cscopepathcomp'+ 0 don't show directories in tags list
Bram Moolenaar22f1d0e2018-02-27 14:53:30 +01001893 'cscoperelative'+ off don't use basename of path as prefix
Bram Moolenaar214641f2017-03-05 17:04:09 +01001894 'cscopetag' + off don't use cscope for ":tag"
Bram Moolenaar036986f2017-03-16 17:41:02 +01001895 'cscopetagorder'+ 0 see |cscopetagorder|
Bram Moolenaar214641f2017-03-05 17:04:09 +01001896 'cscopeverbose' + off see |cscopeverbose|
1897 'delcombine' + off unicode: delete whole char combination
1898 'digraph' + off no digraphs
1899 'esckeys' & off no <Esc>-keys in Insert mode
1900 'expandtab' + off tabs not expanded to spaces
1901 'fileformats' & "" no automatic file format detection,
Bram Moolenaar6f345a12019-12-17 21:27:18 +01001902 "dos,unix" except for MS-Windows
Bram Moolenaar214641f2017-03-05 17:04:09 +01001903 'formatexpr' + "" use 'formatprg' for auto-formatting
1904 'formatoptions' & "vt" Vi compatible formatting
1905 'gdefault' + off no default 'g' flag for ":s"
1906 'history' & 0 no commandline history
1907 'hkmap' + off no Hebrew keyboard mapping
1908 'hkmapp' + off no phonetic Hebrew keyboard mapping
1909 'hlsearch' + off no highlighting of search matches
1910 'incsearch' + off no incremental searching
1911 'indentexpr' + "" no indenting by expression
1912 'insertmode' + off do not start in Insert mode
1913 'iskeyword' & "@,48-57,_" keywords contain alphanumeric
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001914 characters and '_'
Bram Moolenaar214641f2017-03-05 17:04:09 +01001915 'joinspaces' + on insert 2 spaces after period
1916 'modeline' & off no modelines
1917 'more' & off no pauses in listings
1918 'mzquantum' - {unchanged} {set vim default only on resetting 'cp'}
1919 'numberwidth' & 8 min number of columns for line number
1920 'preserveindent'+ off don't preserve current indent structure
1921 when changing it
1922 'revins' + off no reverse insert
1923 'ruler' + off no ruler
1924 'scrolljump' + 1 no jump scroll
1925 'scrolloff' + 0 no scroll offset
1926 'shelltemp' - {unchanged} {set vim default only on resetting 'cp'}
1927 'shiftround' + off indent not rounded to shiftwidth
Bram Moolenaar9dfa3132019-05-04 21:08:40 +02001928 'shortmess' & "S" no shortening of messages
Bram Moolenaar214641f2017-03-05 17:04:09 +01001929 'showcmd' & off command characters not shown
1930 'showmode' & off current mode not shown
1931 'sidescrolloff' + 0 cursor moves to edge of screen in scroll
1932 'smartcase' + off no automatic ignore case switch
1933 'smartindent' + off no smart indentation
1934 'smarttab' + off no smart tab size
1935 'softtabstop' + 0 tabs are always 'tabstop' positions
1936 'startofline' + on goto startofline with some commands
1937 'tagcase' & "followic" 'ignorecase' when searching tags file
1938 'tagrelative' & off tag file names are not relative
1939 'termguicolors' + off don't use highlight-(guifg|guibg)
1940 'textauto' & off no automatic textmode detection
1941 'textwidth' + 0 no automatic line wrap
1942 'tildeop' + off tilde is not an operator
1943 'ttimeout' + off no terminal timeout
1944 'undofile' + off don't use an undo file
Bram Moolenaar036986f2017-03-16 17:41:02 +01001945 'viminfo' - {unchanged} {set Vim default only on resetting 'cp'}
Bram Moolenaar214641f2017-03-05 17:04:09 +01001946 'virtualedit' + "" cursor can only be placed on characters
1947 'whichwrap' & "" left-right movements don't wrap
1948 'wildchar' & CTRL-E only when the current value is <Tab>
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001949 use CTRL-E for cmdline completion
Bram Moolenaar214641f2017-03-05 17:04:09 +01001950 'writebackup' + on or off depends on the |+writebackup| feature
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001951
1952 *'complete'* *'cpt'* *E535*
1953'complete' 'cpt' string (default: ".,w,b,u,t,i")
1954 local to buffer
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001955 This option specifies how keyword completion |ins-completion| works
1956 when CTRL-P or CTRL-N are used. It is also used for whole-line
1957 completion |i_CTRL-X_CTRL-L|. It indicates the type of completion
Bram Moolenaarcbaff5e2022-04-08 17:45:08 +01001958 and the places to scan. It is a comma-separated list of flags:
Bram Moolenaar3848e002016-03-19 18:42:29 +01001959 . scan the current buffer ('wrapscan' is ignored)
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001960 w scan buffers from other windows
1961 b scan other loaded buffers that are in the buffer list
1962 u scan the unloaded buffers that are in the buffer list
1963 U scan the buffers that are not in the buffer list
1964 k scan the files given with the 'dictionary' option
Bram Moolenaar0b238792006-03-02 22:49:12 +00001965 kspell use the currently active spell checking |spell|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001966 k{dict} scan the file {dict}. Several "k" flags can be given,
1967 patterns are valid too. For example: >
1968 :set cpt=k/usr/dict/*,k~/spanish
1969< s scan the files given with the 'thesaurus' option
1970 s{tsr} scan the file {tsr}. Several "s" flags can be given, patterns
1971 are valid too.
1972 i scan current and included files
1973 d scan current and included files for defined name or macro
1974 |i_CTRL-X_CTRL-D|
1975 ] tag completion
1976 t same as "]"
1977
1978 Unloaded buffers are not loaded, thus their autocmds |:autocmd| are
1979 not executed, this may lead to unexpected completions from some files
1980 (gzipped files for example). Unloaded buffers are not scanned for
1981 whole-line completion.
1982
1983 The default is ".,w,b,u,t,i", which means to scan:
1984 1. the current buffer
1985 2. buffers in other windows
1986 3. other loaded buffers
1987 4. unloaded buffers
1988 5. tags
1989 6. included files
1990
1991 As you can see, CTRL-N and CTRL-P can be used to do any 'iskeyword'-
Bram Moolenaar582fd852005-03-28 20:58:01 +00001992 based expansion (e.g., dictionary |i_CTRL-X_CTRL-K|, included patterns
1993 |i_CTRL-X_CTRL-I|, tags |i_CTRL-X_CTRL-]| and normal expansions).
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001994
Bram Moolenaarcfbc5ee2004-07-02 15:38:35 +00001995 *'completefunc'* *'cfu'*
1996'completefunc' 'cfu' string (default: empty)
1997 local to buffer
Bram Moolenaardb84e452010-08-15 13:50:43 +02001998 {not available when compiled without the |+eval|
Bram Moolenaare2c453d2019-08-21 14:37:09 +02001999 feature}
Bram Moolenaarc7486e02005-12-29 22:48:26 +00002000 This option specifies a function to be used for Insert mode completion
2001 with CTRL-X CTRL-U. |i_CTRL-X_CTRL-U|
Bram Moolenaar280f1262006-01-30 00:14:18 +00002002 See |complete-functions| for an explanation of how the function is
Yegappan Lakshmanan8658c752021-12-03 11:09:29 +00002003 invoked and what it should return. The value can be the name of a
2004 function, a |lambda| or a |Funcref|. See |option-value-function| for
2005 more information.
Bram Moolenaar166af9b2010-11-16 20:34:40 +01002006 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
2007 security reasons.
Bram Moolenaar325b7a22004-07-05 15:58:32 +00002008
Bram Moolenaarac3150d2019-07-28 16:36:39 +02002009 *'completeslash'* *'csl'*
2010'completeslash' 'csl' string (default: "")
2011 local to buffer
Bram Moolenaar2e693a82019-10-16 22:35:02 +02002012 {only for MS-Windows}
Bram Moolenaarac3150d2019-07-28 16:36:39 +02002013 When this option is set it overrules 'shellslash' for completion:
2014 - When this option is set to "slash", a forward slash is used for path
2015 completion in insert mode. This is useful when editing HTML tag, or
Bram Moolenaar6f345a12019-12-17 21:27:18 +01002016 Makefile with 'noshellslash' on MS-Windows.
Bram Moolenaarac3150d2019-07-28 16:36:39 +02002017 - When this option is set to "backslash", backslash is used. This is
Bram Moolenaar6f345a12019-12-17 21:27:18 +01002018 useful when editing a batch file with 'shellslash' set on MS-Windows.
Bram Moolenaarac3150d2019-07-28 16:36:39 +02002019 - When this option is empty, same character is used as for
2020 'shellslash'.
2021 For Insert mode completion the buffer-local value is used. For
2022 command line completion the global value is used.
2023
Bram Moolenaar1c7715d2005-10-03 22:02:18 +00002024 *'completeopt'* *'cot'*
Bram Moolenaar96d2c5b2006-03-11 21:27:59 +00002025'completeopt' 'cot' string (default: "menu,preview")
Bram Moolenaar1c7715d2005-10-03 22:02:18 +00002026 global
Bram Moolenaarcbaff5e2022-04-08 17:45:08 +01002027 A comma-separated list of options for Insert mode completion
Bram Moolenaarc7453f52006-02-10 23:20:28 +00002028 |ins-completion|. The supported values are:
Bram Moolenaar1c7715d2005-10-03 22:02:18 +00002029
2030 menu Use a popup menu to show the possible completions. The
2031 menu is only shown when there is more than one match and
2032 sufficient colors are available. |ins-completion-menu|
2033
Bram Moolenaar65c923a2006-03-03 22:56:30 +00002034 menuone Use the popup menu also when there is only one match.
Bram Moolenaarc9b4b052006-04-30 18:54:39 +00002035 Useful when there is additional information about the
Bram Moolenaar65c923a2006-03-03 22:56:30 +00002036 match, e.g., what file it comes from.
2037
Bram Moolenaarc1e37902006-04-18 21:55:01 +00002038 longest Only insert the longest common text of the matches. If
2039 the menu is displayed you can use CTRL-L to add more
2040 characters. Whether case is ignored depends on the kind
2041 of completion. For buffer text the 'ignorecase' option is
2042 used.
Bram Moolenaarc7453f52006-02-10 23:20:28 +00002043
Bram Moolenaar96d2c5b2006-03-11 21:27:59 +00002044 preview Show extra information about the currently selected
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00002045 completion in the preview window. Only works in
2046 combination with "menu" or "menuone".
2047
Bram Moolenaar576a4a62019-08-18 15:25:17 +02002048 popup Show extra information about the currently selected
2049 completion in a popup window. Only works in combination
2050 with "menu" or "menuone". Overrides "preview".
Bram Moolenaar62a0cb42019-08-18 16:35:23 +02002051 See |'completepopup'| for specifying properties.
Bram Moolenaar2e693a82019-10-16 22:35:02 +02002052 {only works when compiled with the |+textprop| feature}
Bram Moolenaar576a4a62019-08-18 15:25:17 +02002053
Bram Moolenaardca7abe2019-10-20 18:17:57 +02002054 popuphidden
Bram Moolenaar0c0734d2019-11-26 21:44:46 +01002055 Just like "popup" but initially hide the popup. Use a
Bram Moolenaardca7abe2019-10-20 18:17:57 +02002056 |CompleteChanged| autocommand to fetch the info and call
2057 |popup_show()| once the popup has been filled.
2058 See the example at |complete-popuphidden|.
2059 {only works when compiled with the |+textprop| feature}
2060
Bram Moolenaarb6be1e22015-07-10 18:18:40 +02002061 noinsert Do not insert any text for a match until the user selects
2062 a match from the menu. Only works in combination with
2063 "menu" or "menuone". No effect if "longest" is present.
2064
2065 noselect Do not select a match in the menu, force the user to
2066 select one from the menu. Only works in combination with
2067 "menu" or "menuone".
2068
Bram Moolenaar96d2c5b2006-03-11 21:27:59 +00002069
Bram Moolenaar62a0cb42019-08-18 16:35:23 +02002070 *'completepopup'* *'cpp'*
2071'completepopup' 'cpp' string (default empty)
2072 global
2073 {not available when compiled without the |+textprop|
2074 or |+quickfix| feature}
2075 When 'completeopt' contains "popup" then this option is used for the
Bram Moolenaar447bfba2020-07-18 16:07:16 +02002076 properties of the info popup when it is created. If an info popup
2077 window already exists it is closed, so that the option value is
2078 applied when it is created again.
2079 You can also use |popup_findinfo()| and then set properties for an
2080 existing info popup with |popup_setoptions()|. See |complete-popup|.
Bram Moolenaar62a0cb42019-08-18 16:35:23 +02002081
2082
Bram Moolenaarf5963f72010-07-23 22:10:27 +02002083 *'concealcursor'* *'cocu'*
2084'concealcursor' 'cocu' string (default: "")
2085 local to window
Bram Moolenaarf5963f72010-07-23 22:10:27 +02002086 {not available when compiled without the |+conceal|
2087 feature}
2088 Sets the modes in which text in the cursor line can also be concealed.
2089 When the current mode is listed then concealing happens just like in
2090 other lines.
2091 n Normal mode
2092 v Visual mode
2093 i Insert mode
Bram Moolenaarca8c9862010-07-24 15:00:38 +02002094 c Command line editing, for 'incsearch'
Bram Moolenaarf5963f72010-07-23 22:10:27 +02002095
Bram Moolenaare6dc5732010-07-24 23:52:26 +02002096 'v' applies to all lines in the Visual area, not only the cursor.
Bram Moolenaarca8c9862010-07-24 15:00:38 +02002097 A useful value is "nc". This is used in help files. So long as you
Bram Moolenaarf5963f72010-07-23 22:10:27 +02002098 are moving around text is concealed, but when starting to insert text
2099 or selecting a Visual area the concealed text is displayed, so that
2100 you can see what you are doing.
Bram Moolenaarf70e3d62010-07-24 13:15:07 +02002101 Keep in mind that the cursor position is not always where it's
2102 displayed. E.g., when moving vertically it may change column.
Bram Moolenaarf5963f72010-07-23 22:10:27 +02002103
2104
Bram Moolenaar95bafa22018-10-02 13:26:25 +02002105 *'conceallevel'* *'cole'*
2106'conceallevel' 'cole' number (default 0)
Bram Moolenaar860cae12010-06-05 23:22:07 +02002107 local to window
Bram Moolenaar860cae12010-06-05 23:22:07 +02002108 {not available when compiled without the |+conceal|
2109 feature}
Bram Moolenaar6df6f472010-07-18 18:04:50 +02002110 Determine how text with the "conceal" syntax attribute |:syn-conceal|
2111 is shown:
Bram Moolenaar860cae12010-06-05 23:22:07 +02002112
Bram Moolenaar6df6f472010-07-18 18:04:50 +02002113 Value Effect ~
Bram Moolenaar860cae12010-06-05 23:22:07 +02002114 0 Text is shown normally
Bram Moolenaar477db062010-07-28 18:17:41 +02002115 1 Each block of concealed text is replaced with one
2116 character. If the syntax item does not have a custom
2117 replacement character defined (see |:syn-cchar|) the
2118 character defined in 'listchars' is used (default is a
2119 space).
2120 It is highlighted with the "Conceal" highlight group.
Bram Moolenaar860cae12010-06-05 23:22:07 +02002121 2 Concealed text is completely hidden unless it has a
2122 custom replacement character defined (see
Bram Moolenaar477db062010-07-28 18:17:41 +02002123 |:syn-cchar|).
Bram Moolenaara7781e02010-07-19 20:13:22 +02002124 3 Concealed text is completely hidden.
Bram Moolenaar860cae12010-06-05 23:22:07 +02002125
Bram Moolenaara7781e02010-07-19 20:13:22 +02002126 Note: in the cursor line concealed text is not hidden, so that you can
Bram Moolenaarf5963f72010-07-23 22:10:27 +02002127 edit and copy the text. This can be changed with the 'concealcursor'
2128 option.
Bram Moolenaar860cae12010-06-05 23:22:07 +02002129
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002130 *'confirm'* *'cf'* *'noconfirm'* *'nocf'*
2131'confirm' 'cf' boolean (default off)
2132 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002133 When 'confirm' is on, certain operations that would normally
2134 fail because of unsaved changes to a buffer, e.g. ":q" and ":e",
2135 instead raise a |dialog| asking if you wish to save the current
2136 file(s). You can still use a ! to unconditionally |abandon| a buffer.
2137 If 'confirm' is off you can still activate confirmation for one
2138 command only (this is most useful in mappings) with the |:confirm|
2139 command.
2140 Also see the |confirm()| function and the 'v' flag in 'guioptions'.
2141
2142 *'conskey'* *'consk'* *'noconskey'* *'noconsk'*
2143'conskey' 'consk' boolean (default off)
2144 global
Bram Moolenaarf3913272016-02-25 00:00:01 +01002145 This was for MS-DOS and is no longer supported.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002146
2147 *'copyindent'* *'ci'* *'nocopyindent'* *'noci'*
2148'copyindent' 'ci' boolean (default off)
2149 local to buffer
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002150 Copy the structure of the existing lines indent when autoindenting a
2151 new line. Normally the new indent is reconstructed by a series of
2152 tabs followed by spaces as required (unless |'expandtab'| is enabled,
2153 in which case only spaces are used). Enabling this option makes the
2154 new line copy whatever characters were used for indenting on the
Bram Moolenaar446cb832008-06-24 21:56:24 +00002155 existing line. 'expandtab' has no effect on these characters, a Tab
2156 remains a Tab. If the new indent is greater than on the existing
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002157 line, the remaining space is filled in the normal manner.
Bram Moolenaar036986f2017-03-16 17:41:02 +01002158 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002159 Also see 'preserveindent'.
2160
Bram Moolenaare0fa3742016-02-20 15:47:01 +01002161 *'cpoptions'* *'cpo'* *cpo*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002162'cpoptions' 'cpo' string (Vim default: "aABceFs",
2163 Vi default: all flags)
2164 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002165 A sequence of single character flags. When a character is present
Bram Moolenaar7cba6c02013-09-05 22:13:31 +02002166 this indicates Vi-compatible behavior. This is used for things where
2167 not being Vi-compatible is mostly or sometimes preferred.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002168 'cpoptions' stands for "compatible-options".
2169 Commas can be added for readability.
2170 To avoid problems with flags that are added in the future, use the
2171 "+=" and "-=" feature of ":set" |add-option-flags|.
Bram Moolenaar71eb3ad2021-12-26 12:07:30 +00002172
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002173 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
2174 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
Bram Moolenaar71eb3ad2021-12-26 12:07:30 +00002175
2176 NOTE: In a |Vim9| script, when `vim9script` is encountered, the value
2177 is saved, 'cpoptions' is set to the Vim default, and the saved value
2178 is restored at the end of the script. Changes to the value of
2179 'cpoptions' will be applied to the saved value, but keep in mind that
2180 removing a flag that is not present when 'cpoptions' is changed has no
2181 effect. In the |.vimrc| file the value is not restored, thus using
2182 `vim9script` in the |.vimrc| file results in using the Vim default.
2183
Bram Moolenaar4399ef42005-02-12 14:29:27 +00002184 NOTE: This option is set to the POSIX default value at startup when
2185 the Vi default value would be used and the $VIM_POSIX environment
Bram Moolenaar8f3f58f2010-01-06 20:52:26 +01002186 variable exists |posix|. This means Vim tries to behave like the
2187 POSIX specification.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002188
2189 contains behavior ~
2190 *cpo-a*
2191 a When included, a ":read" command with a file name
2192 argument will set the alternate file name for the
2193 current window.
2194 *cpo-A*
2195 A When included, a ":write" command with a file name
2196 argument will set the alternate file name for the
2197 current window.
2198 *cpo-b*
2199 b "\|" in a ":map" command is recognized as the end of
2200 the map command. The '\' is included in the mapping,
2201 the text after the '|' is interpreted as the next
2202 command. Use a CTRL-V instead of a backslash to
2203 include the '|' in the mapping. Applies to all
2204 mapping, abbreviation, menu and autocmd commands.
2205 See also |map_bar|.
2206 *cpo-B*
2207 B A backslash has no special meaning in mappings,
Bram Moolenaara9604e62018-07-21 05:56:22 +02002208 abbreviations, user commands and the "to" part of the
2209 menu commands. Remove this flag to be able to use a
2210 backslash like a CTRL-V. For example, the command
2211 ":map X \<Esc>" results in X being mapped to:
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002212 'B' included: "\^[" (^[ is a real <Esc>)
2213 'B' excluded: "<Esc>" (5 characters)
2214 ('<' excluded in both cases)
2215 *cpo-c*
2216 c Searching continues at the end of any match at the
2217 cursor position, but not further than the start of the
2218 next line. When not present searching continues
2219 one character from the cursor position. With 'c'
2220 "abababababab" only gets three matches when repeating
2221 "/abab", without 'c' there are five matches.
2222 *cpo-C*
2223 C Do not concatenate sourced lines that start with a
2224 backslash. See |line-continuation|.
2225 *cpo-d*
2226 d Using "./" in the 'tags' option doesn't mean to use
2227 the tags file relative to the current file, but the
2228 tags file in the current directory.
2229 *cpo-D*
2230 D Can't use CTRL-K to enter a digraph after Normal mode
2231 commands with a character argument, like |r|, |f| and
2232 |t|.
2233 *cpo-e*
2234 e When executing a register with ":@r", always add a
2235 <CR> to the last line, also when the register is not
2236 linewise. If this flag is not present, the register
2237 is not linewise and the last line does not end in a
2238 <CR>, then the last line is put on the command-line
2239 and can be edited before hitting <CR>.
2240 *cpo-E*
2241 E It is an error when using "y", "d", "c", "g~", "gu" or
2242 "gU" on an Empty region. The operators only work when
Bram Moolenaar15142e22018-04-30 22:19:58 +02002243 at least one character is to be operated on. Example:
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002244 This makes "y0" fail in the first column.
2245 *cpo-f*
2246 f When included, a ":read" command with a file name
2247 argument will set the file name for the current buffer,
2248 if the current buffer doesn't have a file name yet.
2249 *cpo-F*
2250 F When included, a ":write" command with a file name
2251 argument will set the file name for the current
2252 buffer, if the current buffer doesn't have a file name
Bram Moolenaarb3480382005-12-11 21:33:32 +00002253 yet. Also see |cpo-P|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002254 *cpo-g*
2255 g Goto line 1 when using ":edit" without argument.
Bram Moolenaar4399ef42005-02-12 14:29:27 +00002256 *cpo-H*
2257 H When using "I" on a line with only blanks, insert
2258 before the last blank. Without this flag insert after
2259 the last blank.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002260 *cpo-i*
2261 i When included, interrupting the reading of a file will
2262 leave it modified.
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00002263 *cpo-I*
2264 I When moving the cursor up or down just after inserting
2265 indent for 'autoindent', do not delete the indent.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002266 *cpo-j*
2267 j When joining lines, only add two spaces after a '.',
2268 not after '!' or '?'. Also see 'joinspaces'.
2269 *cpo-J*
2270 J A |sentence| has to be followed by two spaces after
Bram Moolenaar582fd852005-03-28 20:58:01 +00002271 the '.', '!' or '?'. A <Tab> is not recognized as
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002272 white space.
2273 *cpo-k*
2274 k Disable the recognition of raw key codes in
2275 mappings, abbreviations, and the "to" part of menu
2276 commands. For example, if <Key> sends ^[OA (where ^[
2277 is <Esc>), the command ":map X ^[OA" results in X
2278 being mapped to:
2279 'k' included: "^[OA" (3 characters)
2280 'k' excluded: "<Key>" (one key code)
2281 Also see the '<' flag below.
2282 *cpo-K*
2283 K Don't wait for a key code to complete when it is
2284 halfway a mapping. This breaks mapping <F1><F1> when
2285 only part of the second <F1> has been read. It
2286 enables cancelling the mapping by typing <F1><Esc>.
2287 *cpo-l*
2288 l Backslash in a [] range in a search pattern is taken
Bram Moolenaar26a60b42005-02-22 08:49:11 +00002289 literally, only "\]", "\^", "\-" and "\\" are special.
2290 See |/[]|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002291 'l' included: "/[ \t]" finds <Space>, '\' and 't'
2292 'l' excluded: "/[ \t]" finds <Space> and <Tab>
Bram Moolenaar26a60b42005-02-22 08:49:11 +00002293 Also see |cpo-\|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002294 *cpo-L*
2295 L When the 'list' option is set, 'wrapmargin',
2296 'textwidth', 'softtabstop' and Virtual Replace mode
2297 (see |gR|) count a <Tab> as two characters, instead of
2298 the normal behavior of a <Tab>.
2299 *cpo-m*
2300 m When included, a showmatch will always wait half a
2301 second. When not included, a showmatch will wait half
2302 a second or until a character is typed. |'showmatch'|
2303 *cpo-M*
2304 M When excluded, "%" matching will take backslashes into
2305 account. Thus in "( \( )" and "\( ( \)" the outer
2306 parenthesis match. When included "%" ignores
2307 backslashes, which is Vi compatible.
2308 *cpo-n*
Bram Moolenaar64486672010-05-16 15:46:46 +02002309 n When included, the column used for 'number' and
2310 'relativenumber' will also be used for text of wrapped
2311 lines.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002312 *cpo-o*
2313 o Line offset to search command is not remembered for
2314 next search.
2315 *cpo-O*
2316 O Don't complain if a file is being overwritten, even
2317 when it didn't exist when editing it. This is a
2318 protection against a file unexpectedly created by
2319 someone else. Vi didn't complain about this.
2320 *cpo-p*
2321 p Vi compatible Lisp indenting. When not present, a
2322 slightly better algorithm is used.
Bram Moolenaarb3480382005-12-11 21:33:32 +00002323 *cpo-P*
2324 P When included, a ":write" command that appends to a
2325 file will set the file name for the current buffer, if
2326 the current buffer doesn't have a file name yet and
2327 the 'F' flag is also included |cpo-F|.
Bram Moolenaar4399ef42005-02-12 14:29:27 +00002328 *cpo-q*
2329 q When joining multiple lines leave the cursor at the
2330 position where it would be when joining two lines.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002331 *cpo-r*
2332 r Redo ("." command) uses "/" to repeat a search
2333 command, instead of the actually used search string.
2334 *cpo-R*
2335 R Remove marks from filtered lines. Without this flag
2336 marks are kept like |:keepmarks| was used.
2337 *cpo-s*
2338 s Set buffer options when entering the buffer for the
2339 first time. This is like it is in Vim version 3.0.
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00002340 And it is the default. If not present the options are
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002341 set when the buffer is created.
2342 *cpo-S*
2343 S Set buffer options always when entering a buffer
2344 (except 'readonly', 'fileformat', 'filetype' and
2345 'syntax'). This is the (most) Vi compatible setting.
2346 The options are set to the values in the current
2347 buffer. When you change an option and go to another
2348 buffer, the value is copied. Effectively makes the
2349 buffer options global to all buffers.
2350
2351 's' 'S' copy buffer options
2352 no no when buffer created
2353 yes no when buffer first entered (default)
2354 X yes each time when buffer entered (vi comp.)
2355 *cpo-t*
2356 t Search pattern for the tag command is remembered for
2357 "n" command. Otherwise Vim only puts the pattern in
2358 the history for search pattern, but doesn't change the
2359 last used search pattern.
2360 *cpo-u*
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00002361 u Undo is Vi compatible. See |undo-two-ways|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002362 *cpo-v*
2363 v Backspaced characters remain visible on the screen in
2364 Insert mode. Without this flag the characters are
2365 erased from the screen right away. With this flag the
2366 screen newly typed text overwrites backspaced
2367 characters.
2368 *cpo-w*
2369 w When using "cw" on a blank character, only change one
2370 character and not all blanks until the start of the
2371 next word.
2372 *cpo-W*
2373 W Don't overwrite a readonly file. When omitted, ":w!"
2374 overwrites a readonly file, if possible.
2375 *cpo-x*
2376 x <Esc> on the command-line executes the command-line.
2377 The default in Vim is to abandon the command-line,
2378 because <Esc> normally aborts a command. |c_<Esc>|
Bram Moolenaar4399ef42005-02-12 14:29:27 +00002379 *cpo-X*
2380 X When using a count with "R" the replaced text is
2381 deleted only once. Also when repeating "R" with "."
2382 and a count.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002383 *cpo-y*
Bram Moolenaard09091d2019-01-17 16:07:22 +01002384 y A yank command can be redone with ".". Think twice if
2385 you really want to use this, it may break some
2386 plugins, since most people expect "." to only repeat a
2387 change.
Bram Moolenaar4399ef42005-02-12 14:29:27 +00002388 *cpo-Z*
2389 Z When using "w!" while the 'readonly' option is set,
2390 don't reset 'readonly'.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002391 *cpo-!*
2392 ! When redoing a filter command, use the last used
2393 external command, whatever it was. Otherwise the last
2394 used -filter- command is used.
2395 *cpo-$*
2396 $ When making a change to one line, don't redisplay the
2397 line, but put a '$' at the end of the changed text.
2398 The changed text will be overwritten when you type the
2399 new text. The line is redisplayed if you type any
2400 command that moves the cursor from the insertion
2401 point.
2402 *cpo-%*
2403 % Vi-compatible matching is done for the "%" command.
2404 Does not recognize "#if", "#endif", etc.
2405 Does not recognize "/*" and "*/".
2406 Parens inside single and double quotes are also
2407 counted, causing a string that contains a paren to
2408 disturb the matching. For example, in a line like
2409 "if (strcmp("foo(", s))" the first paren does not
2410 match the last one. When this flag is not included,
2411 parens inside single and double quotes are treated
2412 specially. When matching a paren outside of quotes,
2413 everything inside quotes is ignored. When matching a
2414 paren inside quotes, it will find the matching one (if
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00002415 there is one). This works very well for C programs.
Bram Moolenaar293ee4d2004-12-09 21:34:53 +00002416 This flag is also used for other features, such as
2417 C-indenting.
Bram Moolenaar7c626922005-02-07 22:01:03 +00002418 *cpo--*
2419 - When included, a vertical movement command fails when
Bram Moolenaar8ada17c2006-01-19 22:16:24 +00002420 it would go above the first line or below the last
2421 line. Without it the cursor moves to the first or
2422 last line, unless it already was in that line.
Bram Moolenaar7c626922005-02-07 22:01:03 +00002423 Applies to the commands "-", "k", CTRL-P, "+", "j",
Bram Moolenaar8ada17c2006-01-19 22:16:24 +00002424 CTRL-N, CTRL-J and ":1234".
Bram Moolenaar1cd871b2004-12-19 22:46:22 +00002425 *cpo-+*
2426 + When included, a ":write file" command will reset the
2427 'modified' flag of the buffer, even though the buffer
2428 itself may still be different from its file.
Bram Moolenaarc9b4b052006-04-30 18:54:39 +00002429 *cpo-star*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002430 * Use ":*" in the same way as ":@". When not included,
2431 ":*" is an alias for ":'<,'>", select the Visual area.
2432 *cpo-<*
2433 < Disable the recognition of special key codes in |<>|
2434 form in mappings, abbreviations, and the "to" part of
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00002435 menu commands. For example, the command
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002436 ":map X <Tab>" results in X being mapped to:
2437 '<' included: "<Tab>" (5 characters)
2438 '<' excluded: "^I" (^I is a real <Tab>)
2439 Also see the 'k' flag above.
Bram Moolenaar4399ef42005-02-12 14:29:27 +00002440 *cpo->*
2441 > When appending to a register, put a line break before
2442 the appended text.
Bram Moolenaar8b3e0332011-06-26 05:36:34 +02002443 *cpo-;*
2444 ; When using |,| or |;| to repeat the last |t| search
2445 and the cursor is right in front of the searched
2446 character, the cursor won't move. When not included,
2447 the cursor would skip over it and jump to the
Bram Moolenaarc8734422012-06-01 22:38:45 +02002448 following occurrence.
Bram Moolenaar4399ef42005-02-12 14:29:27 +00002449
2450 POSIX flags. These are not included in the Vi default value, except
2451 when $VIM_POSIX was set on startup. |posix|
2452
2453 contains behavior ~
Bram Moolenaarc9b4b052006-04-30 18:54:39 +00002454 *cpo-#*
Bram Moolenaar4399ef42005-02-12 14:29:27 +00002455 # A count before "D", "o" and "O" has no effect.
Bram Moolenaar4399ef42005-02-12 14:29:27 +00002456 *cpo-&*
2457 & When ":preserve" was used keep the swap file when
2458 exiting normally while this buffer is still loaded.
2459 This flag is tested when exiting.
Bram Moolenaar26a60b42005-02-22 08:49:11 +00002460 *cpo-\*
2461 \ Backslash in a [] range in a search pattern is taken
2462 literally, only "\]" is special See |/[]|
Bram Moolenaar90915b52005-08-21 22:17:52 +00002463 '\' included: "/[ \-]" finds <Space>, '\' and '-'
2464 '\' excluded: "/[ \-]" finds <Space> and '-'
2465 Also see |cpo-l|.
Bram Moolenaar26a60b42005-02-22 08:49:11 +00002466 *cpo-/*
2467 / When "%" is used as the replacement string in a |:s|
2468 command, use the previous replacement string. |:s%|
2469 *cpo-{*
2470 { The |{| and |}| commands also stop at a "{" character
2471 at the start of a line.
2472 *cpo-.*
2473 . The ":chdir" and ":cd" commands fail if the current
2474 buffer is modified, unless ! is used. Vim doesn't
2475 need this, since it remembers the full path of an
2476 opened file.
2477 *cpo-bar*
2478 | The value of the $LINES and $COLUMNS environment
2479 variables overrule the terminal size values obtained
2480 with system specific functions.
Bram Moolenaar4399ef42005-02-12 14:29:27 +00002481
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002482
Bram Moolenaar40e6a712010-05-16 22:32:54 +02002483 *'cryptmethod'* *'cm'*
Bram Moolenaara86187b2018-12-16 18:20:00 +01002484'cryptmethod' 'cm' string (default "blowfish2")
Bram Moolenaar49771f42010-07-20 17:32:38 +02002485 global or local to buffer |global-local|
Bram Moolenaar40e6a712010-05-16 22:32:54 +02002486 Method used for encryption when the buffer is written to a file:
Bram Moolenaar0bbabe82010-05-17 20:32:55 +02002487 *pkzip*
Bram Moolenaar49771f42010-07-20 17:32:38 +02002488 zip PkZip compatible method. A weak kind of encryption.
Bram Moolenaarf50a2532010-05-21 15:36:08 +02002489 Backwards compatible with Vim 7.2 and older.
Bram Moolenaar0bbabe82010-05-17 20:32:55 +02002490 *blowfish*
Bram Moolenaar8f4ac012014-08-10 13:38:34 +02002491 blowfish Blowfish method. Medium strong encryption but it has
2492 an implementation flaw. Requires Vim 7.3 or later,
2493 files can NOT be read by Vim 7.2 and older. This adds
2494 a "seed" to the file, every time you write the file
2495 the encrypted bytes will be different.
2496 *blowfish2*
2497 blowfish2 Blowfish method. Medium strong encryption. Requires
Bram Moolenaar5e9b2fa2016-02-01 22:37:05 +01002498 Vim 7.4.401 or later, files can NOT be read by Vim 7.3
Bram Moolenaar8f4ac012014-08-10 13:38:34 +02002499 and older. This adds a "seed" to the file, every time
2500 you write the file the encrypted bytes will be
2501 different. The whole undo file is encrypted, not just
2502 the pieces of text.
Bram Moolenaara2baa732022-02-04 16:09:54 +00002503 *E1193* *E1194* *E1195* *E1196* *E1230*
Christian Brabandtf573c6e2021-06-20 14:02:16 +02002504 *E1197* *E1198* *E1199* *E1200* *E1201*
2505 xchacha20 XChaCha20 Cipher with Poly1305 Message Authentication
2506 Code. Medium strong till strong encryption.
2507 Encryption is provided by the libsodium library, it
Bram Moolenaar22863042021-10-16 15:23:36 +01002508 requires Vim to be built with |+sodium|.
Christian Brabandtf573c6e2021-06-20 14:02:16 +02002509 It adds a seed and a message authentication code (MAC)
2510 to the file. This needs at least a Vim 8.2.3022 to
2511 read the encrypted file.
2512 Encryption of swap files is not supported, therefore
2513 no swap file will be used when xchacha20 encryption is
2514 enabled.
2515 Encryption of undo files is not yet supported,
2516 therefore no undo file will currently be written.
2517 CURRENTLY EXPERIMENTAL: Files written with this method
2518 might have to be read back with the same version of
2519 Vim if the binary format changes later.
Bram Moolenaarf50a2532010-05-21 15:36:08 +02002520
Bram Moolenaar4f3f6682016-03-26 23:01:59 +01002521 You should use "blowfish2", also to re-encrypt older files.
2522
Bram Moolenaar40e6a712010-05-16 22:32:54 +02002523 When reading an encrypted file 'cryptmethod' will be set automatically
Bram Moolenaarf50a2532010-05-21 15:36:08 +02002524 to the detected method of the file being read. Thus if you write it
2525 without changing 'cryptmethod' the same method will be used.
2526 Changing 'cryptmethod' does not mark the file as modified, you have to
Bram Moolenaar49771f42010-07-20 17:32:38 +02002527 explicitly write it, you don't get a warning unless there are other
2528 modifications. Also see |:X|.
2529
2530 When setting the global value to an empty string, it will end up with
Bram Moolenaara86187b2018-12-16 18:20:00 +01002531 the value "blowfish2". When setting the local value to an empty
2532 string the buffer will use the global value.
Bram Moolenaar49771f42010-07-20 17:32:38 +02002533
Bram Moolenaarf50a2532010-05-21 15:36:08 +02002534 When a new encryption method is added in a later version of Vim, and
2535 the current version does not recognize it, you will get *E821* .
Bram Moolenaar49771f42010-07-20 17:32:38 +02002536 You need to edit this file with the later version of Vim.
Bram Moolenaar40e6a712010-05-16 22:32:54 +02002537
2538
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002539 *'cscopepathcomp'* *'cspc'*
2540'cscopepathcomp' 'cspc' number (default 0)
2541 global
2542 {not available when compiled without the |+cscope|
2543 feature}
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002544 Determines how many components of the path to show in a list of tags.
2545 See |cscopepathcomp|.
Bram Moolenaar036986f2017-03-16 17:41:02 +01002546 NOTE: This option is set to 0 when 'compatible' is set.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002547
2548 *'cscopeprg'* *'csprg'*
2549'cscopeprg' 'csprg' string (default "cscope")
2550 global
2551 {not available when compiled without the |+cscope|
2552 feature}
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002553 Specifies the command to execute cscope. See |cscopeprg|.
2554 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
2555 security reasons.
2556
2557 *'cscopequickfix'* *'csqf'*
2558'cscopequickfix' 'csqf' string (default "")
2559 global
2560 {not available when compiled without the |+cscope|
2561 or |+quickfix| features}
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002562 Specifies whether to use quickfix window to show cscope results.
2563 See |cscopequickfix|.
2564
Bram Moolenaarec7944a2013-06-12 21:29:15 +02002565 *'cscoperelative'* *'csre'* *'nocscoperelative'* *'nocsre'*
Bram Moolenaar2f982e42011-06-12 20:42:22 +02002566'cscoperelative' 'csre' boolean (default off)
2567 global
2568 {not available when compiled without the |+cscope|
2569 feature}
Bram Moolenaar2f982e42011-06-12 20:42:22 +02002570 In the absence of a prefix (-P) for cscope. setting this option enables
2571 to use the basename of cscope.out path as the prefix.
2572 See |cscoperelative|.
Bram Moolenaar036986f2017-03-16 17:41:02 +01002573 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
Bram Moolenaar2f982e42011-06-12 20:42:22 +02002574
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002575 *'cscopetag'* *'cst'* *'nocscopetag'* *'nocst'*
2576'cscopetag' 'cst' boolean (default off)
2577 global
2578 {not available when compiled without the |+cscope|
2579 feature}
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002580 Use cscope for tag commands. See |cscope-options|.
2581 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
2582
2583 *'cscopetagorder'* *'csto'*
2584'cscopetagorder' 'csto' number (default 0)
2585 global
2586 {not available when compiled without the |+cscope|
2587 feature}
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002588 Determines the order in which ":cstag" performs a search. See
2589 |cscopetagorder|.
2590 NOTE: This option is set to 0 when 'compatible' is set.
2591
2592 *'cscopeverbose'* *'csverb'*
2593 *'nocscopeverbose'* *'nocsverb'*
2594'cscopeverbose' 'csverb' boolean (default off)
2595 global
2596 {not available when compiled without the |+cscope|
2597 feature}
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002598 Give messages when adding a cscope database. See |cscopeverbose|.
2599 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
2600
Bram Moolenaar860cae12010-06-05 23:22:07 +02002601 *'cursorbind'* *'crb'* *'nocursorbind'* *'nocrb'*
2602'cursorbind' 'crb' boolean (default off)
2603 local to window
Bram Moolenaar860cae12010-06-05 23:22:07 +02002604 When this option is set, as the cursor in the current
2605 window moves other cursorbound windows (windows that also have
2606 this option set) move their cursors to the corresponding line and
2607 column. This option is useful for viewing the
2608 differences between two versions of a file (see 'diff'); in diff mode,
2609 inserted and deleted lines (though not characters within a line) are
Bram Moolenaar1a384422010-07-14 19:53:30 +02002610 taken into account.
Bram Moolenaar860cae12010-06-05 23:22:07 +02002611
Bram Moolenaar600dddc2006-03-12 22:05:10 +00002612
2613 *'cursorcolumn'* *'cuc'* *'nocursorcolumn'* *'nocuc'*
2614'cursorcolumn' 'cuc' boolean (default off)
2615 local to window
Bram Moolenaardb84e452010-08-15 13:50:43 +02002616 {not available when compiled without the |+syntax|
Bram Moolenaar600dddc2006-03-12 22:05:10 +00002617 feature}
2618 Highlight the screen column of the cursor with CursorColumn
2619 |hl-CursorColumn|. Useful to align text. Will make screen redrawing
2620 slower.
Bram Moolenaar4c3f5362006-04-11 21:38:50 +00002621 If you only want the highlighting in the current window you can use
2622 these autocommands: >
2623 au WinLeave * set nocursorline nocursorcolumn
2624 au WinEnter * set cursorline cursorcolumn
2625<
Bram Moolenaar600dddc2006-03-12 22:05:10 +00002626
2627 *'cursorline'* *'cul'* *'nocursorline'* *'nocul'*
2628'cursorline' 'cul' boolean (default off)
2629 local to window
Bram Moolenaardb84e452010-08-15 13:50:43 +02002630 {not available when compiled without the |+syntax|
Bram Moolenaar600dddc2006-03-12 22:05:10 +00002631 feature}
Bram Moolenaar410e98a2019-09-09 22:05:49 +02002632 Highlight the text line of the cursor with CursorLine |hl-CursorLine|.
2633 Useful to easily spot the cursor. Will make screen redrawing slower.
Bram Moolenaare2f98b92006-03-29 21:18:24 +00002634 When Visual mode is active the highlighting isn't used to make it
Bram Moolenaar779b74b2006-04-10 14:55:34 +00002635 easier to see the selected text.
Bram Moolenaar600dddc2006-03-12 22:05:10 +00002636
2637
Bram Moolenaar410e98a2019-09-09 22:05:49 +02002638 *'cursorlineopt'* *'culopt'*
Bram Moolenaar017ba072019-09-14 21:01:23 +02002639'cursorlineopt' 'culopt' string (default: "number,line")
Bram Moolenaar410e98a2019-09-09 22:05:49 +02002640 local to window
Bram Moolenaar410e98a2019-09-09 22:05:49 +02002641 {not available when compiled without the |+syntax|
2642 feature}
Bram Moolenaarcbaff5e2022-04-08 17:45:08 +01002643 Comma-separated list of settings for how 'cursorline' is displayed.
Bram Moolenaar017ba072019-09-14 21:01:23 +02002644 Valid values:
2645 "line" Highlight the text line of the cursor with
Bram Moolenaar410e98a2019-09-09 22:05:49 +02002646 CursorLine |hl-CursorLine|.
Bram Moolenaar017ba072019-09-14 21:01:23 +02002647 "screenline" Highlight only the screen line of the cursor with
2648 CursorLine |hl-CursorLine|.
2649 "number" Highlight the line number of the cursor with
Bram Moolenaar410e98a2019-09-09 22:05:49 +02002650 CursorLineNr |hl-CursorLineNr|.
Bram Moolenaar017ba072019-09-14 21:01:23 +02002651
2652 Special value:
2653 "both" Alias for the values "line,number".
2654
2655 "line" and "screenline" cannot be used together.
Bram Moolenaar410e98a2019-09-09 22:05:49 +02002656
2657
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002658 *'debug'*
2659'debug' string (default "")
2660 global
Bram Moolenaar57657d82006-04-21 22:12:41 +00002661 These values can be used:
2662 msg Error messages that would otherwise be omitted will be given
2663 anyway.
2664 throw Error messages that would otherwise be omitted will be given
2665 anyway and also throw an exception and set |v:errmsg|.
2666 beep A message will be given when otherwise only a beep would be
2667 produced.
Bram Moolenaar26a60b42005-02-22 08:49:11 +00002668 The values can be combined, separated by a comma.
Bram Moolenaar57657d82006-04-21 22:12:41 +00002669 "msg" and "throw" are useful for debugging 'foldexpr', 'formatexpr' or
2670 'indentexpr'.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002671
2672 *'define'* *'def'*
2673'define' 'def' string (default "^\s*#\s*define")
2674 global or local to buffer |global-local|
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00002675 Pattern to be used to find a macro definition. It is a search
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002676 pattern, just like for the "/" command. This option is used for the
2677 commands like "[i" and "[d" |include-search|. The 'isident' option is
2678 used to recognize the defined name after the match:
2679 {match with 'define'}{non-ID chars}{defined name}{non-ID char}
2680 See |option-backslash| about inserting backslashes to include a space
2681 or backslash.
2682 The default value is for C programs. For C++ this value would be
2683 useful, to include const type declarations: >
2684 ^\(#\s*define\|[a-z]*\s*const\s*[a-z]*\)
Bram Moolenaar63b74a82019-03-24 15:09:13 +01002685< You can also use "\ze" just before the name and continue the pattern
2686 to check what is following. E.g. for Javascript, if a function is
2687 defined with "func_name = function(args)": >
2688 ^\s*\ze\i\+\s*=\s*function(
2689< If the function is defined with "func_name : function() {...": >
2690 ^\s*\ze\i\+\s*[:]\s*(*function\s*(
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002691< When using the ":set" command, you need to double the backslashes!
Bram Moolenaar63b74a82019-03-24 15:09:13 +01002692 To avoid that use `:let` with a single quote string: >
2693 let &l:define = '^\s*\ze\k\+\s*=\s*function('
Bram Moolenaar911ead12019-04-21 00:03:35 +02002694<
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002695
2696 *'delcombine'* *'deco'* *'nodelcombine'* *'nodeco'*
2697'delcombine' 'deco' boolean (default off)
2698 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002699 If editing Unicode and this option is set, backspace and Normal mode
2700 "x" delete each combining character on its own. When it is off (the
2701 default) the character along with its combining characters are
2702 deleted.
Bram Moolenaar4f4d51a2020-10-11 13:57:40 +02002703 Note: When 'delcombine' is set "xx" may work differently from "2x"!
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002704
2705 This is useful for Arabic, Hebrew and many other languages where one
2706 may have combining characters overtop of base characters, and want
2707 to remove only the combining ones.
Bram Moolenaar036986f2017-03-16 17:41:02 +01002708 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002709
2710 *'dictionary'* *'dict'*
2711'dictionary' 'dict' string (default "")
2712 global or local to buffer |global-local|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002713 List of file names, separated by commas, that are used to lookup words
2714 for keyword completion commands |i_CTRL-X_CTRL-K|. Each file should
2715 contain a list of words. This can be one word per line, or several
2716 words per line, separated by non-keyword characters (white space is
2717 preferred). Maximum line length is 510 bytes.
Bram Moolenaar259f26a2018-05-15 22:25:40 +02002718
2719 When this option is empty or an entry "spell" is present, and spell
2720 checking is enabled, words in the word lists for the currently active
2721 'spelllang' are used. See |spell|.
2722
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00002723 To include a comma in a file name precede it with a backslash. Spaces
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002724 after a comma are ignored, otherwise spaces are included in the file
2725 name. See |option-backslash| about using backslashes.
Bram Moolenaard8b02732005-01-14 21:48:43 +00002726 This has nothing to do with the |Dictionary| variable type.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002727 Where to find a list of words?
2728 - On FreeBSD, there is the file "/usr/share/dict/words".
2729 - In the Simtel archive, look in the "msdos/linguist" directory.
2730 - In "miscfiles" of the GNU collection.
2731 The use of |:set+=| and |:set-=| is preferred when adding or removing
2732 directories from the list. This avoids problems when a future version
2733 uses another default.
2734 Backticks cannot be used in this option for security reasons.
2735
2736 *'diff'* *'nodiff'*
2737'diff' boolean (default off)
2738 local to window
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002739 {not available when compiled without the |+diff|
2740 feature}
2741 Join the current window in the group of windows that shows differences
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00002742 between files. See |vimdiff|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002743
2744 *'dex'* *'diffexpr'*
2745'diffexpr' 'dex' string (default "")
2746 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002747 {not available when compiled without the |+diff|
2748 feature}
Bram Moolenaare828b762018-09-10 17:51:58 +02002749 Expression which is evaluated to obtain a diff file (either ed-style
2750 or unified-style) from two versions of a file. See |diff-diffexpr|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002751 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
2752 security reasons.
2753
2754 *'dip'* *'diffopt'*
Bram Moolenaarc8234772019-11-10 21:00:27 +01002755'diffopt' 'dip' string (default "internal,filler,closeoff")
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002756 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002757 {not available when compiled without the |+diff|
2758 feature}
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00002759 Option settings for diff mode. It can consist of the following items.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002760 All are optional. Items must be separated by a comma.
2761
2762 filler Show filler lines, to keep the text
2763 synchronized with a window that has inserted
2764 lines at the same position. Mostly useful
2765 when windows are side-by-side and 'scrollbind'
2766 is set.
2767
2768 context:{n} Use a context of {n} lines between a change
2769 and a fold that contains unchanged lines.
2770 When omitted a context of six lines is used.
Bram Moolenaarf6b40102019-02-22 15:24:03 +01002771 When using zero the context is actually one,
2772 since folds require a line in between, also
2773 for a deleted line.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002774 See |fold-diff|.
2775
Bram Moolenaar95bafa22018-10-02 13:26:25 +02002776 iblank Ignore changes where lines are all blank. Adds
2777 the "-B" flag to the "diff" command if
2778 'diffexpr' is empty. Check the documentation
2779 of the "diff" command for what this does
2780 exactly.
2781 NOTE: the diff windows will get out of sync,
2782 because no differences between blank lines are
2783 taken into account.
2784
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002785 icase Ignore changes in case of text. "a" and "A"
2786 are considered the same. Adds the "-i" flag
2787 to the "diff" command if 'diffexpr' is empty.
2788
2789 iwhite Ignore changes in amount of white space. Adds
2790 the "-b" flag to the "diff" command if
2791 'diffexpr' is empty. Check the documentation
2792 of the "diff" command for what this does
2793 exactly. It should ignore adding trailing
2794 white space, but not leading white space.
2795
Bram Moolenaar95bafa22018-10-02 13:26:25 +02002796 iwhiteall Ignore all white space changes. Adds
2797 the "-w" flag to the "diff" command if
2798 'diffexpr' is empty. Check the documentation
2799 of the "diff" command for what this does
2800 exactly.
2801
2802 iwhiteeol Ignore white space changes at end of line.
2803 Adds the "-Z" flag to the "diff" command if
2804 'diffexpr' is empty. Check the documentation
2805 of the "diff" command for what this does
2806 exactly.
2807
Bram Moolenaar7d47b6e2006-03-15 22:59:18 +00002808 horizontal Start diff mode with horizontal splits (unless
2809 explicitly specified otherwise).
2810
2811 vertical Start diff mode with vertical splits (unless
2812 explicitly specified otherwise).
2813
Bram Moolenaarc8234772019-11-10 21:00:27 +01002814 closeoff When a window is closed where 'diff' is set
2815 and there is only one window remaining in the
2816 same tab page with 'diff' set, execute
2817 `:diffoff` in that window. This undoes a
2818 `:diffsplit` command.
2819
Bram Moolenaar97ce4192017-12-01 20:35:58 +01002820 hiddenoff Do not use diff mode for a buffer when it
2821 becomes hidden.
2822
Bram Moolenaar7d47b6e2006-03-15 22:59:18 +00002823 foldcolumn:{n} Set the 'foldcolumn' option to {n} when
2824 starting diff mode. Without this 2 is used.
2825
Bram Moolenaar4223d432021-02-10 13:18:17 +01002826 followwrap Follow the 'wrap' option and leave as it is.
2827
Bram Moolenaare828b762018-09-10 17:51:58 +02002828 internal Use the internal diff library. This is
2829 ignored when 'diffexpr' is set. *E960*
2830 When running out of memory when writing a
2831 buffer this item will be ignored for diffs
2832 involving that buffer. Set the 'verbose'
2833 option to see when this happens.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002834
Bram Moolenaare828b762018-09-10 17:51:58 +02002835 indent-heuristic
Bram Moolenaarf0d58ef2018-11-16 16:13:44 +01002836 Use the indent heuristic for the internal
2837 diff library.
Bram Moolenaare828b762018-09-10 17:51:58 +02002838
2839 algorithm:{text} Use the specified diff algorithm with the
Bram Moolenaarf0d58ef2018-11-16 16:13:44 +01002840 internal diff engine. Currently supported
Bram Moolenaare828b762018-09-10 17:51:58 +02002841 algorithms are:
2842 myers the default algorithm
2843 minimal spend extra time to generate the
2844 smallest possible diff
2845 patience patience diff algorithm
2846 histogram histogram diff algorithm
2847
2848 Examples: >
2849 :set diffopt=internal,filler,context:4
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002850 :set diffopt=
Bram Moolenaare828b762018-09-10 17:51:58 +02002851 :set diffopt=internal,filler,foldcolumn:3
2852 :set diffopt-=internal " do NOT use the internal diff parser
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002853<
2854 *'digraph'* *'dg'* *'nodigraph'* *'nodg'*
2855'digraph' 'dg' boolean (default off)
2856 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002857 {not available when compiled without the |+digraphs|
2858 feature}
2859 Enable the entering of digraphs in Insert mode with {char1} <BS>
2860 {char2}. See |digraphs|.
2861 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
2862
2863 *'directory'* *'dir'*
2864'directory' 'dir' string (default for Amiga: ".,t:",
Bram Moolenaar5666fcd2019-12-26 14:35:26 +01002865 for Win32: ".,$TEMP,c:\tmp,c:\temp"
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002866 for Unix: ".,~/tmp,/var/tmp,/tmp")
2867 global
2868 List of directory names for the swap file, separated with commas.
Bram Moolenaare7b1ea02020-08-07 19:54:59 +02002869 Recommended value: ".,~/vimswap//" - this will put the swap file next
2870 to the edited file if possible, and in your personal swap directory
2871 otherwise. Make sure "~/vimswap//" is only readable for you.
2872
2873 Possible items:
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002874 - The swap file will be created in the first directory where this is
2875 possible.
2876 - Empty means that no swap file will be used (recovery is
Bram Moolenaar00e192b2019-10-19 17:01:28 +02002877 impossible!) and no |E303| error will be given.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002878 - A directory "." means to put the swap file in the same directory as
2879 the edited file. On Unix, a dot is prepended to the file name, so
2880 it doesn't show in a directory listing. On MS-Windows the "hidden"
2881 attribute is set and a dot prepended if possible.
Bram Moolenaar8024f932020-01-14 19:29:13 +01002882 - A directory starting with "./" (or ".\" for MS-Windows) means to put
2883 the swap file relative to where the edited file is. The leading "."
2884 is replaced with the path name of the edited file.
Bram Moolenaarb782ba42018-08-07 21:39:28 +02002885 - For Unix and Win32, if a directory ends in two path separators "//",
2886 the swap file name will be built from the complete path to the file
Bram Moolenaar207f0092020-08-30 17:20:20 +02002887 with all path separators replaced by percent '%' signs (including
2888 the colon following the drive letter on Win32). This will ensure
2889 file name uniqueness in the preserve directory.
Bram Moolenaarb782ba42018-08-07 21:39:28 +02002890 On Win32, it is also possible to end with "\\". However, When a
2891 separating comma is following, you must use "//", since "\\" will
2892 include the comma in the file name. Therefore it is recommended to
2893 use '//', instead of '\\'.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002894 - Spaces after the comma are ignored, other spaces are considered part
2895 of the directory name. To have a space at the start of a directory
2896 name, precede it with a backslash.
2897 - To include a comma in a directory name precede it with a backslash.
2898 - A directory name may end in an ':' or '/'.
2899 - Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|.
2900 - Careful with '\' characters, type one before a space, type two to
2901 get one in the option (see |option-backslash|), for example: >
2902 :set dir=c:\\tmp,\ dir\\,with\\,commas,\\\ dir\ with\ spaces
2903< - For backwards compatibility with Vim version 3.0 a '>' at the start
2904 of the option is removed.
2905 Using "." first in the list is recommended. This means that editing
2906 the same file twice will result in a warning. Using "/tmp" on Unix is
2907 discouraged: When the system crashes you lose the swap file.
2908 "/var/tmp" is often not cleared when rebooting, thus is a better
Bram Moolenaare7b1ea02020-08-07 19:54:59 +02002909 choice than "/tmp". But others on the computer may be able to see the
2910 files, and it can contain a lot of files, your swap files get lost in
2911 the crowd. That is why a "tmp" directory in your home directory is
2912 tried first.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002913 The use of |:set+=| and |:set-=| is preferred when adding or removing
2914 directories from the list. This avoids problems when a future version
2915 uses another default.
2916 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
2917 security reasons.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002918
2919 *'display'* *'dy'*
Bram Moolenaarbc8801c2016-08-02 21:04:33 +02002920'display' 'dy' string (default "", set to "truncate" in
2921 |defaults.vim|)
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002922 global
Bram Moolenaarcbaff5e2022-04-08 17:45:08 +01002923 Change the way text is displayed. This is comma-separated list of
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002924 flags:
2925 lastline When included, as much as possible of the last line
Bram Moolenaarad9c2a02016-07-27 23:26:04 +02002926 in a window will be displayed. "@@@" is put in the
2927 last columns of the last screen line to indicate the
2928 rest of the line is not displayed.
2929 truncate Like "lastline", but "@@@" is displayed in the first
2930 column of the last screen line. Overrules "lastline".
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002931 uhex Show unprintable characters hexadecimal as <xx>
2932 instead of using ^C and ~C.
2933
Bram Moolenaard0796902016-09-16 20:02:31 +02002934 When neither "lastline" nor "truncate" is included, a last line that
Bram Moolenaarad9c2a02016-07-27 23:26:04 +02002935 doesn't fit is replaced with "@" lines.
2936
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002937 *'eadirection'* *'ead'*
2938'eadirection' 'ead' string (default "both")
2939 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002940 Tells when the 'equalalways' option applies:
2941 ver vertically, width of windows is not affected
2942 hor horizontally, height of windows is not affected
2943 both width and height of windows is affected
2944
2945 *'ed'* *'edcompatible'* *'noed'* *'noedcompatible'*
2946'edcompatible' 'ed' boolean (default off)
2947 global
2948 Makes the 'g' and 'c' flags of the ":substitute" command to be
2949 toggled each time the flag is given. See |complex-change|. See
2950 also 'gdefault' option.
Bram Moolenaarb4d6c3e2017-05-27 16:45:17 +02002951 Switching this option on may break plugins!
Bram Moolenaar4072ba52020-12-23 13:56:35 +01002952 This option is not used in |Vim9| script.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002953
Bram Moolenaar03413f42016-04-12 21:07:15 +02002954 *'emoji'* *'emo'* *'noemoji'* *'noemo'*
Bram Moolenaar3848e002016-03-19 18:42:29 +01002955'emoji' 'emo' boolean (default: on)
2956 global
Bram Moolenaar3848e002016-03-19 18:42:29 +01002957 When on all Unicode emoji characters are considered to be full width.
Bram Moolenaar1d59aa12020-09-19 18:50:13 +02002958 This excludes "text emoji" characters, which are normally displayed as
2959 single width. Unfortunately there is no good specification for this
2960 and it has been determined on trial-and-error basis. Use the
2961 |setcellwidths()| function to change the behavior.
Bram Moolenaar3848e002016-03-19 18:42:29 +01002962
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002963 *'encoding'* *'enc'* *E543*
K.Takataf883d902021-05-30 18:04:19 +02002964'encoding' 'enc' string (default for MS-Windows: "utf-8",
2965 otherwise: value from $LANG or "latin1")
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002966 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002967 Sets the character encoding used inside Vim. It applies to text in
2968 the buffers, registers, Strings in expressions, text stored in the
2969 viminfo file, etc. It sets the kind of characters which Vim can work
2970 with. See |encoding-names| for the possible values.
2971
2972 NOTE: Changing this option will not change the encoding of the
Bram Moolenaar1cd871b2004-12-19 22:46:22 +00002973 existing text in Vim. It may cause non-ASCII text to become invalid.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002974 It should normally be kept at its default value, or set when Vim
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00002975 starts up. See |multibyte|. To reload the menus see |:menutrans|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002976
Bram Moolenaar865242e2010-07-14 21:12:05 +02002977 This option cannot be set from a |modeline|. It would most likely
2978 corrupt the text.
2979
Bram Moolenaar3df01732017-02-17 22:47:16 +01002980 NOTE: For GTK+ 2 or later, it is highly recommended to set 'encoding'
2981 to "utf-8". Although care has been taken to allow different values of
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002982 'encoding', "utf-8" is the natural choice for the environment and
2983 avoids unnecessary conversion overhead. "utf-8" has not been made
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00002984 the default to prevent different behavior of the GUI and terminal
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002985 versions, and to avoid changing the encoding of newly created files
2986 without your knowledge (in case 'fileencodings' is empty).
2987
2988 The character encoding of files can be different from 'encoding'.
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00002989 This is specified with 'fileencoding'. The conversion is done with
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002990 iconv() or as specified with 'charconvert'.
2991
Bram Moolenaar207f0092020-08-30 17:20:20 +02002992 If you need to know whether 'encoding' is a multibyte encoding, you
Bram Moolenaar8f3f58f2010-01-06 20:52:26 +01002993 can use: >
2994 if has("multi_byte_encoding")
2995<
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002996 Normally 'encoding' will be equal to your current locale. This will
2997 be the default if Vim recognizes your environment settings. If
2998 'encoding' is not set to the current locale, 'termencoding' must be
2999 set to convert typed and displayed text. See |encoding-table|.
3000
3001 When you set this option, it fires the |EncodingChanged| autocommand
3002 event so that you can set up fonts if necessary.
3003
3004 When the option is set, the value is converted to lowercase. Thus
3005 you can set it with uppercase values too. Underscores are translated
3006 to '-' signs.
3007 When the encoding is recognized, it is changed to the standard name.
3008 For example "Latin-1" becomes "latin1", "ISO_88592" becomes
3009 "iso-8859-2" and "utf8" becomes "utf-8".
3010
3011 Note: "latin1" is also used when the encoding could not be detected.
3012 This only works when editing files in the same encoding! When the
3013 actual character set is not latin1, make sure 'fileencoding' and
3014 'fileencodings' are empty. When conversion is needed, switch to using
3015 utf-8.
3016
3017 When "unicode", "ucs-2" or "ucs-4" is used, Vim internally uses utf-8.
3018 You don't notice this while editing, but it does matter for the
3019 |viminfo-file|. And Vim expects the terminal to use utf-8 too. Thus
3020 setting 'encoding' to one of these values instead of utf-8 only has
3021 effect for encoding used for files when 'fileencoding' is empty.
3022
Bram Moolenaar661b1822005-07-28 22:36:45 +00003023 When 'encoding' is set to a Unicode encoding, and 'fileencodings' was
3024 not set yet, the default for 'fileencodings' is changed.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003025
3026 *'endofline'* *'eol'* *'noendofline'* *'noeol'*
3027'endofline' 'eol' boolean (default on)
3028 local to buffer
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003029 When writing a file and this option is off and the 'binary' option
Bram Moolenaar34d72d42015-07-17 14:18:08 +02003030 is on, or 'fixeol' option is off, no <EOL> will be written for the
3031 last line in the file. This option is automatically set or reset when
3032 starting to edit a new file, depending on whether file has an <EOL>
3033 for the last line in the file. Normally you don't have to set or
3034 reset this option.
3035 When 'binary' is off and 'fixeol' is on the value is not used when
3036 writing the file. When 'binary' is on or 'fixeol' is off it is used
3037 to remember the presence of a <EOL> for the last line in the file, so
3038 that when you write the file the situation from the original file can
3039 be kept. But you can change it if you want to.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003040
3041 *'equalalways'* *'ea'* *'noequalalways'* *'noea'*
3042'equalalways' 'ea' boolean (default on)
3043 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003044 When on, all the windows are automatically made the same size after
Bram Moolenaar009b2592004-10-24 19:18:58 +00003045 splitting or closing a window. This also happens the moment the
3046 option is switched on. When off, splitting a window will reduce the
3047 size of the current window and leave the other windows the same. When
3048 closing a window the extra lines are given to the window next to it
3049 (depending on 'splitbelow' and 'splitright').
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003050 When mixing vertically and horizontally split windows, a minimal size
3051 is computed and some windows may be larger if there is room. The
3052 'eadirection' option tells in which direction the size is affected.
Bram Moolenaar67f71312007-08-12 14:55:56 +00003053 Changing the height and width of a window can be avoided by setting
3054 'winfixheight' and 'winfixwidth', respectively.
Bram Moolenaar8f3f58f2010-01-06 20:52:26 +01003055 If a window size is specified when creating a new window sizes are
3056 currently not equalized (it's complicated, but may be implemented in
3057 the future).
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003058
3059 *'equalprg'* *'ep'*
3060'equalprg' 'ep' string (default "")
3061 global or local to buffer |global-local|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003062 External program to use for "=" command. When this option is empty
Bram Moolenaar446cb832008-06-24 21:56:24 +00003063 the internal formatting functions are used; either 'lisp', 'cindent'
Bram Moolenaar8f3f58f2010-01-06 20:52:26 +01003064 or 'indentexpr'. When Vim was compiled without internal formatting,
3065 the "indent" program is used.
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00003066 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|. See |option-backslash|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003067 about including spaces and backslashes.
3068 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
3069 security reasons.
3070
3071 *'errorbells'* *'eb'* *'noerrorbells'* *'noeb'*
3072'errorbells' 'eb' boolean (default off)
3073 global
3074 Ring the bell (beep or screen flash) for error messages. This only
3075 makes a difference for error messages, the bell will be used always
3076 for a lot of errors without a message (e.g., hitting <Esc> in Normal
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00003077 mode). See 'visualbell' on how to make the bell behave like a beep,
Bram Moolenaar165bc692015-07-21 17:53:25 +02003078 screen flash or do nothing. See 'belloff' to finetune when to ring the
3079 bell.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003080
3081 *'errorfile'* *'ef'*
3082'errorfile' 'ef' string (Amiga default: "AztecC.Err",
3083 others: "errors.err")
3084 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003085 {not available when compiled without the |+quickfix|
3086 feature}
3087 Name of the errorfile for the QuickFix mode (see |:cf|).
3088 When the "-q" command-line argument is used, 'errorfile' is set to the
3089 following argument. See |-q|.
3090 NOT used for the ":make" command. See 'makeef' for that.
3091 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|.
3092 See |option-backslash| about including spaces and backslashes.
3093 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
3094 security reasons.
3095
3096 *'errorformat'* *'efm'*
3097'errorformat' 'efm' string (default is very long)
3098 global or local to buffer |global-local|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003099 {not available when compiled without the |+quickfix|
3100 feature}
3101 Scanf-like description of the format for the lines in the error file
3102 (see |errorformat|).
3103
3104 *'esckeys'* *'ek'* *'noesckeys'* *'noek'*
3105'esckeys' 'ek' boolean (Vim default: on, Vi default: off)
3106 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003107 Function keys that start with an <Esc> are recognized in Insert
3108 mode. When this option is off, the cursor and function keys cannot be
3109 used in Insert mode if they start with an <Esc>. The advantage of
3110 this is that the single <Esc> is recognized immediately, instead of
3111 after one second. Instead of resetting this option, you might want to
3112 try changing the values for 'timeoutlen' and 'ttimeoutlen'. Note that
3113 when 'esckeys' is off, you can still map anything, but the cursor keys
3114 won't work by default.
3115 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
3116 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
Bram Moolenaarc8234772019-11-10 21:00:27 +01003117 NOTE: when this option is off then the |modifyOtherKeys| functionality
3118 is disabled while in Insert mode to avoid ending Insert mode with any
3119 key that has a modifier.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003120
3121 *'eventignore'* *'ei'*
3122'eventignore' 'ei' string (default "")
3123 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003124 A list of autocommand event names, which are to be ignored.
Bram Moolenaarf193fff2006-04-27 00:02:13 +00003125 When set to "all" or when "all" is one of the items, all autocommand
3126 events are ignored, autocommands will not be executed.
Bram Moolenaarcbaff5e2022-04-08 17:45:08 +01003127 Otherwise this is a comma-separated list of event names. Example: >
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003128 :set ei=WinEnter,WinLeave
3129<
3130 *'expandtab'* *'et'* *'noexpandtab'* *'noet'*
3131'expandtab' 'et' boolean (default off)
3132 local to buffer
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003133 In Insert mode: Use the appropriate number of spaces to insert a
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00003134 <Tab>. Spaces are used in indents with the '>' and '<' commands and
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003135 when 'autoindent' is on. To insert a real tab when 'expandtab' is
3136 on, use CTRL-V<Tab>. See also |:retab| and |ins-expandtab|.
Bram Moolenaarca635012015-09-25 20:34:21 +02003137 This option is reset when the 'paste' option is set and restored when
3138 the 'paste' option is reset.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003139 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
3140
3141 *'exrc'* *'ex'* *'noexrc'* *'noex'*
3142'exrc' 'ex' boolean (default off)
3143 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003144 Enables the reading of .vimrc, .exrc and .gvimrc in the current
Bram Moolenaar36f44c22016-08-28 18:17:20 +02003145 directory.
3146
3147 Setting this option is a potential security leak. E.g., consider
3148 unpacking a package or fetching files from github, a .vimrc in there
3149 might be a trojan horse. BETTER NOT SET THIS OPTION!
3150 Instead, define an autocommand in your .vimrc to set options for a
3151 matching directory.
3152
3153 If you do switch this option on you should also consider setting the
3154 'secure' option (see |initialization|).
3155 Also see |.vimrc| and |gui-init|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003156 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
3157 security reasons.
3158
3159 *'fileencoding'* *'fenc'* *E213*
3160'fileencoding' 'fenc' string (default: "")
3161 local to buffer
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003162 Sets the character encoding for the file of this buffer.
Bram Moolenaar865242e2010-07-14 21:12:05 +02003163
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003164 When 'fileencoding' is different from 'encoding', conversion will be
Bram Moolenaar8f3f58f2010-01-06 20:52:26 +01003165 done when writing the file. For reading see below.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003166 When 'fileencoding' is empty, the same value as 'encoding' will be
3167 used (no conversion when reading or writing a file).
Bram Moolenaar214641f2017-03-05 17:04:09 +01003168 No error will be given when the value is set, only when it is used,
3169 only when writing a file.
Bram Moolenaar8f3f58f2010-01-06 20:52:26 +01003170 Conversion will also be done when 'encoding' and 'fileencoding' are
3171 both a Unicode encoding and 'fileencoding' is not utf-8. That's
3172 because internally Unicode is always stored as utf-8.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003173 WARNING: Conversion can cause loss of information! When
Bram Moolenaar8f3f58f2010-01-06 20:52:26 +01003174 'encoding' is "utf-8" or another Unicode encoding, conversion
3175 is most likely done in a way that the reverse conversion
3176 results in the same text. When 'encoding' is not "utf-8" some
3177 characters may be lost!
Bram Moolenaar865242e2010-07-14 21:12:05 +02003178
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003179 See 'encoding' for the possible values. Additionally, values may be
3180 specified that can be handled by the converter, see
3181 |mbyte-conversion|.
Bram Moolenaar865242e2010-07-14 21:12:05 +02003182
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003183 When reading a file 'fileencoding' will be set from 'fileencodings'.
3184 To read a file in a certain encoding it won't work by setting
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00003185 'fileencoding', use the |++enc| argument. One exception: when
3186 'fileencodings' is empty the value of 'fileencoding' is used.
Bram Moolenaara23ccb82006-02-27 00:08:02 +00003187 For a new file the global value of 'fileencoding' is used.
Bram Moolenaar865242e2010-07-14 21:12:05 +02003188
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003189 Prepending "8bit-" and "2byte-" has no meaning here, they are ignored.
3190 When the option is set, the value is converted to lowercase. Thus
3191 you can set it with uppercase values too. '_' characters are
3192 replaced with '-'. If a name is recognized from the list for
3193 'encoding', it is replaced by the standard name. For example
3194 "ISO8859-2" becomes "iso-8859-2".
Bram Moolenaar865242e2010-07-14 21:12:05 +02003195
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003196 When this option is set, after starting to edit a file, the 'modified'
3197 option is set, because the file would be different when written.
Bram Moolenaar865242e2010-07-14 21:12:05 +02003198
3199 Keep in mind that changing 'fenc' from a modeline happens
3200 AFTER the text has been read, thus it applies to when the file will be
3201 written. If you do set 'fenc' in a modeline, you might want to set
3202 'nomodified' to avoid not being able to ":q".
3203
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003204 This option can not be changed when 'modifiable' is off.
3205
3206 *'fe'*
3207 NOTE: Before version 6.0 this option specified the encoding for the
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00003208 whole of Vim, this was a mistake. Now use 'encoding' instead. The
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003209 old short name was 'fe', which is no longer used.
3210
3211 *'fileencodings'* *'fencs'*
Bram Moolenaar1cd871b2004-12-19 22:46:22 +00003212'fileencodings' 'fencs' string (default: "ucs-bom",
3213 "ucs-bom,utf-8,default,latin1" when
3214 'encoding' is set to a Unicode value)
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003215 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003216 This is a list of character encodings considered when starting to edit
3217 an existing file. When a file is read, Vim tries to use the first
3218 mentioned character encoding. If an error is detected, the next one
3219 in the list is tried. When an encoding is found that works,
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00003220 'fileencoding' is set to it. If all fail, 'fileencoding' is set to
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003221 an empty string, which means the value of 'encoding' is used.
3222 WARNING: Conversion can cause loss of information! When
3223 'encoding' is "utf-8" (or one of the other Unicode variants)
3224 conversion is most likely done in a way that the reverse
3225 conversion results in the same text. When 'encoding' is not
Bram Moolenaarc6d8db72005-12-13 20:04:55 +00003226 "utf-8" some non-ASCII characters may be lost! You can use
3227 the |++bad| argument to specify what is done with characters
3228 that can't be converted.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003229 For an empty file or a file with only ASCII characters most encodings
3230 will work and the first entry of 'fileencodings' will be used (except
3231 "ucs-bom", which requires the BOM to be present). If you prefer
3232 another encoding use an BufReadPost autocommand event to test if your
3233 preferred encoding is to be used. Example: >
3234 au BufReadPost * if search('\S', 'w') == 0 |
3235 \ set fenc=iso-2022-jp | endif
3236< This sets 'fileencoding' to "iso-2022-jp" if the file does not contain
3237 non-blank characters.
Bram Moolenaarc6d8db72005-12-13 20:04:55 +00003238 When the |++enc| argument is used then the value of 'fileencodings' is
3239 not used.
Bram Moolenaara23ccb82006-02-27 00:08:02 +00003240 Note that 'fileencodings' is not used for a new file, the global value
3241 of 'fileencoding' is used instead. You can set it with: >
3242 :setglobal fenc=iso-8859-2
3243< This means that a non-existing file may get a different encoding than
3244 an empty file.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003245 The special value "ucs-bom" can be used to check for a Unicode BOM
3246 (Byte Order Mark) at the start of the file. It must not be preceded
3247 by "utf-8" or another Unicode encoding for this to work properly.
3248 An entry for an 8-bit encoding (e.g., "latin1") should be the last,
3249 because Vim cannot detect an error, thus the encoding is always
3250 accepted.
Bram Moolenaar1cd871b2004-12-19 22:46:22 +00003251 The special value "default" can be used for the encoding from the
K.Takataef8706f2021-05-31 18:40:49 +02003252 environment. On MS-Windows this is the system encoding. Otherwise
3253 this is the default value for 'encoding'. It is useful when
3254 'encoding' is set to "utf-8" and your environment uses a non-latin1
3255 encoding, such as Russian.
Bram Moolenaarca003e12006-03-17 23:19:38 +00003256 When 'encoding' is "utf-8" and a file contains an illegal byte
3257 sequence it won't be recognized as UTF-8. You can use the |8g8|
3258 command to find the illegal byte sequence.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003259 WRONG VALUES: WHAT'S WRONG:
3260 latin1,utf-8 "latin1" will always be used
3261 utf-8,ucs-bom,latin1 BOM won't be recognized in an utf-8
3262 file
3263 cp1250,latin1 "cp1250" will always be used
3264 If 'fileencodings' is empty, 'fileencoding' is not modified.
3265 See 'fileencoding' for the possible values.
3266 Setting this option does not have an effect until the next time a file
3267 is read.
3268
3269 *'fileformat'* *'ff'*
Bram Moolenaar00590742019-02-15 21:06:09 +01003270'fileformat' 'ff' string (MS-Windows default: "dos",
3271 Unix, macOS default: "unix")
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003272 local to buffer
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003273 This gives the <EOL> of the current buffer, which is used for
3274 reading/writing the buffer from/to a file:
Bram Moolenaar4072ba52020-12-23 13:56:35 +01003275 dos <CR><NL>
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003276 unix <NL>
3277 mac <CR>
3278 When "dos" is used, CTRL-Z at the end of a file is ignored.
3279 See |file-formats| and |file-read|.
3280 For the character encoding of the file see 'fileencoding'.
3281 When 'binary' is set, the value of 'fileformat' is ignored, file I/O
Bram Moolenaarbf884932013-04-05 22:26:15 +02003282 works like it was set to "unix".
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003283 This option is set automatically when starting to edit a file and
3284 'fileformats' is not empty and 'binary' is off.
3285 When this option is set, after starting to edit a file, the 'modified'
3286 option is set, because the file would be different when written.
3287 This option can not be changed when 'modifiable' is off.
3288 For backwards compatibility: When this option is set to "dos",
3289 'textmode' is set, otherwise 'textmode' is reset.
3290
3291 *'fileformats'* *'ffs'*
3292'fileformats' 'ffs' string (default:
Bram Moolenaar00590742019-02-15 21:06:09 +01003293 Vim+Vi MS-Windows: "dos,unix",
3294 Vim Unix, macOS: "unix,dos",
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003295 Vi Cygwin: "unix,dos",
3296 Vi others: "")
3297 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003298 This gives the end-of-line (<EOL>) formats that will be tried when
3299 starting to edit a new buffer and when reading a file into an existing
3300 buffer:
3301 - When empty, the format defined with 'fileformat' will be used
3302 always. It is not set automatically.
3303 - When set to one name, that format will be used whenever a new buffer
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00003304 is opened. 'fileformat' is set accordingly for that buffer. The
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003305 'fileformats' name will be used when a file is read into an existing
3306 buffer, no matter what 'fileformat' for that buffer is set to.
3307 - When more than one name is present, separated by commas, automatic
3308 <EOL> detection will be done when reading a file. When starting to
3309 edit a file, a check is done for the <EOL>:
3310 1. If all lines end in <CR><NL>, and 'fileformats' includes "dos",
3311 'fileformat' is set to "dos".
3312 2. If a <NL> is found and 'fileformats' includes "unix", 'fileformat'
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00003313 is set to "unix". Note that when a <NL> is found without a
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003314 preceding <CR>, "unix" is preferred over "dos".
Bram Moolenaar2b8388b2015-02-28 13:11:45 +01003315 3. If 'fileformat' has not yet been set, and if a <CR> is found, and
3316 if 'fileformats' includes "mac", 'fileformat' is set to "mac".
Bram Moolenaar00659062010-09-21 22:34:02 +02003317 This means that "mac" is only chosen when:
3318 "unix" is not present or no <NL> is found in the file, and
3319 "dos" is not present or no <CR><NL> is found in the file.
3320 Except: if "unix" was chosen, but there is a <CR> before
3321 the first <NL>, and there appear to be more <CR>s than <NL>s in
Bram Moolenaar166af9b2010-11-16 20:34:40 +01003322 the first few lines, "mac" is used.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003323 4. If 'fileformat' is still not set, the first name from
3324 'fileformats' is used.
3325 When reading a file into an existing buffer, the same is done, but
3326 this happens like 'fileformat' has been set appropriately for that
3327 file only, the option is not changed.
3328 When 'binary' is set, the value of 'fileformats' is not used.
3329
Bram Moolenaar4f3f6682016-03-26 23:01:59 +01003330 When Vim starts up with an empty buffer the first item is used. You
3331 can overrule this by setting 'fileformat' in your .vimrc.
Bram Moolenaar81af9252010-12-10 20:35:50 +01003332
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003333 For systems with a Dos-like <EOL> (<CR><NL>), when reading files that
3334 are ":source"ed and for vimrc files, automatic <EOL> detection may be
3335 done:
3336 - When 'fileformats' is empty, there is no automatic detection. Dos
3337 format will be used.
3338 - When 'fileformats' is set to one or more names, automatic detection
3339 is done. This is based on the first <NL> in the file: If there is a
3340 <CR> in front of it, Dos format is used, otherwise Unix format is
3341 used.
3342 Also see |file-formats|.
3343 For backwards compatibility: When this option is set to an empty
3344 string or one format (no comma is included), 'textauto' is reset,
3345 otherwise 'textauto' is set.
3346 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
3347 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
3348
Bram Moolenaarbf884932013-04-05 22:26:15 +02003349 *'fileignorecase'* *'fic'* *'nofileignorecase'* *'nofic'*
3350'fileignorecase' 'fic' boolean (default on for systems where case in file
3351 names is normally ignored)
Bram Moolenaar71afbfe2013-03-19 16:49:16 +01003352 global
Bram Moolenaar71afbfe2013-03-19 16:49:16 +01003353 When set case is ignored when using file names and directories.
3354 See 'wildignorecase' for only ignoring case when doing completion.
3355
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003356 *'filetype'* *'ft'*
3357'filetype' 'ft' string (default: "")
3358 local to buffer
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003359 When this option is set, the FileType autocommand event is triggered.
3360 All autocommands that match with the value of this option will be
3361 executed. Thus the value of 'filetype' is used in place of the file
3362 name.
3363 Otherwise this option does not always reflect the current file type.
3364 This option is normally set when the file type is detected. To enable
3365 this use the ":filetype on" command. |:filetype|
3366 Setting this option to a different value is most useful in a modeline,
3367 for a file for which the file type is not automatically recognized.
Bram Moolenaar97b2ad32006-03-18 21:40:56 +00003368 Example, for in an IDL file:
3369 /* vim: set filetype=idl : */ ~
3370 |FileType| |filetypes|
3371 When a dot appears in the value then this separates two filetype
3372 names. Example:
3373 /* vim: set filetype=c.doxygen : */ ~
3374 This will use the "c" filetype first, then the "doxygen" filetype.
3375 This works both for filetype plugins and for syntax files. More than
3376 one dot may appear.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003377 This option is not copied to another buffer, independent of the 's' or
3378 'S' flag in 'cpoptions'.
Bram Moolenaar293ee4d2004-12-09 21:34:53 +00003379 Only normal file name characters can be used, "/\*?[|<>" are illegal.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003380
3381 *'fillchars'* *'fcs'*
Bram Moolenaara98f8a22021-02-13 18:24:23 +01003382'fillchars' 'fcs' string (default "vert:|,fold:-,eob:~")
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003383 global
Bram Moolenaar62a0cb42019-08-18 16:35:23 +02003384 {not available when compiled without the |+folding|
3385 feature}
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003386 Characters to fill the statuslines and vertical separators.
Bram Moolenaarcbaff5e2022-04-08 17:45:08 +01003387 It is a comma-separated list of items:
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003388
3389 item default Used for ~
3390 stl:c ' ' or '^' statusline of the current window
Bram Moolenaar38a55632016-02-15 22:07:32 +01003391 stlnc:c ' ' or '=' statusline of the non-current windows
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003392 vert:c '|' vertical separators |:vsplit|
3393 fold:c '-' filling 'foldtext'
Bram Moolenaar3aca5a62021-02-17 13:14:07 +01003394 foldopen:c '-' mark the beginning of a fold
3395 foldclose:c '+' show a closed fold
3396 foldsep:c '|' open fold middle character
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003397 diff:c '-' deleted lines of the 'diff' option
Bram Moolenaara98f8a22021-02-13 18:24:23 +01003398 eob:c '~' empty lines below the end of a buffer
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003399
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00003400 Any one that is omitted will fall back to the default. For "stl" and
Bram Moolenaar38a55632016-02-15 22:07:32 +01003401 "stlnc" the space will be used when there is highlighting, '^' or '='
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003402 otherwise.
3403
3404 Example: >
Bram Moolenaar38a55632016-02-15 22:07:32 +01003405 :set fillchars=stl:^,stlnc:=,vert:\|,fold:-,diff:-
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003406< This is similar to the default, except that these characters will also
3407 be used when there is highlighting.
3408
Bram Moolenaar008bff92021-03-04 21:55:58 +01003409 For "stl" and "stlnc" single-byte and multibyte characters are
3410 supported. But double-width characters are not supported.
Bram Moolenaar910f66f2006-04-05 20:41:53 +00003411
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003412 The highlighting used for these items:
3413 item highlight group ~
3414 stl:c StatusLine |hl-StatusLine|
3415 stlnc:c StatusLineNC |hl-StatusLineNC|
3416 vert:c VertSplit |hl-VertSplit|
3417 fold:c Folded |hl-Folded|
3418 diff:c DiffDelete |hl-DiffDelete|
Bram Moolenaara98f8a22021-02-13 18:24:23 +01003419 eob:c EndOfBuffer |hl-EndOfBuffer|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003420
Bram Moolenaar34d72d42015-07-17 14:18:08 +02003421 *'fixendofline'* *'fixeol'* *'nofixendofline'* *'nofixeol'*
3422'fixendofline' 'fixeol' boolean (default on)
3423 local to buffer
Bram Moolenaar34d72d42015-07-17 14:18:08 +02003424 When writing a file and this option is on, <EOL> at the end of file
3425 will be restored if missing. Turn this option off if you want to
3426 preserve the situation from the original file.
3427 When the 'binary' option is set the value of this option doesn't
3428 matter.
3429 See the 'endofline' option.
3430
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003431 *'fkmap'* *'fk'* *'nofkmap'* *'nofk'*
Bram Moolenaar98a29d02021-01-18 19:55:44 +01003432'fkmap' 'fk' boolean (default off)
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003433 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003434 {only available when compiled with the |+rightleft|
3435 feature}
Bram Moolenaar14184a32019-02-16 15:10:30 +01003436 This option was for using Farsi, which has been removed. See
3437 |farsi.txt|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003438
3439 *'foldclose'* *'fcl'*
3440'foldclose' 'fcl' string (default "")
3441 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003442 {not available when compiled without the |+folding|
3443 feature}
3444 When set to "all", a fold is closed when the cursor isn't in it and
3445 its level is higher than 'foldlevel'. Useful if you want folds to
3446 automatically close when moving out of them.
3447
3448 *'foldcolumn'* *'fdc'*
3449'foldcolumn' 'fdc' number (default 0)
3450 local to window
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003451 {not available when compiled without the |+folding|
3452 feature}
3453 When non-zero, a column with the specified width is shown at the side
3454 of the window which indicates open and closed folds. The maximum
3455 value is 12.
3456 See |folding|.
3457
3458 *'foldenable'* *'fen'* *'nofoldenable'* *'nofen'*
3459'foldenable' 'fen' boolean (default on)
3460 local to window
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003461 {not available when compiled without the |+folding|
3462 feature}
3463 When off, all folds are open. This option can be used to quickly
3464 switch between showing all text unfolded and viewing the text with
3465 folds (including manually opened or closed folds). It can be toggled
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00003466 with the |zi| command. The 'foldcolumn' will remain blank when
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003467 'foldenable' is off.
3468 This option is set by commands that create a new fold or close a fold.
3469 See |folding|.
3470
3471 *'foldexpr'* *'fde'*
3472'foldexpr' 'fde' string (default: "0")
3473 local to window
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003474 {not available when compiled without the |+folding|
Bram Moolenaardb84e452010-08-15 13:50:43 +02003475 or |+eval| features}
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003476 The expression used for when 'foldmethod' is "expr". It is evaluated
Bram Moolenaar6f4754b2022-01-23 12:07:04 +00003477 for each line to obtain its fold level. The context is set to the
3478 script where 'foldexpr' was set, script-local items can be accessed.
3479 See |fold-expr| for the usage.
Bram Moolenaar97b2ad32006-03-18 21:40:56 +00003480
Bram Moolenaar30b65812012-07-12 22:01:11 +02003481 The expression will be evaluated in the |sandbox| if set from a
3482 modeline, see |sandbox-option|.
Bram Moolenaar8f3f58f2010-01-06 20:52:26 +01003483 This option can't be set from a |modeline| when the 'diff' option is
Bram Moolenaar110289e2019-05-23 15:38:06 +02003484 on or the 'modelineexpr' option is off.
Bram Moolenaarb71eaae2006-01-20 23:10:18 +00003485
3486 It is not allowed to change text or jump to another window while
3487 evaluating 'foldexpr' |textlock|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003488
3489 *'foldignore'* *'fdi'*
3490'foldignore' 'fdi' string (default: "#")
3491 local to window
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003492 {not available when compiled without the |+folding|
3493 feature}
3494 Used only when 'foldmethod' is "indent". Lines starting with
3495 characters in 'foldignore' will get their fold level from surrounding
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00003496 lines. White space is skipped before checking for this character.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003497 The default "#" works well for C programs. See |fold-indent|.
3498
3499 *'foldlevel'* *'fdl'*
3500'foldlevel' 'fdl' number (default: 0)
3501 local to window
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003502 {not available when compiled without the |+folding|
3503 feature}
3504 Sets the fold level: Folds with a higher level will be closed.
3505 Setting this option to zero will close all folds. Higher numbers will
3506 close fewer folds.
3507 This option is set by commands like |zm|, |zM| and |zR|.
3508 See |fold-foldlevel|.
3509
3510 *'foldlevelstart'* *'fdls'*
3511'foldlevelstart' 'fdls' number (default: -1)
3512 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003513 {not available when compiled without the |+folding|
3514 feature}
3515 Sets 'foldlevel' when starting to edit another buffer in a window.
3516 Useful to always start editing with all folds closed (value zero),
3517 some folds closed (one) or no folds closed (99).
3518 This is done before reading any modeline, thus a setting in a modeline
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00003519 overrules this option. Starting to edit a file for |diff-mode| also
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003520 ignores this option and closes all folds.
3521 It is also done before BufReadPre autocommands, to allow an autocmd to
3522 overrule the 'foldlevel' value for specific files.
3523 When the value is negative, it is not used.
3524
3525 *'foldmarker'* *'fmr'* *E536*
3526'foldmarker' 'fmr' string (default: "{{{,}}}")
3527 local to window
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003528 {not available when compiled without the |+folding|
3529 feature}
3530 The start and end marker used when 'foldmethod' is "marker". There
3531 must be one comma, which separates the start and end marker. The
3532 marker is a literal string (a regular expression would be too slow).
3533 See |fold-marker|.
3534
3535 *'foldmethod'* *'fdm'*
3536'foldmethod' 'fdm' string (default: "manual")
3537 local to window
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003538 {not available when compiled without the |+folding|
3539 feature}
3540 The kind of folding used for the current window. Possible values:
3541 |fold-manual| manual Folds are created manually.
3542 |fold-indent| indent Lines with equal indent form a fold.
3543 |fold-expr| expr 'foldexpr' gives the fold level of a line.
3544 |fold-marker| marker Markers are used to specify folds.
3545 |fold-syntax| syntax Syntax highlighting items specify folds.
3546 |fold-diff| diff Fold text that is not changed.
3547
3548 *'foldminlines'* *'fml'*
3549'foldminlines' 'fml' number (default: 1)
3550 local to window
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003551 {not available when compiled without the |+folding|
3552 feature}
Bram Moolenaar00654022011-02-25 14:42:19 +01003553 Sets the number of screen lines above which a fold can be displayed
3554 closed. Also for manually closed folds. With the default value of
3555 one a fold can only be closed if it takes up two or more screen lines.
3556 Set to zero to be able to close folds of just one screen line.
Bram Moolenaar446beb42011-05-10 17:18:44 +02003557 Note that this only has an effect on what is displayed. After using
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003558 "zc" to close a fold, which is displayed open because it's smaller
3559 than 'foldminlines', a following "zc" may close a containing fold.
3560
3561 *'foldnestmax'* *'fdn'*
3562'foldnestmax' 'fdn' number (default: 20)
3563 local to window
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003564 {not available when compiled without the |+folding|
3565 feature}
3566 Sets the maximum nesting of folds for the "indent" and "syntax"
3567 methods. This avoids that too many folds will be created. Using more
3568 than 20 doesn't work, because the internal limit is 20.
3569
3570 *'foldopen'* *'fdo'*
3571'foldopen' 'fdo' string (default: "block,hor,mark,percent,quickfix,
3572 search,tag,undo")
3573 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003574 {not available when compiled without the |+folding|
3575 feature}
3576 Specifies for which type of commands folds will be opened, if the
Bram Moolenaarcbaff5e2022-04-08 17:45:08 +01003577 command moves the cursor into a closed fold. It is a comma-separated
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003578 list of items.
Bram Moolenaar05365702010-10-27 18:34:44 +02003579 NOTE: When the command is part of a mapping this option is not used.
3580 Add the |zv| command to the mapping to get the same effect.
3581 (rationale: the mapping may want to control opening folds itself)
3582
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003583 item commands ~
3584 all any
3585 block "(", "{", "[[", "[{", etc.
3586 hor horizontal movements: "l", "w", "fx", etc.
3587 insert any command in Insert mode
3588 jump far jumps: "G", "gg", etc.
3589 mark jumping to a mark: "'m", CTRL-O, etc.
3590 percent "%"
3591 quickfix ":cn", ":crew", ":make", etc.
3592 search search for a pattern: "/", "n", "*", "gd", etc.
3593 (not for a search pattern in a ":" command)
Bram Moolenaar910f66f2006-04-05 20:41:53 +00003594 Also for |[s| and |]s|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003595 tag jumping to a tag: ":ta", CTRL-T, etc.
3596 undo undo or redo: "u" and CTRL-R
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003597 When a movement command is used for an operator (e.g., "dl" or "y%")
3598 this option is not used. This means the operator will include the
3599 whole closed fold.
3600 Note that vertical movements are not here, because it would make it
3601 very difficult to move onto a closed fold.
3602 In insert mode the folds containing the cursor will always be open
3603 when text is inserted.
3604 To close folds you can re-apply 'foldlevel' with the |zx| command or
3605 set the 'foldclose' option to "all".
3606
3607 *'foldtext'* *'fdt'*
3608'foldtext' 'fdt' string (default: "foldtext()")
3609 local to window
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003610 {not available when compiled without the |+folding|
3611 feature}
3612 An expression which is used to specify the text displayed for a closed
Bram Moolenaar6f4754b2022-01-23 12:07:04 +00003613 fold. The context is set to the script where 'foldexpr' was set,
3614 script-local items can be accessed. See |fold-foldtext| for the
3615 usage.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003616
Bram Moolenaar30b65812012-07-12 22:01:11 +02003617 The expression will be evaluated in the |sandbox| if set from a
3618 modeline, see |sandbox-option|.
Bram Moolenaar110289e2019-05-23 15:38:06 +02003619 This option cannot be set in a modeline when 'modelineexpr' is off.
Bram Moolenaarb71eaae2006-01-20 23:10:18 +00003620
3621 It is not allowed to change text or jump to another window while
3622 evaluating 'foldtext' |textlock|.
3623
Bram Moolenaarc95a3022016-06-12 23:01:46 +02003624 *'formatexpr'* *'fex'*
3625'formatexpr' 'fex' string (default "")
3626 local to buffer
Bram Moolenaarc95a3022016-06-12 23:01:46 +02003627 {not available when compiled without the |+eval|
3628 feature}
3629 Expression which is evaluated to format a range of lines for the |gq|
3630 operator or automatic formatting (see 'formatoptions'). When this
3631 option is empty 'formatprg' is used.
3632
3633 The |v:lnum| variable holds the first line to be formatted.
3634 The |v:count| variable holds the number of lines to be formatted.
3635 The |v:char| variable holds the character that is going to be
3636 inserted if the expression is being evaluated due to
3637 automatic formatting. This can be empty. Don't insert
3638 it yet!
3639
3640 Example: >
3641 :set formatexpr=mylang#Format()
3642< This will invoke the mylang#Format() function in the
3643 autoload/mylang.vim file in 'runtimepath'. |autoload|
3644
3645 The expression is also evaluated when 'textwidth' is set and adding
3646 text beyond that limit. This happens under the same conditions as
3647 when internal formatting is used. Make sure the cursor is kept in the
3648 same spot relative to the text then! The |mode()| function will
3649 return "i" or "R" in this situation.
Bram Moolenaar22f1d0e2018-02-27 14:53:30 +01003650
Bram Moolenaarc95a3022016-06-12 23:01:46 +02003651 When the expression evaluates to non-zero Vim will fall back to using
3652 the internal format mechanism.
3653
Yegappan Lakshmanan8bb65f22021-12-26 10:51:39 +00003654 If the expression starts with s: or |<SID>|, then it is replaced with
3655 the script ID (|local-function|). Example: >
3656 set formatexpr=s:MyFormatExpr()
3657 set formatexpr=<SID>SomeFormatExpr()
Bram Moolenaar6f4754b2022-01-23 12:07:04 +00003658< Otherwise, the expression is evaluated in the context of the script
3659 where the option was set, thus script-local items are available.
3660
Bram Moolenaarc95a3022016-06-12 23:01:46 +02003661 The expression will be evaluated in the |sandbox| when set from a
3662 modeline, see |sandbox-option|. That stops the option from working,
3663 since changing the buffer text is not allowed.
Bram Moolenaar110289e2019-05-23 15:38:06 +02003664 This option cannot be set in a modeline when 'modelineexpr' is off.
Bram Moolenaar036986f2017-03-16 17:41:02 +01003665 NOTE: This option is set to "" when 'compatible' is set.
Bram Moolenaarc95a3022016-06-12 23:01:46 +02003666
Bram Moolenaar86b68352004-12-27 21:59:20 +00003667 *'formatlistpat'* *'flp'*
3668'formatlistpat' 'flp' string (default: "^\s*\d\+[\]:.)}\t ]\s*")
3669 local to buffer
Bram Moolenaar86b68352004-12-27 21:59:20 +00003670 A pattern that is used to recognize a list header. This is used for
3671 the "n" flag in 'formatoptions'.
3672 The pattern must match exactly the text that will be the indent for
Bram Moolenaar677ee682005-01-27 14:41:15 +00003673 the line below it. You can use |/\ze| to mark the end of the match
Bram Moolenaar86b68352004-12-27 21:59:20 +00003674 while still checking more characters. There must be a character
3675 following the pattern, when it matches the whole line it is handled
3676 like there is no match.
3677 The default recognizes a number, followed by an optional punctuation
3678 character and white space.
3679
Bram Moolenaar6c60f472019-04-28 16:00:35 +02003680 *'formatoptions'* *'fo'*
3681'formatoptions' 'fo' string (Vim default: "tcq", Vi default: "vt")
3682 local to buffer
3683 This is a sequence of letters which describes how automatic
3684 formatting is to be done. See |fo-table|. When the 'paste' option is
3685 on, no formatting is done (like 'formatoptions' is empty). Commas can
3686 be inserted for readability.
3687 To avoid problems with flags that are added in the future, use the
3688 "+=" and "-=" feature of ":set" |add-option-flags|.
3689 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
3690 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
3691
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003692 *'formatprg'* *'fp'*
3693'formatprg' 'fp' string (default "")
Bram Moolenaar9be7c042017-01-14 14:28:30 +01003694 global or local to buffer |global-local|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003695 The name of an external program that will be used to format the lines
Bram Moolenaar1d2ba7f2006-02-14 22:29:30 +00003696 selected with the |gq| operator. The program must take the input on
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003697 stdin and produce the output on stdout. The Unix program "fmt" is
Bram Moolenaara5792f52005-11-23 21:25:05 +00003698 such a program.
Bram Moolenaar1d2ba7f2006-02-14 22:29:30 +00003699 If the 'formatexpr' option is not empty it will be used instead.
3700 Otherwise, if 'formatprg' option is an empty string, the internal
3701 format function will be used |C-indenting|.
Bram Moolenaara5792f52005-11-23 21:25:05 +00003702 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|. See |option-backslash|
3703 about including spaces and backslashes.
Bram Moolenaar30b65812012-07-12 22:01:11 +02003704 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
3705 security reasons.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003706
Bram Moolenaard94464e2015-11-02 15:28:18 +01003707 *'fsync'* *'fs'* *'nofsync'* *'nofs'*
Bram Moolenaar293ee4d2004-12-09 21:34:53 +00003708'fsync' 'fs' boolean (default on)
3709 global
Bram Moolenaar293ee4d2004-12-09 21:34:53 +00003710 When on, the library function fsync() will be called after writing a
3711 file. This will flush a file to disk, ensuring that it is safely
3712 written even on filesystems which do metadata-only journaling. This
3713 will force the harddrive to spin up on Linux systems running in laptop
3714 mode, so it may be undesirable in some situations. Be warned that
3715 turning this off increases the chances of data loss after a crash. On
3716 systems without an fsync() implementation, this variable is always
3717 off.
3718 Also see 'swapsync' for controlling fsync() on swap files.
Bram Moolenaar340dd0f2021-10-14 17:52:23 +01003719 'fsync' also applies to |writefile()| (unless a flag is used to
3720 overrule it) and when writing undo files (see |undo-persistence|).
Bram Moolenaar110289e2019-05-23 15:38:06 +02003721 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
3722 security reasons.
Bram Moolenaar293ee4d2004-12-09 21:34:53 +00003723
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003724 *'gdefault'* *'gd'* *'nogdefault'* *'nogd'*
3725'gdefault' 'gd' boolean (default off)
3726 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003727 When on, the ":substitute" flag 'g' is default on. This means that
3728 all matches in a line are substituted instead of one. When a 'g' flag
3729 is given to a ":substitute" command, this will toggle the substitution
3730 of all or one match. See |complex-change|.
3731
3732 command 'gdefault' on 'gdefault' off ~
3733 :s/// subst. all subst. one
3734 :s///g subst. one subst. all
3735 :s///gg subst. all subst. one
3736
3737 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
Bram Moolenaar21020352017-06-13 17:21:04 +02003738 DEPRECATED: Setting this option may break plugins that are not aware
3739 of this option. Also, many users get confused that adding the /g flag
3740 has the opposite effect of that it normally does.
Bram Moolenaar4072ba52020-12-23 13:56:35 +01003741 This option is not used in |Vim9| script.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003742
3743 *'grepformat'* *'gfm'*
Bram Moolenaar6e932462014-09-09 18:48:09 +02003744'grepformat' 'gfm' string (default "%f:%l:%m,%f:%l%m,%f %l%m")
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003745 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003746 Format to recognize for the ":grep" command output.
3747 This is a scanf-like string that uses the same format as the
3748 'errorformat' option: see |errorformat|.
3749
3750 *'grepprg'* *'gp'*
3751'grepprg' 'gp' string (default "grep -n ",
3752 Unix: "grep -n $* /dev/null",
3753 Win32: "findstr /n" or "grep -n",
3754 VMS: "SEARCH/NUMBERS ")
3755 global or local to buffer |global-local|
Bram Moolenaar582fd852005-03-28 20:58:01 +00003756 Program to use for the |:grep| command. This option may contain '%'
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003757 and '#' characters, which are expanded like when used in a command-
3758 line. The placeholder "$*" is allowed to specify where the arguments
3759 will be included. Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|. See
3760 |option-backslash| about including spaces and backslashes.
3761 When your "grep" accepts the "-H" argument, use this to make ":grep"
3762 also work well with a single file: >
3763 :set grepprg=grep\ -nH
Bram Moolenaar7c626922005-02-07 22:01:03 +00003764< Special value: When 'grepprg' is set to "internal" the |:grep| command
Bram Moolenaara6557602006-02-04 22:43:20 +00003765 works like |:vimgrep|, |:lgrep| like |:lvimgrep|, |:grepadd| like
3766 |:vimgrepadd| and |:lgrepadd| like |:lvimgrepadd|.
Bram Moolenaar86b68352004-12-27 21:59:20 +00003767 See also the section |:make_makeprg|, since most of the comments there
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003768 apply equally to 'grepprg'.
3769 For Win32, the default is "findstr /n" if "findstr.exe" can be found,
3770 otherwise it's "grep -n".
3771 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
3772 security reasons.
3773
3774 *'guicursor'* *'gcr'* *E545* *E546* *E548* *E549*
3775'guicursor' 'gcr' string (default "n-v-c:block-Cursor/lCursor,
3776 ve:ver35-Cursor,
3777 o:hor50-Cursor,
3778 i-ci:ver25-Cursor/lCursor,
3779 r-cr:hor20-Cursor/lCursor,
3780 sm:block-Cursor
3781 -blinkwait175-blinkoff150-blinkon175",
Bram Moolenaar5666fcd2019-12-26 14:35:26 +01003782 for Win32 console:
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003783 "n-v-c:block,o:hor50,i-ci:hor15,
3784 r-cr:hor30,sm:block")
3785 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003786 {only available when compiled with GUI enabled, and
Bram Moolenaar5666fcd2019-12-26 14:35:26 +01003787 for Win32 console}
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003788 This option tells Vim what the cursor should look like in different
Bram Moolenaar8024f932020-01-14 19:29:13 +01003789 modes. It fully works in the GUI. In a Win32 console, only the
Bram Moolenaar5666fcd2019-12-26 14:35:26 +01003790 height of the cursor can be changed. This can be done by specifying a
3791 block cursor, or a percentage for a vertical or horizontal cursor.
Bram Moolenaar1e7813a2015-03-31 18:31:03 +02003792 For a console the 't_SI', 't_SR', and 't_EI' escape sequences are
3793 used.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003794
Bram Moolenaarcbaff5e2022-04-08 17:45:08 +01003795 The option is a comma-separated list of parts. Each part consist of a
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003796 mode-list and an argument-list:
3797 mode-list:argument-list,mode-list:argument-list,..
3798 The mode-list is a dash separated list of these modes:
3799 n Normal mode
3800 v Visual mode
3801 ve Visual mode with 'selection' "exclusive" (same as 'v',
3802 if not specified)
3803 o Operator-pending mode
3804 i Insert mode
3805 r Replace mode
3806 c Command-line Normal (append) mode
3807 ci Command-line Insert mode
3808 cr Command-line Replace mode
3809 sm showmatch in Insert mode
3810 a all modes
3811 The argument-list is a dash separated list of these arguments:
3812 hor{N} horizontal bar, {N} percent of the character height
3813 ver{N} vertical bar, {N} percent of the character width
3814 block block cursor, fills the whole character
3815 [only one of the above three should be present]
3816 blinkwait{N} *cursor-blinking*
3817 blinkon{N}
3818 blinkoff{N}
3819 blink times for cursor: blinkwait is the delay before
3820 the cursor starts blinking, blinkon is the time that
3821 the cursor is shown and blinkoff is the time that the
3822 cursor is not shown. The times are in msec. When one
3823 of the numbers is zero, there is no blinking. The
3824 default is: "blinkwait700-blinkon400-blinkoff250".
3825 These numbers are used for a missing entry. This
3826 means that blinking is enabled by default. To switch
3827 blinking off you can use "blinkon0". The cursor only
3828 blinks when Vim is waiting for input, not while
3829 executing a command.
3830 To make the cursor blink in an xterm, see
3831 |xterm-blink|.
3832 {group-name}
3833 a highlight group name, that sets the color and font
3834 for the cursor
3835 {group-name}/{group-name}
3836 Two highlight group names, the first is used when
3837 no language mappings are used, the other when they
3838 are. |language-mapping|
3839
3840 Examples of parts:
3841 n-c-v:block-nCursor in Normal, Command-line and Visual mode, use a
3842 block cursor with colors from the "nCursor"
3843 highlight group
3844 i-ci:ver30-iCursor-blinkwait300-blinkon200-blinkoff150
3845 In Insert and Command-line Insert mode, use a
3846 30% vertical bar cursor with colors from the
3847 "iCursor" highlight group. Blink a bit
3848 faster.
3849
3850 The 'a' mode is different. It will set the given argument-list for
3851 all modes. It does not reset anything to defaults. This can be used
3852 to do a common setting for all modes. For example, to switch off
3853 blinking: "a:blinkon0"
3854
3855 Examples of cursor highlighting: >
3856 :highlight Cursor gui=reverse guifg=NONE guibg=NONE
3857 :highlight Cursor gui=NONE guifg=bg guibg=fg
3858<
3859 *'guifont'* *'gfn'*
Bram Moolenaar251e1912011-06-19 05:09:16 +02003860 *E235* *E596*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003861'guifont' 'gfn' string (default "")
3862 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003863 {only available when compiled with GUI enabled}
3864 This is a list of fonts which will be used for the GUI version of Vim.
Bram Moolenaarf720d0a2019-04-28 14:02:47 +02003865 In its simplest form the value is just one font name.
3866 See |gui-font| for the details.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003867
3868 *'guifontset'* *'gfs'*
3869 *E250* *E252* *E234* *E597* *E598*
3870'guifontset' 'gfs' string (default "")
3871 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003872 {only available when compiled with GUI enabled and
3873 with the |+xfontset| feature}
Bram Moolenaar3df01732017-02-17 22:47:16 +01003874 {not available in the GTK+ GUI}
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003875 When not empty, specifies two (or more) fonts to be used. The first
3876 one for normal English, the second one for your special language. See
3877 |xfontset|.
Bram Moolenaarf720d0a2019-04-28 14:02:47 +02003878
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003879 *'guifontwide'* *'gfw'* *E231* *E533* *E534*
3880'guifontwide' 'gfw' string (default "")
3881 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003882 {only available when compiled with GUI enabled}
3883 When not empty, specifies a comma-separated list of fonts to be used
3884 for double-width characters. The first font that can be loaded is
Bram Moolenaarf720d0a2019-04-28 14:02:47 +02003885 used. See |gui-fontwide|.
Bram Moolenaar0f272122013-01-23 18:37:40 +01003886
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003887 *'guiheadroom'* *'ghr'*
3888'guiheadroom' 'ghr' number (default 50)
3889 global
Bram Moolenaar110289e2019-05-23 15:38:06 +02003890 {only for GTK and X11 GUI}
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003891 The number of pixels subtracted from the screen height when fitting
3892 the GUI window on the screen. Set this before the GUI is started,
3893 e.g., in your |gvimrc| file. When zero, the whole screen height will
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00003894 be used by the window. When positive, the specified number of pixel
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003895 lines will be left for window decorations and other items on the
3896 screen. Set it to a negative value to allow windows taller than the
3897 screen.
3898
Dusan Popovic4eeedc02021-10-16 20:52:05 +01003899 *'guiligatures'* *'gli'* *E1243*
3900'guiligatures' 'gli' string (default "")
3901 global
3902 {only for GTK GUI}
3903 List of ASCII characters that, when combined together, can create more
3904 complex shapes. Each character must be a printable ASCII character
3905 with a value in the 32-127 range.
3906 Example: >
3907 :set guiligatures=!\"#$%&()*+-./:<=>?@[]^_{\|~
3908< Changing this option updates screen output immediately. Set it to an
3909 empty string to disable ligatures.
3910
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003911 *'guioptions'* *'go'*
Bram Moolenaar2c64ca12018-10-19 16:22:31 +02003912'guioptions' 'go' string (default "egmrLtT" (MS-Windows,
3913 "t" is removed in |defaults.vim|),
Bram Moolenaarcbaff5e2022-04-08 17:45:08 +01003914 "aegimrLtT" (GTK and Motif),
Bram Moolenaar8c08b5b2016-07-28 22:24:15 +02003915 )
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003916 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003917 {only available when compiled with GUI enabled}
Bram Moolenaared203462004-06-16 11:19:22 +00003918 This option only has an effect in the GUI version of Vim. It is a
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003919 sequence of letters which describes what components and options of the
3920 GUI should be used.
3921 To avoid problems with flags that are added in the future, use the
3922 "+=" and "-=" feature of ":set" |add-option-flags|.
3923
Bram Moolenaar13568252018-03-16 20:46:58 +01003924 Valid characters are as follows:
3925 *'go-!'*
3926 '!' External commands are executed in a terminal window. Without
3927 this flag the MS-Windows GUI will open a console window to
3928 execute the command. The Unix GUI will simulate a dumb
3929 terminal to list the command output.
3930 The terminal window will be positioned at the bottom, and grow
3931 upwards as needed.
Bram Moolenaarba3ff532018-11-04 14:45:49 +01003932 *'go-a'*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003933 'a' Autoselect: If present, then whenever VISUAL mode is started,
3934 or the Visual area extended, Vim tries to become the owner of
3935 the windowing system's global selection. This means that the
3936 Visually highlighted text is available for pasting into other
3937 applications as well as into Vim itself. When the Visual mode
3938 ends, possibly due to an operation on the text, or when an
3939 application wants to paste the selection, the highlighted text
3940 is automatically yanked into the "* selection register.
3941 Thus the selection is still available for pasting into other
3942 applications after the VISUAL mode has ended.
3943 If not present, then Vim won't become the owner of the
3944 windowing system's global selection unless explicitly told to
3945 by a yank or delete operation for the "* register.
3946 The same applies to the modeless selection.
Bram Moolenaarc0885aa2012-07-10 16:49:23 +02003947 *'go-P'*
3948 'P' Like autoselect but using the "+ register instead of the "*
Bram Moolenaar3848e002016-03-19 18:42:29 +01003949 register.
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00003950 *'go-A'*
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00003951 'A' Autoselect for the modeless selection. Like 'a', but only
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003952 applies to the modeless selection.
3953
3954 'guioptions' autoselect Visual autoselect modeless ~
3955 "" - -
3956 "a" yes yes
3957 "A" - yes
3958 "aA" yes yes
3959
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00003960 *'go-c'*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003961 'c' Use console dialogs instead of popup dialogs for simple
3962 choices.
Bram Moolenaar50bf7ce2019-09-15 13:17:00 +02003963 *'go-d'*
3964 'd' Use dark theme variant if available. Currently only works for
3965 GTK+ GUI.
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00003966 *'go-e'*
Bram Moolenaare224ffa2006-03-01 00:01:28 +00003967 'e' Add tab pages when indicated with 'showtabline'.
Bram Moolenaar5c8837f2006-02-25 21:52:33 +00003968 'guitablabel' can be used to change the text in the labels.
3969 When 'e' is missing a non-GUI tab pages line may be used.
Bram Moolenaard68071d2006-05-02 22:08:30 +00003970 The GUI tabs are only supported on some systems, currently
Bram Moolenaarb3f74062020-02-26 16:16:53 +01003971 GTK, Motif, Mac OS/X, Haiku, and MS-Windows.
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00003972 *'go-f'*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003973 'f' Foreground: Don't use fork() to detach the GUI from the shell
3974 where it was started. Use this for programs that wait for the
3975 editor to finish (e.g., an e-mail program). Alternatively you
3976 can use "gvim -f" or ":gui -f" to start the GUI in the
3977 foreground. |gui-fork|
3978 Note: Set this option in the vimrc file. The forking may have
Bram Moolenaar910f66f2006-04-05 20:41:53 +00003979 happened already when the |gvimrc| file is read.
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00003980 *'go-i'*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003981 'i' Use a Vim icon. For GTK with KDE it is used in the left-upper
3982 corner of the window. It's black&white on non-GTK, because of
3983 limitations of X11. For a color icon, see |X11-icon|.
Bram Moolenaar0bc380a2010-07-10 13:52:13 +02003984 *'go-m'*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003985 'm' Menu bar is present.
Bram Moolenaar0bc380a2010-07-10 13:52:13 +02003986 *'go-M'*
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00003987 'M' The system menu "$VIMRUNTIME/menu.vim" is not sourced. Note
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003988 that this flag must be added in the .vimrc file, before
Bram Moolenaar910f66f2006-04-05 20:41:53 +00003989 switching on syntax or filetype recognition (when the |gvimrc|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003990 file is sourced the system menu has already been loaded; the
Bram Moolenaar01164a62017-11-02 22:58:42 +01003991 `:syntax on` and `:filetype on` commands load the menu too).
Bram Moolenaar0bc380a2010-07-10 13:52:13 +02003992 *'go-g'*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003993 'g' Grey menu items: Make menu items that are not active grey. If
3994 'g' is not included inactive menu items are not shown at all.
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00003995 *'go-t'*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003996 't' Include tearoff menu items. Currently only works for Win32,
3997 GTK+, and Motif 1.2 GUI.
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00003998 *'go-T'*
Bram Moolenaarcbaff5e2022-04-08 17:45:08 +01003999 'T' Include Toolbar. Currently only in Win32, GTK+, Motif and
4000 Photon GUIs.
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00004001 *'go-r'*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004002 'r' Right-hand scrollbar is always present.
Bram Moolenaar0bc380a2010-07-10 13:52:13 +02004003 *'go-R'*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004004 'R' Right-hand scrollbar is present when there is a vertically
4005 split window.
Bram Moolenaar0bc380a2010-07-10 13:52:13 +02004006 *'go-l'*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004007 'l' Left-hand scrollbar is always present.
Bram Moolenaar0bc380a2010-07-10 13:52:13 +02004008 *'go-L'*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004009 'L' Left-hand scrollbar is present when there is a vertically
4010 split window.
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00004011 *'go-b'*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004012 'b' Bottom (horizontal) scrollbar is present. Its size depends on
4013 the longest visible line, or on the cursor line if the 'h'
4014 flag is included. |gui-horiz-scroll|
Bram Moolenaar0bc380a2010-07-10 13:52:13 +02004015 *'go-h'*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004016 'h' Limit horizontal scrollbar size to the length of the cursor
4017 line. Reduces computations. |gui-horiz-scroll|
4018
4019 And yes, you may even have scrollbars on the left AND the right if
4020 you really want to :-). See |gui-scrollbars| for more information.
4021
Bram Moolenaar0bc380a2010-07-10 13:52:13 +02004022 *'go-v'*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004023 'v' Use a vertical button layout for dialogs. When not included,
4024 a horizontal layout is preferred, but when it doesn't fit a
Bram Moolenaardad44732021-03-31 20:07:33 +02004025 vertical layout is used anyway. Not supported in GTK 3.
Bram Moolenaar0bc380a2010-07-10 13:52:13 +02004026 *'go-p'*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004027 'p' Use Pointer callbacks for X11 GUI. This is required for some
4028 window managers. If the cursor is not blinking or hollow at
4029 the right moment, try adding this flag. This must be done
Bram Moolenaar910f66f2006-04-05 20:41:53 +00004030 before starting the GUI. Set it in your |gvimrc|. Adding or
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004031 removing it after the GUI has started has no effect.
Bram Moolenaar0bc380a2010-07-10 13:52:13 +02004032 *'go-F'*
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00004033 'F' Add a footer. Only for Motif. See |gui-footer|.
Bram Moolenaar8ac44152017-11-09 18:33:29 +01004034 *'go-k'*
4035 'k' Keep the GUI window size when adding/removing a scrollbar, or
4036 toolbar, tabline, etc. Instead, the behavior is similar to
4037 when the window is maximized and will adjust 'lines' and
4038 'columns' to fit to the window. Without the 'k' flag Vim will
Bram Moolenaar51b0f372017-11-18 18:52:04 +01004039 try to keep 'lines' and 'columns' the same when adding and
Bram Moolenaar8ac44152017-11-09 18:33:29 +01004040 removing GUI components.
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00004041
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004042 *'guipty'* *'noguipty'*
4043'guipty' boolean (default on)
4044 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004045 {only available when compiled with GUI enabled}
4046 Only in the GUI: If on, an attempt is made to open a pseudo-tty for
4047 I/O to/from shell commands. See |gui-pty|.
4048
Bram Moolenaar5c8837f2006-02-25 21:52:33 +00004049 *'guitablabel'* *'gtl'*
4050'guitablabel' 'gtl' string (default empty)
4051 global
Bram Moolenaar62a0cb42019-08-18 16:35:23 +02004052 {only available when compiled with GUI enabled}
Bram Moolenaar944697a2022-02-20 19:48:20 +00004053 When non-empty describes the text to use in a label of the GUI tab
Bram Moolenaard68071d2006-05-02 22:08:30 +00004054 pages line. When empty and when the result is empty Vim will use a
4055 default label. See |setting-guitablabel| for more info.
Bram Moolenaar5c8837f2006-02-25 21:52:33 +00004056
Bram Moolenaara23ccb82006-02-27 00:08:02 +00004057 The format of this option is like that of 'statusline'.
Bram Moolenaar57657d82006-04-21 22:12:41 +00004058 'guitabtooltip' is used for the tooltip, see below.
Bram Moolenaar51628222016-12-01 23:03:28 +01004059 The expression will be evaluated in the |sandbox| when set from a
4060 modeline, see |sandbox-option|.
Bram Moolenaar110289e2019-05-23 15:38:06 +02004061 This option cannot be set in a modeline when 'modelineexpr' is off.
Bram Moolenaara23ccb82006-02-27 00:08:02 +00004062
Bram Moolenaar5c8837f2006-02-25 21:52:33 +00004063 Only used when the GUI tab pages line is displayed. 'e' must be
4064 present in 'guioptions'. For the non-GUI tab pages line 'tabline' is
4065 used.
4066
Bram Moolenaar57657d82006-04-21 22:12:41 +00004067 *'guitabtooltip'* *'gtt'*
4068'guitabtooltip' 'gtt' string (default empty)
4069 global
Bram Moolenaar62a0cb42019-08-18 16:35:23 +02004070 {only available when compiled with GUI enabled}
Bram Moolenaar944697a2022-02-20 19:48:20 +00004071 When non-empty describes the text to use in a tooltip for the GUI tab
Bram Moolenaar57657d82006-04-21 22:12:41 +00004072 pages line. When empty Vim will use a default tooltip.
4073 This option is otherwise just like 'guitablabel' above.
Bram Moolenaar8f3f58f2010-01-06 20:52:26 +01004074 You can include a line break. Simplest method is to use |:let|: >
4075 :let &guitabtooltip = "line one\nline two"
4076<
Bram Moolenaar57657d82006-04-21 22:12:41 +00004077
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004078 *'helpfile'* *'hf'*
Bram Moolenaar5666fcd2019-12-26 14:35:26 +01004079'helpfile' 'hf' string (default (MS-Windows) "$VIMRUNTIME\doc\help.txt"
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004080 (others) "$VIMRUNTIME/doc/help.txt")
4081 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004082 Name of the main help file. All distributed help files should be
4083 placed together in one directory. Additionally, all "doc" directories
4084 in 'runtimepath' will be used.
4085 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|. For example:
4086 "$VIMRUNTIME/doc/help.txt". If $VIMRUNTIME is not set, $VIM is also
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00004087 tried. Also see |$VIMRUNTIME| and |option-backslash| about including
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004088 spaces and backslashes.
4089 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
4090 security reasons.
4091
4092 *'helpheight'* *'hh'*
4093'helpheight' 'hh' number (default 20)
4094 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004095 Minimal initial height of the help window when it is opened with the
4096 ":help" command. The initial height of the help window is half of the
4097 current window, or (when the 'ea' option is on) the same as other
4098 windows. When the height is less than 'helpheight', the height is
4099 set to 'helpheight'. Set to zero to disable.
4100
4101 *'helplang'* *'hlg'*
4102'helplang' 'hlg' string (default: messages language or empty)
4103 global
4104 {only available when compiled with the |+multi_lang|
4105 feature}
Bram Moolenaarcbaff5e2022-04-08 17:45:08 +01004106 Comma-separated list of languages. Vim will use the first language
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004107 for which the desired help can be found. The English help will always
4108 be used as a last resort. You can add "en" to prefer English over
4109 another language, but that will only find tags that exist in that
4110 language and not in the English help.
4111 Example: >
4112 :set helplang=de,it
4113< This will first search German, then Italian and finally English help
4114 files.
4115 When using |CTRL-]| and ":help!" in a non-English help file Vim will
4116 try to find the tag in the current language before using this option.
4117 See |help-translated|.
4118
4119 *'hidden'* *'hid'* *'nohidden'* *'nohid'*
4120'hidden' 'hid' boolean (default off)
4121 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004122 When off a buffer is unloaded when it is |abandon|ed. When on a
4123 buffer becomes hidden when it is |abandon|ed. If the buffer is still
4124 displayed in another window, it does not become hidden, of course.
Bram Moolenaarcbaff5e2022-04-08 17:45:08 +01004125
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004126 The commands that move through the buffer list sometimes make a buffer
Bram Moolenaarcbaff5e2022-04-08 17:45:08 +01004127 hidden even if the 'hidden' option is off when these three are true:
4128 - the buffer is modified
4129 - 'autowrite' is off or writing is not possible
4130 - the '!' flag was used
4131 Also see |windows.txt|.
4132
Bram Moolenaarcfbc5ee2004-07-02 15:38:35 +00004133 To only make one buffer hidden use the 'bufhidden' option.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004134 This option is set for one command with ":hide {command}" |:hide|.
4135 WARNING: It's easy to forget that you have changes in hidden buffers.
4136 Think twice when using ":q!" or ":qa!".
4137
4138 *'highlight'* *'hl'*
4139'highlight' 'hl' string (default (as a single string):
Bram Moolenaar58b85342016-08-14 19:54:54 +02004140 "8:SpecialKey,~:EndOfBuffer,@:NonText,
4141 d:Directory,e:ErrorMsg,i:IncSearch,
4142 l:Search,m:MoreMsg,M:ModeMsg,n:LineNr,
Bram Moolenaarefae76a2019-10-27 22:54:58 +01004143 a:LineNrAbove,b:LineNrBelow,
Bram Moolenaar58b85342016-08-14 19:54:54 +02004144 N:CursorLineNr,r:Question,s:StatusLine,
4145 S:StatusLineNC,c:VertSplit,t:Title,
Bram Moolenaar9d87a372018-12-18 21:41:50 +01004146 v:Visual,V:VisualNOS,w:WarningMsg,
4147 W:WildMenu,f:Folded,F:FoldColumn,
4148 A:DiffAdd,C:DiffChange,D:DiffDelete,
4149 T:DiffText,>:SignColumn,-:Conceal,
Bram Moolenaarc8c88492018-12-27 23:59:26 +01004150 B:SpellBad,P:SpellCap,R:SpellRare,
Bram Moolenaar9d87a372018-12-18 21:41:50 +01004151 L:SpellLocal,+:Pmenu,=:PmenuSel,
Bram Moolenaar21020352017-06-13 17:21:04 +02004152 x:PmenuSbar,X:PmenuThumb,*:TabLine,
4153 #:TabLineSel,_:TabLineFill,!:CursorColumn,
Bram Moolenaarf55e4c82017-08-01 20:44:53 +02004154 .:CursorLine,o:ColorColumn,q:QuickFixLine,
Bram Moolenaarc572da52017-08-27 16:52:01 +02004155 z:StatusLineTerm,Z:StatusLineTermNC")
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004156 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004157 This option can be used to set highlighting mode for various
Bram Moolenaarcbaff5e2022-04-08 17:45:08 +01004158 occasions. It is a comma-separated list of character pairs. The
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004159 first character in a pair gives the occasion, the second the mode to
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00004160 use for that occasion. The occasions are:
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004161 |hl-SpecialKey| 8 Meta and special keys listed with ":map"
Bram Moolenaar58b85342016-08-14 19:54:54 +02004162 |hl-EndOfBuffer| ~ lines after the last line in the buffer
4163 |hl-NonText| @ '@' at the end of the window and
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004164 characters from 'showbreak'
4165 |hl-Directory| d directories in CTRL-D listing and other special
4166 things in listings
4167 |hl-ErrorMsg| e error messages
4168 h (obsolete, ignored)
4169 |hl-IncSearch| i 'incsearch' highlighting
LemonBoya4399382022-04-09 21:04:08 +01004170 |hl-CurSearch| y current instance of last search pattern
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004171 |hl-Search| l last search pattern highlighting (see 'hlsearch')
4172 |hl-MoreMsg| m |more-prompt|
4173 |hl-ModeMsg| M Mode (e.g., "-- INSERT --")
Bram Moolenaar64486672010-05-16 15:46:46 +02004174 |hl-LineNr| n line number for ":number" and ":#" commands, and
4175 when 'number' or 'relativenumber' option is set.
Bram Moolenaarefae76a2019-10-27 22:54:58 +01004176 |hl-LineNrAbove| a line number above the cursor for when the
4177 'relativenumber' option is set.
4178 |hl-LineNrBelow| b line number below the cursor for when the
4179 'relativenumber' option is set.
Bram Moolenaara3e6bc92013-01-30 14:18:00 +01004180 |hl-CursorLineNr| N like n for when 'cursorline' or 'relativenumber' is
4181 set.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004182 |hl-Question| r |hit-enter| prompt and yes/no questions
4183 |hl-StatusLine| s status line of current window |status-line|
Bram Moolenaarb0d45e72017-11-05 18:19:24 +01004184 |hl-StatusLineNC| S status lines of not-current windows
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004185 |hl-Title| t Titles for output from ":set all", ":autocmd" etc.
4186 |hl-VertSplit| c column used to separate vertically split windows
4187 |hl-Visual| v Visual mode
4188 |hl-VisualNOS| V Visual mode when Vim does is "Not Owning the
4189 Selection" Only X11 Gui's |gui-x11| and
4190 |xterm-clipboard|.
4191 |hl-WarningMsg| w warning messages
4192 |hl-WildMenu| W wildcard matches displayed for 'wildmenu'
4193 |hl-Folded| f line used for closed folds
4194 |hl-FoldColumn| F 'foldcolumn'
Bram Moolenaar0d9c26d2005-07-02 23:19:16 +00004195 |hl-DiffAdd| A added line in diff mode
4196 |hl-DiffChange| C changed line in diff mode
4197 |hl-DiffDelete| D deleted line in diff mode
4198 |hl-DiffText| T inserted text in diff mode
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004199 |hl-SignColumn| > column used for |signs|
Bram Moolenaar9d87a372018-12-18 21:41:50 +01004200 |hl-Conceal| - the placeholders used for concealed characters
4201 (see 'conceallevel')
Bram Moolenaar217ad922005-03-20 22:37:15 +00004202 |hl-SpellBad| B misspelled word |spell|
Bram Moolenaar9855d6b2010-07-18 14:34:51 +02004203 |hl-SpellCap| P word that should start with capital |spell|
Bram Moolenaar217ad922005-03-20 22:37:15 +00004204 |hl-SpellRare| R rare word |spell|
4205 |hl-SpellLocal| L word from other region |spell|
Bram Moolenaar9d87a372018-12-18 21:41:50 +01004206 |hl-Pmenu| + popup menu normal line
4207 |hl-PmenuSel| = popup menu selected line
4208 |hl-PmenuSbar| x popup menu scrollbar
4209 |hl-PmenuThumb| X popup menu scrollbar thumb
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004210
4211 The display modes are:
4212 r reverse (termcap entry "mr" and "me")
4213 i italic (termcap entry "ZH" and "ZR")
4214 b bold (termcap entry "md" and "me")
4215 s standout (termcap entry "so" and "se")
4216 u underline (termcap entry "us" and "ue")
Bram Moolenaare2cc9702005-03-15 22:43:58 +00004217 c undercurl (termcap entry "Cs" and "Ce")
Bram Moolenaarcf4b00c2017-09-02 18:33:56 +02004218 t strikethrough (termcap entry "Ts" and "Te")
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004219 n no highlighting
4220 - no highlighting
4221 : use a highlight group
4222 The default is used for occasions that are not included.
4223 If you want to change what the display modes do, see |dos-colors|
4224 for an example.
4225 When using the ':' display mode, this must be followed by the name of
4226 a highlight group. A highlight group can be used to define any type
4227 of highlighting, including using color. See |:highlight| on how to
4228 define one. The default uses a different group for each occasion.
4229 See |highlight-default| for the default highlight groups.
4230
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004231 *'history'* *'hi'*
Bram Moolenaar8c08b5b2016-07-28 22:24:15 +02004232'history' 'hi' number (Vim default: 50, Vi default: 0,
4233 set to 200 in |defaults.vim|)
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004234 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004235 A history of ":" commands, and a history of previous search patterns
Bram Moolenaar78159bb2014-06-25 11:48:54 +02004236 is remembered. This option decides how many entries may be stored in
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004237 each of these histories (see |cmdline-editing|).
Bram Moolenaar78159bb2014-06-25 11:48:54 +02004238 The maximum value is 10000.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004239 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
4240 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
4241
4242 *'hkmap'* *'hk'* *'nohkmap'* *'nohk'*
4243'hkmap' 'hk' boolean (default off)
4244 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004245 {only available when compiled with the |+rightleft|
4246 feature}
4247 When on, the keyboard is mapped for the Hebrew character set.
4248 Normally you would set 'allowrevins' and use CTRL-_ in insert mode to
4249 toggle this option. See |rileft.txt|.
4250 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
4251
4252 *'hkmapp'* *'hkp'* *'nohkmapp'* *'nohkp'*
4253'hkmapp' 'hkp' boolean (default off)
4254 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004255 {only available when compiled with the |+rightleft|
4256 feature}
4257 When on, phonetic keyboard mapping is used. 'hkmap' must also be on.
4258 This is useful if you have a non-Hebrew keyboard.
4259 See |rileft.txt|.
4260 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
4261
Bram Moolenaar036986f2017-03-16 17:41:02 +01004262 *'hlsearch'* *'hls'* *'nohlsearch'* *'nohls'*
4263'hlsearch' 'hls' boolean (default off)
4264 global
Bram Moolenaar036986f2017-03-16 17:41:02 +01004265 {not available when compiled without the
4266 |+extra_search| feature}
4267 When there is a previous search pattern, highlight all its matches.
4268 The type of highlighting used can be set with the 'l' occasion in the
4269 'highlight' option. This uses the "Search" highlight group by
4270 default. Note that only the matching text is highlighted, any offsets
4271 are not applied.
4272 See also: 'incsearch' and |:match|.
4273 When you get bored looking at the highlighted matches, you can turn it
4274 off with |:nohlsearch|. This does not change the option value, as
4275 soon as you use a search command, the highlighting comes back.
4276 'redrawtime' specifies the maximum time spent on finding matches.
4277 When the search pattern can match an end-of-line, Vim will try to
4278 highlight all of the matched text. However, this depends on where the
4279 search starts. This will be the first line in the window or the first
4280 line below a closed fold. A match in a previous line which is not
4281 drawn may not continue in a newly drawn line.
4282 You can specify whether the highlight status is restored on startup
4283 with the 'h' flag in 'viminfo' |viminfo-h|.
4284 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
4285
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004286 *'icon'* *'noicon'*
4287'icon' boolean (default off, on when title can be restored)
4288 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004289 When on, the icon text of the window will be set to the value of
4290 'iconstring' (if it is not empty), or to the name of the file
4291 currently being edited. Only the last part of the name is used.
4292 Overridden by the 'iconstring' option.
4293 Only works if the terminal supports setting window icons (currently
4294 only X11 GUI and terminals with a non-empty 't_IS' option - these are
4295 Unix xterm and iris-ansi by default, where 't_IS' is taken from the
4296 builtin termcap).
4297 When Vim was compiled with HAVE_X11 defined, the original icon will be
Bram Moolenaar582fd852005-03-28 20:58:01 +00004298 restored if possible |X11|. See |X11-icon| for changing the icon on
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004299 X11.
Bram Moolenaar3a991dd2014-10-02 01:41:41 +02004300 For MS-Windows the icon can be changed, see |windows-icon|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004301
4302 *'iconstring'*
4303'iconstring' string (default "")
4304 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004305 When this option is not empty, it will be used for the icon text of
4306 the window. This happens only when the 'icon' option is on.
4307 Only works if the terminal supports setting window icon text
4308 (currently only X11 GUI and terminals with a non-empty 't_IS' option).
Bram Moolenaar130cbfc2021-04-07 21:07:20 +02004309 Does not work for MS-Windows.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004310 When Vim was compiled with HAVE_X11 defined, the original icon will be
4311 restored if possible |X11|.
4312 When this option contains printf-style '%' items, they will be
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00004313 expanded according to the rules used for 'statusline'. See
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004314 'titlestring' for example settings.
Bram Moolenaar110289e2019-05-23 15:38:06 +02004315 This option cannot be set in a modeline when 'modelineexpr' is off.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004316 {not available when compiled without the |+statusline| feature}
4317
4318 *'ignorecase'* *'ic'* *'noignorecase'* *'noic'*
4319'ignorecase' 'ic' boolean (default off)
4320 global
4321 Ignore case in search patterns. Also used when searching in the tags
4322 file.
Bram Moolenaar0f6562e2015-11-24 18:48:14 +01004323 Also see 'smartcase' and 'tagcase'.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004324 Can be overruled by using "\c" or "\C" in the pattern, see
4325 |/ignorecase|.
4326
Bram Moolenaarabab85a2013-06-26 19:18:05 +02004327 *'imactivatefunc'* *'imaf'*
4328'imactivatefunc' 'imaf' string (default "")
4329 global
Bram Moolenaarabab85a2013-06-26 19:18:05 +02004330 This option specifies a function that will be called to
Yegappan Lakshmanan7645da52021-12-04 14:02:30 +00004331 activate or deactivate the Input Method. The value can be the name of
4332 a function, a |lambda| or a |Funcref|. See |option-value-function| for
4333 more information.
Bram Moolenaaref8c6172020-07-01 15:12:44 +02004334 It is not used in the MS-Windows GUI version.
Bram Moolenaar110289e2019-05-23 15:38:06 +02004335 The expression will be evaluated in the |sandbox| when set from a
4336 modeline, see |sandbox-option|.
Bram Moolenaarabab85a2013-06-26 19:18:05 +02004337
4338 Example: >
4339 function ImActivateFunc(active)
4340 if a:active
4341 ... do something
4342 else
4343 ... do something
4344 endif
4345 " return value is not used
4346 endfunction
4347 set imactivatefunc=ImActivateFunc
4348<
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004349 *'imactivatekey'* *'imak'*
4350'imactivatekey' 'imak' string (default "")
4351 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004352 {only available when compiled with |+xim| and
Bram Moolenaar67c53842010-05-22 18:28:27 +02004353 |+GUI_GTK|} *E599*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004354 Specifies the key that your Input Method in X-Windows uses for
4355 activation. When this is specified correctly, vim can fully control
4356 IM with 'imcmdline', 'iminsert' and 'imsearch'.
4357 You can't use this option to change the activation key, the option
4358 tells Vim what the key is.
4359 Format:
4360 [MODIFIER_FLAG-]KEY_STRING
4361
4362 These characters can be used for MODIFIER_FLAG (case is ignored):
4363 S Shift key
4364 L Lock key
4365 C Control key
4366 1 Mod1 key
4367 2 Mod2 key
4368 3 Mod3 key
4369 4 Mod4 key
4370 5 Mod5 key
4371 Combinations are allowed, for example "S-C-space" or "SC-space" are
4372 both shift+ctrl+space.
4373 See <X11/keysymdef.h> and XStringToKeysym for KEY_STRING.
4374
4375 Example: >
4376 :set imactivatekey=S-space
4377< "S-space" means shift+space. This is the activation key for kinput2 +
4378 canna (Japanese), and ami (Korean).
4379
4380 *'imcmdline'* *'imc'* *'noimcmdline'* *'noimc'*
4381'imcmdline' 'imc' boolean (default off)
4382 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004383 When set the Input Method is always on when starting to edit a command
4384 line, unless entering a search pattern (see 'imsearch' for that).
4385 Setting this option is useful when your input method allows entering
4386 English characters directly, e.g., when it's used to type accented
4387 characters with dead keys.
4388
Bram Moolenaar8f3f58f2010-01-06 20:52:26 +01004389 *'imdisable'* *'imd'* *'noimdisable'* *'noimd'*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004390'imdisable' 'imd' boolean (default off, on for some systems (SGI))
4391 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004392 When set the Input Method is never used. This is useful to disable
4393 the IM when it doesn't work properly.
4394 Currently this option is on by default for SGI/IRIX machines. This
4395 may change in later releases.
4396
4397 *'iminsert'* *'imi'*
Bram Moolenaar4cf56bb2017-09-16 15:50:32 +02004398'iminsert' 'imi' number (default 0)
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004399 local to buffer
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004400 Specifies whether :lmap or an Input Method (IM) is to be used in
4401 Insert mode. Valid values:
4402 0 :lmap is off and IM is off
4403 1 :lmap is ON and IM is off
4404 2 :lmap is off and IM is ON
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004405 To always reset the option to zero when leaving Insert mode with <Esc>
4406 this can be used: >
4407 :inoremap <ESC> <ESC>:set iminsert=0<CR>
4408< This makes :lmap and IM turn off automatically when leaving Insert
4409 mode.
4410 Note that this option changes when using CTRL-^ in Insert mode
4411 |i_CTRL-^|.
4412 The value is set to 1 when setting 'keymap' to a valid keymap name.
4413 It is also used for the argument of commands like "r" and "f".
Bram Moolenaarcbaff5e2022-04-08 17:45:08 +01004414 The value 0 may not work correctly with Motif with some XIM
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004415 methods. Use 'imdisable' to disable XIM then.
4416
Bram Moolenaar6315a9a2017-11-25 15:20:02 +01004417 You can set 'imactivatefunc' and 'imstatusfunc' to handle IME/XIM
Bram Moolenaard473c8c2018-08-11 18:00:22 +02004418 via external command if Vim is not compiled with the |+xim|,
Bram Moolenaar6315a9a2017-11-25 15:20:02 +01004419 |+multi_byte_ime| or |global-ime|.
4420
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004421 *'imsearch'* *'ims'*
Bram Moolenaar4cf56bb2017-09-16 15:50:32 +02004422'imsearch' 'ims' number (default -1)
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004423 local to buffer
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004424 Specifies whether :lmap or an Input Method (IM) is to be used when
4425 entering a search pattern. Valid values:
4426 -1 the value of 'iminsert' is used, makes it look like
4427 'iminsert' is also used when typing a search pattern
4428 0 :lmap is off and IM is off
4429 1 :lmap is ON and IM is off
4430 2 :lmap is off and IM is ON
4431 Note that this option changes when using CTRL-^ in Command-line mode
4432 |c_CTRL-^|.
4433 The value is set to 1 when it is not -1 and setting the 'keymap'
4434 option to a valid keymap name.
Bram Moolenaarcbaff5e2022-04-08 17:45:08 +01004435 The value 0 may not work correctly with Motif with some XIM
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004436 methods. Use 'imdisable' to disable XIM then.
4437
Bram Moolenaarabab85a2013-06-26 19:18:05 +02004438 *'imstatusfunc'* *'imsf'*
4439'imstatusfunc' 'imsf' string (default "")
4440 global
Bram Moolenaarabab85a2013-06-26 19:18:05 +02004441 This option specifies a function that is called to obtain the status
4442 of Input Method. It must return a positive number when IME is active.
Yegappan Lakshmanan7645da52021-12-04 14:02:30 +00004443 The value can be the name of a function, a |lambda| or a |Funcref|.
4444 See |option-value-function| for more information.
Bram Moolenaaref8c6172020-07-01 15:12:44 +02004445 It is not used in the MS-Windows GUI version.
Bram Moolenaarabab85a2013-06-26 19:18:05 +02004446
4447 Example: >
4448 function ImStatusFunc()
4449 let is_active = ...do something
4450 return is_active ? 1 : 0
4451 endfunction
4452 set imstatusfunc=ImStatusFunc
4453<
4454 NOTE: This function is invoked very often. Keep it fast.
Bram Moolenaar110289e2019-05-23 15:38:06 +02004455 The expression will be evaluated in the |sandbox| when set from a
4456 modeline, see |sandbox-option|.
Bram Moolenaarabab85a2013-06-26 19:18:05 +02004457
Bram Moolenaar5c6dbcb2017-08-30 22:00:20 +02004458 *'imstyle'* *'imst'*
4459'imstyle' 'imst' number (default 1)
4460 global
Bram Moolenaar5c6dbcb2017-08-30 22:00:20 +02004461 {only available when compiled with |+xim| and
4462 |+GUI_GTK|}
Bram Moolenaar37c64c72017-09-19 22:06:03 +02004463 This option specifies the input style of Input Method:
4464 0 use on-the-spot style
4465 1 over-the-spot style
Bram Moolenaar5c6dbcb2017-08-30 22:00:20 +02004466 See: |xim-input-style|
4467
Bram Moolenaar24a98a02017-09-27 22:23:55 +02004468 For a long time on-the-spot style had been used in the GTK version of
4469 vim, however, it is known that it causes troubles when using mappings,
Bram Moolenaar5c6dbcb2017-08-30 22:00:20 +02004470 |single-repeat|, etc. Therefore over-the-spot style becomes the
4471 default now. This should work fine for most people, however if you
4472 have any problem with it, try using on-the-spot style.
Bram Moolenaar110289e2019-05-23 15:38:06 +02004473 The expression will be evaluated in the |sandbox| when set from a
4474 modeline, see |sandbox-option|.
Bram Moolenaar5c6dbcb2017-08-30 22:00:20 +02004475
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004476 *'include'* *'inc'*
4477'include' 'inc' string (default "^\s*#\s*include")
4478 global or local to buffer |global-local|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004479 {not available when compiled without the
4480 |+find_in_path| feature}
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00004481 Pattern to be used to find an include command. It is a search
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004482 pattern, just like for the "/" command (See |pattern|). The default
4483 value is for C programs. This option is used for the commands "[i",
Bram Moolenaar1e015462005-09-25 22:16:38 +00004484 "]I", "[d", etc.
4485 Normally the 'isfname' option is used to recognize the file name that
Bram Moolenaar482aaeb2005-09-29 18:26:07 +00004486 comes after the matched pattern. But if "\zs" appears in the pattern
4487 then the text matched from "\zs" to the end, or until "\ze" if it
4488 appears, is used as the file name. Use this to include characters
4489 that are not in 'isfname', such as a space. You can then use
4490 'includeexpr' to process the matched text.
Bram Moolenaar1e015462005-09-25 22:16:38 +00004491 See |option-backslash| about including spaces and backslashes.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004492
4493 *'includeexpr'* *'inex'*
4494'includeexpr' 'inex' string (default "")
4495 local to buffer
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004496 {not available when compiled without the
Bram Moolenaardb84e452010-08-15 13:50:43 +02004497 |+find_in_path| or |+eval| features}
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004498 Expression to be used to transform the string found with the 'include'
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00004499 option to a file name. Mostly useful to change "." to "/" for Java: >
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004500 :set includeexpr=substitute(v:fname,'\\.','/','g')
4501< The "v:fname" variable will be set to the file name that was detected.
Bram Moolenaarb71eaae2006-01-20 23:10:18 +00004502
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004503 Also used for the |gf| command if an unmodified file name can't be
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00004504 found. Allows doing "gf" on the name after an 'include' statement.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004505 Also used for |<cfile>|.
4506
Yegappan Lakshmanan8bb65f22021-12-26 10:51:39 +00004507 If the expression starts with s: or |<SID>|, then it is replaced with
4508 the script ID (|local-function|). Example: >
4509 set includeexpr=s:MyIncludeExpr(v:fname)
4510 set includeexpr=<SID>SomeIncludeExpr(v:fname)
Bram Moolenaar6f4754b2022-01-23 12:07:04 +00004511< Otherwise, the expression is evaluated in the context of the script
4512 where the option was set, thus script-local items are available.
4513
Bram Moolenaar30b65812012-07-12 22:01:11 +02004514 The expression will be evaluated in the |sandbox| when set from a
4515 modeline, see |sandbox-option|.
Bram Moolenaar110289e2019-05-23 15:38:06 +02004516 This option cannot be set in a modeline when 'modelineexpr' is off.
Bram Moolenaarb71eaae2006-01-20 23:10:18 +00004517
4518 It is not allowed to change text or jump to another window while
4519 evaluating 'includeexpr' |textlock|.
4520
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004521 *'incsearch'* *'is'* *'noincsearch'* *'nois'*
Bram Moolenaar8c08b5b2016-07-28 22:24:15 +02004522'incsearch' 'is' boolean (default off, set in |defaults.vim| if the
4523 +reltime feature is supported)
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004524 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004525 {not available when compiled without the
Bram Moolenaardb84e452010-08-15 13:50:43 +02004526 |+extra_search| features}
Bram Moolenaar21cf8232004-07-16 20:18:37 +00004527 While typing a search command, show where the pattern, as it was typed
4528 so far, matches. The matched string is highlighted. If the pattern
4529 is invalid or not found, nothing is shown. The screen will be updated
4530 often, this is only useful on fast terminals.
Bram Moolenaarfc65cab2018-08-28 22:58:02 +02004531 Also applies to the pattern in commands: >
4532 :global
4533 :lvimgrep
4534 :lvimgrepadd
4535 :smagic
4536 :snomagic
4537 :sort
4538 :substitute
4539 :vglobal
4540 :vimgrep
4541 :vimgrepadd
4542< Note that the match will be shown, but the cursor will return to its
Bram Moolenaar21cf8232004-07-16 20:18:37 +00004543 original position when no match is found and when pressing <Esc>. You
4544 still need to finish the search command with <Enter> to move the
4545 cursor to the match.
Bram Moolenaardc083282016-10-11 08:57:33 +02004546 You can use the CTRL-G and CTRL-T keys to move to the next and
4547 previous match. |c_CTRL-G| |c_CTRL-T|
Bram Moolenaar91a4e822008-01-19 14:59:58 +00004548 When compiled with the |+reltime| feature Vim only searches for about
4549 half a second. With a complicated pattern and/or a lot of text the
4550 match may not be found. This is to avoid that Vim hangs while you
4551 are typing the pattern.
Bram Moolenaar21cf8232004-07-16 20:18:37 +00004552 The highlighting can be set with the 'i' flag in 'highlight'.
Bram Moolenaar2f058492017-11-30 20:27:52 +01004553 When 'hlsearch' is on, all matched strings are highlighted too while
4554 typing a search command. See also: 'hlsearch'.
Bram Moolenaard473c8c2018-08-11 18:00:22 +02004555 If you don't want to turn 'hlsearch' on, but want to highlight all
4556 matches while searching, you can turn on and off 'hlsearch' with
4557 autocmd. Example: >
Bram Moolenaar2e51d9a2017-10-29 16:40:30 +01004558 augroup vimrc-incsearch-highlight
4559 autocmd!
Bram Moolenaarf8f8b2e2017-11-02 19:08:48 +01004560 autocmd CmdlineEnter /,\? :set hlsearch
4561 autocmd CmdlineLeave /,\? :set nohlsearch
Bram Moolenaar2e51d9a2017-10-29 16:40:30 +01004562 augroup END
4563<
Bram Moolenaarefd2bf12006-03-16 21:41:35 +00004564 CTRL-L can be used to add one character from after the current match
Bram Moolenaara9dc3752010-07-11 20:46:53 +02004565 to the command line. If 'ignorecase' and 'smartcase' are set and the
4566 command line has no uppercase characters, the added character is
4567 converted to lowercase.
Bram Moolenaarefd2bf12006-03-16 21:41:35 +00004568 CTRL-R CTRL-W can be used to add the word at the end of the current
4569 match, excluding the characters that were already typed.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004570 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
4571
4572 *'indentexpr'* *'inde'*
4573'indentexpr' 'inde' string (default "")
4574 local to buffer
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004575 {not available when compiled without the |+cindent|
4576 or |+eval| features}
4577 Expression which is evaluated to obtain the proper indent for a line.
4578 It is used when a new line is created, for the |=| operator and
4579 in Insert mode as specified with the 'indentkeys' option.
4580 When this option is not empty, it overrules the 'cindent' and
Bram Moolenaar20f90cf2011-05-19 12:22:51 +02004581 'smartindent' indenting. When 'lisp' is set, this option is
4582 overridden by the Lisp indentation algorithm.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004583 When 'paste' is set this option is not used for indenting.
4584 The expression is evaluated with |v:lnum| set to the line number for
Bram Moolenaar482aaeb2005-09-29 18:26:07 +00004585 which the indent is to be computed. The cursor is also in this line
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004586 when the expression is evaluated (but it may be moved around).
Bram Moolenaar6f4754b2022-01-23 12:07:04 +00004587
Yegappan Lakshmanan8bb65f22021-12-26 10:51:39 +00004588 If the expression starts with s: or |<SID>|, then it is replaced with
4589 the script ID (|local-function|). Example: >
4590 set indentexpr=s:MyIndentExpr()
4591 set indentexpr=<SID>SomeIndentExpr()
Bram Moolenaar6f4754b2022-01-23 12:07:04 +00004592< Otherwise, the expression is evaluated in the context of the script
4593 where the option was set, thus script-local items are available.
4594
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004595 The expression must return the number of spaces worth of indent. It
4596 can return "-1" to keep the current indent (this means 'autoindent' is
4597 used for the indent).
4598 Functions useful for computing the indent are |indent()|, |cindent()|
4599 and |lispindent()|.
4600 The evaluation of the expression must not have side effects! It must
4601 not change the text, jump to another window, etc. Afterwards the
4602 cursor position is always restored, thus the cursor may be moved.
4603 Normally this option would be set to call a function: >
4604 :set indentexpr=GetMyIndent()
4605< Error messages will be suppressed, unless the 'debug' option contains
4606 "msg".
Bram Moolenaarb71eaae2006-01-20 23:10:18 +00004607 See |indent-expression|.
Bram Moolenaar036986f2017-03-16 17:41:02 +01004608 NOTE: This option is set to "" when 'compatible' is set.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004609
Bram Moolenaar30b65812012-07-12 22:01:11 +02004610 The expression will be evaluated in the |sandbox| when set from a
4611 modeline, see |sandbox-option|.
Bram Moolenaar110289e2019-05-23 15:38:06 +02004612 This option cannot be set in a modeline when 'modelineexpr' is off.
Bram Moolenaarb71eaae2006-01-20 23:10:18 +00004613
4614 It is not allowed to change text or jump to another window while
4615 evaluating 'indentexpr' |textlock|.
4616
4617
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004618 *'indentkeys'* *'indk'*
Bram Moolenaarce655742019-01-31 14:12:57 +01004619'indentkeys' 'indk' string (default "0{,0},0),0],:,0#,!^F,o,O,e")
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004620 local to buffer
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004621 {not available when compiled without the |+cindent|
4622 feature}
4623 A list of keys that, when typed in Insert mode, cause reindenting of
4624 the current line. Only happens if 'indentexpr' isn't empty.
4625 The format is identical to 'cinkeys', see |indentkeys-format|.
4626 See |C-indenting| and |indent-expression|.
4627
4628 *'infercase'* *'inf'* *'noinfercase'* *'noinf'*
4629'infercase' 'inf' boolean (default off)
4630 local to buffer
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004631 When doing keyword completion in insert mode |ins-completion|, and
Bram Moolenaar446cb832008-06-24 21:56:24 +00004632 'ignorecase' is also on, the case of the match is adjusted depending
4633 on the typed text. If the typed text contains a lowercase letter
4634 where the match has an upper case letter, the completed part is made
4635 lowercase. If the typed text has no lowercase letters and the match
4636 has a lowercase letter where the typed text has an uppercase letter,
4637 and there is a letter before it, the completed part is made uppercase.
4638 With 'noinfercase' the match is used as-is.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004639
4640 *'insertmode'* *'im'* *'noinsertmode'* *'noim'*
4641'insertmode' 'im' boolean (default off)
4642 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004643 Makes Vim work in a way that Insert mode is the default mode. Useful
4644 if you want to use Vim as a modeless editor. Used for |evim|.
4645 These Insert mode commands will be useful:
4646 - Use the cursor keys to move around.
Bram Moolenaardc1f1642016-08-16 18:33:43 +02004647 - Use CTRL-O to execute one Normal mode command |i_CTRL-O|. When
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004648 this is a mapping, it is executed as if 'insertmode' was off.
4649 Normal mode remains active until the mapping is finished.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004650 - Use CTRL-L to execute a number of Normal mode commands, then use
Bram Moolenaar488c6512005-08-11 20:09:58 +00004651 <Esc> to get back to Insert mode. Note that CTRL-L moves the cursor
4652 left, like <Esc> does when 'insertmode' isn't set. |i_CTRL-L|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004653
4654 These items change when 'insertmode' is set:
4655 - when starting to edit of a file, Vim goes to Insert mode.
4656 - <Esc> in Insert mode is a no-op and beeps.
4657 - <Esc> in Normal mode makes Vim go to Insert mode.
4658 - CTRL-L in Insert mode is a command, it is not inserted.
4659 - CTRL-Z in Insert mode suspends Vim, see |CTRL-Z|. *i_CTRL-Z*
4660 However, when <Esc> is used inside a mapping, it behaves like
4661 'insertmode' was not set. This was done to be able to use the same
4662 mappings with 'insertmode' set or not set.
4663 When executing commands with |:normal| 'insertmode' is not used.
4664
4665 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
4666
4667 *'isfname'* *'isf'*
Bram Moolenaar6f345a12019-12-17 21:27:18 +01004668'isfname' 'isf' string (default for Win32:
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004669 "@,48-57,/,\,.,-,_,+,,,#,$,%,{,},[,],:,@-@,!,~,="
4670 for AMIGA: "@,48-57,/,.,-,_,+,,,$,:"
4671 for VMS: "@,48-57,/,.,-,_,+,,,#,$,%,<,>,[,],:,;,~"
4672 for OS/390: "@,240-249,/,.,-,_,+,,,#,$,%,~,="
4673 otherwise: "@,48-57,/,.,-,_,+,,,#,$,%,~,=")
4674 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004675 The characters specified by this option are included in file names and
4676 path names. Filenames are used for commands like "gf", "[i" and in
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00004677 the tags file. It is also used for "\f" in a |pattern|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004678 Multi-byte characters 256 and above are always included, only the
4679 characters up to 255 are specified with this option.
4680 For UTF-8 the characters 0xa0 to 0xff are included as well.
Bram Moolenaar446cb832008-06-24 21:56:24 +00004681 Think twice before adding white space to this option. Although a
4682 space may appear inside a file name, the effect will be that Vim
4683 doesn't know where a file name starts or ends when doing completion.
4684 It most likely works better without a space in 'isfname'.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004685
4686 Note that on systems using a backslash as path separator, Vim tries to
4687 do its best to make it work as you would expect. That is a bit
4688 tricky, since Vi originally used the backslash to escape special
4689 characters. Vim will not remove a backslash in front of a normal file
4690 name character on these systems, but it will on Unix and alikes. The
4691 '&' and '^' are not included by default, because these are special for
4692 cmd.exe.
4693
4694 The format of this option is a list of parts, separated with commas.
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00004695 Each part can be a single character number or a range. A range is two
4696 character numbers with '-' in between. A character number can be a
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004697 decimal number between 0 and 255 or the ASCII character itself (does
4698 not work for digits). Example:
4699 "_,-,128-140,#-43" (include '_' and '-' and the range
4700 128 to 140 and '#' to 43)
4701 If a part starts with '^', the following character number or range
4702 will be excluded from the option. The option is interpreted from left
4703 to right. Put the excluded character after the range where it is
4704 included. To include '^' itself use it as the last character of the
4705 option or the end of a range. Example:
4706 "^a-z,#,^" (exclude 'a' to 'z', include '#' and '^')
4707 If the character is '@', all characters where isalpha() returns TRUE
4708 are included. Normally these are the characters a to z and A to Z,
4709 plus accented characters. To include '@' itself use "@-@". Examples:
4710 "@,^a-z" All alphabetic characters, excluding lower
Bram Moolenaar446cb832008-06-24 21:56:24 +00004711 case ASCII letters.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004712 "a-z,A-Z,@-@" All letters plus the '@' character.
4713 A comma can be included by using it where a character number is
4714 expected. Example:
4715 "48-57,,,_" Digits, comma and underscore.
4716 A comma can be excluded by prepending a '^'. Example:
4717 " -~,^,,9" All characters from space to '~', excluding
4718 comma, plus <Tab>.
4719 See |option-backslash| about including spaces and backslashes.
4720
4721 *'isident'* *'isi'*
Bram Moolenaar6f345a12019-12-17 21:27:18 +01004722'isident' 'isi' string (default for Win32:
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004723 "@,48-57,_,128-167,224-235"
4724 otherwise: "@,48-57,_,192-255")
4725 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004726 The characters given by this option are included in identifiers.
4727 Identifiers are used in recognizing environment variables and after a
4728 match of the 'define' option. It is also used for "\i" in a
Bram Moolenaar582fd852005-03-28 20:58:01 +00004729 |pattern|. See 'isfname' for a description of the format of this
Bram Moolenaar95bafa22018-10-02 13:26:25 +02004730 option. For '@' only characters up to 255 are used.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004731 Careful: If you change this option, it might break expanding
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00004732 environment variables. E.g., when '/' is included and Vim tries to
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004733 expand "$HOME/.viminfo". Maybe you should change 'iskeyword' instead.
4734
4735 *'iskeyword'* *'isk'*
Bram Moolenaar6f345a12019-12-17 21:27:18 +01004736'iskeyword' 'isk' string (Vim default for Win32:
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004737 "@,48-57,_,128-167,224-235"
4738 otherwise: "@,48-57,_,192-255"
4739 Vi default: "@,48-57,_")
4740 local to buffer
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004741 Keywords are used in searching and recognizing with many commands:
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00004742 "w", "*", "[i", etc. It is also used for "\k" in a |pattern|. See
Bram Moolenaar95bafa22018-10-02 13:26:25 +02004743 'isfname' for a description of the format of this option. For '@'
Bram Moolenaar4c295022021-05-02 17:19:11 +02004744 characters above 255 check the "word" character class (any character
4745 that is not white space or punctuation).
Bram Moolenaar95bafa22018-10-02 13:26:25 +02004746 For C programs you could use "a-z,A-Z,48-57,_,.,-,>".
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004747 For a help file it is set to all non-blank printable characters except
4748 '*', '"' and '|' (so that CTRL-] on a command finds the help for that
4749 command).
4750 When the 'lisp' option is on the '-' character is always included.
Bram Moolenaarb8060fe2016-01-19 22:29:28 +01004751 This option also influences syntax highlighting, unless the syntax
4752 uses |:syn-iskeyword|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004753 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
4754 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
4755
4756 *'isprint'* *'isp'*
Bram Moolenaar3d1cde82020-08-15 18:55:18 +02004757'isprint' 'isp' string (default for Win32 and macOS:
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004758 "@,~-255"; otherwise: "@,161-255")
4759 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004760 The characters given by this option are displayed directly on the
4761 screen. It is also used for "\p" in a |pattern|. The characters from
4762 space (ASCII 32) to '~' (ASCII 126) are always displayed directly,
4763 even when they are not included in 'isprint' or excluded. See
4764 'isfname' for a description of the format of this option.
4765
4766 Non-printable characters are displayed with two characters:
4767 0 - 31 "^@" - "^_"
4768 32 - 126 always single characters
4769 127 "^?"
4770 128 - 159 "~@" - "~_"
4771 160 - 254 "| " - "|~"
4772 255 "~?"
4773 When 'encoding' is a Unicode one, illegal bytes from 128 to 255 are
4774 displayed as <xx>, with the hexadecimal value of the byte.
4775 When 'display' contains "uhex" all unprintable characters are
4776 displayed as <xx>.
Bram Moolenaar8f3f58f2010-01-06 20:52:26 +01004777 The SpecialKey highlighting will be used for unprintable characters.
4778 |hl-SpecialKey|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004779
4780 Multi-byte characters 256 and above are always included, only the
4781 characters up to 255 are specified with this option. When a character
4782 is printable but it is not available in the current font, a
4783 replacement character will be shown.
4784 Unprintable and zero-width Unicode characters are displayed as <xxxx>.
4785 There is no option to specify these characters.
4786
4787 *'joinspaces'* *'js'* *'nojoinspaces'* *'nojs'*
4788'joinspaces' 'js' boolean (default on)
4789 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004790 Insert two spaces after a '.', '?' and '!' with a join command.
4791 When 'cpoptions' includes the 'j' flag, only do this after a '.'.
4792 Otherwise only one space is inserted.
4793 NOTE: This option is set when 'compatible' is set.
4794
4795 *'key'*
4796'key' string (default "")
4797 local to buffer
Bram Moolenaar996343d2010-07-04 22:20:21 +02004798 {only available when compiled with the |+cryptv|
4799 feature}
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004800 The key that is used for encrypting and decrypting the current buffer.
Bram Moolenaar40e6a712010-05-16 22:32:54 +02004801 See |encryption| and 'cryptmethod'.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004802 Careful: Do not set the key value by hand, someone might see the typed
4803 key. Use the |:X| command. But you can make 'key' empty: >
4804 :set key=
4805< It is not possible to get the value of this option with ":set key" or
4806 "echo &key". This is to avoid showing it to someone who shouldn't
4807 know. It also means you cannot see it yourself once you have set it,
4808 be careful not to make a typing error!
Bram Moolenaard58e9292011-02-09 17:07:58 +01004809 You can use "&key" in an expression to detect whether encryption is
4810 enabled. When 'key' is set it returns "*****" (five stars).
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004811
4812 *'keymap'* *'kmp'* *E544*
4813'keymap' 'kmp' string (default "")
4814 local to buffer
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004815 {only available when compiled with the |+keymap|
4816 feature}
4817 Name of a keyboard mapping. See |mbyte-keymap|.
4818 Setting this option to a valid keymap name has the side effect of
4819 setting 'iminsert' to one, so that the keymap becomes effective.
4820 'imsearch' is also set to one, unless it was -1
Bram Moolenaar293ee4d2004-12-09 21:34:53 +00004821 Only normal file name characters can be used, "/\*?[|<>" are illegal.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004822
4823 *'keymodel'* *'km'*
4824'keymodel' 'km' string (default "")
4825 global
Bram Moolenaarcbaff5e2022-04-08 17:45:08 +01004826 List of comma-separated words, which enable special things that keys
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004827 can do. These values can be used:
4828 startsel Using a shifted special key starts selection (either
4829 Select mode or Visual mode, depending on "key" being
4830 present in 'selectmode').
4831 stopsel Using a not-shifted special key stops selection.
4832 Special keys in this context are the cursor keys, <End>, <Home>,
4833 <PageUp> and <PageDown>.
4834 The 'keymodel' option is set by the |:behave| command.
4835
4836 *'keywordprg'* *'kp'*
4837'keywordprg' 'kp' string (default "man" or "man -s", DOS: ":help",
Bram Moolenaar2ff8b642016-05-24 10:46:45 +02004838 VMS: "help")
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004839 global or local to buffer |global-local|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004840 Program to use for the |K| command. Environment variables are
4841 expanded |:set_env|. ":help" may be used to access the Vim internal
4842 help. (Note that previously setting the global option to the empty
4843 value did this, which is now deprecated.)
Bram Moolenaar2ff8b642016-05-24 10:46:45 +02004844 When the first character is ":", the command is invoked as a Vim
4845 Ex command prefixed with [count].
4846 When "man", "man -s" or an Ex command is used, Vim will automatically
4847 translate a count for the "K" command and pass it as the first
4848 argument. For "man -s" the "-s" is removed when there is no count.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004849 See |option-backslash| about including spaces and backslashes.
4850 Example: >
4851 :set keywordprg=man\ -s
4852< This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
4853 security reasons.
4854
4855 *'langmap'* *'lmap'* *E357* *E358*
4856'langmap' 'lmap' string (default "")
4857 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004858 {only available when compiled with the |+langmap|
4859 feature}
4860 This option allows switching your keyboard into a special language
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00004861 mode. When you are typing text in Insert mode the characters are
Bram Moolenaarfa735342016-01-03 22:14:44 +01004862 inserted directly. When in Normal mode the 'langmap' option takes
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004863 care of translating these special characters to the original meaning
4864 of the key. This means you don't have to change the keyboard mode to
4865 be able to execute Normal mode commands.
4866 This is the opposite of the 'keymap' option, where characters are
4867 mapped in Insert mode.
Bram Moolenaarb17893a2020-03-14 08:19:51 +01004868 Also consider setting 'langremap' to off, to prevent 'langmap' from
4869 applying to characters resulting from a mapping.
Bram Moolenaare968e362014-05-13 20:23:24 +02004870 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
4871 security reasons.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004872
Bram Moolenaarfd2ac762006-03-01 22:09:21 +00004873 Example (for Greek, in UTF-8): *greek* >
4874 :set langmap=ΑA,ΒB,ΨC,ΔD,ΕE,ΦF,ΓG,ΗH,ΙI,ΞJ,ΚK,ΛL,ΜM,ΝN,ΟO,ΠP,QQ,ΡR,ΣS,ΤT,ΘU,ΩV,WW,ΧX,ΥY,ΖZ,αa,βb,ψc,δd,εe,φf,γg,ηh,ιi,ξj,κk,λl,μm,νn,οo,πp,qq,ρr,σs,τt,θu,ωv,ςw,χx,υy,ζz
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004875< Example (exchanges meaning of z and y for commands): >
4876 :set langmap=zy,yz,ZY,YZ
4877<
4878 The 'langmap' option is a list of parts, separated with commas. Each
4879 part can be in one of two forms:
4880 1. A list of pairs. Each pair is a "from" character immediately
4881 followed by the "to" character. Examples: "aA", "aAbBcC".
4882 2. A list of "from" characters, a semi-colon and a list of "to"
4883 characters. Example: "abc;ABC"
4884 Example: "aA,fgh;FGH,cCdDeE"
4885 Special characters need to be preceded with a backslash. These are
Bram Moolenaar4f4d51a2020-10-11 13:57:40 +02004886 ";", ',', '"', '|' and backslash itself.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004887
4888 This will allow you to activate vim actions without having to switch
4889 back and forth between the languages. Your language characters will
4890 be understood as normal vim English characters (according to the
4891 langmap mappings) in the following cases:
4892 o Normal/Visual mode (commands, buffer/register names, user mappings)
4893 o Insert/Replace Mode: Register names after CTRL-R
4894 o Insert/Replace Mode: Mappings
4895 Characters entered in Command-line mode will NOT be affected by
4896 this option. Note that this option can be changed at any time
4897 allowing to switch between mappings for different languages/encodings.
4898 Use a mapping to avoid having to type it each time!
4899
4900 *'langmenu'* *'lm'*
4901'langmenu' 'lm' string (default "")
4902 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004903 {only available when compiled with the |+menu| and
4904 |+multi_lang| features}
4905 Language to use for menu translation. Tells which file is loaded
4906 from the "lang" directory in 'runtimepath': >
Bram Moolenaarc51cf032022-02-26 12:25:45 +00004907 "lang/menu_" .. &langmenu .. ".vim"
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004908< (without the spaces). For example, to always use the Dutch menus, no
4909 matter what $LANG is set to: >
4910 :set langmenu=nl_NL.ISO_8859-1
4911< When 'langmenu' is empty, |v:lang| is used.
Bram Moolenaar293ee4d2004-12-09 21:34:53 +00004912 Only normal file name characters can be used, "/\*?[|<>" are illegal.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004913 If your $LANG is set to a non-English language but you do want to use
4914 the English menus: >
4915 :set langmenu=none
4916< This option must be set before loading menus, switching on filetype
4917 detection or syntax highlighting. Once the menus are defined setting
4918 this option has no effect. But you could do this: >
4919 :source $VIMRUNTIME/delmenu.vim
4920 :set langmenu=de_DE.ISO_8859-1
4921 :source $VIMRUNTIME/menu.vim
4922< Warning: This deletes all menus that you defined yourself!
4923
Bram Moolenaard94464e2015-11-02 15:28:18 +01004924 *'langnoremap'* *'lnr'* *'nolangnoremap'* *'nolnr'*
Bram Moolenaar8c08b5b2016-07-28 22:24:15 +02004925'langnoremap' 'lnr' boolean (default off, set in |defaults.vim|)
Bram Moolenaar4391cf92014-11-05 17:44:52 +01004926 global
Bram Moolenaar4391cf92014-11-05 17:44:52 +01004927 {only available when compiled with the |+langmap|
4928 feature}
Bram Moolenaare4a3bcf2016-08-26 19:52:37 +02004929 This is just like 'langremap' but with the value inverted. It only
4930 exists for backwards compatibility. When setting 'langremap' then
4931 'langnoremap' is set to the inverted value, and the other way around.
4932
4933 *'langremap'* *'lrm'* *'nolangremap'* *'nolrm'*
Bram Moolenaarb17893a2020-03-14 08:19:51 +01004934'langremap' 'lrm' boolean (default on, set to off in |defaults.vim|)
Bram Moolenaare4a3bcf2016-08-26 19:52:37 +02004935 global
Bram Moolenaare4a3bcf2016-08-26 19:52:37 +02004936 {only available when compiled with the |+langmap|
4937 feature}
4938 When off, setting 'langmap' does not apply to characters resulting from
Bram Moolenaar4391cf92014-11-05 17:44:52 +01004939 a mapping. This basically means, if you noticed that setting
Bram Moolenaare4a3bcf2016-08-26 19:52:37 +02004940 'langmap' disables some of your mappings, try resetting this option.
4941 This option defaults to on for backwards compatibility. Set it off if
Bram Moolenaar4391cf92014-11-05 17:44:52 +01004942 that works for you to avoid mappings to break.
4943
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004944 *'laststatus'* *'ls'*
4945'laststatus' 'ls' number (default 1)
4946 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004947 The value of this option influences when the last window will have a
4948 status line:
4949 0: never
4950 1: only if there are at least two windows
4951 2: always
4952 The screen looks nicer with a status line if you have several
4953 windows, but it takes another screen line. |status-line|
4954
4955 *'lazyredraw'* *'lz'* *'nolazyredraw'* *'nolz'*
4956'lazyredraw' 'lz' boolean (default off)
4957 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004958 When this option is set, the screen will not be redrawn while
4959 executing macros, registers and other commands that have not been
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00004960 typed. Also, updating the window title is postponed. To force an
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004961 update use |:redraw|.
4962
4963 *'linebreak'* *'lbr'* *'nolinebreak'* *'nolbr'*
4964'linebreak' 'lbr' boolean (default off)
4965 local to window
Bram Moolenaardb84e452010-08-15 13:50:43 +02004966 {not available when compiled without the |+linebreak|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004967 feature}
Bram Moolenaar946e27a2014-06-25 18:50:27 +02004968 If on, Vim will wrap long lines at a character in 'breakat' rather
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004969 than at the last character that fits on the screen. Unlike
4970 'wrapmargin' and 'textwidth', this does not insert <EOL>s in the file,
Bram Moolenaar946e27a2014-06-25 18:50:27 +02004971 it only affects the way the file is displayed, not its contents.
4972 If 'breakindent' is set, line is visually indented. Then, the value
4973 of 'showbreak' is used to put in front of wrapped lines. This option
Bram Moolenaar86b17e92014-07-02 20:00:47 +02004974 is not used when the 'wrap' option is off.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004975 Note that <Tab> characters after an <EOL> are mostly not displayed
4976 with the right amount of white space.
4977
4978 *'lines'* *E593*
4979'lines' number (default 24 or terminal height)
4980 global
4981 Number of lines of the Vim window.
4982 Normally you don't need to set this. It is done automatically by the
Bram Moolenaar7c626922005-02-07 22:01:03 +00004983 terminal initialization code. Also see |posix-screen-size|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004984 When Vim is running in the GUI or in a resizable window, setting this
4985 option will cause the window size to be changed. When you only want
4986 to use the size for the GUI, put the command in your |gvimrc| file.
4987 Vim limits the number of lines to what fits on the screen. You can
4988 use this command to get the tallest window possible: >
4989 :set lines=999
Bram Moolenaarf4d11452005-12-02 00:46:37 +00004990< Minimum value is 2, maximum value is 1000.
Bram Moolenaardc1f1642016-08-16 18:33:43 +02004991 If you get fewer lines than expected, check the 'guiheadroom' option.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004992 When you set this option and Vim is unable to change the physical
4993 number of lines of the display, the display may be messed up.
4994
4995 *'linespace'* *'lsp'*
4996'linespace' 'lsp' number (default 0, 1 for Win32 GUI)
4997 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004998 {only in the GUI}
4999 Number of pixel lines inserted between characters. Useful if the font
5000 uses the full character cell height, making lines touch each other.
5001 When non-zero there is room for underlining.
Bram Moolenaarbc7aa852005-03-06 23:38:09 +00005002 With some fonts there can be too much room between lines (to have
5003 space for ascents and descents). Then it makes sense to set
5004 'linespace' to a negative value. This may cause display problems
5005 though!
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005006
5007 *'lisp'* *'nolisp'*
5008'lisp' boolean (default off)
5009 local to buffer
5010 {not available when compiled without the |+lispindent|
5011 feature}
5012 Lisp mode: When <Enter> is typed in insert mode set the indent for
5013 the next line to Lisp standards (well, sort of). Also happens with
5014 "cc" or "S". 'autoindent' must also be on for this to work. The 'p'
5015 flag in 'cpoptions' changes the method of indenting: Vi compatible or
5016 better. Also see 'lispwords'.
5017 The '-' character is included in keyword characters. Redefines the
5018 "=" operator to use this same indentation algorithm rather than
5019 calling an external program if 'equalprg' is empty.
5020 This option is not used when 'paste' is set.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005021
5022 *'lispwords'* *'lw'*
5023'lispwords' 'lw' string (default is very long)
Bram Moolenaaraf6c1312014-03-12 18:55:58 +01005024 global or local to buffer |global-local|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005025 {not available when compiled without the |+lispindent|
5026 feature}
Bram Moolenaarcbaff5e2022-04-08 17:45:08 +01005027 Comma-separated list of words that influence the Lisp indenting.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005028 |'lisp'|
5029
5030 *'list'* *'nolist'*
5031'list' boolean (default off)
5032 local to window
Bram Moolenaar113cb512021-11-07 20:27:04 +00005033 List mode: By default show tabs as CTRL-I is displayed, display $
5034 after end of line. Useful to see the difference between tabs and
5035 spaces and for trailing blanks. Further changed by the 'listchars'
5036 option.
Bram Moolenaar8f3f58f2010-01-06 20:52:26 +01005037
5038 The cursor is displayed at the start of the space a Tab character
5039 occupies, not at the end as usual in Normal mode. To get this cursor
5040 position while displaying Tabs with spaces, use: >
Bram Moolenaardd007ed2013-07-09 15:44:17 +02005041 :set list lcs=tab:\ \
Bram Moolenaar8f3f58f2010-01-06 20:52:26 +01005042<
5043 Note that list mode will also affect formatting (set with 'textwidth'
5044 or 'wrapmargin') when 'cpoptions' includes 'L'. See 'listchars' for
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005045 changing the way tabs are displayed.
5046
5047 *'listchars'* *'lcs'*
5048'listchars' 'lcs' string (default "eol:$")
Bram Moolenaareed9d462021-02-15 20:38:25 +01005049 global or local to window |global-local|
Bram Moolenaarf9d5ca12010-08-01 16:13:51 +02005050 Strings to use in 'list' mode and for the |:list| command. It is a
Bram Moolenaarcbaff5e2022-04-08 17:45:08 +01005051 comma-separated list of string settings.
Bram Moolenaar79278362015-04-21 18:33:48 +02005052 *lcs-eol*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005053 eol:c Character to show at the end of each line. When
5054 omitted, there is no extra character at the end of the
5055 line.
Bram Moolenaar79278362015-04-21 18:33:48 +02005056 *lcs-tab*
Bram Moolenaar83a52172019-01-16 22:41:54 +01005057 tab:xy[z] Two or three characters to be used to show a tab.
5058 The third character is optional.
5059
5060 tab:xy The 'x' is always used, then 'y' as many times as will
5061 fit. Thus "tab:>-" displays:
5062 >
5063 >-
5064 >--
5065 etc.
5066
5067 tab:xyz The 'z' is always used, then 'x' is prepended, and
5068 then 'y' is used as many times as will fit. Thus
5069 "tab:<->" displays:
5070 >
5071 <>
5072 <->
5073 <-->
5074 etc.
5075
5076 When "tab:" is omitted, a tab is shown as ^I.
Bram Moolenaar79278362015-04-21 18:33:48 +02005077 *lcs-space*
5078 space:c Character to show for a space. When omitted, spaces
5079 are left blank.
zeertzjqf14b8ba2021-09-10 16:58:30 +02005080 *lcs-multispace*
5081 multispace:c...
5082 One or more characters to use cyclically to show for
5083 multiple consecutive spaces. Overrides the "space"
5084 setting, except for single spaces. When omitted, the
5085 "space" setting is used. For example,
5086 `:set listchars=multispace:---+` shows ten consecutive
5087 spaces as:
5088 ---+---+--
Bram Moolenaar91478ae2021-02-03 15:58:13 +01005089 *lcs-lead*
5090 lead:c Character to show for leading spaces. When omitted,
zeertzjqf14b8ba2021-09-10 16:58:30 +02005091 leading spaces are blank. Overrides the "space" and
5092 "multispace" settings for leading spaces. You can
5093 combine it with "tab:", for example: >
Bram Moolenaar942db232021-02-13 18:14:48 +01005094 :set listchars+=tab:>-,lead:.
5095< *lcs-trail*
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00005096 trail:c Character to show for trailing spaces. When omitted,
zeertzjqf14b8ba2021-09-10 16:58:30 +02005097 trailing spaces are blank. Overrides the "space" and
5098 "multispace" settings for trailing spaces.
Bram Moolenaar79278362015-04-21 18:33:48 +02005099 *lcs-extends*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005100 extends:c Character to show in the last column, when 'wrap' is
5101 off and the line continues beyond the right of the
5102 screen.
Bram Moolenaar79278362015-04-21 18:33:48 +02005103 *lcs-precedes*
Bram Moolenaarbffba7f2019-09-20 17:00:17 +02005104 precedes:c Character to show in the first visible column of the
5105 physical line, when there is text preceding the
5106 character visible in the first column.
Bram Moolenaar79278362015-04-21 18:33:48 +02005107 *lcs-conceal*
Bram Moolenaar860cae12010-06-05 23:22:07 +02005108 conceal:c Character to show in place of concealed text, when
Bram Moolenaar0bc380a2010-07-10 13:52:13 +02005109 'conceallevel' is set to 1.
Bram Moolenaar79278362015-04-21 18:33:48 +02005110 *lcs-nbsp*
Bram Moolenaar73284b92015-05-04 17:28:22 +02005111 nbsp:c Character to show for a non-breakable space character
5112 (0xA0 (160 decimal) and U+202F). Left blank when
5113 omitted.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005114
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00005115 The characters ':' and ',' should not be used. UTF-8 characters can
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005116 be used when 'encoding' is "utf-8", otherwise only printable
Bram Moolenaar910f66f2006-04-05 20:41:53 +00005117 characters are allowed. All characters must be single width.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005118
Bram Moolenaar93ff6722021-10-16 17:51:40 +01005119 Each character can be specified as hex: >
5120 set listchars=eol:\\x24
5121 set listchars=eol:\\u21b5
5122 set listchars=eol:\\U000021b5
5123< Note that a double backslash is used. The number of hex characters
5124 must be exactly 2 for \\x, 4 for \\u and 8 for \\U.
5125
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005126 Examples: >
5127 :set lcs=tab:>-,trail:-
Bram Moolenaarcfbc5ee2004-07-02 15:38:35 +00005128 :set lcs=tab:>-,eol:<,nbsp:%
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005129 :set lcs=extends:>,precedes:<
5130< The "NonText" highlighting will be used for "eol", "extends" and
Bram Moolenaar34cc7d82021-09-21 20:09:51 +02005131 "precedes". "SpecialKey" will be used for "tab", "nbsp", "space",
5132 "multispace", "lead" and "trail".
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00005133 |hl-NonText| |hl-SpecialKey|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005134
5135 *'lpl'* *'nolpl'* *'loadplugins'* *'noloadplugins'*
5136'loadplugins' 'lpl' boolean (default on)
5137 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005138 When on the plugin scripts are loaded when starting up |load-plugins|.
5139 This option can be reset in your |vimrc| file to disable the loading
5140 of plugins.
Bram Moolenaarc4da1132017-07-15 19:39:43 +02005141 Note that using the "-u NONE", "-u DEFAULTS" and "--noplugin" command
5142 line arguments reset this option. See |-u| and |--noplugin|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005143
Bram Moolenaard94464e2015-11-02 15:28:18 +01005144 *'luadll'*
Bram Moolenaar3848e002016-03-19 18:42:29 +01005145'luadll' string (default depends on the build)
Bram Moolenaard94464e2015-11-02 15:28:18 +01005146 global
Bram Moolenaard94464e2015-11-02 15:28:18 +01005147 {only available when compiled with the |+lua/dyn|
5148 feature}
Bram Moolenaar25e4fcd2016-01-09 14:57:47 +01005149 Specifies the name of the Lua shared library. The default is
5150 DYNAMIC_LUA_DLL, which was specified at compile time.
Bram Moolenaaraa3b15d2016-04-21 08:53:19 +02005151 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|.
Bram Moolenaard94464e2015-11-02 15:28:18 +01005152 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
5153 security reasons.
5154
Bram Moolenaarf9393ef2006-04-24 19:47:27 +00005155 *'macatsui'* *'nomacatsui'*
5156'macatsui' boolean (default on)
5157 global
Bram Moolenaar3d1cde82020-08-15 18:55:18 +02005158 {not supported}
5159 No longer supported, as the Mac OS X GUI code was removed.
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00005160
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005161 *'magic'* *'nomagic'*
5162'magic' boolean (default on)
5163 global
5164 Changes the special characters that can be used in search patterns.
5165 See |pattern|.
Bram Moolenaar64d8e252016-09-06 22:12:34 +02005166 WARNING: Switching this option off most likely breaks plugins! That
5167 is because many patterns assume it's on and will fail when it's off.
5168 Only switch it off when working with old Vi scripts. In any other
5169 situation write patterns that work when 'magic' is on. Include "\M"
5170 when you want to |/\M|.
Bram Moolenaar4072ba52020-12-23 13:56:35 +01005171 In |Vim9| script the value of 'magic' is ignored, patterns behave like
5172 it is always set.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005173
5174 *'makeef'* *'mef'*
5175'makeef' 'mef' string (default: "")
5176 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005177 {not available when compiled without the |+quickfix|
5178 feature}
5179 Name of the errorfile for the |:make| command (see |:make_makeprg|)
5180 and the |:grep| command.
5181 When it is empty, an internally generated temp file will be used.
5182 When "##" is included, it is replaced by a number to make the name
5183 unique. This makes sure that the ":make" command doesn't overwrite an
5184 existing file.
5185 NOT used for the ":cf" command. See 'errorfile' for that.
5186 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|.
5187 See |option-backslash| about including spaces and backslashes.
5188 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
5189 security reasons.
5190
Bram Moolenaar2c7292d2017-03-05 17:43:31 +01005191 *'makeencoding'* *'menc'*
5192'makeencoding' 'menc' string (default "")
5193 global or local to buffer |global-local|
Bram Moolenaar2c7292d2017-03-05 17:43:31 +01005194 Encoding used for reading the output of external commands. When empty,
5195 encoding is not converted.
5196 This is used for `:make`, `:lmake`, `:grep`, `:lgrep`, `:grepadd`,
5197 `:lgrepadd`, `:cfile`, `:cgetfile`, `:caddfile`, `:lfile`, `:lgetfile`,
5198 and `:laddfile`.
5199
5200 This would be mostly useful when you use MS-Windows and set 'encoding'
5201 to "utf-8". If |+iconv| is enabled and GNU libiconv is used, setting
5202 'makeencoding' to "char" has the same effect as setting to the system
5203 locale encoding. Example: >
5204 :set encoding=utf-8
5205 :set makeencoding=char " system locale is used
5206<
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005207 *'makeprg'* *'mp'*
5208'makeprg' 'mp' string (default "make", VMS: "MMS")
5209 global or local to buffer |global-local|
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00005210 Program to use for the ":make" command. See |:make_makeprg|.
Bram Moolenaar22f1d0e2018-02-27 14:53:30 +01005211 This option may contain '%' and '#' characters (see |:_%| and |:_#|),
5212 which are expanded to the current and alternate file name. Use |::S|
Bram Moolenaar26df0922014-02-23 23:39:13 +01005213 to escape file names in case they contain special characters.
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00005214 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|. See |option-backslash|
5215 about including spaces and backslashes.
5216 Note that a '|' must be escaped twice: once for ":set" and once for
5217 the interpretation of a command. When you use a filter called
5218 "myfilter" do it like this: >
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005219 :set makeprg=gmake\ \\\|\ myfilter
5220< The placeholder "$*" can be given (even multiple times) to specify
5221 where the arguments will be included, for example: >
5222 :set makeprg=latex\ \\\\nonstopmode\ \\\\input\\{$*}
5223< This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
5224 security reasons.
5225
5226 *'matchpairs'* *'mps'*
5227'matchpairs' 'mps' string (default "(:),{:},[:]")
5228 local to buffer
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005229 Characters that form pairs. The |%| command jumps from one to the
Bram Moolenaara3e6bc92013-01-30 14:18:00 +01005230 other.
5231 Only character pairs are allowed that are different, thus you cannot
5232 jump between two double quotes.
5233 The characters must be separated by a colon.
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00005234 The pairs must be separated by a comma. Example for including '<' and
Bram Moolenaar130cbfc2021-04-07 21:07:20 +02005235 '>' (for HTML): >
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005236 :set mps+=<:>
5237
5238< A more exotic example, to jump between the '=' and ';' in an
5239 assignment, useful for languages like C and Java: >
5240 :au FileType c,cpp,java set mps+==:;
5241
5242< For a more advanced way of using "%", see the matchit.vim plugin in
Bram Moolenaar01164a62017-11-02 22:58:42 +01005243 the $VIMRUNTIME/pack/dist/opt/matchit directory. |add-local-help|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005244
5245 *'matchtime'* *'mat'*
5246'matchtime' 'mat' number (default 5)
5247 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005248 Tenths of a second to show the matching paren, when 'showmatch' is
5249 set. Note that this is not in milliseconds, like other options that
5250 set a time. This is to be compatible with Nvi.
5251
Bram Moolenaar362e1a32006-03-06 23:29:24 +00005252 *'maxcombine'* *'mco'*
5253'maxcombine' 'mco' number (default 2)
5254 global
Bram Moolenaar362e1a32006-03-06 23:29:24 +00005255 The maximum number of combining characters supported for displaying.
5256 Only used when 'encoding' is "utf-8".
5257 The default is OK for most languages. Hebrew may require 4.
5258 Maximum value is 6.
5259 Even when this option is set to 2 you can still edit text with more
5260 combining characters, you just can't see them. Use |g8| or |ga|.
5261 See |mbyte-combining|.
5262
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005263 *'maxfuncdepth'* *'mfd'*
5264'maxfuncdepth' 'mfd' number (default 100)
5265 global
Bram Moolenaardb84e452010-08-15 13:50:43 +02005266 {not available when compiled without the |+eval|
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00005267 feature}
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005268 Maximum depth of function calls for user functions. This normally
5269 catches endless recursion. When using a recursive function with
5270 more depth, set 'maxfuncdepth' to a bigger number. But this will use
5271 more memory, there is the danger of failing when memory is exhausted.
Bram Moolenaarbc2eada2017-01-02 21:27:47 +01005272 Increasing this limit above 200 also changes the maximum for Ex
Bram Moolenaar0b0f0992018-05-22 21:41:30 +02005273 command recursion, see |E169|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005274 See also |:function|.
5275
5276 *'maxmapdepth'* *'mmd'* *E223*
5277'maxmapdepth' 'mmd' number (default 1000)
5278 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005279 Maximum number of times a mapping is done without resulting in a
5280 character to be used. This normally catches endless mappings, like
5281 ":map x y" with ":map y x". It still does not catch ":map g wg",
5282 because the 'w' is used before the next mapping is done. See also
5283 |key-mapping|.
5284
5285 *'maxmem'* *'mm'*
5286'maxmem' 'mm' number (default between 256 to 5120 (system
5287 dependent) or half the amount of memory
5288 available)
5289 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005290 Maximum amount of memory (in Kbyte) to use for one buffer. When this
5291 limit is reached allocating extra memory for a buffer will cause
Bram Moolenaarcafafb32018-02-22 21:07:09 +01005292 other memory to be freed.
5293 The maximum usable value is about 2000000. Use this to work without a
5294 limit.
5295 The value is ignored when 'swapfile' is off.
5296 Also see 'maxmemtot'.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005297
Bram Moolenaare4efc3b2005-03-07 23:16:51 +00005298 *'maxmempattern'* *'mmp'*
5299'maxmempattern' 'mmp' number (default 1000)
5300 global
Bram Moolenaare4efc3b2005-03-07 23:16:51 +00005301 Maximum amount of memory (in Kbyte) to use for pattern matching.
Bram Moolenaar8f3f58f2010-01-06 20:52:26 +01005302 The maximum value is about 2000000. Use this to work without a limit.
Bram Moolenaare4efc3b2005-03-07 23:16:51 +00005303 *E363*
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00005304 When Vim runs into the limit it gives an error message and mostly
5305 behaves like CTRL-C was typed.
Bram Moolenaare4efc3b2005-03-07 23:16:51 +00005306 Running into the limit often means that the pattern is very
5307 inefficient or too complex. This may already happen with the pattern
5308 "\(.\)*" on a very long line. ".*" works much better.
Bram Moolenaarfd358112018-07-07 23:21:31 +02005309 Might also happen on redraw, when syntax rules try to match a complex
5310 text structure.
5311 Vim may run out of memory before hitting the 'maxmempattern' limit, in
5312 which case you get an "Out of memory" error instead.
Bram Moolenaare4efc3b2005-03-07 23:16:51 +00005313
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005314 *'maxmemtot'* *'mmt'*
5315'maxmemtot' 'mmt' number (default between 2048 and 10240 (system
5316 dependent) or half the amount of memory
5317 available)
5318 global
Bram Moolenaar8f3f58f2010-01-06 20:52:26 +01005319 Maximum amount of memory in Kbyte to use for all buffers together.
5320 The maximum usable value is about 2000000 (2 Gbyte). Use this to work
Bram Moolenaarfa735342016-01-03 22:14:44 +01005321 without a limit.
5322 On 64 bit machines higher values might work. But hey, do you really
5323 need more than 2 Gbyte for text editing? Keep in mind that text is
Bram Moolenaaraa3b15d2016-04-21 08:53:19 +02005324 stored in the swap file, one can edit files > 2 Gbyte anyway. We do
Bram Moolenaarfa735342016-01-03 22:14:44 +01005325 need the memory to store undo info.
Bram Moolenaarcafafb32018-02-22 21:07:09 +01005326 Buffers with 'swapfile' off still count to the total amount of memory
5327 used.
Bram Moolenaar8f3f58f2010-01-06 20:52:26 +01005328 Also see 'maxmem'.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005329
5330 *'menuitems'* *'mis'*
5331'menuitems' 'mis' number (default 25)
5332 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005333 {not available when compiled without the |+menu|
5334 feature}
5335 Maximum number of items to use in a menu. Used for menus that are
5336 generated from a list of items, e.g., the Buffers menu. Changing this
5337 option has no direct effect, the menu must be refreshed first.
5338
Bram Moolenaar8aff23a2005-08-19 20:40:30 +00005339 *'mkspellmem'* *'msm'*
5340'mkspellmem' 'msm' string (default "460000,2000,500")
5341 global
Bram Moolenaar8aff23a2005-08-19 20:40:30 +00005342 {not available when compiled without the |+syntax|
5343 feature}
5344 Parameters for |:mkspell|. This tunes when to start compressing the
5345 word tree. Compression can be slow when there are many words, but
5346 it's needed to avoid running out of memory. The amount of memory used
5347 per word depends very much on how similar the words are, that's why
5348 this tuning is complicated.
5349
5350 There are three numbers, separated by commas:
5351 {start},{inc},{added}
5352
5353 For most languages the uncompressed word tree fits in memory. {start}
5354 gives the amount of memory in Kbyte that can be used before any
5355 compression is done. It should be a bit smaller than the amount of
5356 memory that is available to Vim.
5357
5358 When going over the {start} limit the {inc} number specifies the
5359 amount of memory in Kbyte that can be allocated before another
5360 compression is done. A low number means compression is done after
5361 less words are added, which is slow. A high number means more memory
5362 will be allocated.
5363
5364 After doing compression, {added} times 1024 words can be added before
5365 the {inc} limit is ignored and compression is done when any extra
5366 amount of memory is needed. A low number means there is a smaller
5367 chance of hitting the {inc} limit, less memory is used but it's
5368 slower.
5369
5370 The languages for which these numbers are important are Italian and
5371 Hungarian. The default works for when you have about 512 Mbyte. If
5372 you have 1 Gbyte you could use: >
5373 :set mkspellmem=900000,3000,800
5374< If you have less than 512 Mbyte |:mkspell| may fail for some
5375 languages, no matter what you set 'mkspellmem' to.
5376
Bram Moolenaar07607392019-05-26 19:20:43 +02005377 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|.
5378
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005379 *'modeline'* *'ml'* *'nomodeline'* *'noml'*
Bram Moolenaar8243a792007-05-01 17:05:03 +00005380'modeline' 'ml' boolean (Vim default: on (off for root),
5381 Vi default: off)
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005382 local to buffer
Bram Moolenaar110289e2019-05-23 15:38:06 +02005383 If 'modeline' is on 'modelines' gives the number of lines that is
5384 checked for set commands. If 'modeline' is off or 'modelines' is zero
5385 no lines are checked. See |modeline|.
5386
5387 *'modelineexpr'* *'mle'* *'nomodelineexpr'* *'nomle'*
5388'modelineexpr' 'mle' boolean (default: off)
5389 global
5390 When on allow some options that are an expression to be set in the
5391 modeline. Check the option for whether it is affected by
5392 'modelineexpr'. Also see |modeline|.
Bram Moolenaar1c6fd1e2019-05-23 22:11:59 +02005393 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
5394 security reasons.
Bram Moolenaar110289e2019-05-23 15:38:06 +02005395
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005396 *'modelines'* *'mls'*
5397'modelines' 'mls' number (default 5)
5398 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005399 If 'modeline' is on 'modelines' gives the number of lines that is
5400 checked for set commands. If 'modeline' is off or 'modelines' is zero
5401 no lines are checked. See |modeline|.
5402 NOTE: 'modeline' is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
5403 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
5404
5405 *'modifiable'* *'ma'* *'nomodifiable'* *'noma'*
Bram Moolenaar110289e2019-05-23 15:38:06 +02005406 *E21*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005407'modifiable' 'ma' boolean (default on)
5408 local to buffer
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005409 When off the buffer contents cannot be changed. The 'fileformat' and
5410 'fileencoding' options also can't be changed.
Bram Moolenaar369b6f52017-01-17 12:22:32 +01005411 Can be reset on startup with the |-M| command line argument.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005412
5413 *'modified'* *'mod'* *'nomodified'* *'nomod'*
5414'modified' 'mod' boolean (default off)
5415 local to buffer
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005416 When on, the buffer is considered to be modified. This option is set
5417 when:
5418 1. A change was made to the text since it was last written. Using the
5419 |undo| command to go back to the original text will reset the
5420 option. But undoing changes that were made before writing the
5421 buffer will set the option again, since the text is different from
5422 when it was written.
5423 2. 'fileformat' or 'fileencoding' is different from its original
5424 value. The original value is set when the buffer is read or
5425 written. A ":set nomodified" command also resets the original
5426 values to the current values and the 'modified' option will be
5427 reset.
Bram Moolenaar4f3f6682016-03-26 23:01:59 +01005428 Similarly for 'eol' and 'bomb'.
Bram Moolenaar5302d9e2011-09-14 17:55:08 +02005429 This option is not set when a change is made to the buffer as the
5430 result of a BufNewFile, BufRead/BufReadPost, BufWritePost,
5431 FileAppendPost or VimLeave autocommand event. See |gzip-example| for
5432 an explanation.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005433 When 'buftype' is "nowrite" or "nofile" this option may be set, but
5434 will be ignored.
Bram Moolenaarb5b75622018-03-09 22:22:21 +01005435 Note that the text may actually be the same, e.g. 'modified' is set
5436 when using "rA" on an "A".
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005437
5438 *'more'* *'nomore'*
5439'more' boolean (Vim default: on, Vi default: off)
5440 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005441 When on, listings pause when the whole screen is filled. You will get
5442 the |more-prompt|. When this option is off there are no pauses, the
5443 listing continues until finished.
5444 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
5445 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
5446
Bram Moolenaar98a29d02021-01-18 19:55:44 +01005447 *'mouse'*
Bram Moolenaar5666fcd2019-12-26 14:35:26 +01005448'mouse' string (default "", "a" for GUI and Win32,
Bram Moolenaar5b418992019-10-27 18:50:25 +01005449 set to "a" or "nvi" in |defaults.vim|)
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005450 global
Bram Moolenaar5666fcd2019-12-26 14:35:26 +01005451 Enable the use of the mouse. Works for most terminals (xterm, Win32
5452 |win32-mouse|, QNX pterm, *BSD console with sysmouse and Linux console
5453 with gpm). For using the mouse in the GUI, see |gui-mouse|. The
5454 mouse can be enabled for different modes:
Bram Moolenaar7f2e9d72017-11-11 20:58:53 +01005455 n Normal mode and Terminal modes
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005456 v Visual mode
5457 i Insert mode
5458 c Command-line mode
5459 h all previous modes when editing a help file
5460 a all previous modes
5461 r for |hit-enter| and |more-prompt| prompt
Bram Moolenaar95bafa22018-10-02 13:26:25 +02005462 Normally you would enable the mouse in all five modes with: >
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005463 :set mouse=a
Bram Moolenaar5b418992019-10-27 18:50:25 +01005464< If your terminal can't overrule the mouse events going to the
5465 application, use: >
5466 :set mouse=nvi
Bram Moolenaar65e0d772020-06-14 17:29:55 +02005467< Then you can press ":", select text for the system, and press Esc to go
Bram Moolenaar5b418992019-10-27 18:50:25 +01005468 back to Vim using the mouse events.
5469 In |defaults.vim| "nvi" is used if the 'term' option is not matching
5470 "xterm".
5471
5472 When the mouse is not enabled, the GUI will still use the mouse for
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005473 modeless selection. This doesn't move the text cursor.
5474
5475 See |mouse-using|. Also see |'clipboard'|.
5476
5477 Note: When enabling the mouse in a terminal, copy/paste will use the
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00005478 "* register if there is access to an X-server. The xterm handling of
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005479 the mouse buttons can still be used by keeping the shift key pressed.
5480 Also see the 'clipboard' option.
5481
5482 *'mousefocus'* *'mousef'* *'nomousefocus'* *'nomousef'*
5483'mousefocus' 'mousef' boolean (default off)
5484 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005485 {only works in the GUI}
5486 The window that the mouse pointer is on is automatically activated.
5487 When changing the window layout or window focus in another way, the
5488 mouse pointer is moved to the window with keyboard focus. Off is the
5489 default because it makes using the pull down menus a little goofy, as
5490 a pointer transit may activate a window unintentionally.
Bram Moolenaar5ef1c6a2019-11-10 22:09:11 +01005491 MS-Windows: Also see 'scrollfocus' for what window is scrolled when
Bram Moolenaar1d9215b2020-01-25 13:27:42 +01005492 using the mouse scroll wheel.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005493
5494 *'mousehide'* *'mh'* *'nomousehide'* *'nomh'*
5495'mousehide' 'mh' boolean (default on)
5496 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005497 {only works in the GUI}
5498 When on, the mouse pointer is hidden when characters are typed.
5499 The mouse pointer is restored when the mouse is moved.
5500
5501 *'mousemodel'* *'mousem'*
Bram Moolenaar5666fcd2019-12-26 14:35:26 +01005502'mousemodel' 'mousem' string (default "extend", "popup" for Win32)
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005503 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005504 Sets the model to use for the mouse. The name mostly specifies what
5505 the right mouse button is used for:
5506 extend Right mouse button extends a selection. This works
5507 like in an xterm.
5508 popup Right mouse button pops up a menu. The shifted left
5509 mouse button extends a selection. This works like
Bram Moolenaar582fd852005-03-28 20:58:01 +00005510 with Microsoft Windows.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005511 popup_setpos Like "popup", but the cursor will be moved to the
5512 position where the mouse was clicked, and thus the
5513 selected operation will act upon the clicked object.
5514 If clicking inside a selection, that selection will
Bram Moolenaar582fd852005-03-28 20:58:01 +00005515 be acted upon, i.e. no cursor move. This implies of
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005516 course, that right clicking outside a selection will
5517 end Visual mode.
5518 Overview of what button does what for each model:
5519 mouse extend popup(_setpos) ~
5520 left click place cursor place cursor
5521 left drag start selection start selection
5522 shift-left search word extend selection
5523 right click extend selection popup menu (place cursor)
5524 right drag extend selection -
5525 middle click paste paste
5526
5527 In the "popup" model the right mouse button produces a pop-up menu.
5528 You need to define this first, see |popup-menu|.
5529
5530 Note that you can further refine the meaning of buttons with mappings.
5531 See |gui-mouse-mapping|. But mappings are NOT used for modeless
5532 selection (because that's handled in the GUI code directly).
5533
5534 The 'mousemodel' option is set by the |:behave| command.
5535
Ernie Raelc4cb5442022-04-03 15:47:28 +01005536 *'mousemoveevent'* *'mousemev'*
5537'mousemoveevent' 'mousemev' boolean (default off)
5538 global
5539 {only works in the GUI}
5540 When on, mouse move events are delivered to the input queue and are
5541 available for mapping. The default, off, avoids the mouse movement
5542 overhead except when needed. See |gui-mouse-mapping|.
5543 Warning: Setting this option can make pending mappings to be aborted
5544 when the mouse is moved.
5545 Currently only works in the GUI, may be made to work in a terminal
5546 later.
5547
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005548 *'mouseshape'* *'mouses'* *E547*
Bram Moolenaarf6b40102019-02-22 15:24:03 +01005549'mouseshape' 'mouses' string (default "i-r:beam,s:updown,sd:udsizing,
5550 vs:leftright,vd:lrsizing,m:no,
5551 ml:up-arrow,v:rightup-arrow")
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005552 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005553 {only available when compiled with the |+mouseshape|
5554 feature}
5555 This option tells Vim what the mouse pointer should look like in
Bram Moolenaarcbaff5e2022-04-08 17:45:08 +01005556 different modes. The option is a comma-separated list of parts, much
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005557 like used for 'guicursor'. Each part consist of a mode/location-list
5558 and an argument-list:
5559 mode-list:shape,mode-list:shape,..
5560 The mode-list is a dash separated list of these modes/locations:
5561 In a normal window: ~
5562 n Normal mode
5563 v Visual mode
5564 ve Visual mode with 'selection' "exclusive" (same as 'v',
5565 if not specified)
5566 o Operator-pending mode
5567 i Insert mode
5568 r Replace mode
5569
5570 Others: ~
5571 c appending to the command-line
5572 ci inserting in the command-line
5573 cr replacing in the command-line
5574 m at the 'Hit ENTER' or 'More' prompts
5575 ml idem, but cursor in the last line
5576 e any mode, pointer below last window
5577 s any mode, pointer on a status line
5578 sd any mode, while dragging a status line
5579 vs any mode, pointer on a vertical separator line
5580 vd any mode, while dragging a vertical separator line
5581 a everywhere
5582
5583 The shape is one of the following:
5584 avail name looks like ~
5585 w x arrow Normal mouse pointer
5586 w x blank no pointer at all (use with care!)
5587 w x beam I-beam
5588 w x updown up-down sizing arrows
5589 w x leftright left-right sizing arrows
5590 w x busy The system's usual busy pointer
5591 w x no The system's usual 'no input' pointer
5592 x udsizing indicates up-down resizing
5593 x lrsizing indicates left-right resizing
5594 x crosshair like a big thin +
5595 x hand1 black hand
5596 x hand2 white hand
5597 x pencil what you write with
5598 x question big ?
5599 x rightup-arrow arrow pointing right-up
5600 w x up-arrow arrow pointing up
5601 x <number> any X11 pointer number (see X11/cursorfont.h)
5602
5603 The "avail" column contains a 'w' if the shape is available for Win32,
5604 x for X11.
5605 Any modes not specified or shapes not available use the normal mouse
5606 pointer.
5607
5608 Example: >
5609 :set mouseshape=s:udsizing,m:no
5610< will make the mouse turn to a sizing arrow over the status lines and
5611 indicate no input when the hit-enter prompt is displayed (since
5612 clicking the mouse has no effect in this state.)
5613
5614 *'mousetime'* *'mouset'*
5615'mousetime' 'mouset' number (default 500)
5616 global
Bram Moolenaar5666fcd2019-12-26 14:35:26 +01005617 Only for GUI, Win32 and Unix with xterm. Defines the maximum
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005618 time in msec between two mouse clicks for the second click to be
5619 recognized as a multi click.
5620
Bram Moolenaar0ab35b22017-10-08 17:41:37 +02005621 *'mzschemedll'*
5622'mzschemedll' string (default depends on the build)
5623 global
Bram Moolenaar0ab35b22017-10-08 17:41:37 +02005624 {only available when compiled with the |+mzscheme/dyn|
5625 feature}
5626 Specifies the name of the MzScheme shared library. The default is
5627 DYNAMIC_MZSCH_DLL which was specified at compile time.
5628 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|.
Bram Moolenaarb0d45e72017-11-05 18:19:24 +01005629 The value must be set in the |vimrc| script or earlier. In the
Bram Moolenaar01164a62017-11-02 22:58:42 +01005630 startup, before the |load-plugins| step.
Bram Moolenaar0ab35b22017-10-08 17:41:37 +02005631 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
5632 security reasons.
5633
5634 *'mzschemegcdll'*
5635'mzschemegcdll' string (default depends on the build)
5636 global
Bram Moolenaar0ab35b22017-10-08 17:41:37 +02005637 {only available when compiled with the |+mzscheme/dyn|
5638 feature}
5639 Specifies the name of the MzScheme GC shared library. The default is
5640 DYNAMIC_MZGC_DLL which was specified at compile time.
5641 The value can be equal to 'mzschemedll' if it includes the GC code.
5642 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|.
5643 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
5644 security reasons.
5645
Bram Moolenaar325b7a22004-07-05 15:58:32 +00005646 *'mzquantum'* *'mzq'*
5647'mzquantum' 'mzq' number (default 100)
5648 global
Bram Moolenaar325b7a22004-07-05 15:58:32 +00005649 {not available when compiled without the |+mzscheme|
5650 feature}
5651 The number of milliseconds between polls for MzScheme threads.
5652 Negative or zero value means no thread scheduling.
Bram Moolenaar036986f2017-03-16 17:41:02 +01005653 NOTE: This option is set to the Vim default value when 'compatible'
5654 is reset.
Bram Moolenaar325b7a22004-07-05 15:58:32 +00005655
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005656 *'nrformats'* *'nf'*
Bram Moolenaar8c08b5b2016-07-28 22:24:15 +02005657'nrformats' 'nf' string (default "bin,octal,hex",
5658 set to "bin,hex" in |defaults.vim|)
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005659 local to buffer
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005660 This defines what bases Vim will consider for numbers when using the
5661 CTRL-A and CTRL-X commands for adding to and subtracting from a number
5662 respectively; see |CTRL-A| for more info on these commands.
Bram Moolenaar4770d092006-01-12 23:22:24 +00005663 alpha If included, single alphabetical characters will be
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005664 incremented or decremented. This is useful for a list with a
Bram Moolenaar3848e002016-03-19 18:42:29 +01005665 letter index a), b), etc. *octal-nrformats*
Bram Moolenaar4770d092006-01-12 23:22:24 +00005666 octal If included, numbers that start with a zero will be considered
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005667 to be octal. Example: Using CTRL-A on "007" results in "010".
Bram Moolenaar4770d092006-01-12 23:22:24 +00005668 hex If included, numbers starting with "0x" or "0X" will be
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005669 considered to be hexadecimal. Example: Using CTRL-X on
5670 "0x100" results in "0x0ff".
Bram Moolenaar25e4fcd2016-01-09 14:57:47 +01005671 bin If included, numbers starting with "0b" or "0B" will be
5672 considered to be binary. Example: Using CTRL-X on
5673 "0b1000" subtracts one, resulting in "0b0111".
Bram Moolenaaraaad9952020-05-31 15:08:59 +02005674 unsigned If included, numbers are recognized as unsigned. Thus a
5675 leading dash or negative sign won't be considered as part of
5676 the number. Examples:
5677 Using CTRL-X on "2020" in "9-2020" results in "9-2019"
5678 (without "unsigned" it would become "9-2021").
5679 Using CTRL-A on "2020" in "9-2020" results in "9-2021"
5680 (without "unsigned" it would become "9-2019").
Bram Moolenaaracc22402020-06-07 21:07:18 +02005681 Using CTRL-X on "0" or CTRL-A on "18446744073709551615"
5682 (2^64 - 1) has no effect, overflow is prevented.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005683 Numbers which simply begin with a digit in the range 1-9 are always
5684 considered decimal. This also happens for numbers that are not
5685 recognized as octal or hex.
5686
5687 *'number'* *'nu'* *'nonumber'* *'nonu'*
5688'number' 'nu' boolean (default off)
5689 local to window
5690 Print the line number in front of each line. When the 'n' option is
5691 excluded from 'cpoptions' a wrapped line will not use the column of
5692 line numbers (this is the default when 'compatible' isn't set).
Bram Moolenaar592e0a22004-07-03 16:05:59 +00005693 The 'numberwidth' option can be used to set the room used for the line
5694 number.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005695 When a long, wrapped line doesn't start with the first character, '-'
5696 characters are put before the number.
James McCoya80aad72021-12-22 19:45:28 +00005697 For highlighting see |hl-LineNr|, and |hl-CursorLineNr|, and the
5698 |:sign-define| "numhl" argument.
Bram Moolenaar203d04d2013-06-06 21:36:40 +02005699 *number_relativenumber*
5700 The 'relativenumber' option changes the displayed number to be
5701 relative to the cursor. Together with 'number' there are these
5702 four combinations (cursor in line 3):
5703
Bram Moolenaar3848e002016-03-19 18:42:29 +01005704 'nonu' 'nu' 'nonu' 'nu'
Bram Moolenaar203d04d2013-06-06 21:36:40 +02005705 'nornu' 'nornu' 'rnu' 'rnu'
5706
5707 |apple | 1 apple | 2 apple | 2 apple
5708 |pear | 2 pear | 1 pear | 1 pear
5709 |nobody | 3 nobody | 0 nobody |3 nobody
5710 |there | 4 there | 1 there | 1 there
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005711
Bram Moolenaar592e0a22004-07-03 16:05:59 +00005712 *'numberwidth'* *'nuw'*
5713'numberwidth' 'nuw' number (Vim default: 4 Vi default: 8)
5714 local to window
Bram Moolenaar325b7a22004-07-05 15:58:32 +00005715 {only available when compiled with the |+linebreak|
5716 feature}
Bram Moolenaar592e0a22004-07-03 16:05:59 +00005717 Minimal number of columns to use for the line number. Only relevant
Bram Moolenaar64486672010-05-16 15:46:46 +02005718 when the 'number' or 'relativenumber' option is set or printing lines
5719 with a line number. Since one space is always between the number and
5720 the text, there is one less character for the number itself.
Bram Moolenaar592e0a22004-07-03 16:05:59 +00005721 The value is the minimum width. A bigger width is used when needed to
Bram Moolenaar64486672010-05-16 15:46:46 +02005722 fit the highest line number in the buffer respectively the number of
5723 rows in the window, depending on whether 'number' or 'relativenumber'
5724 is set. Thus with the Vim default of 4 there is room for a line number
5725 up to 999. When the buffer has 1000 lines five columns will be used.
Bram Moolenaarf8a07122019-07-01 22:06:07 +02005726 The minimum value is 1, the maximum value is 20.
Bram Moolenaar036986f2017-03-16 17:41:02 +01005727 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
5728 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
Bram Moolenaar592e0a22004-07-03 16:05:59 +00005729
Bram Moolenaarf75a9632005-09-13 21:20:47 +00005730 *'omnifunc'* *'ofu'*
5731'omnifunc' 'ofu' string (default: empty)
Bram Moolenaare344bea2005-09-01 20:46:49 +00005732 local to buffer
Bram Moolenaardb84e452010-08-15 13:50:43 +02005733 {not available when compiled without the |+eval|
Bram Moolenaare2c453d2019-08-21 14:37:09 +02005734 feature}
Bram Moolenaarc7486e02005-12-29 22:48:26 +00005735 This option specifies a function to be used for Insert mode omni
5736 completion with CTRL-X CTRL-O. |i_CTRL-X_CTRL-O|
Bram Moolenaar280f1262006-01-30 00:14:18 +00005737 See |complete-functions| for an explanation of how the function is
Yegappan Lakshmanan8658c752021-12-03 11:09:29 +00005738 invoked and what it should return. The value can be the name of a
5739 function, a |lambda| or a |Funcref|. See |option-value-function| for
5740 more information.
Bram Moolenaar043545e2006-10-10 16:44:07 +00005741 This option is usually set by a filetype plugin:
Bram Moolenaar9c102382006-05-03 21:26:49 +00005742 |:filetype-plugin-on|
Bram Moolenaar30b65812012-07-12 22:01:11 +02005743 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
5744 security reasons.
Bram Moolenaare344bea2005-09-01 20:46:49 +00005745
5746
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00005747 *'opendevice'* *'odev'* *'noopendevice'* *'noodev'*
Bram Moolenaar043545e2006-10-10 16:44:07 +00005748'opendevice' 'odev' boolean (default off)
5749 global
Bram Moolenaar6f4754b2022-01-23 12:07:04 +00005750 {only for MS-Windows} *E796*
Bram Moolenaar043545e2006-10-10 16:44:07 +00005751 Enable reading and writing from devices. This may get Vim stuck on a
5752 device that can be opened but doesn't actually do the I/O. Therefore
5753 it is off by default.
5754 Note that on MS-Windows editing "aux.h", "lpt1.txt" and the like also
5755 result in editing a device.
5756
5757
Bram Moolenaar2c7a29c2005-12-12 22:02:31 +00005758 *'operatorfunc'* *'opfunc'*
5759'operatorfunc' 'opfunc' string (default: empty)
5760 global
Bram Moolenaar2c7a29c2005-12-12 22:02:31 +00005761 This option specifies a function to be called by the |g@| operator.
Yegappan Lakshmanan777175b2021-11-18 22:08:57 +00005762 See |:map-operator| for more info and an example. The value can be
5763 the name of a function, a |lambda| or a |Funcref|. See
5764 |option-value-function| for more information.
Bram Moolenaar2c7a29c2005-12-12 22:02:31 +00005765
5766 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
5767 security reasons.
5768
5769
Bram Moolenaar251e1912011-06-19 05:09:16 +02005770 *'osfiletype'* *'oft'*
5771'osfiletype' 'oft' string (default: "")
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005772 local to buffer
Bram Moolenaar251e1912011-06-19 05:09:16 +02005773 This option was supported on RISC OS, which has been removed.
5774
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005775
Bram Moolenaarf6fee0e2016-02-21 23:02:49 +01005776 *'packpath'* *'pp'*
5777'packpath' 'pp' string (default: see 'runtimepath')
Bram Moolenaarf6fee0e2016-02-21 23:02:49 +01005778 Directories used to find packages. See |packages|.
5779
5780
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005781 *'paragraphs'* *'para'*
Bram Moolenaar57e48462008-03-12 16:38:55 +00005782'paragraphs' 'para' string (default "IPLPPPQPP TPHPLIPpLpItpplpipbp")
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005783 global
5784 Specifies the nroff macros that separate paragraphs. These are pairs
5785 of two letters (see |object-motions|).
5786
5787 *'paste'* *'nopaste'*
5788'paste' boolean (default off)
5789 global
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00005790 Put Vim in Paste mode. This is useful if you want to cut or copy
5791 some text from one window and paste it in Vim. This will avoid
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005792 unexpected effects.
5793 Setting this option is useful when using Vim in a terminal, where Vim
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00005794 cannot distinguish between typed text and pasted text. In the GUI, Vim
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005795 knows about pasting and will mostly do the right thing without 'paste'
5796 being set. The same is true for a terminal where Vim handles the
5797 mouse clicks itself.
Bram Moolenaar2ce06f62005-01-31 19:19:04 +00005798 This option is reset when starting the GUI. Thus if you set it in
5799 your .vimrc it will work in a terminal, but not in the GUI. Setting
5800 'paste' in the GUI has side effects: e.g., the Paste toolbar button
5801 will no longer work in Insert mode, because it uses a mapping.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005802 When the 'paste' option is switched on (also when it was already on):
5803 - mapping in Insert mode and Command-line mode is disabled
5804 - abbreviations are disabled
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005805 - 'autoindent' is reset
Bram Moolenaarca635012015-09-25 20:34:21 +02005806 - 'expandtab' is reset
Bram Moolenaar4d8f4762021-06-27 15:18:56 +02005807 - 'hkmap' is reset
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005808 - 'revins' is reset
5809 - 'ruler' is reset
5810 - 'showmatch' is reset
Bram Moolenaarca635012015-09-25 20:34:21 +02005811 - 'smarttab' is reset
5812 - 'softtabstop' is set to 0
5813 - 'textwidth' is set to 0
5814 - 'wrapmargin' is set to 0
Bram Moolenaar4d8f4762021-06-27 15:18:56 +02005815 - 'varsofttabstop' is made empty
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005816 These options keep their value, but their effect is disabled:
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005817 - 'cindent'
Bram Moolenaar4d8f4762021-06-27 15:18:56 +02005818 - 'formatoptions' is used like it is empty
Bram Moolenaarca635012015-09-25 20:34:21 +02005819 - 'indentexpr'
5820 - 'lisp'
Bram Moolenaar4d8f4762021-06-27 15:18:56 +02005821 - 'smartindent'
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005822 NOTE: When you start editing another file while the 'paste' option is
5823 on, settings from the modelines or autocommands may change the
5824 settings again, causing trouble when pasting text. You might want to
5825 set the 'paste' option again.
5826 When the 'paste' option is reset the mentioned options are restored to
5827 the value before the moment 'paste' was switched from off to on.
5828 Resetting 'paste' before ever setting it does not have any effect.
5829 Since mapping doesn't work while 'paste' is active, you need to use
5830 the 'pastetoggle' option to toggle the 'paste' option with some key.
5831
5832 *'pastetoggle'* *'pt'*
5833'pastetoggle' 'pt' string (default "")
5834 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005835 When non-empty, specifies the key sequence that toggles the 'paste'
5836 option. This is like specifying a mapping: >
5837 :map {keys} :set invpaste<CR>
5838< Where {keys} is the value of 'pastetoggle'.
5839 The difference is that it will work even when 'paste' is set.
5840 'pastetoggle' works in Insert mode and Normal mode, but not in
5841 Command-line mode.
5842 Mappings are checked first, thus overrule 'pastetoggle'. However,
5843 when 'paste' is on mappings are ignored in Insert mode, thus you can do
5844 this: >
5845 :map <F10> :set paste<CR>
5846 :map <F11> :set nopaste<CR>
5847 :imap <F10> <C-O>:set paste<CR>
5848 :imap <F11> <nop>
5849 :set pastetoggle=<F11>
5850< This will make <F10> start paste mode and <F11> stop paste mode.
5851 Note that typing <F10> in paste mode inserts "<F10>", since in paste
5852 mode everything is inserted literally, except the 'pastetoggle' key
5853 sequence.
Bram Moolenaar446cb832008-06-24 21:56:24 +00005854 When the value has several bytes 'ttimeoutlen' applies.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005855
5856 *'pex'* *'patchexpr'*
5857'patchexpr' 'pex' string (default "")
5858 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005859 {not available when compiled without the |+diff|
5860 feature}
5861 Expression which is evaluated to apply a patch to a file and generate
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00005862 the resulting new version of the file. See |diff-patchexpr|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005863
Bram Moolenaardbc28022014-07-26 13:40:44 +02005864 *'patchmode'* *'pm'* *E205* *E206*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005865'patchmode' 'pm' string (default "")
5866 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005867 When non-empty the oldest version of a file is kept. This can be used
5868 to keep the original version of a file if you are changing files in a
5869 source distribution. Only the first time that a file is written a
5870 copy of the original file will be kept. The name of the copy is the
5871 name of the original file with the string in the 'patchmode' option
5872 appended. This option should start with a dot. Use a string like
Bram Moolenaardf980db2017-12-24 13:22:00 +01005873 ".orig" or ".org". 'backupdir' must not be empty for this to work
5874 (Detail: The backup file is renamed to the patchmode file after the
5875 new file has been successfully written, that's why it must be possible
5876 to write a backup file). If there was no file to be backed up, an
5877 empty file is created.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005878 When the 'backupskip' pattern matches, a patchmode file is not made.
5879 Using 'patchmode' for compressed files appends the extension at the
5880 end (e.g., "file.gz.orig"), thus the resulting name isn't always
5881 recognized as a compressed file.
Bram Moolenaar293ee4d2004-12-09 21:34:53 +00005882 Only normal file name characters can be used, "/\*?[|<>" are illegal.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005883
Bram Moolenaarf1568ec2011-12-14 21:17:39 +01005884 *'path'* *'pa'* *E343* *E345* *E347* *E854*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005885'path' 'pa' string (default on Unix: ".,/usr/include,,"
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005886 other systems: ".,,")
5887 global or local to buffer |global-local|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005888 This is a list of directories which will be searched when using the
Bram Moolenaarc236c162008-07-13 17:41:49 +00005889 |gf|, [f, ]f, ^Wf, |:find|, |:sfind|, |:tabfind| and other commands,
5890 provided that the file being searched for has a relative path (not
5891 starting with "/", "./" or "../"). The directories in the 'path'
5892 option may be relative or absolute.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005893 - Use commas to separate directory names: >
5894 :set path=.,/usr/local/include,/usr/include
5895< - Spaces can also be used to separate directory names (for backwards
5896 compatibility with version 3.0). To have a space in a directory
5897 name, precede it with an extra backslash, and escape the space: >
5898 :set path=.,/dir/with\\\ space
5899< - To include a comma in a directory name precede it with an extra
5900 backslash: >
5901 :set path=.,/dir/with\\,comma
5902< - To search relative to the directory of the current file, use: >
5903 :set path=.
5904< - To search in the current directory use an empty string between two
5905 commas: >
5906 :set path=,,
5907< - A directory name may end in a ':' or '/'.
5908 - Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|.
5909 - When using |netrw.vim| URLs can be used. For example, adding
5910 "http://www.vim.org" will make ":find index.html" work.
Bram Moolenaarc236c162008-07-13 17:41:49 +00005911 - Search upwards and downwards in a directory tree using "*", "**" and
5912 ";". See |file-searching| for info and syntax.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005913 {not available when compiled without the |+path_extra| feature}
5914 - Careful with '\' characters, type two to get one in the option: >
5915 :set path=.,c:\\include
5916< Or just use '/' instead: >
5917 :set path=.,c:/include
5918< Don't forget "." or files won't even be found in the same directory as
5919 the file!
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00005920 The maximum length is limited. How much depends on the system, mostly
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005921 it is something like 256 or 1024 characters.
5922 You can check if all the include files are found, using the value of
5923 'path', see |:checkpath|.
5924 The use of |:set+=| and |:set-=| is preferred when adding or removing
5925 directories from the list. This avoids problems when a future version
5926 uses another default. To remove the current directory use: >
5927 :set path-=
5928< To add the current directory use: >
5929 :set path+=
5930< To use an environment variable, you probably need to replace the
5931 separator. Here is an example to append $INCL, in which directory
5932 names are separated with a semi-colon: >
Bram Moolenaarc51cf032022-02-26 12:25:45 +00005933 :let &path = &path .. "," .. substitute($INCL, ';', ',', 'g')
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005934< Replace the ';' with a ':' or whatever separator is used. Note that
5935 this doesn't work when $INCL contains a comma or white space.
5936
Bram Moolenaar37c64c72017-09-19 22:06:03 +02005937 *'perldll'*
5938'perldll' string (default depends on the build)
5939 global
Bram Moolenaar37c64c72017-09-19 22:06:03 +02005940 {only available when compiled with the |+perl/dyn|
5941 feature}
5942 Specifies the name of the Perl shared library. The default is
5943 DYNAMIC_PERL_DLL, which was specified at compile time.
5944 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|.
5945 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
5946 security reasons.
5947
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005948 *'preserveindent'* *'pi'* *'nopreserveindent'* *'nopi'*
5949'preserveindent' 'pi' boolean (default off)
5950 local to buffer
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005951 When changing the indent of the current line, preserve as much of the
5952 indent structure as possible. Normally the indent is replaced by a
5953 series of tabs followed by spaces as required (unless |'expandtab'| is
5954 enabled, in which case only spaces are used). Enabling this option
5955 means the indent will preserve as many existing characters as possible
5956 for indenting, and only add additional tabs or spaces as required.
Bram Moolenaar446cb832008-06-24 21:56:24 +00005957 'expandtab' does not apply to the preserved white space, a Tab remains
5958 a Tab.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005959 NOTE: When using ">>" multiple times the resulting indent is a mix of
5960 tabs and spaces. You might not like this.
Bram Moolenaar036986f2017-03-16 17:41:02 +01005961 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005962 Also see 'copyindent'.
5963 Use |:retab| to clean up white space.
5964
5965 *'previewheight'* *'pvh'*
5966'previewheight' 'pvh' number (default 12)
5967 global
Bram Moolenaar62a0cb42019-08-18 16:35:23 +02005968 {not available when compiled without the |+quickfix|
5969 feature}
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005970 Default height for a preview window. Used for |:ptag| and associated
Bram Moolenaar79648732019-07-18 21:43:07 +02005971 commands. Used for |CTRL-W_}| when no count is given. Not used when
5972 'previewpopup' is set.
5973
5974 *'previewpopup'* *'pvp'*
5975'previewpopup' 'pvp' string (default empty)
5976 global
Bram Moolenaar62a0cb42019-08-18 16:35:23 +02005977 {not available when compiled without the |+textprop|
5978 or |+quickfix| feature}
Bram Moolenaar79648732019-07-18 21:43:07 +02005979 When not empty a popup window is used for commands that would open a
5980 preview window. See |preview-popup|.
Bram Moolenaar576a4a62019-08-18 15:25:17 +02005981 Not used for the insert completion info, add "popup" to
5982 'completeopt' for that.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005983
5984 *'previewwindow'* *'nopreviewwindow'*
5985 *'pvw'* *'nopvw'* *E590*
5986'previewwindow' 'pvw' boolean (default off)
5987 local to window
Bram Moolenaar62a0cb42019-08-18 16:35:23 +02005988 {not available when compiled without the |+quickfix|
5989 feature}
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00005990 Identifies the preview window. Only one window can have this option
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005991 set. It's normally not set directly, but by using one of the commands
5992 |:ptag|, |:pedit|, etc.
5993
5994 *'printdevice'* *'pdev'*
5995'printdevice' 'pdev' string (default empty)
5996 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005997 {only available when compiled with the |+printer|
5998 feature}
Bram Moolenaar8299df92004-07-10 09:47:34 +00005999 The name of the printer to be used for |:hardcopy|.
6000 See |pdev-option|.
Bram Moolenaar293ee4d2004-12-09 21:34:53 +00006001 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
6002 security reasons.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006003
Bram Moolenaar8299df92004-07-10 09:47:34 +00006004 *'printencoding'* *'penc'*
Bram Moolenaar95bafa22018-10-02 13:26:25 +02006005'printencoding' 'penc' string (default empty, except for some systems)
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006006 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006007 {only available when compiled with the |+printer|
6008 and |+postscript| features}
Bram Moolenaar8299df92004-07-10 09:47:34 +00006009 Sets the character encoding used when printing.
6010 See |penc-option|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006011
6012 *'printexpr'* *'pexpr'*
Bram Moolenaar95bafa22018-10-02 13:26:25 +02006013'printexpr' 'pexpr' string (default: see below)
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006014 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006015 {only available when compiled with the |+printer|
6016 and |+postscript| features}
Bram Moolenaar8299df92004-07-10 09:47:34 +00006017 Expression used to print the PostScript produced with |:hardcopy|.
6018 See |pexpr-option|.
Bram Moolenaar51628222016-12-01 23:03:28 +01006019 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
6020 security reasons.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006021
Bram Moolenaar8299df92004-07-10 09:47:34 +00006022 *'printfont'* *'pfn'*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006023'printfont' 'pfn' string (default "courier")
6024 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006025 {only available when compiled with the |+printer|
6026 feature}
Bram Moolenaar8299df92004-07-10 09:47:34 +00006027 The name of the font that will be used for |:hardcopy|.
6028 See |pfn-option|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006029
6030 *'printheader'* *'pheader'*
6031'printheader' 'pheader' string (default "%<%f%h%m%=Page %N")
6032 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006033 {only available when compiled with the |+printer|
6034 feature}
Bram Moolenaar8299df92004-07-10 09:47:34 +00006035 The format of the header produced in |:hardcopy| output.
6036 See |pheader-option|.
6037
6038 *'printmbcharset'* *'pmbcs'*
6039'printmbcharset' 'pmbcs' string (default "")
6040 global
Bram Moolenaar4c92e752019-02-17 21:18:32 +01006041 {only available when compiled with the |+printer|
6042 and |+postscript| features}
Bram Moolenaar8299df92004-07-10 09:47:34 +00006043 The CJK character set to be used for CJK output from |:hardcopy|.
6044 See |pmbcs-option|.
6045
6046 *'printmbfont'* *'pmbfn'*
6047'printmbfont' 'pmbfn' string (default "")
6048 global
Bram Moolenaar4c92e752019-02-17 21:18:32 +01006049 {only available when compiled with the |+printer|
6050 and |+postscript| features}
Bram Moolenaar8299df92004-07-10 09:47:34 +00006051 List of font names to be used for CJK output from |:hardcopy|.
6052 See |pmbfn-option|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006053
6054 *'printoptions'* *'popt'*
6055'printoptions' 'popt' string (default "")
6056 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006057 {only available when compiled with |+printer| feature}
Bram Moolenaar8299df92004-07-10 09:47:34 +00006058 List of items that control the format of the output of |:hardcopy|.
6059 See |popt-option|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006060
Bram Moolenaar26a60b42005-02-22 08:49:11 +00006061 *'prompt'* *'noprompt'*
6062'prompt' boolean (default on)
6063 global
6064 When on a ":" prompt is used in Ex mode.
6065
Bram Moolenaar7d47b6e2006-03-15 22:59:18 +00006066 *'pumheight'* *'ph'*
6067'pumheight' 'ph' number (default 0)
6068 global
Bram Moolenaar06a89a52006-04-29 22:01:03 +00006069 Determines the maximum number of items to show in the popup menu for
6070 Insert mode completion. When zero as much space as available is used.
Bram Moolenaar7d47b6e2006-03-15 22:59:18 +00006071 |ins-completion-menu|.
6072
Bram Moolenaara8f04aa2018-02-10 15:36:55 +01006073 *'pumwidth'* *'pw'*
Bram Moolenaarcafafb32018-02-22 21:07:09 +01006074'pumwidth' 'pw' number (default 15)
Bram Moolenaara8f04aa2018-02-10 15:36:55 +01006075 global
Bram Moolenaar22f1d0e2018-02-27 14:53:30 +01006076 Determines the minimum width to use for the popup menu for Insert mode
Bram Moolenaarcafafb32018-02-22 21:07:09 +01006077 completion. |ins-completion-menu|.
Bram Moolenaara8f04aa2018-02-10 15:36:55 +01006078
Bram Moolenaard94464e2015-11-02 15:28:18 +01006079 *'pythondll'*
Bram Moolenaar3848e002016-03-19 18:42:29 +01006080'pythondll' string (default depends on the build)
Bram Moolenaard94464e2015-11-02 15:28:18 +01006081 global
Bram Moolenaard94464e2015-11-02 15:28:18 +01006082 {only available when compiled with the |+python/dyn|
6083 feature}
Bram Moolenaar25e4fcd2016-01-09 14:57:47 +01006084 Specifies the name of the Python 2.x shared library. The default is
6085 DYNAMIC_PYTHON_DLL, which was specified at compile time.
Bram Moolenaaraa3b15d2016-04-21 08:53:19 +02006086 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|.
Bram Moolenaard94464e2015-11-02 15:28:18 +01006087 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
6088 security reasons.
Bram Moolenaar7d47b6e2006-03-15 22:59:18 +00006089
Bram Moolenaar94073162018-01-31 21:49:05 +01006090 *'pythonhome'*
6091'pythonhome' string (default "")
6092 global
Bram Moolenaar94073162018-01-31 21:49:05 +01006093 {only available when compiled with the |+python/dyn|
6094 feature}
6095 Specifies the name of the Python 2.x home directory. When 'pythonhome'
6096 and the PYTHONHOME environment variable are not set, PYTHON_HOME,
6097 which was specified at compile time, will be used for the Python 2.x
6098 home directory.
6099 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|.
6100 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
6101 security reasons.
6102
Bram Moolenaarb4ff5182015-11-10 21:15:48 +01006103 *'pythonthreedll'*
Bram Moolenaar25e4fcd2016-01-09 14:57:47 +01006104'pythonthreedll' string (default depends on the build)
Bram Moolenaarb4ff5182015-11-10 21:15:48 +01006105 global
Bram Moolenaarb4ff5182015-11-10 21:15:48 +01006106 {only available when compiled with the |+python3/dyn|
6107 feature}
Bram Moolenaar25e4fcd2016-01-09 14:57:47 +01006108 Specifies the name of the Python 3 shared library. The default is
6109 DYNAMIC_PYTHON3_DLL, which was specified at compile time.
Bram Moolenaaraa3b15d2016-04-21 08:53:19 +02006110 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|.
Bram Moolenaarb4ff5182015-11-10 21:15:48 +01006111 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
6112 security reasons.
6113
Bram Moolenaar94073162018-01-31 21:49:05 +01006114 *'pythonthreehome'*
6115'pythonthreehome' string (default "")
6116 global
Bram Moolenaar94073162018-01-31 21:49:05 +01006117 {only available when compiled with the |+python3/dyn|
6118 feature}
6119 Specifies the name of the Python 3 home directory. When
6120 'pythonthreehome' and the PYTHONHOME environment variable are not set,
6121 PYTHON3_HOME, which was specified at compile time, will be used for
6122 the Python 3 home directory.
6123 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|.
6124 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
6125 security reasons.
6126
Bram Moolenaarf42dd3c2017-01-28 16:06:38 +01006127 *'pyxversion'* *'pyx'*
6128'pyxversion' 'pyx' number (default depends on the build)
6129 global
Bram Moolenaarf42dd3c2017-01-28 16:06:38 +01006130 {only available when compiled with the |+python| or
6131 the |+python3| feature}
6132 Specifies the python version used for pyx* functions and commands
6133 |python_x|. The default value is as follows:
6134
6135 Compiled with Default ~
6136 |+python| and |+python3| 0
6137 only |+python| 2
6138 only |+python3| 3
6139
6140 Available values are 0, 2 and 3.
6141 If 'pyxversion' is 0, it is set to 2 or 3 after the first execution of
6142 any python2/3 commands or functions. E.g. `:py` sets to 2, and `:py3`
6143 sets to 3. `:pyx` sets it to 3 if Python 3 is available, otherwise sets
6144 to 2 if Python 2 is available.
6145 See also: |has-pythonx|
6146
6147 If Vim is compiled with only |+python| or |+python3| setting
6148 'pyxversion' has no effect. The pyx* functions and commands are
6149 always the same as the compiled version.
6150
6151 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
6152 security reasons.
6153
Bram Moolenaar858ba062020-05-31 23:11:59 +02006154 *'quickfixtextfunc'* *'qftf'*
6155'quickfixtextfunc' 'qftf' string (default "")
6156 global
6157 {only available when compiled with the |+quickfix|
6158 feature}
6159 This option specifies a function to be used to get the text to display
6160 in the quickfix and location list windows. This can be used to
6161 customize the information displayed in the quickfix or location window
6162 for each entry in the corresponding quickfix or location list. See
6163 |quickfix-window-function| for an explanation of how to write the
Yegappan Lakshmanan777175b2021-11-18 22:08:57 +00006164 function and an example. The value can be the name of a function, a
6165 |lambda| or a |Funcref|. See |option-value-function| for more
6166 information.
Bram Moolenaar858ba062020-05-31 23:11:59 +02006167
6168 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
6169 security reasons.
6170
Bram Moolenaar677ee682005-01-27 14:41:15 +00006171 *'quoteescape'* *'qe'*
Bram Moolenaarcfbc5ee2004-07-02 15:38:35 +00006172'quoteescape' 'qe' string (default "\")
6173 local to buffer
Bram Moolenaarcfbc5ee2004-07-02 15:38:35 +00006174 The characters that are used to escape quotes in a string. Used for
6175 objects like a', a" and a` |a'|.
6176 When one of the characters in this option is found inside a string,
6177 the following character will be skipped. The default value makes the
6178 text "foo\"bar\\" considered to be one string.
6179
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006180 *'readonly'* *'ro'* *'noreadonly'* *'noro'*
6181'readonly' 'ro' boolean (default off)
6182 local to buffer
6183 If on, writes fail unless you use a '!'. Protects you from
6184 accidentally overwriting a file. Default on when Vim is started
6185 in read-only mode ("vim -R") or when the executable is called "view".
Bram Moolenaar4399ef42005-02-12 14:29:27 +00006186 When using ":w!" the 'readonly' option is reset for the current
6187 buffer, unless the 'Z' flag is in 'cpoptions'.
Bram Moolenaar6c60f472019-04-28 16:00:35 +02006188 When using the ":view" command the 'readonly' option is set for the
6189 newly edited buffer.
Bram Moolenaar369b6f52017-01-17 12:22:32 +01006190 See 'modifiable' for disallowing changes to the buffer.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006191
Bram Moolenaar91a4e822008-01-19 14:59:58 +00006192 *'redrawtime'* *'rdt'*
6193'redrawtime' 'rdt' number (default 2000)
6194 global
Bram Moolenaar91a4e822008-01-19 14:59:58 +00006195 {only available when compiled with the |+reltime|
6196 feature}
6197 The time in milliseconds for redrawing the display. This applies to
Bram Moolenaar15142e22018-04-30 22:19:58 +02006198 searching for patterns for 'hlsearch', |:match| highlighting and syntax
Bram Moolenaar06f1ed22017-06-18 22:41:03 +02006199 highlighting.
Bram Moolenaar91a4e822008-01-19 14:59:58 +00006200 When redrawing takes more than this many milliseconds no further
Bram Moolenaar06f1ed22017-06-18 22:41:03 +02006201 matches will be highlighted.
6202 For syntax highlighting the time applies per window. When over the
6203 limit syntax highlighting is disabled until |CTRL-L| is used.
6204 This is used to avoid that Vim hangs when using a very complicated
6205 pattern.
Bram Moolenaar91a4e822008-01-19 14:59:58 +00006206
Bram Moolenaar543b7ef2013-06-01 14:50:56 +02006207 *'regexpengine'* *'re'*
Bram Moolenaare6ae6222013-05-21 21:01:10 +02006208'regexpengine' 're' number (default 0)
6209 global
Bram Moolenaare6ae6222013-05-21 21:01:10 +02006210 This selects the default regexp engine. |two-engines|
6211 The possible values are:
6212 0 automatic selection
6213 1 old engine
6214 2 NFA engine
6215 Note that when using the NFA engine and the pattern contains something
6216 that is not supported the pattern will not match. This is only useful
6217 for debugging the regexp engine.
Bram Moolenaarfda37292014-11-05 14:27:36 +01006218 Using automatic selection enables Vim to switch the engine, if the
6219 default engine becomes too costly. E.g., when the NFA engine uses too
6220 many states. This should prevent Vim from hanging on a combination of
6221 a complex pattern with long text.
Bram Moolenaare6ae6222013-05-21 21:01:10 +02006222
Bram Moolenaar64486672010-05-16 15:46:46 +02006223 *'relativenumber'* *'rnu'* *'norelativenumber'* *'nornu'*
6224'relativenumber' 'rnu' boolean (default off)
6225 local to window
Bram Moolenaar64486672010-05-16 15:46:46 +02006226 Show the line number relative to the line with the cursor in front of
Bram Moolenaar06b5d512010-05-22 15:37:44 +02006227 each line. Relative line numbers help you use the |count| you can
Bram Moolenaar64486672010-05-16 15:46:46 +02006228 precede some vertical motion commands (e.g. j k + -) with, without
6229 having to calculate it yourself. Especially useful in combination with
6230 other commands (e.g. y d c < > gq gw =).
6231 When the 'n' option is excluded from 'cpoptions' a wrapped
6232 line will not use the column of line numbers (this is the default when
6233 'compatible' isn't set).
6234 The 'numberwidth' option can be used to set the room used for the line
6235 number.
6236 When a long, wrapped line doesn't start with the first character, '-'
6237 characters are put before the number.
Bram Moolenaar61d35bd2012-03-28 20:51:51 +02006238 See |hl-LineNr| and |hl-CursorLineNr| for the highlighting used for
6239 the number.
Bram Moolenaar22f1d0e2018-02-27 14:53:30 +01006240
Bram Moolenaar203d04d2013-06-06 21:36:40 +02006241 The number in front of the cursor line also depends on the value of
6242 'number', see |number_relativenumber| for all combinations of the two
6243 options.
Bram Moolenaar64486672010-05-16 15:46:46 +02006244
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006245 *'remap'* *'noremap'*
6246'remap' boolean (default on)
6247 global
6248 Allows for mappings to work recursively. If you do not want this for
6249 a single entry, use the :noremap[!] command.
Bram Moolenaara3227e22006-03-08 21:32:40 +00006250 NOTE: To avoid portability problems with Vim scripts, always keep
6251 this option at the default "on". Only switch it off when working with
6252 old Vi scripts.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006253
Bram Moolenaarb5a7a8b2014-08-06 14:52:30 +02006254 *'renderoptions'* *'rop'*
6255'renderoptions' 'rop' string (default: empty)
6256 global
Bram Moolenaarb5a7a8b2014-08-06 14:52:30 +02006257 {only available when compiled with GUI and DIRECTX on
6258 MS-Windows}
6259 Select a text renderer and set its options. The options depend on the
6260 renderer.
6261
6262 Syntax: >
6263 set rop=type:{renderer}(,{name}:{value})*
6264<
6265 Currently, only one optional renderer is available.
6266
6267 render behavior ~
6268 directx Vim will draw text using DirectX (DirectWrite). It makes
6269 drawn glyphs more beautiful than default GDI.
6270 It requires 'encoding' is "utf-8", and only works on
6271 MS-Windows Vista or newer version.
6272
6273 Options:
6274 name meaning type value ~
6275 gamma gamma float 1.0 - 2.2 (maybe)
6276 contrast enhancedContrast float (unknown)
6277 level clearTypeLevel float (unknown)
6278 geom pixelGeometry int 0 - 2 (see below)
6279 renmode renderingMode int 0 - 6 (see below)
6280 taamode textAntialiasMode int 0 - 3 (see below)
Bram Moolenaara338adc2018-01-31 20:51:47 +01006281 scrlines Scroll Lines int (deprecated)
Bram Moolenaarb5a7a8b2014-08-06 14:52:30 +02006282
Bram Moolenaar92467d32017-12-05 13:22:16 +01006283 See this URL for detail (except for scrlines):
6284 https://msdn.microsoft.com/en-us/library/dd368190.aspx
Bram Moolenaarb5a7a8b2014-08-06 14:52:30 +02006285
6286 For geom: structure of a device pixel.
6287 0 - DWRITE_PIXEL_GEOMETRY_FLAT
6288 1 - DWRITE_PIXEL_GEOMETRY_RGB
6289 2 - DWRITE_PIXEL_GEOMETRY_BGR
6290
6291 See this URL for detail:
Bram Moolenaar92467d32017-12-05 13:22:16 +01006292 https://msdn.microsoft.com/en-us/library/dd368114.aspx
Bram Moolenaarb5a7a8b2014-08-06 14:52:30 +02006293
6294 For renmode: method of rendering glyphs.
6295 0 - DWRITE_RENDERING_MODE_DEFAULT
6296 1 - DWRITE_RENDERING_MODE_ALIASED
6297 2 - DWRITE_RENDERING_MODE_GDI_CLASSIC
6298 3 - DWRITE_RENDERING_MODE_GDI_NATURAL
6299 4 - DWRITE_RENDERING_MODE_NATURAL
6300 5 - DWRITE_RENDERING_MODE_NATURAL_SYMMETRIC
6301 6 - DWRITE_RENDERING_MODE_OUTLINE
6302
6303 See this URL for detail:
Bram Moolenaar92467d32017-12-05 13:22:16 +01006304 https://msdn.microsoft.com/en-us/library/dd368118.aspx
Bram Moolenaarb5a7a8b2014-08-06 14:52:30 +02006305
6306 For taamode: antialiasing mode used for drawing text.
6307 0 - D2D1_TEXT_ANTIALIAS_MODE_DEFAULT
6308 1 - D2D1_TEXT_ANTIALIAS_MODE_CLEARTYPE
6309 2 - D2D1_TEXT_ANTIALIAS_MODE_GRAYSCALE
6310 3 - D2D1_TEXT_ANTIALIAS_MODE_ALIASED
6311
6312 See this URL for detail:
Bram Moolenaar92467d32017-12-05 13:22:16 +01006313 https://msdn.microsoft.com/en-us/library/dd368170.aspx
6314
Bram Moolenaara338adc2018-01-31 20:51:47 +01006315 For scrlines:
6316 This was used for optimizing scrolling behavior, however this
6317 is now deprecated. If specified, it is simply ignored.
Bram Moolenaarb5a7a8b2014-08-06 14:52:30 +02006318
6319 Example: >
6320 set encoding=utf-8
Bram Moolenaard7ccc4d2017-11-26 14:29:32 +01006321 set gfn=Ricty_Diminished:h12
Bram Moolenaarb5a7a8b2014-08-06 14:52:30 +02006322 set rop=type:directx
6323<
Bram Moolenaard7ccc4d2017-11-26 14:29:32 +01006324 If select a raster font (Courier, Terminal or FixedSys which
6325 have ".fon" extension in file name) to 'guifont', it will be
Bram Moolenaar92467d32017-12-05 13:22:16 +01006326 drawn by GDI as a fallback.
Bram Moolenaard7ccc4d2017-11-26 14:29:32 +01006327
6328 NOTE: It is known that some fonts and options combination
6329 causes trouble on drawing glyphs.
6330
Bram Moolenaar92467d32017-12-05 13:22:16 +01006331 - 'renmode:5' and 'renmode:6' will not work with some
Bram Moolenaard7ccc4d2017-11-26 14:29:32 +01006332 special made fonts (True-Type fonts which includes only
6333 bitmap glyphs).
6334 - 'taamode:3' will not work with some vector fonts.
6335
6336 NOTE: With this option, you can display colored emoji
6337 (emoticon) in Windows 8.1 or later. To display colored emoji,
6338 there are some conditions which you should notice.
6339
6340 - If your font includes non-colored emoji already, it will
6341 be used.
6342 - If your font doesn't have emoji, the system chooses an
6343 alternative symbol font. On Windows 10, "Segoe UI Emoji"
6344 will be used.
6345 - When this alternative font didn't have fixed width glyph,
6346 emoji might be rendered beyond the bounding box of drawing
6347 cell.
Bram Moolenaarb5a7a8b2014-08-06 14:52:30 +02006348
6349 Other render types are currently not supported.
6350
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006351 *'report'*
6352'report' number (default 2)
6353 global
6354 Threshold for reporting number of lines changed. When the number of
6355 changed lines is more than 'report' a message will be given for most
6356 ":" commands. If you want it always, set 'report' to 0.
6357 For the ":substitute" command the number of substitutions is used
6358 instead of the number of lines.
6359
6360 *'restorescreen'* *'rs'* *'norestorescreen'* *'nors'*
6361'restorescreen' 'rs' boolean (default on)
6362 global
Bram Moolenaar8024f932020-01-14 19:29:13 +01006363 {only in MS-Windows console version}
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006364 When set, the screen contents is restored when exiting Vim. This also
6365 happens when executing external commands.
6366
6367 For non-Windows Vim: You can set or reset the 't_ti' and 't_te'
6368 options in your .vimrc. To disable restoring:
6369 set t_ti= t_te=
6370 To enable restoring (for an xterm):
6371 set t_ti=^[7^[[r^[[?47h t_te=^[[?47l^[8
6372 (Where ^[ is an <Esc>, type CTRL-V <Esc> to insert it)
6373
6374 *'revins'* *'ri'* *'norevins'* *'nori'*
6375'revins' 'ri' boolean (default off)
6376 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006377 {only available when compiled with the |+rightleft|
6378 feature}
6379 Inserting characters in Insert mode will work backwards. See "typing
6380 backwards" |ins-reverse|. This option can be toggled with the CTRL-_
6381 command in Insert mode, when 'allowrevins' is set.
Bram Moolenaarca635012015-09-25 20:34:21 +02006382 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
6383 This option is reset when 'paste' is set and restored when 'paste' is
6384 reset.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006385
6386 *'rightleft'* *'rl'* *'norightleft'* *'norl'*
6387'rightleft' 'rl' boolean (default off)
6388 local to window
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006389 {only available when compiled with the |+rightleft|
6390 feature}
6391 When on, display orientation becomes right-to-left, i.e., characters
6392 that are stored in the file appear from the right to the left.
6393 Using this option, it is possible to edit files for languages that
6394 are written from the right to the left such as Hebrew and Arabic.
6395 This option is per window, so it is possible to edit mixed files
6396 simultaneously, or to view the same file in both ways (this is
6397 useful whenever you have a mixed text file with both right-to-left
6398 and left-to-right strings so that both sets are displayed properly
6399 in different windows). Also see |rileft.txt|.
6400
Bram Moolenaar607cc1e2010-07-18 18:47:44 +02006401 *'rightleftcmd'* *'rlc'*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006402'rightleftcmd' 'rlc' string (default "search")
6403 local to window
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006404 {only available when compiled with the |+rightleft|
6405 feature}
6406 Each word in this option enables the command line editing to work in
6407 right-to-left mode for a group of commands:
6408
6409 search "/" and "?" commands
6410
6411 This is useful for languages such as Hebrew, Arabic and Farsi.
6412 The 'rightleft' option must be set for 'rightleftcmd' to take effect.
6413
Bram Moolenaard94464e2015-11-02 15:28:18 +01006414 *'rubydll'*
Bram Moolenaar3848e002016-03-19 18:42:29 +01006415'rubydll' string (default: depends on the build)
Bram Moolenaard94464e2015-11-02 15:28:18 +01006416 global
Bram Moolenaard94464e2015-11-02 15:28:18 +01006417 {only available when compiled with the |+ruby/dyn|
6418 feature}
Bram Moolenaar25e4fcd2016-01-09 14:57:47 +01006419 Specifies the name of the Ruby shared library. The default is
6420 DYNAMIC_RUBY_DLL, which was specified at compile time.
Bram Moolenaaraa3b15d2016-04-21 08:53:19 +02006421 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|.
Bram Moolenaard94464e2015-11-02 15:28:18 +01006422 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
6423 security reasons.
6424
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006425 *'ruler'* *'ru'* *'noruler'* *'noru'*
Bram Moolenaar8c08b5b2016-07-28 22:24:15 +02006426'ruler' 'ru' boolean (default off, set in |defaults.vim|)
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006427 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006428 {not available when compiled without the
6429 |+cmdline_info| feature}
6430 Show the line and column number of the cursor position, separated by a
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00006431 comma. When there is room, the relative position of the displayed
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006432 text in the file is shown on the far right:
6433 Top first line is visible
6434 Bot last line is visible
6435 All first and last line are visible
6436 45% relative position in the file
6437 If 'rulerformat' is set, it will determine the contents of the ruler.
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00006438 Each window has its own ruler. If a window has a status line, the
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006439 ruler is shown there. Otherwise it is shown in the last line of the
Bram Moolenaar582fd852005-03-28 20:58:01 +00006440 screen. If the statusline is given by 'statusline' (i.e. not empty),
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006441 this option takes precedence over 'ruler' and 'rulerformat'
6442 If the number of characters displayed is different from the number of
Bram Moolenaar207f0092020-08-30 17:20:20 +02006443 bytes in the text (e.g., for a TAB or a multibyte character), both
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006444 the text column (byte number) and the screen column are shown,
6445 separated with a dash.
6446 For an empty line "0-1" is shown.
6447 For an empty buffer the line number will also be zero: "0,0-1".
Bram Moolenaarca635012015-09-25 20:34:21 +02006448 This option is reset when 'paste' is set and restored when 'paste' is
6449 reset.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006450 If you don't want to see the ruler all the time but want to know where
6451 you are, use "g CTRL-G" |g_CTRL-G|.
6452 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
6453
6454 *'rulerformat'* *'ruf'*
6455'rulerformat' 'ruf' string (default empty)
6456 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006457 {not available when compiled without the |+statusline|
6458 feature}
6459 When this option is not empty, it determines the content of the ruler
6460 string, as displayed for the 'ruler' option.
Bram Moolenaara23ccb82006-02-27 00:08:02 +00006461 The format of this option is like that of 'statusline'.
Bram Moolenaar110289e2019-05-23 15:38:06 +02006462 This option cannot be set in a modeline when 'modelineexpr' is off.
6463
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006464 The default ruler width is 17 characters. To make the ruler 15
6465 characters wide, put "%15(" at the start and "%)" at the end.
6466 Example: >
6467 :set rulerformat=%15(%c%V\ %p%%%)
6468<
6469 *'runtimepath'* *'rtp'* *vimfiles*
6470'runtimepath' 'rtp' string (default:
Bram Moolenaar942db232021-02-13 18:14:48 +01006471 Unix: "$HOME/.vim,
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006472 $VIM/vimfiles,
6473 $VIMRUNTIME,
6474 $VIM/vimfiles/after,
6475 $HOME/.vim/after"
6476 Amiga: "home:vimfiles,
6477 $VIM/vimfiles,
6478 $VIMRUNTIME,
6479 $VIM/vimfiles/after,
6480 home:vimfiles/after"
Bram Moolenaar942db232021-02-13 18:14:48 +01006481 MS-Windows: "$HOME/vimfiles,
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006482 $VIM/vimfiles,
6483 $VIMRUNTIME,
6484 $VIM/vimfiles/after,
6485 $HOME/vimfiles/after"
Bram Moolenaar3d1cde82020-08-15 18:55:18 +02006486 macOS: "$VIM:vimfiles,
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006487 $VIMRUNTIME,
6488 $VIM:vimfiles:after"
Bram Moolenaarb3f74062020-02-26 16:16:53 +01006489 Haiku: "$BE_USER_SETTINGS/vim,
6490 $VIM/vimfiles,
6491 $VIMRUNTIME,
6492 $VIM/vimfiles/after,
Bram Moolenaar942db232021-02-13 18:14:48 +01006493 $BE_USER_SETTINGS/vim/after"
6494 VMS: "sys$login:vimfiles,
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006495 $VIM/vimfiles,
6496 $VIMRUNTIME,
6497 $VIM/vimfiles/after,
Bram Moolenaar582fd852005-03-28 20:58:01 +00006498 sys$login:vimfiles/after")
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006499 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006500 This is a list of directories which will be searched for runtime
6501 files:
6502 filetype.vim filetypes by file name |new-filetype|
6503 scripts.vim filetypes by file contents |new-filetype-scripts|
Bram Moolenaar4399ef42005-02-12 14:29:27 +00006504 autoload/ automatically loaded scripts |autoload-functions|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006505 colors/ color scheme files |:colorscheme|
6506 compiler/ compiler files |:compiler|
6507 doc/ documentation |write-local-help|
6508 ftplugin/ filetype plugins |write-filetype-plugin|
Bram Moolenaar8a7d6542020-01-26 15:56:19 +01006509 import/ files that are found by `:import`
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006510 indent/ indent scripts |indent-expression|
6511 keymap/ key mapping files |mbyte-keymap|
6512 lang/ menu translations |:menutrans|
6513 menu.vim GUI menus |menu.vim|
Bram Moolenaar26852122016-05-24 20:02:38 +02006514 pack/ packages |:packadd|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006515 plugin/ plugin scripts |write-plugin|
6516 print/ files for printing |postscript-print-encoding|
Bram Moolenaarafeb4fa2006-02-01 21:51:12 +00006517 spell/ spell checking files |spell|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006518 syntax/ syntax files |mysyntaxfile|
6519 tutor/ files for vimtutor |tutor|
6520
6521 And any other file searched for with the |:runtime| command.
6522
6523 The defaults for most systems are setup to search five locations:
6524 1. In your home directory, for your personal preferences.
6525 2. In a system-wide Vim directory, for preferences from the system
6526 administrator.
6527 3. In $VIMRUNTIME, for files distributed with Vim.
6528 *after-directory*
6529 4. In the "after" directory in the system-wide Vim directory. This is
6530 for the system administrator to overrule or add to the distributed
6531 defaults (rarely needed)
6532 5. In the "after" directory in your home directory. This is for
6533 personal preferences to overrule or add to the distributed defaults
6534 or system-wide settings (rarely needed).
6535
Bram Moolenaard0796902016-09-16 20:02:31 +02006536 More entries are added when using |packages|. If it gets very long
6537 then `:set rtp` will be truncated, use `:echo &rtp` to see the full
6538 string.
Bram Moolenaar26852122016-05-24 20:02:38 +02006539
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006540 Note that, unlike 'path', no wildcards like "**" are allowed. Normal
6541 wildcards are allowed, but can significantly slow down searching for
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00006542 runtime files. For speed, use as few items as possible and avoid
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006543 wildcards.
6544 See |:runtime|.
6545 Example: >
6546 :set runtimepath=~/vimruntime,/mygroup/vim,$VIMRUNTIME
6547< This will use the directory "~/vimruntime" first (containing your
6548 personal Vim runtime files), then "/mygroup/vim" (shared between a
6549 group of people) and finally "$VIMRUNTIME" (the distributed runtime
6550 files).
6551 You probably should always include $VIMRUNTIME somewhere, to use the
6552 distributed runtime files. You can put a directory before $VIMRUNTIME
6553 to find files which replace a distributed runtime files. You can put
6554 a directory after $VIMRUNTIME to find files which add to distributed
6555 runtime files.
Bram Moolenaarb5b75622018-03-09 22:22:21 +01006556 When Vim is started with |--clean| the home directory entries are not
6557 included.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006558 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
6559 security reasons.
6560
6561 *'scroll'* *'scr'*
6562'scroll' 'scr' number (default: half the window height)
6563 local to window
6564 Number of lines to scroll with CTRL-U and CTRL-D commands. Will be
6565 set to half the number of lines in the window when the window size
Bram Moolenaar74667062020-12-28 15:41:41 +01006566 changes. This may happen when enabling the |status-line| or
6567 'tabline' option after setting the 'scroll' option.
6568 If you give a count to the CTRL-U or CTRL-D command it will
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00006569 be used as the new value for 'scroll'. Reset to half the window
Bram Moolenaar25c9c682019-05-05 18:13:34 +02006570 height with ":set scroll=0".
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006571
6572 *'scrollbind'* *'scb'* *'noscrollbind'* *'noscb'*
6573'scrollbind' 'scb' boolean (default off)
6574 local to window
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006575 See also |scroll-binding|. When this option is set, the current
6576 window scrolls as other scrollbind windows (windows that also have
6577 this option set) scroll. This option is useful for viewing the
6578 differences between two versions of a file, see 'diff'.
6579 See |'scrollopt'| for options that determine how this option should be
6580 interpreted.
6581 This option is mostly reset when splitting a window to edit another
6582 file. This means that ":split | edit file" results in two windows
6583 with scroll-binding, but ":split file" does not.
6584
Bram Moolenaarae20f342019-11-05 21:09:23 +01006585 *'scrollfocus'* *'scf'* *'noscrollfocus'* *'noscf'*
6586'scrollfocus' 'scf' boolean (default off)
6587 global
6588 {only for MS-Windows GUI}
6589 When using the scroll wheel and this option is set, the window under
6590 the mouse pointer is scrolled. With this option off the current
6591 window is scrolled.
Bram Moolenaar5ef1c6a2019-11-10 22:09:11 +01006592 Systems other than MS-Windows always behave like this option is on.
Bram Moolenaarae20f342019-11-05 21:09:23 +01006593
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006594 *'scrolljump'* *'sj'*
6595'scrolljump' 'sj' number (default 1)
6596 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006597 Minimal number of lines to scroll when the cursor gets off the
6598 screen (e.g., with "j"). Not used for scroll commands (e.g., CTRL-E,
6599 CTRL-D). Useful if your terminal scrolls very slowly.
Bram Moolenaar1e015462005-09-25 22:16:38 +00006600 When set to a negative number from -1 to -100 this is used as the
6601 percentage of the window height. Thus -50 scrolls half the window
6602 height.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006603 NOTE: This option is set to 1 when 'compatible' is set.
6604
6605 *'scrolloff'* *'so'*
Bram Moolenaar50ba5262016-09-22 22:33:02 +02006606'scrolloff' 'so' number (default 0, set to 5 in |defaults.vim|)
Bram Moolenaar375e3392019-01-31 18:26:10 +01006607 global or local to window |global-local|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006608 Minimal number of screen lines to keep above and below the cursor.
6609 This will make some context visible around where you are working. If
6610 you set it to a very large value (999) the cursor line will always be
6611 in the middle of the window (except at the start or end of the file or
6612 when long lines wrap).
Bram Moolenaar375e3392019-01-31 18:26:10 +01006613 After using the local value, go back the global value with one of
6614 these two: >
6615 setlocal scrolloff<
6616 setlocal scrolloff=-1
6617< For scrolling horizontally see 'sidescrolloff'.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006618 NOTE: This option is set to 0 when 'compatible' is set.
6619
6620 *'scrollopt'* *'sbo'*
6621'scrollopt' 'sbo' string (default "ver,jump")
6622 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006623 This is a comma-separated list of words that specifies how
Bram Moolenaar402d2fe2005-04-15 21:00:38 +00006624 'scrollbind' windows should behave. 'sbo' stands for ScrollBind
6625 Options.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006626 The following words are available:
6627 ver Bind vertical scrolling for 'scrollbind' windows
6628 hor Bind horizontal scrolling for 'scrollbind' windows
6629 jump Applies to the offset between two windows for vertical
6630 scrolling. This offset is the difference in the first
6631 displayed line of the bound windows. When moving
6632 around in a window, another 'scrollbind' window may
6633 reach a position before the start or after the end of
6634 the buffer. The offset is not changed though, when
6635 moving back the 'scrollbind' window will try to scroll
6636 to the desired position when possible.
6637 When now making that window the current one, two
6638 things can be done with the relative offset:
6639 1. When "jump" is not included, the relative offset is
6640 adjusted for the scroll position in the new current
6641 window. When going back to the other window, the
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00006642 new relative offset will be used.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006643 2. When "jump" is included, the other windows are
6644 scrolled to keep the same relative offset. When
6645 going back to the other window, it still uses the
6646 same relative offset.
6647 Also see |scroll-binding|.
Bram Moolenaar910f66f2006-04-05 20:41:53 +00006648 When 'diff' mode is active there always is vertical scroll binding,
6649 even when "ver" isn't there.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006650
6651 *'sections'* *'sect'*
6652'sections' 'sect' string (default "SHNHH HUnhsh")
6653 global
6654 Specifies the nroff macros that separate sections. These are pairs of
6655 two letters (See |object-motions|). The default makes a section start
6656 at the nroff macros ".SH", ".NH", ".H", ".HU", ".nh" and ".sh".
6657
6658 *'secure'* *'nosecure'* *E523*
6659'secure' boolean (default off)
6660 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006661 When on, ":autocmd", shell and write commands are not allowed in
6662 ".vimrc" and ".exrc" in the current directory and map commands are
6663 displayed. Switch it off only if you know that you will not run into
6664 problems, or when the 'exrc' option is off. On Unix this option is
6665 only used if the ".vimrc" or ".exrc" is not owned by you. This can be
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00006666 dangerous if the systems allows users to do a "chown". You better set
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006667 'secure' at the end of your ~/.vimrc then.
6668 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
6669 security reasons.
6670
6671 *'selection'* *'sel'*
6672'selection' 'sel' string (default "inclusive")
6673 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006674 This option defines the behavior of the selection. It is only used
6675 in Visual and Select mode.
6676 Possible values:
6677 value past line inclusive ~
6678 old no yes
6679 inclusive yes yes
6680 exclusive yes no
6681 "past line" means that the cursor is allowed to be positioned one
6682 character past the line.
6683 "inclusive" means that the last character of the selection is included
6684 in an operation. For example, when "x" is used to delete the
6685 selection.
Bram Moolenaare4a3bcf2016-08-26 19:52:37 +02006686 When "old" is used and 'virtualedit' allows the cursor to move past
6687 the end of line the line break still isn't included.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006688 Note that when "exclusive" is used and selecting from the end
6689 backwards, you cannot include the last character of a line, when
6690 starting in Normal mode and 'virtualedit' empty.
6691
6692 The 'selection' option is set by the |:behave| command.
6693
6694 *'selectmode'* *'slm'*
6695'selectmode' 'slm' string (default "")
6696 global
Bram Moolenaarcbaff5e2022-04-08 17:45:08 +01006697 This is a comma-separated list of words, which specifies when to start
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006698 Select mode instead of Visual mode, when a selection is started.
6699 Possible values:
6700 mouse when using the mouse
6701 key when using shifted special keys
6702 cmd when using "v", "V" or CTRL-V
6703 See |Select-mode|.
6704 The 'selectmode' option is set by the |:behave| command.
6705
6706 *'sessionoptions'* *'ssop'*
6707'sessionoptions' 'ssop' string (default: "blank,buffers,curdir,folds,
Bram Moolenaarb5b75622018-03-09 22:22:21 +01006708 help,options,tabpages,winsize,terminal")
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006709 global
Bram Moolenaardb84e452010-08-15 13:50:43 +02006710 {not available when compiled without the |+mksession|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006711 feature}
6712 Changes the effect of the |:mksession| command. It is a comma
6713 separated list of words. Each word enables saving and restoring
6714 something:
6715 word save and restore ~
6716 blank empty windows
6717 buffers hidden and unloaded buffers, not just those in windows
6718 curdir the current directory
6719 folds manually created folds, opened/closed folds and local
6720 fold options
6721 globals global variables that start with an uppercase letter
Bram Moolenaar12805862005-01-05 22:16:17 +00006722 and contain at least one lowercase letter. Only
6723 String and Number types are stored.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006724 help the help window
6725 localoptions options and mappings local to a window or buffer (not
6726 global values for local options)
6727 options all options and mappings (also global values for local
6728 options)
Bram Moolenaard23b7142021-04-17 21:04:34 +02006729 skiprtp exclude 'runtimepath' and 'packpath' from the options
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006730 resize size of the Vim window: 'lines' and 'columns'
6731 sesdir the directory in which the session file is located
6732 will become the current directory (useful with
6733 projects accessed over a network from different
6734 systems)
6735 slash backslashes in file names replaced with forward
6736 slashes
Bram Moolenaar18144c82006-04-12 21:52:12 +00006737 tabpages all tab pages; without this only the current tab page
6738 is restored, so that you can make a session for each
6739 tab page separately
Bram Moolenaard473c8c2018-08-11 18:00:22 +02006740 terminal include terminal windows where the command can be
6741 restored
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006742 unix with Unix end-of-line format (single <NL>), even when
6743 on Windows or DOS
6744 winpos position of the whole Vim window
6745 winsize window sizes
6746
6747 Don't include both "curdir" and "sesdir".
Bram Moolenaar8f3f58f2010-01-06 20:52:26 +01006748 When neither "curdir" nor "sesdir" is included, file names are stored
6749 with absolute paths.
Bram Moolenaar2f0936c2022-01-08 21:51:59 +00006750 If you leave out "options" many things won't work well after restoring
6751 the session.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006752 "slash" and "unix" are useful on Windows when sharing session files
6753 with Unix. The Unix version of Vim cannot source dos format scripts,
6754 but the Windows version of Vim can source unix format scripts.
6755
6756 *'shell'* *'sh'* *E91*
Bram Moolenaar95a9dd12019-12-19 22:12:03 +01006757'shell' 'sh' string (default $SHELL or "sh", Win32: "cmd.exe")
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006758 global
6759 Name of the shell to use for ! and :! commands. When changing the
6760 value also check these options: 'shelltype', 'shellpipe', 'shellslash'
6761 'shellredir', 'shellquote', 'shellxquote' and 'shellcmdflag'.
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00006762 It is allowed to give an argument to the command, e.g. "csh -f".
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006763 See |option-backslash| about including spaces and backslashes.
6764 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|.
Bram Moolenaar4bfa8af2018-02-03 15:14:46 +01006765
Bram Moolenaara2baa732022-02-04 16:09:54 +00006766 In |restricted-mode| shell commands will not be possible. This mode
6767 is used if the value of $SHELL ends in "false" or "nologin".
6768
Bram Moolenaar1ff14ba2019-11-02 14:09:23 +01006769 If the name of the shell contains a space, you need to enclose it in
Bram Moolenaar5ef1c6a2019-11-10 22:09:11 +01006770 quotes and escape the space. Example with quotes: >
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006771 :set shell=\"c:\program\ files\unix\sh.exe\"\ -f
6772< Note the backslash before each quote (to avoid starting a comment) and
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00006773 each space (to avoid ending the option value). Also note that the
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006774 "-f" is not inside the quotes, because it is not part of the command
Bram Moolenaar4bfa8af2018-02-03 15:14:46 +01006775 name. Vim automagically recognizes the backslashes that are path
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006776 separators.
Bram Moolenaar4bfa8af2018-02-03 15:14:46 +01006777 Example with escaped space (Vim will do this when initializing the
6778 option from $SHELL): >
6779 :set shell=/bin/with\\\ space/sh
Bram Moolenaard473c8c2018-08-11 18:00:22 +02006780< The resulting value of 'shell' is "/bin/with\ space/sh", two
Bram Moolenaar4bfa8af2018-02-03 15:14:46 +01006781 backslashes are consumed by `:set`.
6782
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006783 Under MS-Windows, when the executable ends in ".com" it must be
6784 included. Thus setting the shell to "command.com" or "4dos.com"
6785 works, but "command" and "4dos" do not work for all commands (e.g.,
6786 filtering).
6787 For unknown reasons, when using "4dos.com" the current directory is
6788 changed to "C:\". To avoid this set 'shell' like this: >
6789 :set shell=command.com\ /c\ 4dos
6790< This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
6791 security reasons.
6792
6793 *'shellcmdflag'* *'shcf'*
Bram Moolenaar5dc62522012-02-13 00:05:22 +01006794'shellcmdflag' 'shcf' string (default: "-c";
Mike Williams12795022021-06-28 20:53:58 +02006795 Win32, when 'shell' contains "powershell":
6796 "-Command", or when it does not contain "sh"
Bram Moolenaar5666fcd2019-12-26 14:35:26 +01006797 somewhere: "/c")
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006798 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006799 Flag passed to the shell to execute "!" and ":!" commands; e.g.,
Mike Williams12795022021-06-28 20:53:58 +02006800 "bash.exe -c ls", "powershell.exe -Command dir", or "cmd.exe /c dir".
6801 For MS-Windows, the default is set according to the value of 'shell',
6802 to reduce the need to set this option by the user.
Bram Moolenaar5302d9e2011-09-14 17:55:08 +02006803 On Unix it can have more than one flag. Each white space separated
6804 part is passed as an argument to the shell command.
6805 See |option-backslash| about including spaces and backslashes.
Mike Williams12795022021-06-28 20:53:58 +02006806 Also see |dos-shell| and |dos-powershell| for MS-Windows.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006807 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
6808 security reasons.
6809
6810 *'shellpipe'* *'sp'*
Mike Williams12795022021-06-28 20:53:58 +02006811'shellpipe' 'sp' string (default ">", ">%s 2>&1", "| tee", "|& tee"
6812 "2>&1| tee", or
6813 "2>&1 | Out-File -Encoding default")
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006814 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006815 {not available when compiled without the |+quickfix|
6816 feature}
6817 String to be used to put the output of the ":make" command in the
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00006818 error file. See also |:make_makeprg|. See |option-backslash| about
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006819 including spaces and backslashes.
6820 The name of the temporary file can be represented by "%s" if necessary
6821 (the file name is appended automatically if no %s appears in the value
6822 of this option).
Mike Williams12795022021-06-28 20:53:58 +02006823 For the Amiga the default is ">". For MS-Windows using powershell the
6824 default is "2>&1 | Out-File -Encoding default", otherwise the default
6825 is ">%s 2>&1". The output is directly saved in a file and not echoed
6826 to the screen.
Bram Moolenaar1c6737b2020-09-07 22:18:52 +02006827 For Unix the default is "| tee". The stdout of the compiler is saved
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006828 in a file and echoed to the screen. If the 'shell' option is "csh" or
6829 "tcsh" after initializations, the default becomes "|& tee". If the
Bram Moolenaar96f45c02019-10-26 19:53:45 +02006830 'shell' option is "sh", "ksh", "mksh", "pdksh", "zsh", "zsh-beta",
Natanael Copa56318362021-05-06 18:46:35 +02006831 "bash", "fish", "ash" or "dash" the default becomes "2>&1| tee". This
6832 means that stderr is also included. Before using the 'shell' option a
6833 path is removed, thus "/bin/sh" uses "sh".
Mike Williamsa3d1b292021-06-30 20:56:00 +02006834 For Unix and MS-Windows, when the 'shell' option is "pwsh" the default
6835 becomes ">%s 2>&1" and the output is not echoed to the screen.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006836 The initialization of this option is done after reading the ".vimrc"
6837 and the other initializations, so that when the 'shell' option is set
6838 there, the 'shellpipe' option changes automatically, unless it was
6839 explicitly set before.
6840 When 'shellpipe' is set to an empty string, no redirection of the
6841 ":make" output will be done. This is useful if you use a 'makeprg'
6842 that writes to 'makeef' by itself. If you want no piping, but do
6843 want to include the 'makeef', set 'shellpipe' to a single space.
6844 Don't forget to precede the space with a backslash: ":set sp=\ ".
6845 In the future pipes may be used for filtering and this option will
6846 become obsolete (at least for Unix).
6847 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
6848 security reasons.
6849
6850 *'shellquote'* *'shq'*
Mike Williamsa3d1b292021-06-30 20:56:00 +02006851'shellquote' 'shq' string (default: "")
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006852 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006853 Quoting character(s), put around the command passed to the shell, for
6854 the "!" and ":!" commands. The redirection is kept outside of the
6855 quoting. See 'shellxquote' to include the redirection. It's
6856 probably not useful to set both options.
6857 This is an empty string by default. Only known to be useful for
Bram Moolenaar5666fcd2019-12-26 14:35:26 +01006858 third-party shells on MS-Windows-like systems, such as the MKS Korn
Mike Williamsa3d1b292021-06-30 20:56:00 +02006859 Shell or bash, where it should be "\"". See |dos-shell|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006860 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
6861 security reasons.
6862
6863 *'shellredir'* *'srr'*
Mike Williams12795022021-06-28 20:53:58 +02006864'shellredir' 'srr' string (default ">", ">&", ">%s 2>&1", or
6865 "2>&1 | Out-File -Encoding default")
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006866 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006867 String to be used to put the output of a filter command in a temporary
6868 file. See also |:!|. See |option-backslash| about including spaces
6869 and backslashes.
6870 The name of the temporary file can be represented by "%s" if necessary
6871 (the file name is appended automatically if no %s appears in the value
6872 of this option).
Bram Moolenaar96f45c02019-10-26 19:53:45 +02006873 The default is ">". For Unix, if the 'shell' option is "csh" or
6874 "tcsh" during initializations, the default becomes ">&". If the
Bram Moolenaar0c0734d2019-11-26 21:44:46 +01006875 'shell' option is "sh", "ksh", "mksh", "pdksh", "zsh", "zsh-beta",
Mike Williamsa3d1b292021-06-30 20:56:00 +02006876 "bash", "fish", or "pwsh", the default becomes ">%s 2>&1". This means
6877 that stderr is also included. For Win32, the Unix checks are done and
Mike Williams12795022021-06-28 20:53:58 +02006878 additionally "cmd" is checked for, which makes the default ">%s 2>&1",
6879 and "powershell" is checked for which makes the default
Mike Williamsa3d1b292021-06-30 20:56:00 +02006880 "2>&1 | Out-File -Encoding default" (see |dos-powershell|). Also, the
6881 same names with ".exe" appended are checked for.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006882 The initialization of this option is done after reading the ".vimrc"
6883 and the other initializations, so that when the 'shell' option is set
6884 there, the 'shellredir' option changes automatically unless it was
6885 explicitly set before.
6886 In the future pipes may be used for filtering and this option will
6887 become obsolete (at least for Unix).
6888 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
6889 security reasons.
6890
6891 *'shellslash'* *'ssl'* *'noshellslash'* *'nossl'*
6892'shellslash' 'ssl' boolean (default off)
6893 global
Bram Moolenaar6f345a12019-12-17 21:27:18 +01006894 {only for MS-Windows}
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006895 When set, a forward slash is used when expanding file names. This is
Mike Williamsa3d1b292021-06-30 20:56:00 +02006896 useful when a Unix-like shell is used instead of cmd.exe, pwsh.exe, or
Mike Williams12795022021-06-28 20:53:58 +02006897 powershell.exe. Backward slashes can still be typed, but they are
6898 changed to forward slashes by Vim.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006899 Note that setting or resetting this option has no effect for some
6900 existing file names, thus this option needs to be set before opening
6901 any file for best results. This might change in the future.
6902 'shellslash' only works when a backslash can be used as a path
6903 separator. To test if this is so use: >
6904 if exists('+shellslash')
Bram Moolenaarac3150d2019-07-28 16:36:39 +02006905< Also see 'completeslash'.
6906
Bram Moolenaar26a60b42005-02-22 08:49:11 +00006907 *'shelltemp'* *'stmp'* *'noshelltemp'* *'nostmp'*
6908'shelltemp' 'stmp' boolean (Vi default off, Vim default on)
6909 global
Bram Moolenaar26a60b42005-02-22 08:49:11 +00006910 When on, use temp files for shell commands. When off use a pipe.
6911 When using a pipe is not possible temp files are used anyway.
Bram Moolenaar97293012011-07-18 19:40:27 +02006912 Currently a pipe is only supported on Unix and MS-Windows 2K and
6913 later. You can check it with: >
Bram Moolenaar26a60b42005-02-22 08:49:11 +00006914 :if has("filterpipe")
6915< The advantage of using a pipe is that nobody can read the temp file
6916 and the 'shell' command does not need to support redirection.
6917 The advantage of using a temp file is that the file type and encoding
6918 can be detected.
6919 The |FilterReadPre|, |FilterReadPost| and |FilterWritePre|,
6920 |FilterWritePost| autocommands event are not triggered when
6921 'shelltemp' is off.
Bram Moolenaar269f5952016-07-15 22:54:41 +02006922 The `system()` function does not respect this option and always uses
6923 temp files.
Bram Moolenaar036986f2017-03-16 17:41:02 +01006924 NOTE: This option is set to the Vim default value when 'compatible'
6925 is reset.
Bram Moolenaar26a60b42005-02-22 08:49:11 +00006926
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006927 *'shelltype'* *'st'*
6928'shelltype' 'st' number (default 0)
6929 global
Bram Moolenaar6c60f472019-04-28 16:00:35 +02006930 {only for the Amiga}
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006931 On the Amiga this option influences the way how the commands work
6932 which use a shell.
6933 0 and 1: always use the shell
6934 2 and 3: use the shell only to filter lines
6935 4 and 5: use shell only for ':sh' command
6936 When not using the shell, the command is executed directly.
6937
6938 0 and 2: use "shell 'shellcmdflag' cmd" to start external commands
6939 1 and 3: use "shell cmd" to start external commands
6940
Bram Moolenaardb7207e2012-02-22 17:30:19 +01006941 *'shellxescape'* *'sxe'*
6942'shellxescape' 'sxe' string (default: "";
Bram Moolenaar5666fcd2019-12-26 14:35:26 +01006943 for MS-Windows: "\"&|<>()@^")
Bram Moolenaardb7207e2012-02-22 17:30:19 +01006944 global
Bram Moolenaardb7207e2012-02-22 17:30:19 +01006945 When 'shellxquote' is set to "(" then the characters listed in this
6946 option will be escaped with a '^' character. This makes it possible
6947 to execute most external commands with cmd.exe.
6948
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006949 *'shellxquote'* *'sxq'*
6950'shellxquote' 'sxq' string (default: "";
Bram Moolenaarf66b3fc2012-02-20 22:18:30 +01006951 for Win32, when 'shell' is cmd.exe: "("
Mike Williams12795022021-06-28 20:53:58 +02006952 for Win32, when 'shell' is
6953 powershell.exe: "\""
Bram Moolenaarf66b3fc2012-02-20 22:18:30 +01006954 for Win32, when 'shell' contains "sh"
6955 somewhere: "\""
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006956 for Unix, when using system(): "\"")
6957 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006958 Quoting character(s), put around the command passed to the shell, for
6959 the "!" and ":!" commands. Includes the redirection. See
6960 'shellquote' to exclude the redirection. It's probably not useful
6961 to set both options.
Bram Moolenaarf66b3fc2012-02-20 22:18:30 +01006962 When the value is '(' then ')' is appended. When the value is '"('
6963 then ')"' is appended.
6964 When the value is '(' then also see 'shellxescape'.
Bram Moolenaara64ba222012-02-12 23:23:31 +01006965 This is an empty string by default on most systems, but is known to be
Mike Williamsa3d1b292021-06-30 20:56:00 +02006966 useful for on Win32 version, either for cmd.exe, powershell.exe, or
6967 pwsh.exe which automatically strips off the first and last quote on a
6968 command, or 3rd-party shells such as the MKS Korn Shell or bash, where
6969 it should be "\"". The default is adjusted according the value of
Mike Williams12795022021-06-28 20:53:58 +02006970 'shell', to reduce the need to set this option by the user. See
6971 |dos-shell|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006972 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
6973 security reasons.
6974
6975 *'shiftround'* *'sr'* *'noshiftround'* *'nosr'*
6976'shiftround' 'sr' boolean (default off)
6977 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006978 Round indent to multiple of 'shiftwidth'. Applies to > and <
6979 commands. CTRL-T and CTRL-D in Insert mode always round the indent to
6980 a multiple of 'shiftwidth' (this is Vi compatible).
6981 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
6982
6983 *'shiftwidth'* *'sw'*
6984'shiftwidth' 'sw' number (default 8)
6985 local to buffer
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00006986 Number of spaces to use for each step of (auto)indent. Used for
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006987 |'cindent'|, |>>|, |<<|, etc.
Bram Moolenaar3a0d8092012-10-21 03:02:54 +02006988 When zero the 'ts' value will be used. Use the |shiftwidth()|
6989 function to get the effective shiftwidth value.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006990
6991 *'shortmess'* *'shm'*
Bram Moolenaar9dfa3132019-05-04 21:08:40 +02006992'shortmess' 'shm' string (Vim default "filnxtToOS", Vi default: "S",
6993 POSIX default: "AS")
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006994 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006995 This option helps to avoid all the |hit-enter| prompts caused by file
6996 messages, for example with CTRL-G, and to avoid some other messages.
6997 It is a list of flags:
6998 flag meaning when present ~
6999 f use "(3 of 5)" instead of "(file 3 of 5)"
7000 i use "[noeol]" instead of "[Incomplete last line]"
Bram Moolenaar3f40ce72020-07-05 14:10:13 +02007001 l use "999L, 888B" instead of "999 lines, 888 bytes"
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007002 m use "[+]" instead of "[Modified]"
7003 n use "[New]" instead of "[New File]"
7004 r use "[RO]" instead of "[readonly]"
7005 w use "[w]" instead of "written" for file write message
7006 and "[a]" instead of "appended" for ':w >> file' command
7007 x use "[dos]" instead of "[dos format]", "[unix]" instead of
7008 "[unix format]" and "[mac]" instead of "[mac format]".
7009 a all of the above abbreviations
7010
7011 o overwrite message for writing a file with subsequent message
7012 for reading a file (useful for ":wn" or when 'autowrite' on)
7013 O message for reading a file overwrites any previous message.
7014 Also for quickfix message (e.g., ":cn").
7015 s don't give "search hit BOTTOM, continuing at TOP" or "search
Bram Moolenaara6c27c42019-05-09 19:16:22 +02007016 hit TOP, continuing at BOTTOM" messages; when using the search
7017 count do not show "W" after the count message (see S below)
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007018 t truncate file message at the start if it is too long to fit
7019 on the command-line, "<" will appear in the left most column.
7020 Ignored in Ex mode.
7021 T truncate other messages in the middle if they are too long to
Bram Moolenaar582fd852005-03-28 20:58:01 +00007022 fit on the command line. "..." will appear in the middle.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007023 Ignored in Ex mode.
7024 W don't give "written" or "[w]" when writing a file
7025 A don't give the "ATTENTION" message when an existing swap file
7026 is found.
7027 I don't give the intro message when starting Vim |:intro|.
Bram Moolenaarea389e92014-05-28 21:40:52 +02007028 c don't give |ins-completion-menu| messages. For example,
7029 "-- XXX completion (YYY)", "match 1 of 2", "The only match",
7030 "Pattern not found", "Back at original", etc.
Bram Moolenaar426dd022016-03-15 15:09:29 +01007031 q use "recording" instead of "recording @a"
7032 F don't give the file info when editing a file, like `:silent`
Bram Moolenaar110289e2019-05-23 15:38:06 +02007033 was used for the command; note that this also affects messages
7034 from autocommands
Bram Moolenaar9dfa3132019-05-04 21:08:40 +02007035 S do not show search count message when searching, e.g.
7036 "[1/5]"
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007037
7038 This gives you the opportunity to avoid that a change between buffers
7039 requires you to hit <Enter>, but still gives as useful a message as
7040 possible for the space available. To get the whole message that you
7041 would have got with 'shm' empty, use ":file!"
7042 Useful values:
7043 shm= No abbreviation of message.
7044 shm=a Abbreviation, but no loss of information.
7045 shm=at Abbreviation, and truncate message when necessary.
7046
7047 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
7048 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
7049
7050 *'shortname'* *'sn'* *'noshortname'* *'nosn'*
7051'shortname' 'sn' boolean (default off)
7052 local to buffer
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007053 Filenames are assumed to be 8 characters plus one extension of 3
7054 characters. Multiple dots in file names are not allowed. When this
7055 option is on, dots in file names are replaced with underscores when
Bram Moolenaar5666fcd2019-12-26 14:35:26 +01007056 adding an extension (".~" or ".swp"). This option is useful
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007057 when editing files on an MS-DOS compatible filesystem, e.g., messydos
Bram Moolenaarade0d392020-01-21 22:33:58 +01007058 or crossdos.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007059
7060 *'showbreak'* *'sbr'* *E595*
7061'showbreak' 'sbr' string (default "")
Bram Moolenaaree857022019-11-09 23:26:40 +01007062 global or local to window |global-local|
Bram Moolenaardb84e452010-08-15 13:50:43 +02007063 {not available when compiled without the |+linebreak|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007064 feature}
7065 String to put at the start of lines that have been wrapped. Useful
Bram Moolenaar8f3f58f2010-01-06 20:52:26 +01007066 values are "> " or "+++ ": >
7067 :set showbreak=>\
7068< Note the backslash to escape the trailing space. It's easier like
7069 this: >
Bram Moolenaar1a384422010-07-14 19:53:30 +02007070 :let &showbreak = '+++ '
Bram Moolenaar8f3f58f2010-01-06 20:52:26 +01007071< Only printable single-cell characters are allowed, excluding <Tab> and
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007072 comma (in a future version the comma might be used to separate the
7073 part that is shown at the end and at the start of a line).
7074 The characters are highlighted according to the '@' flag in
7075 'highlight'.
7076 Note that tabs after the showbreak will be displayed differently.
7077 If you want the 'showbreak' to appear in between line numbers, add the
7078 "n" flag to 'cpoptions'.
Bram Moolenaaree857022019-11-09 23:26:40 +01007079 A window-local value overrules a global value. If the global value is
7080 set and you want no value in the current window use NONE: >
7081 :setlocal showbreak=NONE
7082<
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007083 *'showcmd'* *'sc'* *'noshowcmd'* *'nosc'*
Bram Moolenaar8c08b5b2016-07-28 22:24:15 +02007084'showcmd' 'sc' boolean (Vim default: on, off for Unix,
7085 Vi default: off, set in |defaults.vim|)
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007086 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007087 {not available when compiled without the
7088 |+cmdline_info| feature}
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00007089 Show (partial) command in the last line of the screen. Set this
7090 option off if your terminal is slow.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007091 In Visual mode the size of the selected area is shown:
7092 - When selecting characters within a line, the number of characters.
Bram Moolenaarf91787c2010-07-17 12:47:16 +02007093 If the number of bytes is different it is also displayed: "2-6"
7094 means two characters and six bytes.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007095 - When selecting more than one line, the number of lines.
Bram Moolenaar8f3f58f2010-01-06 20:52:26 +01007096 - When selecting a block, the size in screen characters:
7097 {lines}x{columns}.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007098 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
7099 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
7100
7101 *'showfulltag'* *'sft'* *'noshowfulltag'* *'nosft'*
7102'showfulltag' 'sft' boolean (default off)
7103 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007104 When completing a word in insert mode (see |ins-completion|) from the
7105 tags file, show both the tag name and a tidied-up form of the search
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00007106 pattern (if there is one) as possible matches. Thus, if you have
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007107 matched a C function, you can see a template for what arguments are
7108 required (coding style permitting).
Bram Moolenaar446cb832008-06-24 21:56:24 +00007109 Note that this doesn't work well together with having "longest" in
7110 'completeopt', because the completion from the search pattern may not
7111 match the typed text.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007112
7113 *'showmatch'* *'sm'* *'noshowmatch'* *'nosm'*
7114'showmatch' 'sm' boolean (default off)
7115 global
7116 When a bracket is inserted, briefly jump to the matching one. The
7117 jump is only done if the match can be seen on the screen. The time to
7118 show the match can be set with 'matchtime'.
7119 A Beep is given if there is no match (no matter if the match can be
Bram Moolenaarca635012015-09-25 20:34:21 +02007120 seen or not).
7121 This option is reset when 'paste' is set and restored when 'paste' is
7122 reset.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007123 When the 'm' flag is not included in 'cpoptions', typing a character
7124 will immediately move the cursor back to where it belongs.
7125 See the "sm" field in 'guicursor' for setting the cursor shape and
7126 blinking when showing the match.
7127 The 'matchpairs' option can be used to specify the characters to show
7128 matches for. 'rightleft' and 'revins' are used to look for opposite
7129 matches.
Bram Moolenaarfd2ac762006-03-01 22:09:21 +00007130 Also see the matchparen plugin for highlighting the match when moving
7131 around |pi_paren.txt|.
7132 Note: Use of the short form is rated PG.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007133
7134 *'showmode'* *'smd'* *'noshowmode'* *'nosmd'*
7135'showmode' 'smd' boolean (Vim default: on, Vi default: off)
7136 global
7137 If in Insert, Replace or Visual mode put a message on the last line.
7138 Use the 'M' flag in 'highlight' to set the type of highlighting for
7139 this message.
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00007140 When |XIM| may be used the message will include "XIM". But this
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007141 doesn't mean XIM is really active, especially when 'imactivatekey' is
7142 not set.
7143 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
7144 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
7145
Bram Moolenaarfaa959a2006-02-20 21:37:40 +00007146 *'showtabline'* *'stal'*
7147'showtabline' 'stal' number (default 1)
7148 global
Bram Moolenaarfaa959a2006-02-20 21:37:40 +00007149 The value of this option specifies when the line with tab page labels
7150 will be displayed:
7151 0: never
7152 1: only if there are at least two tab pages
7153 2: always
7154 This is both for the GUI and non-GUI implementation of the tab pages
7155 line.
7156 See |tab-page| for more information about tab pages.
7157
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007158 *'sidescroll'* *'ss'*
7159'sidescroll' 'ss' number (default 0)
7160 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007161 The minimal number of columns to scroll horizontally. Used only when
7162 the 'wrap' option is off and the cursor is moved off of the screen.
7163 When it is zero the cursor will be put in the middle of the screen.
7164 When using a slow terminal set it to a large number or 0. When using
7165 a fast terminal use a small number or 1. Not used for "zh" and "zl"
7166 commands.
7167
7168 *'sidescrolloff'* *'siso'*
7169'sidescrolloff' 'siso' number (default 0)
Bram Moolenaar375e3392019-01-31 18:26:10 +01007170 global or local to window |global-local|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007171 The minimal number of screen columns to keep to the left and to the
Bram Moolenaar482aaeb2005-09-29 18:26:07 +00007172 right of the cursor if 'nowrap' is set. Setting this option to a
7173 value greater than 0 while having |'sidescroll'| also at a non-zero
7174 value makes some context visible in the line you are scrolling in
7175 horizontally (except at beginning of the line). Setting this option
7176 to a large value (like 999) has the effect of keeping the cursor
7177 horizontally centered in the window, as long as one does not come too
7178 close to the beginning of the line.
Bram Moolenaar375e3392019-01-31 18:26:10 +01007179 After using the local value, go back the global value with one of
7180 these two: >
7181 setlocal sidescrolloff<
7182 setlocal sidescrolloff=-1
7183< NOTE: This option is set to 0 when 'compatible' is set.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007184
7185 Example: Try this together with 'sidescroll' and 'listchars' as
7186 in the following example to never allow the cursor to move
Bram Moolenaar95ec9d62016-08-12 18:29:59 +02007187 onto the "extends" character: >
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007188
7189 :set nowrap sidescroll=1 listchars=extends:>,precedes:<
7190 :set sidescrolloff=1
Bram Moolenaar95ec9d62016-08-12 18:29:59 +02007191<
7192 *'signcolumn'* *'scl'*
7193'signcolumn' 'scl' string (default "auto")
7194 local to window
Bram Moolenaar95ec9d62016-08-12 18:29:59 +02007195 {not available when compiled without the |+signs|
7196 feature}
Bram Moolenaar09521312016-08-12 22:54:35 +02007197 Whether or not to draw the signcolumn. Valid values are:
7198 "auto" only when there is a sign to display
7199 "no" never
7200 "yes" always
Bram Moolenaar394c5d82019-06-17 21:48:05 +02007201 "number" display signs in the 'number' column. If the number
Bram Moolenaar6c1e1572019-06-22 02:13:00 +02007202 column is not present, then behaves like "auto".
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007203
7204
7205 *'smartcase'* *'scs'* *'nosmartcase'* *'noscs'*
7206'smartcase' 'scs' boolean (default off)
7207 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007208 Override the 'ignorecase' option if the search pattern contains upper
7209 case characters. Only used when the search pattern is typed and
7210 'ignorecase' option is on. Used for the commands "/", "?", "n", "N",
Bram Moolenaarc8734422012-06-01 22:38:45 +02007211 ":g" and ":s". Not used for "*", "#", "gd", tag search, etc. After
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007212 "*" and "#" you can make 'smartcase' used by doing a "/" command,
7213 recalling the search pattern from history and hitting <Enter>.
7214 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
7215
7216 *'smartindent'* *'si'* *'nosmartindent'* *'nosi'*
7217'smartindent' 'si' boolean (default off)
7218 local to buffer
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007219 {not available when compiled without the
7220 |+smartindent| feature}
7221 Do smart autoindenting when starting a new line. Works for C-like
7222 programs, but can also be used for other languages. 'cindent' does
7223 something like this, works better in most cases, but is more strict,
Bram Moolenaar81af9252010-12-10 20:35:50 +01007224 see |C-indenting|. When 'cindent' is on or 'indentexpr' is set,
Bram Moolenaar166af9b2010-11-16 20:34:40 +01007225 setting 'si' has no effect. 'indentexpr' is a more advanced
7226 alternative.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007227 Normally 'autoindent' should also be on when using 'smartindent'.
7228 An indent is automatically inserted:
7229 - After a line ending in '{'.
7230 - After a line starting with a keyword from 'cinwords'.
7231 - Before a line starting with '}' (only with the "O" command).
7232 When typing '}' as the first character in a new line, that line is
7233 given the same indent as the matching '{'.
7234 When typing '#' as the first character in a new line, the indent for
7235 that line is removed, the '#' is put in the first column. The indent
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00007236 is restored for the next line. If you don't want this, use this
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007237 mapping: ":inoremap # X^H#", where ^H is entered with CTRL-V CTRL-H.
7238 When using the ">>" command, lines starting with '#' are not shifted
7239 right.
Bram Moolenaar036986f2017-03-16 17:41:02 +01007240 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
Bram Moolenaarca635012015-09-25 20:34:21 +02007241 This option is reset when 'paste' is set and restored when 'paste' is
7242 reset.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007243
7244 *'smarttab'* *'sta'* *'nosmarttab'* *'nosta'*
7245'smarttab' 'sta' boolean (default off)
7246 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007247 When on, a <Tab> in front of a line inserts blanks according to
Bram Moolenaar280f1262006-01-30 00:14:18 +00007248 'shiftwidth'. 'tabstop' or 'softtabstop' is used in other places. A
7249 <BS> will delete a 'shiftwidth' worth of space at the start of the
7250 line.
Bram Moolenaarafeb4fa2006-02-01 21:51:12 +00007251 When off, a <Tab> always inserts blanks according to 'tabstop' or
Bram Moolenaar280f1262006-01-30 00:14:18 +00007252 'softtabstop'. 'shiftwidth' is only used for shifting text left or
7253 right |shift-left-right|.
Bram Moolenaarebcbd022007-05-12 14:28:25 +00007254 What gets inserted (a <Tab> or spaces) depends on the 'expandtab'
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007255 option. Also see |ins-expandtab|. When 'expandtab' is not set, the
Bram Moolenaar843ee412004-06-30 16:16:41 +00007256 number of spaces is minimized by using <Tab>s.
Bram Moolenaarca635012015-09-25 20:34:21 +02007257 This option is reset when 'paste' is set and restored when 'paste' is
7258 reset.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007259 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
7260
7261 *'softtabstop'* *'sts'*
7262'softtabstop' 'sts' number (default 0)
7263 local to buffer
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007264 Number of spaces that a <Tab> counts for while performing editing
7265 operations, like inserting a <Tab> or using <BS>. It "feels" like
7266 <Tab>s are being inserted, while in fact a mix of spaces and <Tab>s is
7267 used. This is useful to keep the 'ts' setting at its standard value
7268 of 8, while being able to edit like it is set to 'sts'. However,
7269 commands like "x" still work on the actual characters.
7270 When 'sts' is zero, this feature is off.
Bram Moolenaar3a0d8092012-10-21 03:02:54 +02007271 When 'sts' is negative, the value of 'shiftwidth' is used.
Bram Moolenaarca635012015-09-25 20:34:21 +02007272 'softtabstop' is set to 0 when the 'paste' option is set and restored
7273 when 'paste' is reset.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007274 See also |ins-expandtab|. When 'expandtab' is not set, the number of
7275 spaces is minimized by using <Tab>s.
7276 The 'L' flag in 'cpoptions' changes how tabs are used when 'list' is
7277 set.
7278 NOTE: This option is set to 0 when 'compatible' is set.
7279
Bram Moolenaar04958cb2018-06-23 19:23:02 +02007280 If Vim is compiled with the |+vartabs| feature then the value of
7281 'softtabstop' will be ignored if |'varsofttabstop'| is set to
7282 anything other than an empty string.
7283
Bram Moolenaar217ad922005-03-20 22:37:15 +00007284 *'spell'* *'nospell'*
7285'spell' boolean (default off)
7286 local to window
Bram Moolenaar217ad922005-03-20 22:37:15 +00007287 {not available when compiled without the |+syntax|
7288 feature}
7289 When on spell checking will be done. See |spell|.
Bram Moolenaar402d2fe2005-04-15 21:00:38 +00007290 The languages are specified with 'spelllang'.
Bram Moolenaar217ad922005-03-20 22:37:15 +00007291
Bram Moolenaar0d9c26d2005-07-02 23:19:16 +00007292 *'spellcapcheck'* *'spc'*
Bram Moolenaar0dc065e2005-07-04 22:49:24 +00007293'spellcapcheck' 'spc' string (default "[.?!]\_[\])'" \t]\+")
Bram Moolenaar0d9c26d2005-07-02 23:19:16 +00007294 local to buffer
Bram Moolenaar0d9c26d2005-07-02 23:19:16 +00007295 {not available when compiled without the |+syntax|
7296 feature}
7297 Pattern to locate the end of a sentence. The following word will be
7298 checked to start with a capital letter. If not then it is highlighted
Bram Moolenaar8aff23a2005-08-19 20:40:30 +00007299 with SpellCap |hl-SpellCap| (unless the word is also badly spelled).
Bram Moolenaar0d9c26d2005-07-02 23:19:16 +00007300 When this check is not wanted make this option empty.
7301 Only used when 'spell' is set.
Bram Moolenaar0dc065e2005-07-04 22:49:24 +00007302 Be careful with special characters, see |option-backslash| about
7303 including spaces and backslashes.
Bram Moolenaar90cfdbe2005-08-12 19:59:19 +00007304 To set this option automatically depending on the language, see
7305 |set-spc-auto|.
Bram Moolenaar0d9c26d2005-07-02 23:19:16 +00007306
Bram Moolenaar82cf9b62005-06-07 21:09:25 +00007307 *'spellfile'* *'spf'*
7308'spellfile' 'spf' string (default empty)
7309 local to buffer
Bram Moolenaar82cf9b62005-06-07 21:09:25 +00007310 {not available when compiled without the |+syntax|
7311 feature}
7312 Name of the word list file where words are added for the |zg| and |zw|
Bram Moolenaar045e82d2005-07-08 22:25:33 +00007313 commands. It must end in ".{encoding}.add". You need to include the
7314 path, otherwise the file is placed in the current directory.
Bram Moolenaar0d9c26d2005-07-02 23:19:16 +00007315 *E765*
Bram Moolenaarcbaff5e2022-04-08 17:45:08 +01007316 It may also be a comma-separated list of names. A count before the
Bram Moolenaar0d9c26d2005-07-02 23:19:16 +00007317 |zg| and |zw| commands can be used to access each. This allows using
7318 a personal word list file and a project word list file.
Bram Moolenaar82cf9b62005-06-07 21:09:25 +00007319 When a word is added while this option is empty Vim will set it for
Bram Moolenaar910f66f2006-04-05 20:41:53 +00007320 you: Using the first directory in 'runtimepath' that is writable. If
7321 there is no "spell" directory yet it will be created. For the file
7322 name the first language name that appears in 'spelllang' is used,
Bram Moolenaar3b506942005-06-23 22:36:45 +00007323 ignoring the region.
7324 The resulting ".spl" file will be used for spell checking, it does not
7325 have to appear in 'spelllang'.
7326 Normally one file is used for all regions, but you can add the region
7327 name if you want to. However, it will then only be used when
7328 'spellfile' is set to it, for entries in 'spelllang' only files
7329 without region name will be found.
Bram Moolenaare7566042005-06-17 22:00:15 +00007330 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
7331 security reasons.
Bram Moolenaar82cf9b62005-06-07 21:09:25 +00007332
Bram Moolenaar217ad922005-03-20 22:37:15 +00007333 *'spelllang'* *'spl'*
Bram Moolenaar82cf9b62005-06-07 21:09:25 +00007334'spelllang' 'spl' string (default "en")
Bram Moolenaar217ad922005-03-20 22:37:15 +00007335 local to buffer
Bram Moolenaar217ad922005-03-20 22:37:15 +00007336 {not available when compiled without the |+syntax|
7337 feature}
Bram Moolenaarcbaff5e2022-04-08 17:45:08 +01007338 A comma-separated list of word list names. When the 'spell' option is
Bram Moolenaar3b506942005-06-23 22:36:45 +00007339 on spellchecking will be done for these languages. Example: >
7340 set spelllang=en_us,nl,medical
7341< This means US English, Dutch and medical words are recognized. Words
7342 that are not recognized will be highlighted.
Bram Moolenaar911ead12019-04-21 00:03:35 +02007343 The word list name must consist of alphanumeric characters, a dash or
7344 an underscore. It should not include a comma or dot. Using a dash is
Bram Moolenaar3b506942005-06-23 22:36:45 +00007345 recommended to separate the two letter language name from a
7346 specification. Thus "en-rare" is used for rare English words.
7347 A region name must come last and have the form "_xx", where "xx" is
7348 the two-letter, lower case region name. You can use more than one
7349 region by listing them: "en_us,en_ca" supports both US and Canadian
7350 English, but not words specific for Australia, New Zealand or Great
Bram Moolenaarfa735342016-01-03 22:14:44 +01007351 Britain. (Note: currently en_au and en_nz dictionaries are older than
7352 en_ca, en_gb and en_us).
Bram Moolenaarcc63c642013-11-12 04:44:01 +01007353 If the name "cjk" is included East Asian characters are excluded from
7354 spell checking. This is useful when editing text that also has Asian
7355 words.
Bram Moolenaar6c391a72021-09-09 21:55:11 +02007356 Note that the "medical" dictionary does not exist, it is just an
7357 example of a longer name.
Bram Moolenaar8aff23a2005-08-19 20:40:30 +00007358 *E757*
Bram Moolenaarce0842a2005-07-18 21:58:11 +00007359 As a special case the name of a .spl file can be given as-is. The
7360 first "_xx" in the name is removed and used as the region name
7361 (_xx is an underscore, two letters and followed by a non-letter).
7362 This is mainly for testing purposes. You must make sure the correct
7363 encoding is used, Vim doesn't check it.
Bram Moolenaar402d2fe2005-04-15 21:00:38 +00007364 When 'encoding' is set the word lists are reloaded. Thus it's a good
Bram Moolenaarce0842a2005-07-18 21:58:11 +00007365 idea to set 'spelllang' after setting 'encoding' to avoid loading the
7366 files twice.
Bram Moolenaar3b506942005-06-23 22:36:45 +00007367 How the related spell files are found is explained here: |spell-load|.
Bram Moolenaar217ad922005-03-20 22:37:15 +00007368
Bram Moolenaar98692072006-02-04 00:57:42 +00007369 If the |spellfile.vim| plugin is active and you use a language name
7370 for which Vim cannot find the .spl file in 'runtimepath' the plugin
7371 will ask you if you want to download the file.
7372
Bram Moolenaar90cfdbe2005-08-12 19:59:19 +00007373 After this option has been set successfully, Vim will source the files
7374 "spell/LANG.vim" in 'runtimepath'. "LANG" is the value of 'spelllang'
Bram Moolenaarb730f0c2018-11-25 03:56:26 +01007375 up to the first character that is not an ASCII letter or number and
7376 not a dash. Also see |set-spc-auto|.
Bram Moolenaar90cfdbe2005-08-12 19:59:19 +00007377
Bram Moolenaar362b44b2020-06-10 21:47:00 +02007378 *'spelloptions'* *'spo'*
7379'spelloptions' 'spo' string (default "")
7380 local to buffer
7381 {not available when compiled without the |+syntax|
7382 feature}
Bram Moolenaarcbaff5e2022-04-08 17:45:08 +01007383 A comma-separated list of options for spell checking:
Bram Moolenaar362b44b2020-06-10 21:47:00 +02007384 camel When a word is CamelCased, assume "Cased" is a
7385 separate word: every upper-case character in a word
7386 that comes after a lower case character indicates the
7387 start of a new word.
Bram Moolenaar90cfdbe2005-08-12 19:59:19 +00007388
Bram Moolenaard857f0e2005-06-21 22:37:39 +00007389 *'spellsuggest'* *'sps'*
7390'spellsuggest' 'sps' string (default "best")
7391 global
Bram Moolenaard857f0e2005-06-21 22:37:39 +00007392 {not available when compiled without the |+syntax|
7393 feature}
Bram Moolenaar2c7a29c2005-12-12 22:02:31 +00007394 Methods used for spelling suggestions. Both for the |z=| command and
Bram Moolenaar24bbcfe2005-06-28 23:32:02 +00007395 the |spellsuggest()| function. This is a comma-separated list of
7396 items:
Bram Moolenaard857f0e2005-06-21 22:37:39 +00007397
Bram Moolenaar24bbcfe2005-06-28 23:32:02 +00007398 best Internal method that works best for English. Finds
7399 changes like "fast" and uses a bit of sound-a-like
7400 scoring to improve the ordering.
7401
7402 double Internal method that uses two methods and mixes the
7403 results. The first method is "fast", the other method
Bram Moolenaard857f0e2005-06-21 22:37:39 +00007404 computes how much the suggestion sounds like the bad
Bram Moolenaar24bbcfe2005-06-28 23:32:02 +00007405 word. That only works when the language specifies
7406 sound folding. Can be slow and doesn't always give
7407 better results.
7408
7409 fast Internal method that only checks for simple changes:
7410 character inserts/deletes/swaps. Works well for
7411 simple typing mistakes.
7412
Bram Moolenaar2c7a29c2005-12-12 22:02:31 +00007413 {number} The maximum number of suggestions listed for |z=|.
Bram Moolenaar8aff23a2005-08-19 20:40:30 +00007414 Not used for |spellsuggest()|. The number of
7415 suggestions is never more than the value of 'lines'
7416 minus two.
7417
Bram Moolenaar585ee072022-01-29 11:22:17 +00007418 timeout:{millisec} Limit the time searching for suggestions to
7419 {millisec} milli seconds. Applies to the following
7420 methods. When omitted the limit is 5000. When
7421 negative there is no limit. {only works when built
7422 with the +reltime feature}
7423
Bram Moolenaar24bbcfe2005-06-28 23:32:02 +00007424 file:{filename} Read file {filename}, which must have two columns,
7425 separated by a slash. The first column contains the
7426 bad word, the second column the suggested good word.
7427 Example:
7428 theribal/terrible ~
7429 Use this for common mistakes that do not appear at the
7430 top of the suggestion list with the internal methods.
7431 Lines without a slash are ignored, use this for
7432 comments.
Bram Moolenaarbcb98982014-05-01 14:08:19 +02007433 The word in the second column must be correct,
7434 otherwise it will not be used. Add the word to an
7435 ".add" file if it is currently flagged as a spelling
7436 mistake.
Bram Moolenaar24bbcfe2005-06-28 23:32:02 +00007437 The file is used for all languages.
7438
7439 expr:{expr} Evaluate expression {expr}. Use a function to avoid
7440 trouble with spaces. |v:val| holds the badly spelled
7441 word. The expression must evaluate to a List of
7442 Lists, each with a suggestion and a score.
7443 Example:
Bram Moolenaar214641f2017-03-05 17:04:09 +01007444 [['the', 33], ['that', 44]] ~
Bram Moolenaar2c7a29c2005-12-12 22:02:31 +00007445 Set 'verbose' and use |z=| to see the scores that the
Bram Moolenaar24bbcfe2005-06-28 23:32:02 +00007446 internal methods use. A lower score is better.
7447 This may invoke |spellsuggest()| if you temporarily
7448 set 'spellsuggest' to exclude the "expr:" part.
7449 Errors are silently ignored, unless you set the
7450 'verbose' option to a non-zero value.
7451
7452 Only one of "best", "double" or "fast" may be used. The others may
7453 appear several times in any order. Example: >
7454 :set sps=file:~/.vim/sugg,best,expr:MySuggest()
7455<
7456 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
7457 security reasons.
Bram Moolenaard857f0e2005-06-21 22:37:39 +00007458
7459
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007460 *'splitbelow'* *'sb'* *'nosplitbelow'* *'nosb'*
7461'splitbelow' 'sb' boolean (default off)
7462 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007463 When on, splitting a window will put the new window below the current
7464 one. |:split|
7465
7466 *'splitright'* *'spr'* *'nosplitright'* *'nospr'*
7467'splitright' 'spr' boolean (default off)
7468 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007469 When on, splitting a window will put the new window right of the
7470 current one. |:vsplit|
7471
7472 *'startofline'* *'sol'* *'nostartofline'* *'nosol'*
7473'startofline' 'sol' boolean (default on)
7474 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007475 When "on" the commands listed below move the cursor to the first
Bram Moolenaar843ee412004-06-30 16:16:41 +00007476 non-blank of the line. When off the cursor is kept in the same column
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00007477 (if possible). This applies to the commands: CTRL-D, CTRL-U, CTRL-B,
Bram Moolenaar843ee412004-06-30 16:16:41 +00007478 CTRL-F, "G", "H", "M", "L", gg, and to the commands "d", "<<" and ">>"
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007479 with a linewise operator, with "%" with a count and to buffer changing
7480 commands (CTRL-^, :bnext, :bNext, etc.). Also for an Ex command that
7481 only has a line number, e.g., ":25" or ":+".
7482 In case of buffer changing commands the cursor is placed at the column
7483 where it was the last time the buffer was edited.
7484 NOTE: This option is set when 'compatible' is set.
7485
Bram Moolenaar00654022011-02-25 14:42:19 +01007486 *'statusline'* *'stl'* *E540* *E542*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007487'statusline' 'stl' string (default empty)
Bram Moolenaarb5bf5b82004-12-24 14:35:23 +00007488 global or local to window |global-local|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007489 {not available when compiled without the |+statusline|
7490 feature}
Bram Moolenaar944697a2022-02-20 19:48:20 +00007491 When non-empty, this option determines the content of the status line.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007492 Also see |status-line|.
7493
7494 The option consists of printf style '%' items interspersed with
7495 normal text. Each status line item is of the form:
7496 %-0{minwid}.{maxwid}{item}
Bram Moolenaar5e9b2fa2016-02-01 22:37:05 +01007497 All fields except the {item} are optional. A single percent sign can
Bram Moolenaar8133cc62020-10-26 21:05:27 +01007498 be given as "%%".
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007499
Bram Moolenaar238a5642006-02-21 22:12:05 +00007500 When the option starts with "%!" then it is used as an expression,
7501 evaluated and the result is used as the option value. Example: >
7502 :set statusline=%!MyStatusLine()
Bram Moolenaar1c6fd1e2019-05-23 22:11:59 +02007503< The *g:statusline_winid* variable will be set to the |window-ID| of the
7504 window that the status line belongs to.
7505 The result can contain %{} items that will be evaluated too.
Bram Moolenaar61d35bd2012-03-28 20:51:51 +02007506 Note that the "%!" expression is evaluated in the context of the
7507 current window and buffer, while %{} items are evaluated in the
7508 context of the window that the statusline belongs to.
Bram Moolenaar238a5642006-02-21 22:12:05 +00007509
7510 When there is error while evaluating the option then it will be made
7511 empty to avoid further errors. Otherwise screen updating would loop.
7512
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007513 Note that the only effect of 'ruler' when this option is set (and
7514 'laststatus' is 2) is controlling the output of |CTRL-G|.
7515
7516 field meaning ~
Bram Moolenaar582fd852005-03-28 20:58:01 +00007517 - Left justify the item. The default is right justified
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007518 when minwid is larger than the length of the item.
Bram Moolenaar582fd852005-03-28 20:58:01 +00007519 0 Leading zeroes in numeric items. Overridden by '-'.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007520 minwid Minimum width of the item, padding as set by '-' & '0'.
7521 Value must be 50 or less.
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00007522 maxwid Maximum width of the item. Truncation occurs with a '<'
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007523 on the left for text items. Numeric items will be
7524 shifted down to maxwid-2 digits followed by '>'number
7525 where number is the amount of missing digits, much like
7526 an exponential notation.
7527 item A one letter code as described below.
7528
7529 Following is a description of the possible statusline items. The
7530 second character in "item" is the type:
7531 N for number
7532 S for string
7533 F for flags as described below
7534 - not applicable
7535
7536 item meaning ~
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00007537 f S Path to the file in the buffer, as typed or relative to current
7538 directory.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007539 F S Full path to the file in the buffer.
7540 t S File name (tail) of file in the buffer.
Bram Moolenaare37d50a2008-08-06 17:06:04 +00007541 m F Modified flag, text is "[+]"; "[-]" if 'modifiable' is off.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007542 M F Modified flag, text is ",+" or ",-".
Bram Moolenaare37d50a2008-08-06 17:06:04 +00007543 r F Readonly flag, text is "[RO]".
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007544 R F Readonly flag, text is ",RO".
Bram Moolenaare37d50a2008-08-06 17:06:04 +00007545 h F Help buffer flag, text is "[help]".
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007546 H F Help buffer flag, text is ",HLP".
Bram Moolenaare37d50a2008-08-06 17:06:04 +00007547 w F Preview window flag, text is "[Preview]".
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007548 W F Preview window flag, text is ",PRV".
Bram Moolenaare37d50a2008-08-06 17:06:04 +00007549 y F Type of file in the buffer, e.g., "[vim]". See 'filetype'.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007550 Y F Type of file in the buffer, e.g., ",VIM". See 'filetype'.
Bram Moolenaar7fd73202010-07-25 16:58:46 +02007551 q S "[Quickfix List]", "[Location List]" or empty.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007552 k S Value of "b:keymap_name" or 'keymap' when |:lmap| mappings are
7553 being used: "<keymap>"
7554 n N Buffer number.
Bram Moolenaar00654022011-02-25 14:42:19 +01007555 b N Value of character under cursor.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007556 B N As above, in hexadecimal.
7557 o N Byte number in file of byte under cursor, first byte is 1.
7558 Mnemonic: Offset from start of file (with one added)
7559 {not available when compiled without |+byte_offset| feature}
7560 O N As above, in hexadecimal.
Bram Moolenaar582fd852005-03-28 20:58:01 +00007561 N N Printer page number. (Only works in the 'printheader' option.)
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007562 l N Line number.
7563 L N Number of lines in buffer.
Bram Moolenaar1d59aa12020-09-19 18:50:13 +02007564 c N Column number (byte index).
7565 v N Virtual column number (screen column).
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00007566 V N Virtual column number as -{num}. Not displayed if equal to 'c'.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007567 p N Percentage through file in lines as in |CTRL-G|.
7568 P S Percentage through file of displayed window. This is like the
Bram Moolenaar14b69452013-06-29 23:05:20 +02007569 percentage described for 'ruler'. Always 3 in length, unless
7570 translated.
Bram Moolenaar582fd852005-03-28 20:58:01 +00007571 a S Argument list status as in default title. ({current} of {max})
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007572 Empty if the argument file count is zero or one.
Bram Moolenaar238a5642006-02-21 22:12:05 +00007573 { NF Evaluate expression between '%{' and '}' and substitute result.
Bram Moolenaar6d150f72018-04-21 20:03:20 +02007574 Note that there is no '%' before the closing '}'. The
7575 expression cannot contain a '}' character, call a function to
Bram Moolenaar0c0734d2019-11-26 21:44:46 +01007576 work around that. See |stl-%{| below.
shadmansaleh30e3de22021-05-15 17:23:28 +02007577 {% - This is almost same as { except the result of the expression is
7578 re-evaluated as a statusline format string. Thus if the
7579 return value of expr contains % items they will get expanded.
7580 The expression can contain the } character, the end of
7581 expression is denoted by %}.
Bram Moolenaar22863042021-10-16 15:23:36 +01007582 For example: >
shadmansaleh30e3de22021-05-15 17:23:28 +02007583 func! Stl_filename() abort
7584 return "%t"
7585 endfunc
7586< `stl=%{Stl_filename()}` results in `"%t"`
7587 `stl=%{%Stl_filename()%}` results in `"Name of current file"`
Bram Moolenaar22863042021-10-16 15:23:36 +01007588 %} - End of `{%` expression
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007589 ( - Start of item group. Can be used for setting the width and
7590 alignment of a section. Must be followed by %) somewhere.
7591 ) - End of item group. No width fields allowed.
Bram Moolenaard1f56e62006-02-22 21:25:37 +00007592 T N For 'tabline': start of tab page N label. Use %T after the last
7593 label. This information is used for mouse clicks.
7594 X N For 'tabline': start of close tab N label. Use %X after the
7595 label, e.g.: %3Xclose%X. Use %999X for a "close current tab"
7596 mark. This information is used for mouse clicks.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007597 < - Where to truncate line if too long. Default is at the start.
7598 No width fields allowed.
7599 = - Separation point between left and right aligned items.
7600 No width fields allowed.
Bram Moolenaar238a5642006-02-21 22:12:05 +00007601 # - Set highlight group. The name must follow and then a # again.
7602 Thus use %#HLname# for highlight group HLname. The same
7603 highlighting is used, also for the statusline of non-current
7604 windows.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007605 * - Set highlight group to User{N}, where {N} is taken from the
Bram Moolenaar582fd852005-03-28 20:58:01 +00007606 minwid field, e.g. %1*. Restore normal highlight with %* or %0*.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007607 The difference between User{N} and StatusLine will be applied
7608 to StatusLineNC for the statusline of non-current windows.
7609 The number N must be between 1 and 9. See |hl-User1..9|
7610
Bram Moolenaare37d50a2008-08-06 17:06:04 +00007611 When displaying a flag, Vim removes the leading comma, if any, when
7612 that flag comes right after plaintext. This will make a nice display
7613 when flags are used like in the examples below.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007614
Bram Moolenaar582fd852005-03-28 20:58:01 +00007615 When all items in a group becomes an empty string (i.e. flags that are
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007616 not set) and a minwid is not set for the group, the whole group will
7617 become empty. This will make a group like the following disappear
7618 completely from the statusline when none of the flags are set. >
7619 :set statusline=...%(\ [%M%R%H]%)...
Bram Moolenaar1c6fd1e2019-05-23 22:11:59 +02007620< Beware that an expression is evaluated each and every time the status
7621 line is displayed.
Bram Moolenaar0c0734d2019-11-26 21:44:46 +01007622 *stl-%{* *g:actual_curbuf* *g:actual_curwin*
Bram Moolenaarade0d392020-01-21 22:33:58 +01007623 While evaluating %{} the current buffer and current window will be set
7624 temporarily to that of the window (and buffer) whose statusline is
Bram Moolenaar0c0734d2019-11-26 21:44:46 +01007625 currently being drawn. The expression will evaluate in this context.
7626 The variable "g:actual_curbuf" is set to the `bufnr()` number of the
7627 real current buffer and "g:actual_curwin" to the |window-ID| of the
7628 real current window. These values are strings.
Bram Moolenaarb71eaae2006-01-20 23:10:18 +00007629
Bram Moolenaar30b65812012-07-12 22:01:11 +02007630 The 'statusline' option will be evaluated in the |sandbox| if set from
7631 a modeline, see |sandbox-option|.
Bram Moolenaar110289e2019-05-23 15:38:06 +02007632 This option cannot be set in a modeline when 'modelineexpr' is off.
Bram Moolenaarb71eaae2006-01-20 23:10:18 +00007633
7634 It is not allowed to change text or jump to another window while
7635 evaluating 'statusline' |textlock|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007636
7637 If the statusline is not updated when you want it (e.g., after setting
7638 a variable that's used in an expression), you can force an update by
7639 setting an option without changing its value. Example: >
7640 :let &ro = &ro
7641
7642< A result of all digits is regarded a number for display purposes.
7643 Otherwise the result is taken as flag text and applied to the rules
7644 described above.
7645
Bram Moolenaarcd71fa32005-03-11 22:46:48 +00007646 Watch out for errors in expressions. They may render Vim unusable!
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007647 If you are stuck, hold down ':' or 'Q' to get a prompt, then quit and
Bram Moolenaarc4da1132017-07-15 19:39:43 +02007648 edit your .vimrc or whatever with "vim --clean" to get it right.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007649
7650 Examples:
7651 Emulate standard status line with 'ruler' set >
7652 :set statusline=%<%f\ %h%m%r%=%-14.(%l,%c%V%)\ %P
7653< Similar, but add ASCII value of char under the cursor (like "ga") >
7654 :set statusline=%<%f%h%m%r%=%b\ 0x%B\ \ %l,%c%V\ %P
7655< Display byte count and byte value, modified flag in red. >
7656 :set statusline=%<%f%=\ [%1*%M%*%n%R%H]\ %-19(%3l,%02c%03V%)%O'%02b'
7657 :hi User1 term=inverse,bold cterm=inverse,bold ctermfg=red
7658< Display a ,GZ flag if a compressed file is loaded >
7659 :set statusline=...%r%{VarExists('b:gzflag','\ [GZ]')}%h...
7660< In the |:autocmd|'s: >
7661 :let b:gzflag = 1
7662< And: >
7663 :unlet b:gzflag
7664< And define this function: >
7665 :function VarExists(var, val)
7666 : if exists(a:var) | return a:val | else | return '' | endif
7667 :endfunction
7668<
7669 *'suffixes'* *'su'*
7670'suffixes' 'su' string (default ".bak,~,.o,.h,.info,.swp,.obj")
7671 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007672 Files with these suffixes get a lower priority when multiple files
7673 match a wildcard. See |suffixes|. Commas can be used to separate the
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00007674 suffixes. Spaces after the comma are ignored. A dot is also seen as
7675 the start of a suffix. To avoid a dot or comma being recognized as a
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007676 separator, precede it with a backslash (see |option-backslash| about
7677 including spaces and backslashes).
7678 See 'wildignore' for completely ignoring files.
7679 The use of |:set+=| and |:set-=| is preferred when adding or removing
7680 suffixes from the list. This avoids problems when a future version
7681 uses another default.
7682
7683 *'suffixesadd'* *'sua'*
7684'suffixesadd' 'sua' string (default "")
7685 local to buffer
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007686 {not available when compiled without the
7687 |+file_in_path| feature}
Bram Moolenaarcbaff5e2022-04-08 17:45:08 +01007688 Comma-separated list of suffixes, which are used when searching for a
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007689 file for the "gf", "[I", etc. commands. Example: >
7690 :set suffixesadd=.java
7691<
7692 *'swapfile'* *'swf'* *'noswapfile'* *'noswf'*
7693'swapfile' 'swf' boolean (default on)
7694 local to buffer
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00007695 Use a swapfile for the buffer. This option can be reset when a
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007696 swapfile is not wanted for a specific buffer. For example, with
7697 confidential information that even root must not be able to access.
7698 Careful: All text will be in memory:
7699 - Don't use this for big files.
7700 - Recovery will be impossible!
7701 A swapfile will only be present when |'updatecount'| is non-zero and
7702 'swapfile' is set.
7703 When 'swapfile' is reset, the swap file for the current buffer is
7704 immediately deleted. When 'swapfile' is set, and 'updatecount' is
7705 non-zero, a swap file is immediately created.
7706 Also see |swap-file| and |'swapsync'|.
Bram Moolenaar76f3b1a2014-03-27 22:30:07 +01007707 If you want to open a new buffer without creating a swap file for it,
7708 use the |:noswapfile| modifier.
Bram Moolenaar22f1d0e2018-02-27 14:53:30 +01007709 See 'directory' for where the swap file is created.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007710
7711 This option is used together with 'bufhidden' and 'buftype' to
7712 specify special kinds of buffers. See |special-buffers|.
7713
7714 *'swapsync'* *'sws'*
7715'swapsync' 'sws' string (default "fsync")
7716 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007717 When this option is not empty a swap file is synced to disk after
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00007718 writing to it. This takes some time, especially on busy unix systems.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007719 When this option is empty parts of the swap file may be in memory and
7720 not written to disk. When the system crashes you may lose more work.
7721 On Unix the system does a sync now and then without Vim asking for it,
7722 so the disadvantage of setting this option off is small. On some
7723 systems the swap file will not be written at all. For a unix system
7724 setting it to "sync" will use the sync() call instead of the default
7725 fsync(), which may work better on some systems.
Bram Moolenaar293ee4d2004-12-09 21:34:53 +00007726 The 'fsync' option is used for the actual file.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007727
7728 *'switchbuf'* *'swb'*
7729'switchbuf' 'swb' string (default "")
7730 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007731 This option controls the behavior when switching between buffers.
Bram Moolenaard2ea7cf2021-05-30 20:54:13 +02007732 Mostly for |quickfix| commands some values are also used for other
7733 commands, as mentioned below.
Bram Moolenaarcbaff5e2022-04-08 17:45:08 +01007734 Possible values (comma-separated list):
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007735 useopen If included, jump to the first open window that
7736 contains the specified buffer (if there is one).
7737 Otherwise: Do not examine other windows.
7738 This setting is checked with |quickfix| commands, when
7739 jumping to errors (":cc", ":cn", "cp", etc.). It is
7740 also used in all buffer related split commands, for
7741 example ":sbuffer", ":sbnext", or ":sbrewind".
Bram Moolenaar779b74b2006-04-10 14:55:34 +00007742 usetab Like "useopen", but also consider windows in other tab
Bram Moolenaarc9b4b052006-04-30 18:54:39 +00007743 pages.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007744 split If included, split the current window before loading
Bram Moolenaar15146672011-10-20 22:22:38 +02007745 a buffer for a |quickfix| command that display errors.
Bram Moolenaar63b74a82019-03-24 15:09:13 +01007746 Otherwise: do not split, use current window (when used
7747 in the quickfix window: the previously used window or
7748 split if there is no other window).
Bram Moolenaara594d772015-06-19 14:41:49 +02007749 vsplit Just like "split" but split vertically.
Bram Moolenaar446cb832008-06-24 21:56:24 +00007750 newtab Like "split", but open a new tab page. Overrules
Bram Moolenaar0bc380a2010-07-10 13:52:13 +02007751 "split" when both are present.
Bram Moolenaar539aa6b2019-11-17 18:09:38 +01007752 uselast If included, jump to the previously used window when
7753 jumping to errors with |quickfix| commands.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007754
Bram Moolenaar3b56eb32005-07-11 22:40:32 +00007755 *'synmaxcol'* *'smc'*
7756'synmaxcol' 'smc' number (default 3000)
7757 local to buffer
Bram Moolenaar3b56eb32005-07-11 22:40:32 +00007758 {not available when compiled without the |+syntax|
7759 feature}
Bram Moolenaarce0842a2005-07-18 21:58:11 +00007760 Maximum column in which to search for syntax items. In long lines the
7761 text after this column is not highlighted and following lines may not
7762 be highlighted correctly, because the syntax state is cleared.
Bram Moolenaar3b56eb32005-07-11 22:40:32 +00007763 This helps to avoid very slow redrawing for an XML file that is one
7764 long line.
7765 Set to zero to remove the limit.
7766
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007767 *'syntax'* *'syn'*
7768'syntax' 'syn' string (default empty)
7769 local to buffer
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007770 {not available when compiled without the |+syntax|
7771 feature}
7772 When this option is set, the syntax with this name is loaded, unless
7773 syntax highlighting has been switched off with ":syntax off".
7774 Otherwise this option does not always reflect the current syntax (the
7775 b:current_syntax variable does).
7776 This option is most useful in a modeline, for a file which syntax is
Bram Moolenaar97b2ad32006-03-18 21:40:56 +00007777 not automatically recognized. Example, in an IDL file:
7778 /* vim: set syntax=idl : */ ~
7779 When a dot appears in the value then this separates two filetype
7780 names. Example:
7781 /* vim: set syntax=c.doxygen : */ ~
7782 This will use the "c" syntax first, then the "doxygen" syntax.
7783 Note that the second one must be prepared to be loaded as an addition,
7784 otherwise it will be skipped. More than one dot may appear.
7785 To switch off syntax highlighting for the current file, use: >
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007786 :set syntax=OFF
7787< To switch syntax highlighting on according to the current value of the
7788 'filetype' option: >
7789 :set syntax=ON
7790< What actually happens when setting the 'syntax' option is that the
7791 Syntax autocommand event is triggered with the value as argument.
7792 This option is not copied to another buffer, independent of the 's' or
7793 'S' flag in 'cpoptions'.
Bram Moolenaar293ee4d2004-12-09 21:34:53 +00007794 Only normal file name characters can be used, "/\*?[|<>" are illegal.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007795
Bram Moolenaarfd2ac762006-03-01 22:09:21 +00007796 *'tabline'* *'tal'*
Bram Moolenaarfaa959a2006-02-20 21:37:40 +00007797'tabline' 'tal' string (default empty)
Bram Moolenaar7e8fd632006-02-18 22:14:51 +00007798 global
Bram Moolenaar944697a2022-02-20 19:48:20 +00007799 When non-empty, this option determines the content of the tab pages
Bram Moolenaarfaa959a2006-02-20 21:37:40 +00007800 line at the top of the Vim window. When empty Vim will use a default
Bram Moolenaard1f56e62006-02-22 21:25:37 +00007801 tab pages line. See |setting-tabline| for more info.
Bram Moolenaarfaa959a2006-02-20 21:37:40 +00007802
7803 The tab pages line only appears as specified with the 'showtabline'
Bram Moolenaar5c8837f2006-02-25 21:52:33 +00007804 option and only when there is no GUI tab line. When 'e' is in
7805 'guioptions' and the GUI supports a tab line 'guitablabel' is used
Bram Moolenaar7f036442010-08-15 15:24:20 +02007806 instead. Note that the two tab pages lines are very different.
Bram Moolenaarfaa959a2006-02-20 21:37:40 +00007807
7808 The value is evaluated like with 'statusline'. You can use
7809 |tabpagenr()|, |tabpagewinnr()| and |tabpagebuflist()| to figure out
Bram Moolenaard1f56e62006-02-22 21:25:37 +00007810 the text to be displayed. Use "%1T" for the first label, "%2T" for
7811 the second one, etc. Use "%X" items for closing labels.
Bram Moolenaarfaa959a2006-02-20 21:37:40 +00007812
Bram Moolenaare12bab32019-01-08 22:02:56 +01007813 When changing something that is used in 'tabline' that does not
7814 trigger it to be updated, use |:redrawtabline|.
Bram Moolenaar110289e2019-05-23 15:38:06 +02007815 This option cannot be set in a modeline when 'modelineexpr' is off.
Bram Moolenaare12bab32019-01-08 22:02:56 +01007816
Bram Moolenaarfaa959a2006-02-20 21:37:40 +00007817 Keep in mind that only one of the tab pages is the current one, others
7818 are invisible and you can't jump to their windows.
7819
Bram Moolenaar7e8fd632006-02-18 22:14:51 +00007820
Bram Moolenaarfd2ac762006-03-01 22:09:21 +00007821 *'tabpagemax'* *'tpm'*
7822'tabpagemax' 'tpm' number (default 10)
7823 global
Bram Moolenaarfd2ac762006-03-01 22:09:21 +00007824 Maximum number of tab pages to be opened by the |-p| command line
7825 argument or the ":tab all" command. |tabpage|
7826
7827
7828 *'tabstop'* *'ts'*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007829'tabstop' 'ts' number (default 8)
7830 local to buffer
7831 Number of spaces that a <Tab> in the file counts for. Also see
Bram Moolenaarf10911e2022-01-29 22:20:48 +00007832 the |:retab| command, and the 'softtabstop' option.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007833
7834 Note: Setting 'tabstop' to any other value than 8 can make your file
Bram Moolenaarf10911e2022-01-29 22:20:48 +00007835 appear wrong in many places, e.g., when printing it.
7836 The value must be more than 0 and less than 10000.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007837
7838 There are four main ways to use tabs in Vim:
7839 1. Always keep 'tabstop' at 8, set 'softtabstop' and 'shiftwidth' to 4
7840 (or 3 or whatever you prefer) and use 'noexpandtab'. Then Vim
Bram Moolenaarebcbd022007-05-12 14:28:25 +00007841 will use a mix of tabs and spaces, but typing <Tab> and <BS> will
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007842 behave like a tab appears every 4 (or 3) characters.
7843 2. Set 'tabstop' and 'shiftwidth' to whatever you prefer and use
7844 'expandtab'. This way you will always insert spaces. The
7845 formatting will never be messed up when 'tabstop' is changed.
7846 3. Set 'tabstop' and 'shiftwidth' to whatever you prefer and use a
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00007847 |modeline| to set these values when editing the file again. Only
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007848 works when using Vim to edit the file.
7849 4. Always set 'tabstop' and 'shiftwidth' to the same value, and
7850 'noexpandtab'. This should then work (for initial indents only)
7851 for any tabstop setting that people use. It might be nice to have
7852 tabs after the first non-blank inserted as spaces if you do this
7853 though. Otherwise aligned comments will be wrong when 'tabstop' is
7854 changed.
7855
Bram Moolenaar04958cb2018-06-23 19:23:02 +02007856 If Vim is compiled with the |+vartabs| feature then the value of
7857 'tabstop' will be ignored if |'vartabstop'| is set to anything other
7858 than an empty string.
7859
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007860 *'tagbsearch'* *'tbs'* *'notagbsearch'* *'notbs'*
7861'tagbsearch' 'tbs' boolean (default on)
7862 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007863 When searching for a tag (e.g., for the |:ta| command), Vim can either
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00007864 use a binary search or a linear search in a tags file. Binary
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007865 searching makes searching for a tag a LOT faster, but a linear search
7866 will find more tags if the tags file wasn't properly sorted.
7867 Vim normally assumes that your tags files are sorted, or indicate that
7868 they are not sorted. Only when this is not the case does the
7869 'tagbsearch' option need to be switched off.
7870
7871 When 'tagbsearch' is on, binary searching is first used in the tags
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00007872 files. In certain situations, Vim will do a linear search instead for
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007873 certain files, or retry all files with a linear search. When
7874 'tagbsearch' is off, only a linear search is done.
7875
7876 Linear searching is done anyway, for one file, when Vim finds a line
7877 at the start of the file indicating that it's not sorted: >
Bram Moolenaar446cb832008-06-24 21:56:24 +00007878 !_TAG_FILE_SORTED 0 /some comment/
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007879< [The whitespace before and after the '0' must be a single <Tab>]
7880
7881 When a binary search was done and no match was found in any of the
Bram Moolenaar0f6562e2015-11-24 18:48:14 +01007882 files listed in 'tags', and case is ignored or a pattern is used
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007883 instead of a normal tag name, a retry is done with a linear search.
7884 Tags in unsorted tags files, and matches with different case will only
7885 be found in the retry.
7886
Bram Moolenaard4755bb2004-09-02 19:12:26 +00007887 If a tag file indicates that it is case-fold sorted, the second,
Bram Moolenaar0f6562e2015-11-24 18:48:14 +01007888 linear search can be avoided when case is ignored. Use a value of '2'
7889 in the "!_TAG_FILE_SORTED" line for this. A tag file can be case-fold
7890 sorted with the -f switch to "sort" in most unices, as in the command:
Bram Moolenaar47c532e2022-03-19 15:18:53 +00007891 "sort -f -o tags tags". For Universal ctags and Exuberant ctags
7892 version 5.x or higher (at least 5.5) the --sort=foldcase switch can be
7893 used for this as well. Note that case must be folded to uppercase for
7894 this to work.
Bram Moolenaar0f6562e2015-11-24 18:48:14 +01007895
7896 By default, tag searches are case-sensitive. Case is ignored when
7897 'ignorecase' is set and 'tagcase' is "followic", or when 'tagcase' is
7898 "ignore".
Bram Moolenaar66e29d72016-08-20 16:57:02 +02007899 Also when 'tagcase' is "followscs" and 'smartcase' is set, or
7900 'tagcase' is "smart", and the pattern contains only lowercase
7901 characters.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007902
7903 When 'tagbsearch' is off, tags searching is slower when a full match
7904 exists, but faster when no full match exists. Tags in unsorted tags
7905 files may only be found with 'tagbsearch' off.
7906 When the tags file is not sorted, or sorted in a wrong way (not on
7907 ASCII byte value), 'tagbsearch' should be off, or the line given above
7908 must be included in the tags file.
7909 This option doesn't affect commands that find all matching tags (e.g.,
7910 command-line completion and ":help").
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007911
Bram Moolenaar0f6562e2015-11-24 18:48:14 +01007912 *'tagcase'* *'tc'*
7913'tagcase' 'tc' string (default "followic")
7914 global or local to buffer |global-local|
Bram Moolenaar0f6562e2015-11-24 18:48:14 +01007915 This option specifies how case is handled when searching the tags
7916 file:
7917 followic Follow the 'ignorecase' option
Bram Moolenaar66e29d72016-08-20 16:57:02 +02007918 followscs Follow the 'smartcase' and 'ignorecase' options
Bram Moolenaar0f6562e2015-11-24 18:48:14 +01007919 ignore Ignore case
7920 match Match case
Bram Moolenaar66e29d72016-08-20 16:57:02 +02007921 smart Ignore case unless an upper case letter is used
Bram Moolenaar036986f2017-03-16 17:41:02 +01007922 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
7923 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
Bram Moolenaar0f6562e2015-11-24 18:48:14 +01007924
Bram Moolenaar45e18cb2019-04-28 18:05:35 +02007925 *'tagfunc'* *'tfu'*
7926'tagfunc' 'tfu' string (default: empty)
7927 local to buffer
7928 {not available when compiled without the |+eval|
7929 feature}
7930 This option specifies a function to be used to perform tag searches.
7931 The function gets the tag pattern and should return a List of matching
7932 tags. See |tag-function| for an explanation of how to write the
Yegappan Lakshmanan19916a82021-11-24 16:32:55 +00007933 function and an example. The value can be the name of a function, a
7934 |lambda| or a |Funcref|. See |option-value-function| for more
7935 information.
Bram Moolenaar45e18cb2019-04-28 18:05:35 +02007936
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007937 *'taglength'* *'tl'*
7938'taglength' 'tl' number (default 0)
7939 global
7940 If non-zero, tags are significant up to this number of characters.
7941
7942 *'tagrelative'* *'tr'* *'notagrelative'* *'notr'*
7943'tagrelative' 'tr' boolean (Vim default: on, Vi default: off)
7944 global
Bram Moolenaarc6fe9192006-04-09 21:54:49 +00007945 If on and using a tags file in another directory, file names in that
7946 tags file are relative to the directory where the tags file is.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007947 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
7948 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
7949
7950 *'tags'* *'tag'* *E433*
7951'tags' 'tag' string (default "./tags,tags", when compiled with
7952 |+emacs_tags|: "./tags,./TAGS,tags,TAGS")
7953 global or local to buffer |global-local|
7954 Filenames for the tag command, separated by spaces or commas. To
7955 include a space or comma in a file name, precede it with a backslash
7956 (see |option-backslash| about including spaces and backslashes).
7957 When a file name starts with "./", the '.' is replaced with the path
7958 of the current file. But only when the 'd' flag is not included in
7959 'cpoptions'. Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|. Also see
7960 |tags-option|.
7961 "*", "**" and other wildcards can be used to search for tags files in
Bram Moolenaare2b590e2010-08-08 18:29:48 +02007962 a directory tree. See |file-searching|. E.g., "/lib/**/tags" will
7963 find all files named "tags" below "/lib". The filename itself cannot
7964 contain wildcards, it is used as-is. E.g., "/lib/**/tags?" will find
7965 files called "tags?". {not available when compiled without the
7966 |+path_extra| feature}
Bram Moolenaare7eb9df2005-09-09 19:49:30 +00007967 The |tagfiles()| function can be used to get a list of the file names
7968 actually used.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007969 If Vim was compiled with the |+emacs_tags| feature, Emacs-style tag
7970 files are also supported. They are automatically recognized. The
7971 default value becomes "./tags,./TAGS,tags,TAGS", unless case
7972 differences are ignored (MS-Windows). |emacs-tags|
7973 The use of |:set+=| and |:set-=| is preferred when adding or removing
7974 file names from the list. This avoids problems when a future version
7975 uses another default.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007976
7977 *'tagstack'* *'tgst'* *'notagstack'* *'notgst'*
7978'tagstack' 'tgst' boolean (default on)
7979 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007980 When on, the |tagstack| is used normally. When off, a ":tag" or
7981 ":tselect" command with an argument will not push the tag onto the
7982 tagstack. A following ":tag" without an argument, a ":pop" command or
7983 any other command that uses the tagstack will use the unmodified
7984 tagstack, but does change the pointer to the active entry.
7985 Resetting this option is useful when using a ":tag" command in a
7986 mapping which should not change the tagstack.
7987
Bram Moolenaar8a5115c2016-01-09 19:41:11 +01007988 *'tcldll'*
Bram Moolenaar3848e002016-03-19 18:42:29 +01007989'tcldll' string (default depends on the build)
Bram Moolenaar8a5115c2016-01-09 19:41:11 +01007990 global
Bram Moolenaar8a5115c2016-01-09 19:41:11 +01007991 {only available when compiled with the |+tcl/dyn|
7992 feature}
7993 Specifies the name of the Tcl shared library. The default is
7994 DYNAMIC_TCL_DLL, which was specified at compile time.
Bram Moolenaaraa3b15d2016-04-21 08:53:19 +02007995 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|.
Bram Moolenaar8a5115c2016-01-09 19:41:11 +01007996 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
7997 security reasons.
7998
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007999 *'term'* *E529* *E530* *E531*
8000'term' string (default is $TERM, if that fails:
8001 in the GUI: "builtin_gui"
8002 on Amiga: "amiga"
Bram Moolenaarb3f74062020-02-26 16:16:53 +01008003 on Haiku: "xterm"
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008004 on Mac: "mac-ansi"
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008005 on Unix: "ansi"
8006 on VMS: "ansi"
8007 on Win 32: "win32")
8008 global
8009 Name of the terminal. Used for choosing the terminal control
8010 characters. Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|.
8011 For example: >
8012 :set term=$TERM
8013< See |termcap|.
8014
8015 *'termbidi'* *'tbidi'*
8016 *'notermbidi'* *'notbidi'*
8017'termbidi' 'tbidi' boolean (default off, on for "mlterm")
8018 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008019 {only available when compiled with the |+arabic|
8020 feature}
8021 The terminal is in charge of Bi-directionality of text (as specified
8022 by Unicode). The terminal is also expected to do the required shaping
8023 that some languages (such as Arabic) require.
8024 Setting this option implies that 'rightleft' will not be set when
8025 'arabic' is set and the value of 'arabicshape' will be ignored.
8026 Note that setting 'termbidi' has the immediate effect that
8027 'arabicshape' is ignored, but 'rightleft' isn't changed automatically.
8028 This option is reset when the GUI is started.
8029 For further details see |arabic.txt|.
8030
8031 *'termencoding'* *'tenc'*
Bram Moolenaar3d1cde82020-08-15 18:55:18 +02008032'termencoding' 'tenc' string (default ""; with GTK+ GUI: "utf-8")
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008033 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008034 Encoding used for the terminal. This specifies what character
8035 encoding the keyboard produces and the display will understand. For
Bram Moolenaar3848e002016-03-19 18:42:29 +01008036 the GUI it only applies to the keyboard ('encoding' is used for the
Bram Moolenaar3d1cde82020-08-15 18:55:18 +02008037 display).
Bram Moolenaar4b7cdca2020-01-01 16:18:38 +01008038 *E617* *E950*
Bram Moolenaar3df01732017-02-17 22:47:16 +01008039 Note: This does not apply to the GTK+ GUI. After the GUI has been
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008040 successfully initialized, 'termencoding' is forcibly set to "utf-8".
8041 Any attempts to set a different value will be rejected, and an error
8042 message is shown.
Bram Moolenaarac360bf2015-09-01 20:31:20 +02008043 For the Win32 GUI and console versions 'termencoding' is not used,
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008044 because the Win32 system always passes Unicode characters.
8045 When empty, the same encoding is used as for the 'encoding' option.
8046 This is the normal value.
8047 Not all combinations for 'termencoding' and 'encoding' are valid. See
8048 |encoding-table|.
8049 The value for this option must be supported by internal conversions or
8050 iconv(). When this is not possible no conversion will be done and you
8051 will probably experience problems with non-ASCII characters.
8052 Example: You are working with the locale set to euc-jp (Japanese) and
8053 want to edit a UTF-8 file: >
8054 :let &termencoding = &encoding
8055 :set encoding=utf-8
8056< You need to do this when your system has no locale support for UTF-8.
8057
Bram Moolenaarcafafb32018-02-22 21:07:09 +01008058 *'termguicolors'* *'tgc'* *E954*
Bram Moolenaar61be73b2016-04-29 22:59:22 +02008059'termguicolors' 'tgc' boolean (default off)
8060 global
Bram Moolenaar61be73b2016-04-29 22:59:22 +02008061 {not available when compiled without the
8062 |+termguicolors| feature}
8063 When on, uses |highlight-guifg| and |highlight-guibg| attributes in
Bram Moolenaarcafafb32018-02-22 21:07:09 +01008064 the terminal (thus using 24-bit color).
Bram Moolenaar22f1d0e2018-02-27 14:53:30 +01008065
Bram Moolenaarcafafb32018-02-22 21:07:09 +01008066 Requires a ISO-8613-3 compatible terminal. If setting this option
8067 does not work (produces a colorless UI) reading |xterm-true-color|
8068 might help.
8069
8070 For Win32 console, Windows 10 version 1703 (Creators Update) or later
8071 is required. Use this check to find out: >
8072 if has('vcon')
Bram Moolenaar22f1d0e2018-02-27 14:53:30 +01008073< This requires Vim to be built with the |+vtp| feature.
8074
Bram Moolenaar6aa8cea2017-06-05 14:44:35 +02008075 Note that the "cterm" attributes are still used, not the "gui" ones.
Bram Moolenaar036986f2017-03-16 17:41:02 +01008076 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
Bram Moolenaar61be73b2016-04-29 22:59:22 +02008077
Bram Moolenaar7dda86f2018-04-20 22:36:41 +02008078 *'termwinkey'* *'twk'*
8079'termwinkey' 'twk' string (default "")
Bram Moolenaar74675a62017-07-15 13:53:23 +02008080 local to window
Bram Moolenaarf55e4c82017-08-01 20:44:53 +02008081 The key that starts a CTRL-W command in a terminal window. Other keys
Bram Moolenaar74675a62017-07-15 13:53:23 +02008082 are sent to the job running in the window.
Bram Moolenaarf55e4c82017-08-01 20:44:53 +02008083 The <> notation can be used, e.g.: >
Bram Moolenaar7dda86f2018-04-20 22:36:41 +02008084 :set termwinkey=<C-L>
Bram Moolenaarf55e4c82017-08-01 20:44:53 +02008085< The string must be one key stroke but can be multiple bytes.
8086 When not set CTRL-W is used, so that CTRL-W : gets you to the command
Bram Moolenaar7dda86f2018-04-20 22:36:41 +02008087 line. If 'termwinkey' is set to CTRL-L then CTRL-L : gets you to the
Bram Moolenaarf55e4c82017-08-01 20:44:53 +02008088 command line.
Bram Moolenaar74675a62017-07-15 13:53:23 +02008089
Bram Moolenaar6c60f472019-04-28 16:00:35 +02008090 *'termwinscroll'* *'twsl'*
8091'termwinscroll' 'twsl' number (default 10000)
8092 local to buffer
8093 {not available when compiled without the
8094 |+terminal| feature}
8095 Number of scrollback lines to keep. When going over this limit the
8096 first 10% of the scrollback lines are deleted. This is just to reduce
8097 the memory usage. See |Terminal-Normal|.
Bram Moolenaar36968af2021-11-15 17:13:11 +00008098 Also used as a limit for text sent to the terminal in one write,
8099 multiplied by the number of columns times 3 (average number of bytes
8100 per cell).
Bram Moolenaar6c60f472019-04-28 16:00:35 +02008101
Bram Moolenaar7dda86f2018-04-20 22:36:41 +02008102 *'termwinsize'* *'tws'*
8103'termwinsize' 'tws' string (default "")
Bram Moolenaar74675a62017-07-15 13:53:23 +02008104 local to window
Bram Moolenaar1c6737b2020-09-07 22:18:52 +02008105 Size used when opening the |terminal| window. Format:
8106 {rows}x{columns} or {rows}*{columns}.
Bram Moolenaar74675a62017-07-15 13:53:23 +02008107 - When empty the terminal gets the size from the window.
Bram Moolenaar498c2562018-04-15 23:45:15 +02008108 - When set with a "x" (e.g., "24x80") the terminal size is not
8109 adjusted to the window size. If the window is smaller only the
8110 top-left part is displayed.
8111 - When set with a "*" (e.g., "10*50") the terminal size follows the
8112 window size, but will not be smaller than the specified rows and/or
8113 columns.
8114 - When rows is zero then use the height of the window.
8115 - When columns is zero then use the width of the window.
8116 - Using "0x0" or "0*0" is the same as empty.
Bram Moolenaar1c6737b2020-09-07 22:18:52 +02008117 - Can be overruled in the |term_start()| options with "term_rows" and
8118 "term_cols".
Bram Moolenaar498c2562018-04-15 23:45:15 +02008119
8120 Examples:
8121 "30x0" uses 30 rows and the current window width.
8122 "20*0" uses at least 20 rows and the current window width.
8123 "0*40" uses the current window height and at least 40 columns.
Bram Moolenaar1f2903c2017-07-23 19:51:01 +02008124 Note that the command running in the terminal window may still change
8125 the size of the terminal. In that case the Vim window will be
8126 adjusted to that size, if possible.
Bram Moolenaar74675a62017-07-15 13:53:23 +02008127
Bram Moolenaarc6ddce32019-02-08 12:47:03 +01008128 *'termwintype'* *'twt'*
8129'termwintype' 'twt' string (default "")
8130 global
Bram Moolenaarc6ddce32019-02-08 12:47:03 +01008131 {only available when compiled with the |terminal|
8132 feature on MS-Windows}
8133 Specify the virtual console (pty) used when opening the terminal
8134 window.
8135
8136 Possible values are:
Bram Moolenaard9ef1b82019-02-13 19:23:10 +01008137 "" use ConPTY if it is stable, winpty otherwise
Bram Moolenaarc6ddce32019-02-08 12:47:03 +01008138 "winpty" use winpty, fail if not supported
8139 "conpty" use |ConPTY|, fail if not supported
8140
Bram Moolenaard9ef1b82019-02-13 19:23:10 +01008141 |ConPTY| support depends on the platform. Windows 10 October 2018
8142 Update is the first version that supports ConPTY, however it is still
8143 considered unstable. ConPTY might become stable in the next release
8144 of Windows 10. winpty support needs to be installed. If neither is
Bram Moolenaarc6ddce32019-02-08 12:47:03 +01008145 supported then you cannot open a terminal window.
8146
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008147 *'terse'* *'noterse'*
8148'terse' boolean (default off)
8149 global
8150 When set: Add 's' flag to 'shortmess' option (this makes the message
8151 for a search that hits the start or end of the file not being
8152 displayed). When reset: Remove 's' flag from 'shortmess' option. {Vi
8153 shortens a lot of messages}
8154
8155 *'textauto'* *'ta'* *'notextauto'* *'nota'*
8156'textauto' 'ta' boolean (Vim default: on, Vi default: off)
8157 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008158 This option is obsolete. Use 'fileformats'.
8159 For backwards compatibility, when 'textauto' is set, 'fileformats' is
8160 set to the default value for the current system. When 'textauto' is
8161 reset, 'fileformats' is made empty.
8162 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
8163 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
8164
8165 *'textmode'* *'tx'* *'notextmode'* *'notx'*
Bram Moolenaar6f345a12019-12-17 21:27:18 +01008166'textmode' 'tx' boolean (Win32: default on,
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008167 others: default off)
8168 local to buffer
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008169 This option is obsolete. Use 'fileformat'.
8170 For backwards compatibility, when 'textmode' is set, 'fileformat' is
8171 set to "dos". When 'textmode' is reset, 'fileformat' is set to
8172 "unix".
8173
8174 *'textwidth'* *'tw'*
8175'textwidth' 'tw' number (default 0)
8176 local to buffer
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008177 Maximum width of text that is being inserted. A longer line will be
8178 broken after white space to get this width. A zero value disables
Bram Moolenaarca635012015-09-25 20:34:21 +02008179 this.
8180 'textwidth' is set to 0 when the 'paste' option is set and restored
8181 when 'paste' is reset.
8182 When 'textwidth' is zero, 'wrapmargin' may be used. See also
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008183 'formatoptions' and |ins-textwidth|.
Bram Moolenaarfc1421e2006-04-20 22:17:20 +00008184 When 'formatexpr' is set it will be used to break the line.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008185 NOTE: This option is set to 0 when 'compatible' is set.
8186
8187 *'thesaurus'* *'tsr'*
8188'thesaurus' 'tsr' string (default "")
8189 global or local to buffer |global-local|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008190 List of file names, separated by commas, that are used to lookup words
Bram Moolenaarf4d8b762021-10-17 14:13:09 +01008191 for thesaurus completion commands |i_CTRL-X_CTRL-T|. See
8192 |compl-thesaurus|.
Bram Moolenaarf0d58ef2018-11-16 16:13:44 +01008193
Bram Moolenaarf4d8b762021-10-17 14:13:09 +01008194 This option is not used if 'thesaurusfunc' is set, either for the
8195 buffer or globally.
Bram Moolenaarf0d58ef2018-11-16 16:13:44 +01008196
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00008197 To include a comma in a file name precede it with a backslash. Spaces
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008198 after a comma are ignored, otherwise spaces are included in the file
Bram Moolenaarf4d8b762021-10-17 14:13:09 +01008199 name. See |option-backslash| about using backslashes. The use of
8200 |:set+=| and |:set-=| is preferred when adding or removing directories
8201 from the list. This avoids problems when a future version uses
8202 another default. Backticks cannot be used in this option for security
8203 reasons.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008204
Bram Moolenaar2f0936c2022-01-08 21:51:59 +00008205 *'thesaurusfunc'* *'tsrfu'*
Yegappan Lakshmanan160e9942021-10-16 15:41:29 +01008206'thesaurusfunc' 'tsrfu' string (default: empty)
Bram Moolenaarf4d8b762021-10-17 14:13:09 +01008207 global or local to buffer |global-local|
Yegappan Lakshmanan160e9942021-10-16 15:41:29 +01008208 {not available when compiled without the |+eval|
8209 feature}
8210 This option specifies a function to be used for thesaurus completion
Bram Moolenaarf4d8b762021-10-17 14:13:09 +01008211 with CTRL-X CTRL-T. |i_CTRL-X_CTRL-T| See |compl-thesaurusfunc|.
Yegappan Lakshmanan8658c752021-12-03 11:09:29 +00008212 The value can be the name of a function, a |lambda| or a |Funcref|.
8213 See |option-value-function| for more information.
Bram Moolenaarf4d8b762021-10-17 14:13:09 +01008214
Yegappan Lakshmanan160e9942021-10-16 15:41:29 +01008215 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
8216 security reasons.
8217
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008218 *'tildeop'* *'top'* *'notildeop'* *'notop'*
8219'tildeop' 'top' boolean (default off)
8220 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008221 When on: The tilde command "~" behaves like an operator.
8222 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
8223
8224 *'timeout'* *'to'* *'notimeout'* *'noto'*
8225'timeout' 'to' boolean (default on)
8226 global
8227 *'ttimeout'* *'nottimeout'*
Bram Moolenaar94237492017-04-23 18:40:21 +02008228'ttimeout' boolean (default off, set in |defaults.vim|)
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008229 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008230 These two options together determine the behavior when part of a
8231 mapped key sequence or keyboard code has been received:
8232
8233 'timeout' 'ttimeout' action ~
8234 off off do not time out
8235 on on or off time out on :mappings and key codes
8236 off on time out on key codes
8237
8238 If both options are off, Vim will wait until either the complete
8239 mapping or key sequence has been received, or it is clear that there
8240 is no mapping or key sequence for the received characters. For
8241 example: if you have mapped "vl" and Vim has received 'v', the next
8242 character is needed to see if the 'v' is followed by an 'l'.
8243 When one of the options is on, Vim will wait for about 1 second for
8244 the next character to arrive. After that the already received
8245 characters are interpreted as single characters. The waiting time can
8246 be changed with the 'timeoutlen' option.
8247 On slow terminals or very busy systems timing out may cause
8248 malfunctioning cursor keys. If both options are off, Vim waits
8249 forever after an entered <Esc> if there are key codes that start
8250 with <Esc>. You will have to type <Esc> twice. If you do not have
8251 problems with key codes, but would like to have :mapped key
8252 sequences not timing out in 1 second, set the 'ttimeout' option and
8253 reset the 'timeout' option.
8254
8255 NOTE: 'ttimeout' is reset when 'compatible' is set.
8256
8257 *'timeoutlen'* *'tm'*
8258'timeoutlen' 'tm' number (default 1000)
8259 global
Bram Moolenaar25c9c682019-05-05 18:13:34 +02008260
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008261 *'ttimeoutlen'* *'ttm'*
Bram Moolenaar94237492017-04-23 18:40:21 +02008262'ttimeoutlen' 'ttm' number (default -1, set to 100 in |defaults.vim|)
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008263 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008264 The time in milliseconds that is waited for a key code or mapped key
8265 sequence to complete. Also used for CTRL-\ CTRL-N and CTRL-\ CTRL-G
8266 when part of a command has been typed.
8267 Normally only 'timeoutlen' is used and 'ttimeoutlen' is -1. When a
8268 different timeout value for key codes is desired set 'ttimeoutlen' to
8269 a non-negative number.
8270
8271 ttimeoutlen mapping delay key code delay ~
8272 < 0 'timeoutlen' 'timeoutlen'
8273 >= 0 'timeoutlen' 'ttimeoutlen'
8274
8275 The timeout only happens when the 'timeout' and 'ttimeout' options
8276 tell so. A useful setting would be >
8277 :set timeout timeoutlen=3000 ttimeoutlen=100
8278< (time out on mapping after three seconds, time out on key codes after
8279 a tenth of a second).
8280
8281 *'title'* *'notitle'*
8282'title' boolean (default off, on when title can be restored)
8283 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008284 When on, the title of the window will be set to the value of
8285 'titlestring' (if it is not empty), or to:
8286 filename [+=-] (path) - VIM
8287 Where:
8288 filename the name of the file being edited
8289 - indicates the file cannot be modified, 'ma' off
8290 + indicates the file was modified
8291 = indicates the file is read-only
8292 =+ indicates the file is read-only and modified
8293 (path) is the path of the file being edited
8294 - VIM the server name |v:servername| or "VIM"
8295 Only works if the terminal supports setting window titles
8296 (currently Amiga console, Win32 console, all GUI versions and
Bram Moolenaard1caa942020-04-10 22:10:56 +02008297 terminals with a non-empty 't_ts' option - these are Unix xterm and
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008298 iris-ansi by default, where 't_ts' is taken from the builtin termcap).
8299 *X11*
8300 When Vim was compiled with HAVE_X11 defined, the original title will
8301 be restored if possible. The output of ":version" will include "+X11"
8302 when HAVE_X11 was defined, otherwise it will be "-X11". This also
8303 works for the icon name |'icon'|.
8304 But: When Vim was started with the |-X| argument, restoring the title
8305 will not work (except in the GUI).
8306 If the title cannot be restored, it is set to the value of 'titleold'.
8307 You might want to restore the title outside of Vim then.
8308 When using an xterm from a remote machine you can use this command:
8309 rsh machine_name xterm -display $DISPLAY &
8310 then the WINDOWID environment variable should be inherited and the
8311 title of the window should change back to what it should be after
8312 exiting Vim.
8313
8314 *'titlelen'*
8315'titlelen' number (default 85)
8316 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008317 Gives the percentage of 'columns' to use for the length of the window
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00008318 title. When the title is longer, only the end of the path name is
8319 shown. A '<' character before the path name is used to indicate this.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008320 Using a percentage makes this adapt to the width of the window. But
8321 it won't work perfectly, because the actual number of characters
8322 available also depends on the font used and other things in the title
8323 bar. When 'titlelen' is zero the full path is used. Otherwise,
8324 values from 1 to 30000 percent can be used.
8325 'titlelen' is also used for the 'titlestring' option.
8326
8327 *'titleold'*
8328'titleold' string (default "Thanks for flying Vim")
8329 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008330 This option will be used for the window title when exiting Vim if the
8331 original title cannot be restored. Only happens if 'title' is on or
8332 'titlestring' is not empty.
Bram Moolenaar293ee4d2004-12-09 21:34:53 +00008333 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
8334 security reasons.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008335 *'titlestring'*
8336'titlestring' string (default "")
8337 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008338 When this option is not empty, it will be used for the title of the
8339 window. This happens only when the 'title' option is on.
8340 Only works if the terminal supports setting window titles (currently
8341 Amiga console, Win32 console, all GUI versions and terminals with a
8342 non-empty 't_ts' option).
8343 When Vim was compiled with HAVE_X11 defined, the original title will
Bram Moolenaar51628222016-12-01 23:03:28 +01008344 be restored if possible, see |X11|.
Bram Moolenaar110289e2019-05-23 15:38:06 +02008345
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008346 When this option contains printf-style '%' items, they will be
8347 expanded according to the rules used for 'statusline'.
Bram Moolenaar110289e2019-05-23 15:38:06 +02008348 This option cannot be set in a modeline when 'modelineexpr' is off.
8349
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008350 Example: >
Bram Moolenaarc51cf032022-02-26 12:25:45 +00008351 :auto BufEnter * let &titlestring = hostname() .. "/" .. expand("%:p")
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008352 :set title titlestring=%<%F%=%l/%L-%P titlelen=70
8353< The value of 'titlelen' is used to align items in the middle or right
8354 of the available space.
8355 Some people prefer to have the file name first: >
8356 :set titlestring=%t%(\ %M%)%(\ (%{expand(\"%:~:.:h\")})%)%(\ %a%)
8357< Note the use of "%{ }" and an expression to get the path of the file,
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00008358 without the file name. The "%( %)" constructs are used to add a
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008359 separating space only when needed.
8360 NOTE: Use of special characters in 'titlestring' may cause the display
8361 to be garbled (e.g., when it contains a CR or NL character).
8362 {not available when compiled without the |+statusline| feature}
8363
8364 *'toolbar'* *'tb'*
8365'toolbar' 'tb' string (default "icons,tooltips")
8366 global
Bram Moolenaarcbaff5e2022-04-08 17:45:08 +01008367 {only for |+GUI_GTK|, |+GUI_Motif| and |+GUI_Photon|}
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00008368 The contents of this option controls various toolbar settings. The
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008369 possible values are:
8370 icons Toolbar buttons are shown with icons.
8371 text Toolbar buttons shown with text.
8372 horiz Icon and text of a toolbar button are
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00008373 horizontally arranged. {only in GTK+ 2 GUI}
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008374 tooltips Tooltips are active for toolbar buttons.
8375 Tooltips refer to the popup help text which appears after the mouse
8376 cursor is placed over a toolbar button for a brief moment.
8377
8378 If you want the toolbar to be shown with icons as well as text, do the
8379 following: >
8380 :set tb=icons,text
Bram Moolenaarcbaff5e2022-04-08 17:45:08 +01008381< Motif cannot display icons and text at the same time. They
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008382 will show icons if both are requested.
8383
8384 If none of the strings specified in 'toolbar' are valid or if
8385 'toolbar' is empty, this option is ignored. If you want to disable
8386 the toolbar, you need to set the 'guioptions' option. For example: >
8387 :set guioptions-=T
8388< Also see |gui-toolbar|.
8389
8390 *'toolbariconsize'* *'tbis'*
8391'toolbariconsize' 'tbis' string (default "small")
8392 global
Bram Moolenaar3df01732017-02-17 22:47:16 +01008393 {only in the GTK+ GUI}
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008394 Controls the size of toolbar icons. The possible values are:
Bram Moolenaar77cdfd12016-03-12 12:57:59 +01008395 tiny Use tiny icons.
8396 small Use small icons (default).
8397 medium Use medium-sized icons.
8398 large Use large icons.
8399 huge Use even larger icons.
8400 giant Use very big icons.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008401 The exact dimensions in pixels of the various icon sizes depend on
Bram Moolenaar77cdfd12016-03-12 12:57:59 +01008402 the current theme. Common dimensions are giant=48x48, huge=32x32,
8403 large=24x24, medium=24x24, small=20x20 and tiny=16x16.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008404
8405 If 'toolbariconsize' is empty, the global default size as determined
8406 by user preferences or the current theme is used.
8407
8408 *'ttybuiltin'* *'tbi'* *'nottybuiltin'* *'notbi'*
8409'ttybuiltin' 'tbi' boolean (default on)
8410 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008411 When on, the builtin termcaps are searched before the external ones.
8412 When off the builtin termcaps are searched after the external ones.
8413 When this option is changed, you should set the 'term' option next for
8414 the change to take effect, for example: >
8415 :set notbi term=$TERM
8416< See also |termcap|.
8417 Rationale: The default for this option is "on", because the builtin
8418 termcap entries are generally better (many systems contain faulty
8419 xterm entries...).
8420
8421 *'ttyfast'* *'tf'* *'nottyfast'* *'notf'*
8422'ttyfast' 'tf' boolean (default off, on when 'term' is xterm, hpterm,
8423 sun-cmd, screen, rxvt, dtterm or
8424 iris-ansi; also on when running Vim in
8425 a DOS console)
8426 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008427 Indicates a fast terminal connection. More characters will be sent to
8428 the screen for redrawing, instead of using insert/delete line
8429 commands. Improves smoothness of redrawing when there are multiple
8430 windows and the terminal does not support a scrolling region.
8431 Also enables the extra writing of characters at the end of each screen
8432 line for lines that wrap. This helps when using copy/paste with the
8433 mouse in an xterm and other terminals.
8434
8435 *'ttymouse'* *'ttym'*
8436'ttymouse' 'ttym' string (default depends on 'term')
8437 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008438 {only in Unix and VMS, doesn't work in the GUI; not
8439 available when compiled without |+mouse|}
8440 Name of the terminal type for which mouse codes are to be recognized.
Bram Moolenaar2c7a7632007-05-10 18:19:11 +00008441 Currently these strings are valid:
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008442 *xterm-mouse*
8443 xterm xterm-like mouse handling. The mouse generates
8444 "<Esc>[Mscr", where "scr" is three bytes:
8445 "s" = button state
8446 "c" = column plus 33
8447 "r" = row plus 33
Bram Moolenaare968e362014-05-13 20:23:24 +02008448 This only works up to 223 columns! See "dec",
8449 "urxvt", and "sgr" for solutions.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008450 xterm2 Works like "xterm", but with the xterm reporting the
8451 mouse position while the mouse is dragged. This works
8452 much faster and more precise. Your xterm must at
Bram Moolenaarbc7aa852005-03-06 23:38:09 +00008453 least at patchlevel 88 / XFree 3.3.3 for this to
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008454 work. See below for how Vim detects this
8455 automatically.
8456 *netterm-mouse*
Bram Moolenaar25c9c682019-05-05 18:13:34 +02008457 netterm NetTerm mouse handling. A left mouse click generates
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008458 "<Esc>}r,c<CR>", where "r,c" are two decimal numbers
Bram Moolenaar25c9c682019-05-05 18:13:34 +02008459 for the row and column. No other mouse events are
8460 supported.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008461 *dec-mouse*
8462 dec DEC terminal mouse handling. The mouse generates a
8463 rather complex sequence, starting with "<Esc>[".
Bram Moolenaare4efc3b2005-03-07 23:16:51 +00008464 This is also available for an Xterm, if it was
8465 configured with "--enable-dec-locator".
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008466 *jsbterm-mouse*
8467 jsbterm JSB term mouse handling.
8468 *pterm-mouse*
8469 pterm QNX pterm mouse handling.
Bram Moolenaarf1568ec2011-12-14 21:17:39 +01008470 *urxvt-mouse*
8471 urxvt Mouse handling for the urxvt (rxvt-unicode) terminal.
Bram Moolenaare968e362014-05-13 20:23:24 +02008472 The mouse works only if the terminal supports this
8473 encoding style, but it does not have 223 columns limit
8474 unlike "xterm" or "xterm2".
Bram Moolenaar9b451252012-08-15 17:43:31 +02008475 *sgr-mouse*
8476 sgr Mouse handling for the terminal that emits SGR-styled
Bram Moolenaare968e362014-05-13 20:23:24 +02008477 mouse reporting. The mouse works even in columns
8478 beyond 223. This option is backward compatible with
8479 "xterm2" because it can also decode "xterm2" style
8480 mouse codes.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008481
8482 The mouse handling must be enabled at compile time |+mouse_xterm|
Bram Moolenaare968e362014-05-13 20:23:24 +02008483 |+mouse_dec| |+mouse_netterm| |+mouse_jsbterm| |+mouse_urxvt|
8484 |+mouse_sgr|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008485 Only "xterm"(2) is really recognized. NetTerm mouse codes are always
8486 recognized, if enabled at compile time. DEC terminal mouse codes
8487 are recognized if enabled at compile time, and 'ttymouse' is not
Bram Moolenaare968e362014-05-13 20:23:24 +02008488 "xterm", "xterm2", "urxvt" or "sgr" (because dec mouse codes conflict
8489 with them).
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008490 This option is automatically set to "xterm", when the 'term' option is
Bram Moolenaar45758762016-10-12 23:08:06 +02008491 set to a name that starts with "xterm", "mlterm", "screen", "tmux",
8492 "st" (full match only), "st-" or "stterm", and 'ttymouse' is not set
8493 already.
Bram Moolenaare968e362014-05-13 20:23:24 +02008494 Additionally, if vim is compiled with the |+termresponse| feature and
8495 |t_RV| is set to the escape sequence to request the xterm version
Bram Moolenaarf8a07122019-07-01 22:06:07 +02008496 number, more intelligent detection is done.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008497 The "xterm2" value will be set if the xterm version is reported to be
Bram Moolenaard47d5222018-12-09 20:43:55 +01008498 from 95 to 276. The "sgr" value will be set if Vim detects Mac
8499 Terminal.app, iTerm2 or mintty, and when the xterm version is 277 or
8500 higher.
Bram Moolenaare968e362014-05-13 20:23:24 +02008501 If you do not want 'ttymouse' to be set to "xterm2" or "sgr"
8502 automatically, set t_RV to an empty string: >
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008503 :set t_RV=
8504<
8505 *'ttyscroll'* *'tsl'*
8506'ttyscroll' 'tsl' number (default 999)
8507 global
8508 Maximum number of lines to scroll the screen. If there are more lines
8509 to scroll the window is redrawn. For terminals where scrolling is
8510 very slow and redrawing is not slow this can be set to a small number,
8511 e.g., 3, to speed up displaying.
8512
8513 *'ttytype'* *'tty'*
8514'ttytype' 'tty' string (default from $TERM)
8515 global
8516 Alias for 'term', see above.
8517
Bram Moolenaar55debbe2010-05-23 23:34:36 +02008518 *'undodir'* *'udir'*
8519'undodir' 'udir' string (default ".")
8520 global
Bram Moolenaardb84e452010-08-15 13:50:43 +02008521 {only when compiled with the |+persistent_undo| feature}
Bram Moolenaar55debbe2010-05-23 23:34:36 +02008522 List of directory names for undo files, separated with commas.
Bram Moolenaarb230bd52010-05-25 21:02:00 +02008523 See |'backupdir'| for details of the format.
Bram Moolenaar6a244fe2010-05-24 22:02:24 +02008524 "." means using the directory of the file. The undo file name for
8525 "file.txt" is ".file.txt.un~".
8526 For other directories the file name is the full path of the edited
8527 file, with path separators replaced with "%".
Bram Moolenaar55debbe2010-05-23 23:34:36 +02008528 When writing: The first directory that exists is used. "." always
8529 works, no directories after "." will be used for writing.
8530 When reading all entries are tried to find an undo file. The first
8531 undo file that exists is used. When it cannot be read an error is
8532 given, no further entry is used.
8533 See |undo-persistence|.
Bram Moolenaar110289e2019-05-23 15:38:06 +02008534 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
8535 security reasons.
Bram Moolenaar55debbe2010-05-23 23:34:36 +02008536
Bram Moolenaar543b7ef2013-06-01 14:50:56 +02008537 *'undofile'* *'noundofile'* *'udf'* *'noudf'*
Bram Moolenaar55debbe2010-05-23 23:34:36 +02008538'undofile' 'udf' boolean (default off)
8539 local to buffer
Bram Moolenaardb84e452010-08-15 13:50:43 +02008540 {only when compiled with the |+persistent_undo| feature}
Bram Moolenaar55debbe2010-05-23 23:34:36 +02008541 When on, Vim automatically saves undo history to an undo file when
8542 writing a buffer to a file, and restores undo history from the same
8543 file on buffer read.
Bram Moolenaarb230bd52010-05-25 21:02:00 +02008544 The directory where the undo file is stored is specified by 'undodir'.
8545 For more information about this feature see |undo-persistence|.
Bram Moolenaar59f931e2010-07-24 20:27:03 +02008546 The undo file is not read when 'undoreload' causes the buffer from
8547 before a reload to be saved for undo.
Bram Moolenaar97d62492012-11-15 21:28:22 +01008548 When 'undofile' is turned off the undo file is NOT deleted.
Bram Moolenaar036986f2017-03-16 17:41:02 +01008549 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
Bram Moolenaar55debbe2010-05-23 23:34:36 +02008550
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008551 *'undolevels'* *'ul'*
Bram Moolenaar8024f932020-01-14 19:29:13 +01008552'undolevels' 'ul' number (default 100, 1000 for Unix, VMS and Win32)
Bram Moolenaarf5a2fd82013-11-06 05:26:15 +01008553 global or local to buffer |global-local|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008554 Maximum number of changes that can be undone. Since undo information
Bram Moolenaar5be4cee2019-09-27 19:34:08 +02008555 is kept in memory, higher numbers will cause more memory to be used.
8556 Nevertheless, a single change can already use a large amount of memory.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008557 Set to 0 for Vi compatibility: One level of undo and "u" undoes
8558 itself: >
8559 set ul=0
8560< But you can also get Vi compatibility by including the 'u' flag in
8561 'cpoptions', and still be able to use CTRL-R to repeat undo.
Bram Moolenaar945e2db2010-06-05 17:43:32 +02008562 Also see |undo-two-ways|.
Bram Moolenaarf5a2fd82013-11-06 05:26:15 +01008563 Set to -1 for no undo at all. You might want to do this only for the
8564 current buffer: >
8565 setlocal ul=-1
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008566< This helps when you run out of memory for a single change.
Bram Moolenaar32efaf62014-11-05 17:02:17 +01008567
8568 The local value is set to -123456 when the global value is to be used.
8569
Bram Moolenaar945e2db2010-06-05 17:43:32 +02008570 Also see |clear-undo|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008571
Bram Moolenaar59f931e2010-07-24 20:27:03 +02008572 *'undoreload'* *'ur'*
8573'undoreload' 'ur' number (default 10000)
8574 global
Bram Moolenaar59f931e2010-07-24 20:27:03 +02008575 Save the whole buffer for undo when reloading it. This applies to the
8576 ":e!" command and reloading for when the buffer changed outside of
8577 Vim. |FileChangedShell|
Bram Moolenaar24a98a02017-09-27 22:23:55 +02008578 The save only happens when this option is negative or when the number
Bram Moolenaar59f931e2010-07-24 20:27:03 +02008579 of lines is smaller than the value of this option.
8580 Set this option to zero to disable undo for a reload.
8581
8582 When saving undo for a reload, any undo file is not read.
8583
8584 Note that this causes the whole buffer to be stored in memory. Set
8585 this option to a lower value if you run out of memory.
8586
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008587 *'updatecount'* *'uc'*
8588'updatecount' 'uc' number (default: 200)
8589 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008590 After typing this many characters the swap file will be written to
8591 disk. When zero, no swap file will be created at all (see chapter on
8592 recovery |crash-recovery|). 'updatecount' is set to zero by starting
8593 Vim with the "-n" option, see |startup|. When editing in readonly
8594 mode this option will be initialized to 10000.
8595 The swapfile can be disabled per buffer with |'swapfile'|.
8596 When 'updatecount' is set from zero to non-zero, swap files are
8597 created for all buffers that have 'swapfile' set. When 'updatecount'
8598 is set to zero, existing swap files are not deleted.
8599 Also see |'swapsync'|.
8600 This option has no meaning in buffers where |'buftype'| is "nofile"
8601 or "nowrite".
8602
8603 *'updatetime'* *'ut'*
8604'updatetime' 'ut' number (default 4000)
8605 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008606 If this many milliseconds nothing is typed the swap file will be
8607 written to disk (see |crash-recovery|). Also used for the
8608 |CursorHold| autocommand event.
8609
Bram Moolenaar04958cb2018-06-23 19:23:02 +02008610 *'varsofttabstop'* *'vsts'*
8611'varsofttabstop' 'vsts' string (default "")
8612 local to buffer
8613 {only available when compiled with the |+vartabs|
8614 feature}
Bram Moolenaar04958cb2018-06-23 19:23:02 +02008615 A list of the number of spaces that a <Tab> counts for while editing,
8616 such as inserting a <Tab> or using <BS>. It "feels" like variable-
8617 width <Tab>s are being inserted, while in fact a mixture of spaces
8618 and <Tab>s is used. Tab widths are separated with commas, with the
8619 final value applying to all subsequent tabs.
8620
8621 For example, when editing assembly language files where statements
Bram Moolenaar6dc819b2018-07-03 16:42:19 +02008622 start in the 9th column and comments in the 41st, it may be useful
Bram Moolenaar04958cb2018-06-23 19:23:02 +02008623 to use the following: >
8624 :set varsofttabstop=8,32,8
Bram Moolenaar6dc819b2018-07-03 16:42:19 +02008625< This will set soft tabstops with 8 and 8 + 32 spaces, and 8 more
8626 for every column thereafter.
Bram Moolenaar04958cb2018-06-23 19:23:02 +02008627
8628 Note that the value of |'softtabstop'| will be ignored while
8629 'varsofttabstop' is set.
8630
8631 *'vartabstop'* *'vts'*
8632'vartabstop' 'vts' string (default "")
8633 local to buffer
8634 {only available when compiled with the |+vartabs|
8635 feature}
Bram Moolenaar04958cb2018-06-23 19:23:02 +02008636 A list of the number of spaces that a <Tab> in the file counts for,
8637 separated by commas. Each value corresponds to one tab, with the
8638 final value applying to all subsequent tabs. For example: >
8639 :set vartabstop=4,20,10,8
8640< This will make the first tab 4 spaces wide, the second 20 spaces,
8641 the third 10 spaces, and all following tabs 8 spaces.
8642
8643 Note that the value of |'tabstop'| will be ignored while 'vartabstop'
8644 is set.
8645
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008646 *'verbose'* *'vbs'*
8647'verbose' 'vbs' number (default 0)
8648 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008649 When bigger than zero, Vim will give messages about what it is doing.
8650 Currently, these messages are given:
8651 >= 1 When the viminfo file is read or written.
8652 >= 2 When a file is ":source"'ed.
Bram Moolenaar647a5302020-05-03 17:01:24 +02008653 >= 4 Shell commands.
Bram Moolenaar87b5ca52006-03-04 21:55:31 +00008654 >= 5 Every searched tags file and include file.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008655 >= 8 Files for which a group of autocommands is executed.
8656 >= 9 Every executed autocommand.
Bram Moolenaar647a5302020-05-03 17:01:24 +02008657 >= 11 Finding items in a path
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008658 >= 12 Every executed function.
8659 >= 13 When an exception is thrown, caught, finished, or discarded.
8660 >= 14 Anything pending in a ":finally" clause.
Bram Moolenaar823654b2020-05-29 23:03:09 +02008661 >= 15 Every executed Ex command from a script (truncated at 200
8662 characters).
Bram Moolenaare7b1ea02020-08-07 19:54:59 +02008663 >= 16 Every executed Ex command.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008664
8665 This option can also be set with the "-V" argument. See |-V|.
8666 This option is also set by the |:verbose| command.
8667
Bram Moolenaar5c06f8b2005-05-31 22:14:58 +00008668 When the 'verbosefile' option is set then the verbose messages are not
8669 displayed.
8670
8671 *'verbosefile'* *'vfile'*
8672'verbosefile' 'vfile' string (default empty)
8673 global
Bram Moolenaar5c06f8b2005-05-31 22:14:58 +00008674 When not empty all messages are written in a file with this name.
8675 When the file exists messages are appended.
8676 Writing to the file ends when Vim exits or when 'verbosefile' is made
Bram Moolenaar80794b12010-06-13 05:20:42 +02008677 empty. Writes are buffered, thus may not show up for some time.
Bram Moolenaar5c06f8b2005-05-31 22:14:58 +00008678 Setting 'verbosefile' to a new value is like making it empty first.
8679 The difference with |:redir| is that verbose messages are not
8680 displayed when 'verbosefile' is set.
8681
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008682 *'viewdir'* *'vdir'*
Bram Moolenaar6f345a12019-12-17 21:27:18 +01008683'viewdir' 'vdir' string (default for Amiga and Win32:
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008684 "$VIM/vimfiles/view",
8685 for Unix: "~/.vim/view",
Bram Moolenaar3d1cde82020-08-15 18:55:18 +02008686 for macOS: "$VIM:vimfiles:view"
Bram Moolenaar5666fcd2019-12-26 14:35:26 +01008687 for VMS: "sys$login:vimfiles/view")
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008688 global
Bram Moolenaardb84e452010-08-15 13:50:43 +02008689 {not available when compiled without the |+mksession|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008690 feature}
8691 Name of the directory where to store files for |:mkview|.
8692 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
8693 security reasons.
8694
8695 *'viewoptions'* *'vop'*
Bram Moolenaar13e90412017-11-11 18:16:48 +01008696'viewoptions' 'vop' string (default: "folds,options,cursor,curdir")
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008697 global
Bram Moolenaardb84e452010-08-15 13:50:43 +02008698 {not available when compiled without the |+mksession|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008699 feature}
Bram Moolenaarcbaff5e2022-04-08 17:45:08 +01008700 Changes the effect of the |:mkview| command. It is a comma-separated
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00008701 list of words. Each word enables saving and restoring something:
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008702 word save and restore ~
8703 cursor cursor position in file and in window
8704 folds manually created folds, opened/closed folds and local
8705 fold options
8706 options options and mappings local to a window or buffer (not
8707 global values for local options)
Bram Moolenaar6e932462014-09-09 18:48:09 +02008708 localoptions same as "options"
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008709 slash backslashes in file names replaced with forward
8710 slashes
8711 unix with Unix end-of-line format (single <NL>), even when
Bram Moolenaar6f345a12019-12-17 21:27:18 +01008712 on MS-Windows
Bram Moolenaar13e90412017-11-11 18:16:48 +01008713 curdir the window-local directory, if set with `:lcd`
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008714
Bram Moolenaar6f345a12019-12-17 21:27:18 +01008715 "slash" and "unix" are useful on MS-Windows when sharing view files
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008716 with Unix. The Unix version of Vim cannot source dos format scripts,
Bram Moolenaar6f345a12019-12-17 21:27:18 +01008717 but the MS-Windows version of Vim can source unix format scripts.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008718
8719 *'viminfo'* *'vi'* *E526* *E527* *E528*
Bram Moolenaar6f345a12019-12-17 21:27:18 +01008720'viminfo' 'vi' string (Vi default: "", Vim default for
8721 MS-Windows: '100,<50,s10,h,rA:,rB:,
Bram Moolenaar8f3f58f2010-01-06 20:52:26 +01008722 for Amiga: '100,<50,s10,h,rdf0:,rdf1:,rdf2:
8723 for others: '100,<50,s10,h)
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008724 global
Bram Moolenaardb84e452010-08-15 13:50:43 +02008725 {not available when compiled without the |+viminfo|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008726 feature}
8727 When non-empty, the viminfo file is read upon startup and written
Bram Moolenaarc4da1132017-07-15 19:39:43 +02008728 when exiting Vim (see |viminfo-file|). Except when 'viminfofile' is
8729 "NONE".
Bram Moolenaarcbaff5e2022-04-08 17:45:08 +01008730 The string should be a comma-separated list of parameters, each
Bram Moolenaarc4da1132017-07-15 19:39:43 +02008731 consisting of a single character identifying the particular parameter,
8732 followed by a number or string which specifies the value of that
8733 parameter. If a particular character is left out, then the default
8734 value is used for that parameter. The following is a list of the
8735 identifying characters and the effect of their value.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008736 CHAR VALUE ~
Bram Moolenaarf1568ec2011-12-14 21:17:39 +01008737 *viminfo-!*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008738 ! When included, save and restore global variables that start
8739 with an uppercase letter, and don't contain a lowercase
8740 letter. Thus "KEEPTHIS and "K_L_M" are stored, but "KeepThis"
Bram Moolenaar680eeca2010-10-20 17:44:42 +02008741 and "_K_L_M" are not. Nested List and Dict items may not be
Bram Moolenaar166af9b2010-11-16 20:34:40 +01008742 read back correctly, you end up with an empty item.
Bram Moolenaarf1568ec2011-12-14 21:17:39 +01008743 *viminfo-quote*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008744 " Maximum number of lines saved for each register. Old name of
8745 the '<' item, with the disadvantage that you need to put a
8746 backslash before the ", otherwise it will be recognized as the
8747 start of a comment!
Bram Moolenaarf1568ec2011-12-14 21:17:39 +01008748 *viminfo-%*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008749 % When included, save and restore the buffer list. If Vim is
8750 started with a file name argument, the buffer list is not
8751 restored. If Vim is started without a file name argument, the
Bram Moolenaard042dc82015-11-24 19:18:36 +01008752 buffer list is restored from the viminfo file. Quickfix
8753 ('buftype'), unlisted ('buflisted'), unnamed and buffers on
8754 removable media (|viminfo-r|) are not saved.
Bram Moolenaar15d0a8c2004-09-06 17:44:46 +00008755 When followed by a number, the number specifies the maximum
8756 number of buffers that are stored. Without a number all
8757 buffers are stored.
Bram Moolenaarf1568ec2011-12-14 21:17:39 +01008758 *viminfo-'*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008759 ' Maximum number of previously edited files for which the marks
8760 are remembered. This parameter must always be included when
8761 'viminfo' is non-empty.
8762 Including this item also means that the |jumplist| and the
8763 |changelist| are stored in the viminfo file.
Bram Moolenaarf1568ec2011-12-14 21:17:39 +01008764 *viminfo-/*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008765 / Maximum number of items in the search pattern history to be
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00008766 saved. If non-zero, then the previous search and substitute
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008767 patterns are also saved. When not included, the value of
8768 'history' is used.
Bram Moolenaarf1568ec2011-12-14 21:17:39 +01008769 *viminfo-:*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008770 : Maximum number of items in the command-line history to be
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00008771 saved. When not included, the value of 'history' is used.
Bram Moolenaarf1568ec2011-12-14 21:17:39 +01008772 *viminfo-<*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008773 < Maximum number of lines saved for each register. If zero then
8774 registers are not saved. When not included, all lines are
8775 saved. '"' is the old name for this item.
8776 Also see the 's' item below: limit specified in Kbyte.
Bram Moolenaarf1568ec2011-12-14 21:17:39 +01008777 *viminfo-@*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008778 @ Maximum number of items in the input-line history to be
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00008779 saved. When not included, the value of 'history' is used.
Bram Moolenaarf1568ec2011-12-14 21:17:39 +01008780 *viminfo-c*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008781 c When included, convert the text in the viminfo file from the
8782 'encoding' used when writing the file to the current
Bram Moolenaar582fd852005-03-28 20:58:01 +00008783 'encoding'. See |viminfo-encoding|.
Bram Moolenaarf1568ec2011-12-14 21:17:39 +01008784 *viminfo-f*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008785 f Whether file marks need to be stored. If zero, file marks ('0
8786 to '9, 'A to 'Z) are not stored. When not present or when
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00008787 non-zero, they are all stored. '0 is used for the current
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008788 cursor position (when exiting or when doing ":wviminfo").
Bram Moolenaarf1568ec2011-12-14 21:17:39 +01008789 *viminfo-h*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008790 h Disable the effect of 'hlsearch' when loading the viminfo
8791 file. When not included, it depends on whether ":nohlsearch"
8792 has been used since the last search command.
Bram Moolenaarf1568ec2011-12-14 21:17:39 +01008793 *viminfo-n*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008794 n Name of the viminfo file. The name must immediately follow
Bram Moolenaarc4da1132017-07-15 19:39:43 +02008795 the 'n'. Must be at the end of the option! If the
8796 'viminfofile' option is set, that file name overrides the one
8797 given here with 'viminfo'. Environment variables are
Bram Moolenaar063b9d12016-07-09 20:21:48 +02008798 expanded when opening the file, not when setting the option.
Bram Moolenaarf1568ec2011-12-14 21:17:39 +01008799 *viminfo-r*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008800 r Removable media. The argument is a string (up to the next
8801 ','). This parameter can be given several times. Each
8802 specifies the start of a path for which no marks will be
Bram Moolenaar5666fcd2019-12-26 14:35:26 +01008803 stored. This is to avoid removable media. For MS-Windows you
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008804 could use "ra:,rb:", for Amiga "rdf0:,rdf1:,rdf2:". You can
8805 also use it for temp files, e.g., for Unix: "r/tmp". Case is
8806 ignored. Maximum length of each 'r' argument is 50
8807 characters.
Bram Moolenaarf1568ec2011-12-14 21:17:39 +01008808 *viminfo-s*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008809 s Maximum size of an item in Kbyte. If zero then registers are
8810 not saved. Currently only applies to registers. The default
8811 "s10" will exclude registers with more than 10 Kbyte of text.
8812 Also see the '<' item above: line count limit.
8813
8814 Example: >
8815 :set viminfo='50,<1000,s100,:0,n~/vim/viminfo
8816<
8817 '50 Marks will be remembered for the last 50 files you
8818 edited.
8819 <1000 Contents of registers (up to 1000 lines each) will be
8820 remembered.
8821 s100 Registers with more than 100 Kbyte text are skipped.
8822 :0 Command-line history will not be saved.
8823 n~/vim/viminfo The name of the file to use is "~/vim/viminfo".
8824 no / Since '/' is not specified, the default will be used,
8825 that is, save all of the search history, and also the
8826 previous search and substitute patterns.
8827 no % The buffer list will not be saved nor read back.
8828 no h 'hlsearch' highlighting will be restored.
8829
8830 When setting 'viminfo' from an empty value you can use |:rviminfo| to
8831 load the contents of the file, this is not done automatically.
8832
8833 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
8834 security reasons.
Bram Moolenaar036986f2017-03-16 17:41:02 +01008835 NOTE: This option is set to the Vim default value when 'compatible'
8836 is reset.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008837
Bram Moolenaarc4da1132017-07-15 19:39:43 +02008838 *'viminfofile'* *'vif'*
8839'viminfofile' 'vif' string (default: "")
8840 global
Bram Moolenaarc4da1132017-07-15 19:39:43 +02008841 {not available when compiled without the |+viminfo|
8842 feature}
8843 When non-empty, overrides the file name used for viminfo.
8844 When equal to "NONE" no viminfo file will be read or written.
8845 This option can be set with the |-i| command line flag. The |--clean|
8846 command line flag sets it to "NONE".
Bram Moolenaar110289e2019-05-23 15:38:06 +02008847 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
8848 security reasons.
Bram Moolenaarc4da1132017-07-15 19:39:43 +02008849
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008850 *'virtualedit'* *'ve'*
8851'virtualedit' 've' string (default "")
Gary Johnson51ad8502021-08-03 18:33:08 +02008852 global or local to window |global-local|
Bram Moolenaarcbaff5e2022-04-08 17:45:08 +01008853 A comma-separated list of these words:
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008854 block Allow virtual editing in Visual block mode.
8855 insert Allow virtual editing in Insert mode.
8856 all Allow virtual editing in all modes.
Bram Moolenaarefd2bf12006-03-16 21:41:35 +00008857 onemore Allow the cursor to move just past the end of the line
Gary Johnson53ba05b2021-07-26 22:19:10 +02008858 none When used as the local value, do not allow virtual
8859 editing even when the global value is set. When used
8860 as the global value, "none" is the same as "".
8861 NONE Alternative spelling of "none".
Bram Moolenaar97b2ad32006-03-18 21:40:56 +00008862
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008863 Virtual editing means that the cursor can be positioned where there is
Bram Moolenaarebcbd022007-05-12 14:28:25 +00008864 no actual character. This can be halfway into a tab or beyond the end
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008865 of the line. Useful for selecting a rectangle in Visual mode and
8866 editing a table.
Bram Moolenaarefd2bf12006-03-16 21:41:35 +00008867 "onemore" is not the same, it will only allow moving the cursor just
8868 after the last character of the line. This makes some commands more
8869 consistent. Previously the cursor was always past the end of the line
8870 if the line was empty. But it is far from Vi compatible. It may also
Bram Moolenaar97b2ad32006-03-18 21:40:56 +00008871 break some plugins or Vim scripts. For example because |l| can move
8872 the cursor after the last character. Use with care!
Bram Moolenaar9ba7e172013-07-17 22:37:26 +02008873 Using the `$` command will move to the last character in the line, not
Bram Moolenaar97b2ad32006-03-18 21:40:56 +00008874 past it. This may actually move the cursor to the left!
Bram Moolenaar9ba7e172013-07-17 22:37:26 +02008875 The `g$` command will move to the end of the screen line.
Bram Moolenaarefd2bf12006-03-16 21:41:35 +00008876 It doesn't make sense to combine "all" with "onemore", but you will
8877 not get a warning for it.
Bram Moolenaar53f7fcc2021-07-28 20:10:16 +02008878 When combined with other words, "none" is ignored.
Bram Moolenaar036986f2017-03-16 17:41:02 +01008879 NOTE: This option is set to "" when 'compatible' is set.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008880
8881 *'visualbell'* *'vb'* *'novisualbell'* *'novb'* *beep*
8882'visualbell' 'vb' boolean (default off)
8883 global
Bram Moolenaar74675a62017-07-15 13:53:23 +02008884 Use a visual bell instead of beeping. The terminal code to display the
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008885 visual bell is given with 't_vb'. When no beep or flash is wanted,
Bram Moolenaar74675a62017-07-15 13:53:23 +02008886 use: >
8887 :set vb t_vb=
8888< If you want a short flash, you can use this on many terminals: >
8889 :set vb t_vb=[?5h$<100>[?5l
8890< Here $<100> specifies the time, you can use a smaller or bigger value
8891 to get a shorter or longer flash.
8892
8893 Note: Vim will limit the bell to once per half a second. This avoids
8894 having to wait for the flashing to finish when there are lots of
8895 bells, e.g. on key repeat. This also happens without 'visualbell'
8896 set.
8897
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008898 In the GUI, 't_vb' defaults to "<Esc>|f", which inverts the display
8899 for 20 msec. If you want to use a different time, use "<Esc>|40f",
8900 where 40 is the time in msec.
Bram Moolenaar74675a62017-07-15 13:53:23 +02008901
8902 Note: When the GUI starts, 't_vb' is reset to its default value. You
8903 might want to set it again in your |gvimrc|.
8904
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008905 Does not work on the Amiga, you always get a screen flash.
8906 Also see 'errorbells'.
8907
8908 *'warn'* *'nowarn'*
8909'warn' boolean (default on)
8910 global
8911 Give a warning message when a shell command is used while the buffer
8912 has been changed.
8913
8914 *'weirdinvert'* *'wiv'* *'noweirdinvert'* *'nowiv'*
8915'weirdinvert' 'wiv' boolean (default off)
8916 global
Bram Moolenaar1d2ba7f2006-02-14 22:29:30 +00008917 This option has the same effect as the 't_xs' terminal option.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008918 It is provided for backwards compatibility with version 4.x.
8919 Setting 'weirdinvert' has the effect of making 't_xs' non-empty, and
8920 vice versa. Has no effect when the GUI is running.
8921
8922 *'whichwrap'* *'ww'*
8923'whichwrap' 'ww' string (Vim default: "b,s", Vi default: "")
8924 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008925 Allow specified keys that move the cursor left/right to move to the
8926 previous/next line when the cursor is on the first/last character in
8927 the line. Concatenate characters to allow this for these keys:
8928 char key mode ~
8929 b <BS> Normal and Visual
8930 s <Space> Normal and Visual
Bram Moolenaar87b5ca52006-03-04 21:55:31 +00008931 h "h" Normal and Visual (not recommended)
8932 l "l" Normal and Visual (not recommended)
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008933 < <Left> Normal and Visual
8934 > <Right> Normal and Visual
8935 ~ "~" Normal
8936 [ <Left> Insert and Replace
8937 ] <Right> Insert and Replace
8938 For example: >
8939 :set ww=<,>,[,]
8940< allows wrap only when cursor keys are used.
8941 When the movement keys are used in combination with a delete or change
8942 operator, the <EOL> also counts for a character. This makes "3h"
8943 different from "3dh" when the cursor crosses the end of a line. This
8944 is also true for "x" and "X", because they do the same as "dl" and
8945 "dh". If you use this, you may also want to use the mapping
8946 ":map <BS> X" to make backspace delete the character in front of the
8947 cursor.
Bram Moolenaar362e1a32006-03-06 23:29:24 +00008948 When 'l' is included and it is used after an operator at the end of a
Bram Moolenaar589edb32019-09-20 14:38:13 +02008949 line (not an empty line) then it will not move to the next line. This
8950 makes "dl", "cl", "yl" etc. work normally.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008951 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
8952 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
8953
8954 *'wildchar'* *'wc'*
8955'wildchar' 'wc' number (Vim default: <Tab>, Vi default: CTRL-E)
8956 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008957 Character you have to type to start wildcard expansion in the
8958 command-line, as specified with 'wildmode'.
Bram Moolenaar446cb832008-06-24 21:56:24 +00008959 More info here: |cmdline-completion|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008960 The character is not recognized when used inside a macro. See
8961 'wildcharm' for that.
Bram Moolenaar34cc7d82021-09-21 20:09:51 +02008962 Some keys will not work, such as CTRL-C, <CR> and Enter.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008963 Although 'wc' is a number option, you can set it to a special key: >
Bram Moolenaar34cc7d82021-09-21 20:09:51 +02008964 :set wc=<Tab>
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008965< NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
8966 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
8967
8968 *'wildcharm'* *'wcm'*
8969'wildcharm' 'wcm' number (default: none (0))
8970 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008971 'wildcharm' works exactly like 'wildchar', except that it is
Bram Moolenaar582fd852005-03-28 20:58:01 +00008972 recognized when used inside a macro. You can find "spare" command-line
8973 keys suitable for this option by looking at |ex-edit-index|. Normally
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008974 you'll never actually type 'wildcharm', just use it in mappings that
8975 automatically invoke completion mode, e.g.: >
8976 :set wcm=<C-Z>
Bram Moolenaar446cb832008-06-24 21:56:24 +00008977 :cnoremap ss so $vim/sessions/*.vim<C-Z>
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008978< Then after typing :ss you can use CTRL-P & CTRL-N.
8979
8980 *'wildignore'* *'wig'*
8981'wildignore' 'wig' string (default "")
8982 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008983 {not available when compiled without the |+wildignore|
8984 feature}
8985 A list of file patterns. A file that matches with one of these
Bram Moolenaar30b65812012-07-12 22:01:11 +02008986 patterns is ignored when expanding |wildcards|, completing file or
8987 directory names, and influences the result of |expand()|, |glob()| and
8988 |globpath()| unless a flag is passed to disable this.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008989 The pattern is used like with |:autocmd|, see |autocmd-patterns|.
8990 Also see 'suffixes'.
8991 Example: >
8992 :set wildignore=*.o,*.obj
8993< The use of |:set+=| and |:set-=| is preferred when adding or removing
8994 a pattern from the list. This avoids problems when a future version
8995 uses another default.
8996
Bram Moolenaar94950a92010-12-02 16:01:29 +01008997
Bram Moolenaar81af9252010-12-10 20:35:50 +01008998 *'wildignorecase'* *'wic'* *'nowildignorecase'* *'nowic'*
Bram Moolenaar94950a92010-12-02 16:01:29 +01008999'wildignorecase' 'wic' boolean (default off)
9000 global
Bram Moolenaar94950a92010-12-02 16:01:29 +01009001 When set case is ignored when completing file names and directories.
Bram Moolenaar71afbfe2013-03-19 16:49:16 +01009002 Has no effect when 'fileignorecase' is set.
Bram Moolenaar94950a92010-12-02 16:01:29 +01009003 Does not apply when the shell is used to expand wildcards, which
9004 happens when there are special characters.
9005
9006
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009007 *'wildmenu'* *'wmnu'* *'nowildmenu'* *'nowmnu'*
Bram Moolenaar8c08b5b2016-07-28 22:24:15 +02009008'wildmenu' 'wmnu' boolean (default off, set in |defaults.vim|)
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009009 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009010 {not available if compiled without the |+wildmenu|
9011 feature}
9012 When 'wildmenu' is on, command-line completion operates in an enhanced
9013 mode. On pressing 'wildchar' (usually <Tab>) to invoke completion,
9014 the possible matches are shown just above the command line, with the
9015 first match highlighted (overwriting the status line, if there is
Yegappan Lakshmanan3908ef52022-02-08 12:08:07 +00009016 one). This is the behavior without "pum" in 'wildoptions.
9017 Keys that show the previous/next match, such as <Tab> or
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009018 CTRL-P/CTRL-N, cause the highlight to move to the appropriate match.
9019 When 'wildmode' is used, "wildmenu" mode is used where "full" is
9020 specified. "longest" and "list" do not start "wildmenu" mode.
Bram Moolenaar26402cb2013-02-20 21:26:00 +01009021 You can check the current mode with |wildmenumode()|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009022 If there are more matches than can fit in the line, a ">" is shown on
9023 the right and/or a "<" is shown on the left. The status line scrolls
9024 as needed.
Yegappan Lakshmanan3908ef52022-02-08 12:08:07 +00009025 When 'wildoptions' contains "pum", then the completion matches are
9026 shown in a popup menu.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009027 The "wildmenu" mode is abandoned when a key is hit that is not used
9028 for selecting a completion.
Yegappan Lakshmanan3908ef52022-02-08 12:08:07 +00009029 While the "wildmenu" is active, not using the popup menu, the
9030 following keys have special meanings:
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009031
9032 <Left> <Right> - select previous/next match (like CTRL-P/CTRL-N)
9033 <Down> - in filename/menu name completion: move into a
9034 subdirectory or submenu.
9035 <CR> - in menu completion, when the cursor is just after a
9036 dot: move into a submenu.
9037 <Up> - in filename/menu name completion: move up into
9038 parent directory or parent menu.
9039
Yegappan Lakshmanan3908ef52022-02-08 12:08:07 +00009040 When using the popup menu for command line completion, the following
9041 keys have special meanings:
9042 <Down> - select next match (like CTRL-N)
9043 <Left> - in filename/menu name completion: move up into
9044 parent directory or parent menu.
9045 <Right> - in filename/menu name completion: move into a
9046 subdirectory or submenu.
9047 <Up> - select previous match (like CTRL-P)
9048 CTRL-E - end completion, go back to what was there before
9049 selecting a match.
9050 CTRL-N - go to the next entry
9051 CTRL-P - go to the previous entry
9052 CTRL-Y - accept the currently selected match and stop
9053 completion.
9054
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009055 This makes the menus accessible from the console |console-menus|.
9056
9057 If you prefer the <Left> and <Right> keys to move the cursor instead
9058 of selecting a different match, use this: >
9059 :cnoremap <Left> <Space><BS><Left>
9060 :cnoremap <Right> <Space><BS><Right>
9061<
9062 The "WildMenu" highlighting is used for displaying the current match
9063 |hl-WildMenu|.
9064
9065 *'wildmode'* *'wim'*
9066'wildmode' 'wim' string (Vim default: "full")
9067 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009068 Completion mode that is used for the character specified with
Bram Moolenaarcbaff5e2022-04-08 17:45:08 +01009069 'wildchar'. It is a comma-separated list of up to four parts. Each
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00009070 part specifies what to do for each consecutive use of 'wildchar'. The
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009071 first part specifies the behavior for the first use of 'wildchar',
9072 The second part for the second use, etc.
Bram Moolenaar130cbfc2021-04-07 21:07:20 +02009073
9074 Each part consists of a colon separated list consisting of the
9075 following possible values:
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009076 "" Complete only the first match.
9077 "full" Complete the next full match. After the last match,
9078 the original string is used and then the first match
Bram Moolenaar130cbfc2021-04-07 21:07:20 +02009079 again. Will also start 'wildmenu' if it is enabled.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009080 "longest" Complete till longest common string. If this doesn't
9081 result in a longer string, use the next part.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009082 "list" When more than one match, list all matches.
Bram Moolenaar130cbfc2021-04-07 21:07:20 +02009083 "lastused" When completing buffer names and more than one buffer
9084 matches, sort buffers by time last used (other than
9085 the current buffer).
9086 When there is only a single match, it is fully completed in all cases.
9087
9088 Examples of useful colon-separated values:
9089 "longest:full" Like "longest", but also start 'wildmenu' if it is
9090 enabled. Will not complete to the next full match.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009091 "list:full" When more than one match, list all matches and
9092 complete first match.
9093 "list:longest" When more than one match, list all matches and
9094 complete till longest common string.
Bram Moolenaar130cbfc2021-04-07 21:07:20 +02009095 "list:lastused" When more than one buffer matches, list all matches
9096 and sort buffers by time last used (other than the
9097 current buffer).
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009098
9099 Examples: >
9100 :set wildmode=full
Bram Moolenaar582fd852005-03-28 20:58:01 +00009101< Complete first full match, next match, etc. (the default) >
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009102 :set wildmode=longest,full
9103< Complete longest common string, then each full match >
9104 :set wildmode=list:full
9105< List all matches and complete each full match >
9106 :set wildmode=list,full
9107< List all matches without completing, then each full match >
9108 :set wildmode=longest,list
9109< Complete longest common string, then list alternatives.
Bram Moolenaar446cb832008-06-24 21:56:24 +00009110 More info here: |cmdline-completion|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009111
Bram Moolenaarb5bf5b82004-12-24 14:35:23 +00009112 *'wildoptions'* *'wop'*
9113'wildoptions' 'wop' string (default "")
9114 global
Bram Moolenaarb5bf5b82004-12-24 14:35:23 +00009115 {not available when compiled without the |+wildignore|
9116 feature}
Yegappan Lakshmanan3908ef52022-02-08 12:08:07 +00009117 A list of words that change how |cmdline-completion| is done.
9118 The following values are supported:
Bram Moolenaar1588bc82022-03-08 21:35:07 +00009119 fuzzy Use |fuzzy-matching| to find completion matches. When
Yegappan Lakshmanan38b85cb2022-02-24 13:28:41 +00009120 this value is specified, wildcard expansion will not
9121 be used for completion. The matches will be sorted by
9122 the "best match" rather than alphabetically sorted.
9123 This will find more matches than the wildcard
9124 expansion. Currently fuzzy matching based completion
9125 is not supported for file and directory names and
9126 instead wildcard expansion is used.
Yegappan Lakshmanan3908ef52022-02-08 12:08:07 +00009127 pum Display the completion matches using the popupmenu
9128 in the same style as the |ins-completion-menu|.
Bram Moolenaarb5bf5b82004-12-24 14:35:23 +00009129 tagfile When using CTRL-D to list matching tags, the kind of
Bram Moolenaarc9b4b052006-04-30 18:54:39 +00009130 tag and the file of the tag is listed. Only one match
Bram Moolenaarb5bf5b82004-12-24 14:35:23 +00009131 is displayed per line. Often used tag kinds are:
9132 d #define
9133 f function
Bram Moolenaarb5bf5b82004-12-24 14:35:23 +00009134
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009135 *'winaltkeys'* *'wak'*
9136'winaltkeys' 'wak' string (default "menu")
9137 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009138 {only used in Win32, Motif, GTK and Photon GUI}
9139 Some GUI versions allow the access to menu entries by using the ALT
9140 key in combination with a character that appears underlined in the
9141 menu. This conflicts with the use of the ALT key for mappings and
9142 entering special characters. This option tells what to do:
9143 no Don't use ALT keys for menus. ALT key combinations can be
9144 mapped, but there is no automatic handling. This can then be
9145 done with the |:simalt| command.
9146 yes ALT key handling is done by the windowing system. ALT key
9147 combinations cannot be mapped.
9148 menu Using ALT in combination with a character that is a menu
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00009149 shortcut key, will be handled by the windowing system. Other
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009150 keys can be mapped.
9151 If the menu is disabled by excluding 'm' from 'guioptions', the ALT
9152 key is never used for the menu.
Bram Moolenaar293ee4d2004-12-09 21:34:53 +00009153 This option is not used for <F10>; on Win32 and with GTK <F10> will
9154 select the menu, unless it has been mapped.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009155
Bram Moolenaar4d784b22019-05-25 19:51:39 +02009156 *'wincolor'* *'wcr'*
9157'wincolor' 'wcr' string (default empty)
9158 local to window
9159 Highlight group name to use for this window instead of the Normal
9160 color |hl-Normal|.
9161
Bram Moolenaar4399ef42005-02-12 14:29:27 +00009162 *'window'* *'wi'*
9163'window' 'wi' number (default screen height - 1)
9164 global
Bram Moolenaardad44732021-03-31 20:07:33 +02009165 Window height used for |CTRL-F| and |CTRL-B| when there is only one
9166 window and the value is smaller than 'lines' minus one. The screen
9167 will scroll 'window' minus two lines, with a minimum of one.
Bram Moolenaar4399ef42005-02-12 14:29:27 +00009168 When 'window' is equal to 'lines' minus one CTRL-F and CTRL-B scroll
9169 in a much smarter way, taking care of wrapping lines.
9170 When resizing the Vim window, the value is smaller than 1 or more than
9171 or equal to 'lines' it will be set to 'lines' minus 1.
Bram Moolenaardad44732021-03-31 20:07:33 +02009172 Note: Do not confuse this with the height of the Vim window, use
9173 'lines' for that.
Bram Moolenaar4399ef42005-02-12 14:29:27 +00009174
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009175 *'winheight'* *'wh'* *E591*
9176'winheight' 'wh' number (default 1)
9177 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009178 Minimal number of lines for the current window. This is not a hard
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00009179 minimum, Vim will use fewer lines if there is not enough room. If the
Bram Moolenaar446cb832008-06-24 21:56:24 +00009180 focus goes to a window that is smaller, its size is increased, at the
9181 cost of the height of other windows.
9182 Set 'winheight' to a small number for normal editing.
9183 Set it to 999 to make the current window fill most of the screen.
9184 Other windows will be only 'winminheight' high. This has the drawback
9185 that ":all" will create only two windows. To avoid "vim -o 1 2 3 4"
9186 to create only two windows, set the option after startup is done,
9187 using the |VimEnter| event: >
9188 au VimEnter * set winheight=999
9189< Minimum value is 1.
9190 The height is not adjusted after one of the commands that change the
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009191 height of the current window.
9192 'winheight' applies to the current window. Use 'winminheight' to set
9193 the minimal height for other windows.
9194
9195 *'winfixheight'* *'wfh'* *'nowinfixheight'* *'nowfh'*
9196'winfixheight' 'wfh' boolean (default off)
9197 local to window
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009198 Keep the window height when windows are opened or closed and
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00009199 'equalalways' is set. Also for |CTRL-W_=|. Set by default for the
9200 |preview-window| and |quickfix-window|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009201 The height may be changed anyway when running out of room.
9202
Bram Moolenaar97b2ad32006-03-18 21:40:56 +00009203 *'winfixwidth'* *'wfw'* *'nowinfixwidth'* *'nowfw'*
9204'winfixwidth' 'wfw' boolean (default off)
9205 local to window
Bram Moolenaar97b2ad32006-03-18 21:40:56 +00009206 Keep the window width when windows are opened or closed and
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00009207 'equalalways' is set. Also for |CTRL-W_=|.
Bram Moolenaar97b2ad32006-03-18 21:40:56 +00009208 The width may be changed anyway when running out of room.
9209
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009210 *'winminheight'* *'wmh'*
9211'winminheight' 'wmh' number (default 1)
9212 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009213 The minimal height of a window, when it's not the current window.
9214 This is a hard minimum, windows will never become smaller.
9215 When set to zero, windows may be "squashed" to zero lines (i.e. just a
9216 status bar) if necessary. They will return to at least one line when
9217 they become active (since the cursor has to have somewhere to go.)
9218 Use 'winheight' to set the minimal height of the current window.
9219 This option is only checked when making a window smaller. Don't use a
9220 large number, it will cause errors when opening more than a few
9221 windows. A value of 0 to 3 is reasonable.
9222
9223 *'winminwidth'* *'wmw'*
9224'winminwidth' 'wmw' number (default 1)
9225 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009226 The minimal width of a window, when it's not the current window.
9227 This is a hard minimum, windows will never become smaller.
9228 When set to zero, windows may be "squashed" to zero columns (i.e. just
9229 a vertical separator) if necessary. They will return to at least one
9230 line when they become active (since the cursor has to have somewhere
9231 to go.)
9232 Use 'winwidth' to set the minimal width of the current window.
9233 This option is only checked when making a window smaller. Don't use a
9234 large number, it will cause errors when opening more than a few
9235 windows. A value of 0 to 12 is reasonable.
9236
Bram Moolenaar9e13aa72017-08-16 23:14:08 +02009237 *'winptydll'*
9238'winptydll' string (default "winpty32.dll" or "winpty64.dll")
9239 global
Bram Moolenaar9e13aa72017-08-16 23:14:08 +02009240 {only available when compiled with the |terminal|
9241 feature on MS-Windows}
9242 Specifies the name of the winpty shared library, used for the
Bram Moolenaare7b1ea02020-08-07 19:54:59 +02009243 |:terminal| command. The default depends on whether Vim was built as a
Bram Moolenaarc572da52017-08-27 16:52:01 +02009244 32-bit or 64-bit executable. If not found, "winpty.dll" is tried as
Bram Moolenaar9e13aa72017-08-16 23:14:08 +02009245 a fallback.
9246 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|.
9247 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
9248 security reasons.
9249
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009250 *'winwidth'* *'wiw'* *E592*
9251'winwidth' 'wiw' number (default 20)
9252 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009253 Minimal number of columns for the current window. This is not a hard
9254 minimum, Vim will use fewer columns if there is not enough room. If
9255 the current window is smaller, its size is increased, at the cost of
9256 the width of other windows. Set it to 999 to make the current window
9257 always fill the screen. Set it to a small number for normal editing.
9258 The width is not adjusted after one of the commands to change the
9259 width of the current window.
9260 'winwidth' applies to the current window. Use 'winminwidth' to set
9261 the minimal width for other windows.
9262
9263 *'wrap'* *'nowrap'*
9264'wrap' boolean (default on)
9265 local to window
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009266 This option changes how text is displayed. It doesn't change the text
9267 in the buffer, see 'textwidth' for that.
9268 When on, lines longer than the width of the window will wrap and
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00009269 displaying continues on the next line. When off lines will not wrap
9270 and only part of long lines will be displayed. When the cursor is
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009271 moved to a part that is not shown, the screen will scroll
9272 horizontally.
9273 The line will be broken in the middle of a word if necessary. See
9274 'linebreak' to get the break at a word boundary.
9275 To make scrolling horizontally a bit more useful, try this: >
9276 :set sidescroll=5
9277 :set listchars+=precedes:<,extends:>
9278< See 'sidescroll', 'listchars' and |wrap-off|.
Bram Moolenaar8f3f58f2010-01-06 20:52:26 +01009279 This option can't be set from a |modeline| when the 'diff' option is
9280 on.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009281
9282 *'wrapmargin'* *'wm'*
9283'wrapmargin' 'wm' number (default 0)
9284 local to buffer
9285 Number of characters from the right window border where wrapping
9286 starts. When typing text beyond this limit, an <EOL> will be inserted
9287 and inserting continues on the next line.
9288 Options that add a margin, such as 'number' and 'foldcolumn', cause
9289 the text width to be further reduced. This is Vi compatible.
9290 When 'textwidth' is non-zero, this option is not used.
Bram Moolenaarca635012015-09-25 20:34:21 +02009291 This option is set to 0 when 'paste' is set and restored when 'paste'
9292 is reset.
Bram Moolenaara6c27c42019-05-09 19:16:22 +02009293 See also 'formatoptions' and |ins-textwidth|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009294
9295 *'wrapscan'* *'ws'* *'nowrapscan'* *'nows'*
9296'wrapscan' 'ws' boolean (default on) *E384* *E385*
9297 global
Bram Moolenaarac6e65f2005-08-29 22:25:38 +00009298 Searches wrap around the end of the file. Also applies to |]s| and
9299 |[s|, searching for spelling mistakes.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009300
9301 *'write'* *'nowrite'*
9302'write' boolean (default on)
9303 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009304 Allows writing files. When not set, writing a file is not allowed.
9305 Can be used for a view-only mode, where modifications to the text are
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00009306 still allowed. Can be reset with the |-m| or |-M| command line
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009307 argument. Filtering text is still possible, even though this requires
9308 writing a temporary file.
9309
9310 *'writeany'* *'wa'* *'nowriteany'* *'nowa'*
9311'writeany' 'wa' boolean (default off)
9312 global
9313 Allows writing to any file with no need for "!" override.
9314
9315 *'writebackup'* *'wb'* *'nowritebackup'* *'nowb'*
9316'writebackup' 'wb' boolean (default on with |+writebackup| feature, off
9317 otherwise)
9318 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009319 Make a backup before overwriting a file. The backup is removed after
9320 the file was successfully written, unless the 'backup' option is
Bram Moolenaar1aeaf8c2012-05-18 13:46:39 +02009321 also on.
9322 WARNING: Switching this option off means that when Vim fails to write
9323 your buffer correctly and then, for whatever reason, Vim exits, you
9324 lose both the original file and what you were writing. Only reset
9325 this option if your file system is almost full and it makes the write
9326 fail (and make sure not to exit Vim until the write was successful).
9327 See |backup-table| for another explanation.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009328 When the 'backupskip' pattern matches, a backup is not made anyway.
Bram Moolenaar0c0734d2019-11-26 21:44:46 +01009329 Depending on 'backupcopy' the backup is a new file or the original
9330 file renamed (and a new file is written).
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009331 NOTE: This option is set to the default value when 'compatible' is
9332 set.
9333
9334 *'writedelay'* *'wd'*
9335'writedelay' 'wd' number (default 0)
9336 global
Bram Moolenaar802a0d92016-06-26 16:17:58 +02009337 The number of milliseconds to wait for each character sent to the
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009338 screen. When non-zero, characters are sent to the terminal one by
Bram Moolenaar5666fcd2019-12-26 14:35:26 +01009339 one. For debugging purposes.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009340
Bram Moolenaar6f79e612021-12-21 09:12:23 +00009341 *'xtermcodes'* *'noxtermcodes'*
9342'xtermcodes' boolean (default on)
9343 global
9344 When detecting xterm patchlevel 141 or higher with the termresponse
Bram Moolenaarfa3b7232021-12-24 13:18:38 +00009345 mechanism and this option is set, Vim will request the actual terminal
Bram Moolenaar6f79e612021-12-21 09:12:23 +00009346 key codes and number of colors from the terminal. This takes care of
9347 various configuration options of the terminal that cannot be obtained
9348 from the termlib/terminfo entry, see |xterm-codes|.
9349 A side effect may be that t_Co changes and Vim will redraw the
9350 display.
9351
9352
Bram Moolenaar91f84f62018-07-29 15:07:52 +02009353 vim:tw=78:ts=8:noet:ft=help:norl: